Chevrolet Automobile 2010 HHR User Manual

2010 Chevrolet HHR Owner Manual M  
In Brief . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-1  
Object Detection Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-44  
Storage Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-52  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2  
Initial Drive Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
Vehicle Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15  
Performance and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-1  
Instrument Panel Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
Audio System(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-60  
Seats and Restraint System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-1  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11  
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14  
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35  
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-60  
Restraint System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-78  
Driving Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-1  
Your Driving, the Road, and the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-29  
Service and Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-1  
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Checking Things Under the Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14  
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-45  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . 6-53  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-54  
Features and Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-1  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3  
Doors and Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16  
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Starting and Operating Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22  
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Canadian Owners  
Propriétaires Canadiens  
A French language copy of this manual can be obtained  
from your dealer/retailer or from:  
On peut obtenir un exemplaire de ce guide en français  
auprès du concessionnaire ou à l'adresse suivante:  
GENERAL MOTORS, GM, the GM Emblem,  
CHEVROLET, the CHEVROLET Emblem, and  
the name HHR are registered trademarks of  
General Motors.  
Helm, Incorporated  
P.O. Box 07130  
Detroit, MI 48207  
1-800-551-4123  
This manual describes features that may or may  
not be on your specific vehicle either because they are  
options that you did not purchase or due to changes  
subsequent to the printing of this owner manual. Please  
refer to the purchase documentation relating to your  
specific vehicle to confirm each of the features found  
on your vehicle. For vehicles first sold in Canada,  
substitute the name General Motors of Canada  
Limitedfor Chevrolet Motor Division wherever it  
appears in this manual.  
Numéro de poste 6438 de langue française  
www.helminc.com  
Index  
To quickly locate information about the vehicle, use the  
index in the back of the manual. It is an alphabetical list  
of what is in the manual and the page number where it  
can be found.  
Keep this manual in the vehicle for quick reference.  
Litho in U.S.A.  
Part No. 25901250 B Second Printing  
©2009 General Motors. All Rights Reserved.  
iii  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A circle with a slash  
through it is a safety  
symbol which means Do  
Not,” “Do not do this,or  
Do not let this happen.”  
Safety Warnings and Symbols  
Warning messages found on vehicle labels and in this  
manual describe hazards and what to do to avoid or  
reduce them.  
Danger indicates a hazard with a high level of risk  
which will result in serious injury or death.  
Warning or Caution indicates a hazard that could  
result in injury or death.  
Vehicle Symbols  
The vehicle has components and labels that use  
symbols instead of text. Symbols are shown along with  
the text describing the operation or information relating  
to a specific component, control, message, gauge,  
or indicator.  
WARNING:  
{
These mean there is something that could hurt  
you or other people.  
M : This symbol is shown when you need to see your  
owner manual for additional instructions or information.  
Notice: This means there is something that could  
result in property or vehicle damage. This would  
not be covered by the vehicle's warranty.  
* : This symbol is shown when you need to see a  
service manual for additional instructions or information.  
iv  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Symbol Chart  
. : Fuel Gauge  
Here are some additional symbols that may be found on  
the vehicle and what they mean. For more information  
on the symbol, refer to the index.  
+ : Fuses  
i : Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer  
j : LATCH System Child Restraints  
* : Malfunction Indicator Lamp  
: : Oil Pressure  
9 : Airbag Readiness Light  
# : Air Conditioning  
! : Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
g : Audio Steering Wheel Controls or OnStar®  
$ : Brake System Warning Light  
" : Charging System  
I : Cruise Control  
B : Engine Coolant Temperature  
O : Exterior Lamps  
} : Power  
/ : Remote Vehicle Start  
> : Safety Belt Reminders  
7 : Tire Pressure Monitor  
F : Traction Control  
M : Windshield Washer Fluid  
# : Fog Lamps  
v
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
vi  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 1 In Brief  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-2  
Vehicle Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15  
Radio(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-15  
Satellite Radio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16  
Portable Audio Devices  
(Auxiliary Input or USB Port) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-16  
Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17  
Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-17  
Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-18  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19  
Storage Compartments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-19  
Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-20  
Initial Drive Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-4  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5  
Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-5  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6  
Seat Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-6  
Second Row Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-8  
Heated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9  
Head Restraint Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9  
Safety Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-9  
Sensing System for Passenger Airbag . . . . . . . . . 1-10  
Mirror Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-10  
Steering Wheel Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-11  
Interior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12  
Exterior Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-12  
Windshield Wiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-13  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Performance and Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21  
Traction Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-21  
Tire Pressure Monitor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-22  
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23  
Fuel E85 (85% Ethanol) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-23  
Driving for Better Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24  
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24  
Roadside Assistance Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24  
OnStar® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25  
1-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel  
1-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Outlet Adjustment on page 421.  
L. Horn on page 43.  
B. Cruise Control on page 48 (If Equipped).  
C. Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever on page 44.  
D. Instrument Panel Cluster on page 424.  
M. Audio Steering Wheel Controls on page 492  
(If Equipped).  
N. Instrument Panel Brightness on page 414.  
O. Audio System(s) on page 460.  
E. Windshield Wipers on page 45 and Windshield  
Washer on page 46.  
P. Climate Control System on page 418.  
Q. Rear Window Wiper/Washer on page 47.  
F. Instrument Panel Storage on page 347.  
G. Traction Control System (TCS) on page 59  
(If Equipped). Electronic Stability Control (ESC).  
See Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on  
R. Shift Lever (Manual Shown). See Manual  
Transmission Operation on page 331 and  
Automatic Transmission Operation on page 328.  
page 56  
.
S. Accessory Power Outlet(s). on page 416  
(If Equipped) and Cigarette Lighter (If Equipped).  
See Ashtray(s) and Cigarette Lighter on  
H. Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 428.  
I. Rear Side Cargo Door on page 312  
page 418  
.
(If Equipped).  
T. Fog Lamps on page 413 (If Equipped).  
U. Hazard Warning Flashers on page 43.  
V. Glove Box on page 347.  
J. Hood Release on page 615.  
K. Driver Information Center (DIC) Buttons. See  
Driver Information Center (DIC) on page 446  
Buttons.  
1-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Initial Drive Information  
Press Q to lock all doors.  
This section provides a brief overview about some of  
the important features that may or may not be on your  
specific vehicle.  
Lock and unlock feedback can be personalized.  
Press and hold * or + for approximately  
one second to open the rear driver or passenger  
side door.  
For more detailed information, refer to each of the  
features which can be found later in this owner manual.  
Press L and release to locate the vehicle.  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
The RKE transmitter is used to remotely lock and  
unlock the doors from up to 18 m (60 feet) away from  
the vehicle.  
Press L and hold for three seconds to sound the panic  
alarm.  
Press L again to cancel the panic alarm.  
See Keys on page 33 and Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) System Operation on page 34.  
Press K to unlock  
the driver door.  
Press K again within  
five seconds to unlock all  
remaining doors.  
Remote Vehicle Start  
With this feature the engine can be started from outside  
of the vehicle.  
Starting the Vehicle  
1. Aim the RKE transmitter at the vehicle.  
2. Press Q .  
3. Immediately after completing Step 2, press and  
hold / until the turn signal lamps flash.  
1-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the vehicle starts, the parking lamps will turn on  
and remain on as long as the engine is running. The  
doors will be locked and the climate control system may  
come on.  
The power door lock  
switches are on the front  
doors.  
The engine will continue to run for 10 minutes. Repeat  
the steps for a 10-minute time extension. Remote start  
can be extended only once.  
Canceling a Remote Start  
To cancel a remote start:  
.
Aim the RKE transmitter at the vehicle and press  
Power Door Locks  
and hold / until the parking lamps turn off.  
Press the top or bottom of the switch to unlock or lock  
the doors.  
.
Turn on the hazard warning flashers.  
.
Turn the ignition on and then back off.  
For more information see Power Door Locks on  
See Remote Vehicle Start on page 37.  
page 310  
.
Door Locks  
From outside the vehicle, unlock the door using either  
the key or the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.  
Liftgate  
Open the liftgate by pressing the touchpad located in  
the handle above the license plate. Once slightly  
opened, the liftgate will rise by itself.  
From inside, use the manual lock knobs located at the  
top of the door panel near the window.  
See Liftgate on page 313 for more information.  
See Door Locks on page 39.  
1-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows  
Seat Adjustment  
Manual Seats  
1. Lift the bar under the  
seat to unlock the seat.  
2. Slide the seat to the  
desired position and  
release the bar.  
On vehicles with power windows, the switches are on  
each of the side doors. The driver door also has  
switches that control the passenger and rear windows.  
Press the front of the switch to lower the window.  
Pull the switch up to raise it.  
Try to move the seat to be sure it is locked in place.  
See Manual Seats on page 24.  
For more information, see Power Windows on  
page 317  
.
1-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Seats  
Reclining Seatbacks  
1. Lift the lever to release the seatback.  
Move the seat forward or rearward by moving the  
control forward or rearward.  
2. Move the seatback to where you want it and  
release the lever.  
Raise or lower the front of the seat, or the entire seat,  
by moving the front or rear of the control up or down.  
3. Press rearward on the seatback to be sure it is  
locked in place.  
See Power Seat on page 25.  
See Reclining Seatbacks on page 27.  
1-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Second Row Seats  
Power Lumbar  
Press the front or rear of the control to increase or  
decrease lumbar support.  
The seatbacks can be folded flat.  
See Power Lumbar on page 26.  
For detailed instructions for lowering the seatback(s),  
see Split Folding Rear Seat on page 211.  
1-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Heated Seats  
Safety Belt  
On vehicles with this feature, the controls are located  
on the climate control panel.  
Press the button to turn the heated seat on to the high  
setting, a second time to go to the low setting, and a  
third to turn it off.  
Refer to the following sections for important information  
on how to use safety belts properly.  
.
Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone on page 214.  
See Heated Seats on page 26 for more information.  
.
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly on page 219.  
Head Restraint Adjustment  
.
Lap-Shoulder Belt on page 228.  
Do not drive until the head restraints for all occupants  
are installed and adjusted properly.  
.
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH)  
on page 245  
.
For more information see Head Restraints on  
page 22  
.
1-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sensing System for Passenger  
Airbag  
The passenger sensing system, if equipped, will turn off  
the right front passenger frontal airbag under certain  
conditions. The driver airbags and roofrail airbags are  
not affected by this.  
Mirror Adjustment  
Exterior Mirrors  
Controls for the outside  
power mirrors are located  
on the driver door  
armrest.  
If the vehicle has a passenger sensing system, the  
passenger airbag status indicator will be visible on the  
instrument panel when the vehicle is started.  
1. Press the left or right side of the selector, located  
beneath the control pad, to adjust the driver or  
passenger mirror.  
United States  
Canada  
2. Press the control pad to move the mirror to the  
desired direction.  
See Passenger Sensing System on page 270 for  
important information.  
Manually fold the mirrors inward to prevent damage  
when going through an automatic car wash. To fold, pull  
the mirror toward the vehicle. Push the mirror outward,  
to return to its original position.  
1-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Interior Mirror  
Steering Wheel Adjustment  
Vehicles with a manual rearview mirror can be adjusted  
by holding the mirror in the center to move it for a  
clearer view behind the vehicle. To avoid glare from the  
headlamps behind you, push the tab, located at the  
base of the mirror, toward you for daytime use and pull  
it for nighttime use.  
Vehicles with an automatic dimming rearview mirror will  
automatically reduce the glare from the headlamps of  
the vehicle behind. The dimming feature comes on and  
the indicator light illuminates each time the ignition is  
turned to start.  
See Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror on page 341.  
The adjustment lever is located on the left side of the  
steering column.  
1. Pull the lever down to adjust the steering wheel.  
2. Move the steering wheel up or down into a  
comfortable position.  
3. Pull the lever up to lock the steering wheel in  
place.  
See Tilt Wheel on page 43.  
1-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Interior Lighting  
Exterior Lighting  
Dome Lamps  
The front and rear dome lamps turn on when any  
door is opened. To turn on all dome lamps with the  
doors closed, turn the instrument panel brightness  
thumbwheel located to the right of the steering wheel  
and above the radio, completely to the right.  
Reading Lamps  
There are reading lamps located on the front and rear  
dome lamps.  
To turn the front reading lamps on or off, press the lamp  
lens. To turn the rear reading lamps on or off, press the  
button next to the lamp.  
The lever is on the left side of the steering column.  
2: Turns on the headlamps, parking lamps, and  
taillamps.  
For more information, see:  
.
;: Turns on the parking lamps and taillamps only.  
Instrument Panel Brightness on page 414.  
.
Entry/Exit Lighting on page 414.  
AUTO: Automatically turns on the Daytime Running  
Lamps during daytime, and the headlamps, parking  
lamps, and taillamps at night.  
1-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
P: This position is the momentary Off/On switch for the  
Automatic Headlamp System. In Canada, this only  
works when the vehicles with an automatic transmission  
are in P (Park) and vehicles with a manual transmission  
have the parking brake set and the vehicle is not  
moving.  
Windshield Wiper/Washer  
For more information, see:  
.
Headlamps on page 411.  
.
Fog Lamps on page 413.  
.
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) on page 412.  
.
Automatic Headlamp System on page 412.  
The windshield wiper lever is on the right side of the  
steering wheel.  
1 (High Speed): Fast wipes.  
6 (Low Speed): Slow wipes.  
& (Delay): Sets a delay between wipes.  
1-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6 (Delay/Intermittent Speed Sensitive): When the  
lever is in the delay position, turn the band up for more  
frequent wipes or down for less frequent wipes.  
Climate Controls  
The heating, cooling, and ventilation for the vehicle can  
be controlled with this system.  
During intermittent wiping mode, the delay cycle time  
is sensitive to vehicle speed. As the vehicle speed  
increases the delay cycle time decreases and wiper  
movement occurs more frequently.  
9 (Off): Turns the windshield wipers off.  
8 (Mist): Single wipe, move the lever to z and then  
release it. Several wipes, hold lever on z longer.  
Windshield Washer: Press the button at the end of the  
lever until the washers begin.  
See Windshield Wipers on page 45 Windshield  
Wipers and Windshield Washer on page 46  
Windshield Washer .  
A. Temperature  
Control  
D. Air Conditioning  
E. Outside Air  
B. Fan Control  
F. Air Recirculation  
C. Air Delivery Mode  
Control  
G. Rear Window  
Defogger  
See Climate Control System on page 418.  
1-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4 : For vehicles with XM, MP3, WMA, or RDS features,  
press to display additional text information related to  
the current FM-RDS or XM station; or CD, MP3, WMA  
song. Song title information will be displayed on the top  
line of the display while the artist information will be  
displayed on the bottom line, if the information is  
available during XM, CD, MP3, or WMA playback.  
When information is not available, "No Info" displays.  
Vehicle Features  
Radio(s)  
For more information about these and other radio  
features, see Audio System(s) on page 460 and  
Radio(s) on page 462.  
Storing a Favorite Station  
Depending on which radio the vehicle has, radio  
stations are stored as either favorites or presets.  
For radios with a FAV button, a maximum of 36 stations  
can be stored as favorites using the six softkeys located  
below the radio station frequency tabs and by using the  
radio FAV button. Press FAV to go through up to six  
pages of favorites, each having six favorite stations  
available per page. Each page of favorites can contain  
any combination of AM, FM, or XMstations.  
Radio with CD (MP3) and USB Port shown  
O : Press to turn the system on and off. Turn to  
increase or decrease the volume.  
BAND: Press to choose between FM, AM, or XM,  
if equipped.  
For radios without a FAV button, up to 18 stations  
(six FM1, six FM2, and six AM), can be programmed  
on the six numbered buttons.  
f : Select radio stations.  
© ¨ : Seek or scan stations.  
See Radio(s) on page 462.  
1-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting the Clock  
Satellite Radio  
To set the time and date for the Radio with CD (MP3)  
and USB port or Radio with a Single CD (MP3) player:  
XM is a satellite radio service that is based in the  
48 contiguous United States and 10 Canadian  
provinces. XM satellite radio has a wide variety of  
programming and commercial-free music,  
1. Turn the ignition key to ACC/ACCESSORY or  
ON/RUN.  
coast-to-coast, and in digital-quality sound.  
2. Press O to turn the radio on.  
A fee is required to receive the XM service.  
For more information, refer to:  
3. Press H and the HR, MIN, MM, DD, YYYY  
(hour, minute, month, day, and year) displays.  
.
www.xmradio.com or call 1-800-929-2100 (U.S.)  
4. Press the softkey located below any one of the  
tabs that you want to change.  
.
www.xmradio.ca or call 1-877-438-9677 (Canada)  
See XM Satellite Radio Serviceunder Radio(s) on  
5. Increase or decrease the time or date by  
page 462  
.
turning f clockwise or counterclockwise.  
For detailed instructions on setting the clock for your  
specific audio system, see Setting the Clock on  
Portable Audio Devices (Auxiliary  
Input or USB Port)  
page 461  
.
This vehicle may have an auxiliary input jack and a  
USB port, located on the audio faceplate. External  
devices such as iPods®, laptop computers, MP3  
players, CD changers, USB storage devices, etc. can  
be connected to the auxiliary input jack using a 3.5 mm  
(1/8 in) cable or the USB port depending on the audio  
system.  
1-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press the CD/AUX button to play audio from the  
portable player.  
b g : Press to silence the vehicle speakers only. Press  
again to turn the sound on. Press and hold longer than  
two seconds to interact with the OnStar® or Bluetooth  
systems.  
See Using the Auxiliary Input Jackand Using the  
USB Portunder Radio(s) on page 462.  
c : Press to reject an incoming call, or to end a call.  
For more information, see Audio Steering Wheel  
Controls on page 492.  
Steering Wheel Controls  
If equipped, some audio  
controls can be adjusted  
using the controls on the  
right side of the steering  
wheel.  
Bluetooth®  
For vehicles with an in-vehicle Bluetooth system, it  
allows users with a Bluetooth enabled cell phone to  
make and receive hands-free calls using the vehicles  
audio system and controls.  
The Bluetooth enabled cell phone must be paired with  
the in-vehicle Bluetooth system before it can be used in  
the vehicle. Not all phones will support all functions. For  
more information visit www.gm.com/bluetooth.  
For more information, see Bluetooth® on page 482.  
e + / e : Increases or decreases volume.  
w / x : Press to change radio stations, select tracks  
on a CD, or to select tracks and navigate folders on an  
iPod® or USB device.  
1-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle Personalization  
Driver Information Center (DIC)  
Some vehicle features can be programmed by using the  
DIC buttons on the left side of the steering wheel.  
These features include:  
The DIC display is located at the bottom of the  
instrument panel cluster. It shows the status of  
many vehicle systems and enables access to the  
personalization menu.  
.
Oil Life Reset  
.
The DIC buttons are  
located on the left side  
of the steering wheel.  
Units  
.
RKE Lock and Unlock Feedback  
.
Door Lock and Unlock Settings  
.
Language  
See DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 454.  
INFO: Press to scroll through the vehicle information  
displays.  
r : Press to reset some vehicle information displays,  
select a personalization setting, or acknowledge a  
warning message.  
For more information, see Driver Information Center  
(DIC) on page 446.  
1-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cruise Control  
Storage Compartments  
Vehicles with a panel/cargo cover feature can be  
adjusted into four positions.  
The cruise control buttons  
are located on the left  
side of the steering wheel.  
J: On/Off.  
RES+: Press to resume or accelerate speed.  
SET: Press to set or decrease speed.  
For more information, see Cruise Control on page 48.  
Place the panel lower position for additional cargo  
space above it.  
1-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Outlets  
Accessory power outlets can be used to connect  
electrical equipment, such as a cellular phone.  
There are two accessory power outlets located on the  
instrument panel below the climate controls and at the  
rear of the center console. There may be another outlet  
in the rear cargo area on the passenger side.  
To use the outlet, remove the cover.  
See Accessory Power Outlet(s) on page 416 and  
Ashtray(s) and Cigarette Lighter on page 418.  
Place the panel in the upper position to conceal the  
cargo area.  
There is also a center position and a sideways position  
that allows access to the rear cargo area.  
For more information, see Rear Compartment Storage  
Panel/Cover on page 348.  
1-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)  
Performance and Maintenance  
The Electronic Stability Control system assists with  
directional control of the vehicle in difficult driving  
conditions. The system turns on automatically every  
time the vehicle is started.  
Traction Control System (TCS)  
The traction control system limits wheel spin. The  
system turns on automatically every time the vehicle is  
started.  
.
To turn off both traction control and Electronic  
Stability Control, press and hold d until F  
illuminates and the appropriate DIC message  
displays. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
.
To turn off traction control, press and release d on  
the instrument panel. F illuminates and the  
appropriate DIC message displays. See DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 448.  
page 448  
.
.
Press and release the button again to turn on both  
systems.  
.
Press and release the button again to turn on  
traction control.  
For more information, see Electronic Stability Control  
(ESC) on page 56.  
For more information, see Traction Control System  
(TCS) on page 59.  
1-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
You may notice during cooler conditions that the low tire  
pressure warning light will appear when the vehicle is  
first started and then turn off as you drive. This may be  
an early indicator that your tire pressures are getting  
low and the tires need to be inflated to the proper  
pressure.  
Tire Pressure Monitor  
This vehicle may have a Tire Pressure Monitor  
System (TPMS).  
The Tire Pressure Monitor  
alerts you when a  
significant reduction in  
pressure occurs in one or  
more of the vehicles tires  
by illuminating the low tire  
pressure warning light on  
the instrument cluster.  
The Tire Pressure Monitor can alert you about low tire  
pressure, but it does not replace normal monthly tire  
maintenance. It is the drivers responsibility to maintain  
correct tire pressures.  
See Tire Pressure Monitor System on page 664 and  
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on page 665.  
If the warning light comes on, stop as soon as possible  
and inflate the tires to the recommended pressure  
shown on the tire loading information label located on  
the driver side center pillar (B pillar). See Loading the  
Vehicle on page 524. The warning light will remain on  
until the tire pressure is corrected.  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit  
This vehicle may come with a jack and spare tire or a  
tire sealant and compressor kit. The kit can be used to  
seal small punctures in the tread area of the tire.  
See Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit on page 678 for  
complete operating information.  
1-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For vehicles with the 2.2L (VIN Code V) or  
2.4L (VIN Code B) engines, you can also reset  
the system as follows:  
Engine Oil Life System  
The engine oil life system calculates engine oil life  
based on vehicle use and displays a DIC message  
when it is necessary to change the engine oil and filter.  
The oil life system should be reset to 100% only  
following an oil change.  
1. Turn the ignition key to ON/RUN with the  
engine off.  
2. Fully press and release the accelerator pedal  
slowly three times within five seconds.  
Resetting the Oil Life System  
1. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN, with the engine off.  
3. Turn the key to LOCK/OFF, then start the engine.  
See Engine Oil Life System on page 623.  
2. Press the information and reset buttons on the  
Driver Information Center (DIC) at the same time  
to enter the personalization menu.  
Fuel E85 (85% Ethanol)  
Vehicles that have the 2.2L L4 engine (VIN Code B) or  
the 2.4L L4 engine (VIN Code V) have a yellow fuel cap  
and can use either unleaded gasoline or ethanol fuel  
containing up to 85% ethanol (E85). See Fuel E85  
(85% Ethanol) on page 68. In all other engines,  
use only the unleaded gasoline described under  
Gasoline Octane on page 66.  
3. Press the information button to scroll through the  
available personalization menu modes until the  
DIC display shows OIL-LIFE RESET.  
4. Press and hold the reset button until the DIC  
display shows ACKNOWLEDGED. This will tell  
you the system has been reset.  
5. Turn the key to LOCK/OFF.  
1-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving for Better Fuel Economy  
Driving habits can affect fuel mileage. Here are some  
driving tips to get the best fuel economy possible.  
Roadside Assistance Program  
U.S.: 1-800-CHEV-USA (1-800-243-8872)  
TTY Users: 1-888-889-2438  
.
Avoid fast starts and accelerate smoothly.  
Canada: 1-800-268-6800  
.
Brake gradually and avoid abrupt stops.  
As the owner of a new Chevrolet, you are automatically  
enrolled in the Roadside Assistance program. This  
program provides technically trained advisors who are  
available 24 hours a day, 365 days a year, minor repair  
information or towing arrangements.  
.
Avoid idling the engine for long periods of time.  
.
When road and weather conditions are  
appropriate, use cruise control, if equipped.  
.
Always follow posted speed limits or drive more  
slowly when conditions require.  
Roadside Assistance and OnStar  
.
Keep vehicle tires properly inflated.  
If you have a current OnStar subscription, press the  
OnStar button and the current GPS location will be sent  
to an OnStar Advisor who will assess your problem,  
contact Roadside Assistance, and relay exact location  
to get you the help you need.  
.
Combine several trips into a single trip.  
.
Replace the vehicle's tires with the same TPC  
Spec number molded into the tire's sidewall near  
the size.  
.
Online Owner Center  
Follow recommended scheduled maintenance.  
The Online Owner Center is a complimentary service  
that includes online service reminders, vehicle  
maintenance tips, online owner manual, special  
privileges and more.  
Battery  
This vehicle has a maintenance free battery located in  
the cargo area. Access to the battery is not necessary  
to jump start the vehicle. There are positive (+) and  
negative () terminals in the engine compartment.  
Sign up today at: www.gmownercenter.com/chevrolet  
(U.S.) or www.gm.ca (Canada).  
See Battery on page 640 and Jump Starting on  
page 641  
.
1-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
OnStar®  
Crisis Assist, Stolen Vehicle Assistance, Vehicle  
Diagnostics, Remote Door Unlock, Roadside  
Assistance, TurnbyTurn Navigation and HandsFree  
Calling are available on most vehicles. Not all OnStar  
services are available on all vehicles. For more  
information see the OnStar Owner's Guide or visit  
www.onstar.com (U.S.) or www.onstar.ca (Canada),  
contact OnStar at 1-888-4-ONSTAR (18884667827)  
or TTY 18772482080, or press Q to speak with an  
OnStar advisor 24 hours a day, 7 days a week.  
OnStar® uses several innovative technologies and live  
advisors to provide a wide range of safety, security,  
navigation, diagnostics, and calling services.  
For a full description of OnStar services and system  
limitations, see the OnStar Owner's Guide in the  
glove box.  
OnStar service is subject to the OnStar terms and  
conditions included in the OnStar Subscriber  
Information.  
Automatic Crash Response  
In a crash, built in sensors can automatically alert an  
OnStar advisor who is immediately connected to the  
vehicle to see if you need help.  
OnStar service cannot work unless the vehicle is in a  
place where OnStar has an agreement with a wireless  
service provider for service in that area. OnStar service  
also cannot work unless the vehicle is in a place where  
the wireless service provider OnStar has hired for that  
area has coverage, network capacity and reception  
when the service is needed, and technology that is  
compatible with the OnStar service. Not all services are  
available everywhere, particularly in remote or enclosed  
areas, or at all times.  
How OnStar Service Works  
Q : This blue button connects you to a specially  
trained OnStar advisor to verify your account  
information and to answer questions.  
] : Push this red emergency button to get priority help  
from specially trained OnStar emergency advisors.  
X : Push this button for handsfree, voiceactivated  
calling and to give voice commands for turnbyturn  
navigation.  
1-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The OnStar system can record and transmit vehicle  
information. This information is automatically sent to an  
OnStar Steering Wheel Controls  
This vehicle may have a Talk/Mute button that can be  
used to interact with OnStar hands-free calling. See  
Audio Steering Wheel Controls on page 492 for more  
information.  
OnStar call center when Q is pressed, ] is pressed,  
or if the airbags or ACR system deploy. This information  
usually includes the vehicle's GPS location and, in the  
event of a crash, additional information regarding the  
crash that the vehicle was involved in (e.g. the direction  
from which the vehicle was hit). When the virtual  
advisor feature of OnStar hands-free calling is used, the  
vehicle also sends OnStar the vehicle's GPS location  
so they can provide services where it is located.  
On some vehicles, the mute button can be used to dial  
numbers into voice mail systems, or to dial phone  
extensions. See the OnStar Owner's Guide for more  
information.  
Your Responsibility  
Increase the volume of the radio if the OnStar advisor  
cannot be heard.  
Location information about the vehicle is only available  
if the GPS satellite signals are unobstructed and  
available.  
If the light next to the OnStar buttons is red, the system  
The vehicle must have a working electrical system,  
including adequate battery power, for the OnStar  
equipment to operate. There are other problems OnStar  
cannot control that may prevent OnStar from providing  
OnStar service at any particular time or place. Some  
examples are damage to important parts of the vehicle  
in a crash, hills, tall buildings, tunnels, weather or  
wireless phone network congestion.  
may not be functioning properly. Press Q and request a  
vehicle diagnostic. If the light appears clear (no light is  
appearing), your OnStar subscription has expired and  
all services have been deactivated. Press Q to confirm  
that the OnStar equipment is active.  
1-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 2 Seats and Restraint System  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Where to Put the Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children  
(LATCH) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45  
Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear  
Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53  
Securing a Child Restraint in the Right  
Front Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-56  
Front Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Manual Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-4  
Seat Height Adjuster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Power Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Power Lumbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6  
Heated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6  
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7  
Passenger Folding Seatback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9  
Airbag System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-60  
Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-63  
When Should an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-65  
What Makes an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-67  
How Does an Airbag Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-67  
What Will You See After an Airbag Inflates? . . . 2-68  
Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . 2-76  
Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped  
Rear Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11  
Split Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11  
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14  
Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28  
Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34  
Safety Belt Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-77  
Restraint System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-78  
Checking the Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-78  
Replacing Restraint System Parts After a  
Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35  
Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35  
Infants and Young Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38  
Child Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41  
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-79  
2-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Head Restraints  
The front seats have adjustable head restraints in the  
outboard seating positions.  
WARNING:  
{
With head restraints that are not installed and  
adjusted properly, there is a greater chance that  
occupants will suffer a neck/spinal injury in a  
crash. Do not drive until the head restraints for all  
occupants are installed and adjusted properly.  
Adjust the head restraint so that the top of the restraint  
is at the same height as the top of the occupant's head.  
This position reduces the chance of a neck injury in a  
crash.  
2-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Push down on the head restraint after the button is  
released to make sure that it is locked in place.  
The head restraints are not designed to be removed.  
The rear seat has head rests that can be adjusted up  
and down.  
Pull the head restraint up to raise it. To lower the  
head restraint, press the button, located on the  
top of the seatback, and push the restraint down.  
2-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle has a manual seat, it can be moved  
forward or rearward.  
Front Seats  
1. Lift the bar to unlock  
the seat.  
Manual Seats  
2. Slide the seat to the  
desired position and  
release the bar.  
WARNING:  
{
You can lose control of the vehicle if you try to  
adjust a manual driver's seat while the vehicle is  
moving. The sudden movement could startle and  
confuse you, or make you push a pedal when you  
do not want to. Adjust the driver's seat only when  
the vehicle is not moving.  
Try to move the seat with your body to be sure the seat  
is locked in place.  
2-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seat Height Adjuster  
Power Seat  
Driver's Seat with Power Seat Control and Power  
Lumbar shown  
If your vehicle has this feature, the driver's seat height  
adjuster is located on the outboard side of the seat.  
If the vehicle has a power seat, the control used to  
operate it is located on the outboard side of the driver's  
seat. To adjust the seat, do any of the following:  
To raise the seat, move the lever upward repeatedly  
until the seat is at the desired height. To lower the seat,  
move the lever downward repeatedly until the seat is at  
the desired height.  
.
Move the seat forward or rearward by sliding the  
control forward or rearward.  
.
Raise or lower the front part of the seat cushion by  
holding the front of the control up or down.  
.
Raise or lower the entire seat by holding the rear  
of the control up or down.  
2-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Lumbar  
Heated Seats  
If your vehicle has this  
feature, the driver's and  
passenger's heated seat  
buttons are located on the  
climate control panel  
below the fan switch.  
Driver's side button  
shown, Passenger's side  
button similar  
Press the button once to turn the heated seat to the  
high setting. Both lights below the heated seat symbol  
will come on. Press the button a second time and the  
heated seat will go to the low setting. The bottom light  
will come on to indicate that the setting is on low. Press  
the button a third time to turn the heated seat off.  
If your vehicle has this feature, the control is located on  
the outboard side of the driver's seat cushion.  
To increase support, press and hold the front of the  
control. To decrease support, press and hold the rear of  
the control. Keep in mind that as your seating position  
changes, as it may during long trips, so should the  
position of your lumbar support. Adjust the seat as  
needed.  
The heated seat feature will need to be turned on each  
time the ignition is turned off and back on again.  
2-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reclining Seatbacks  
WARNING:  
{
You can lose control of the vehicle if you try to  
adjust a manual driver's seat while the vehicle is  
moving. The sudden movement could startle and  
confuse you, or make you push a pedal when you  
do not want to. Adjust the driver's seat only when  
the vehicle is not moving.  
Passenger's Side Reclining Lever shown,  
Driver's Side similar  
WARNING:  
{
The seats have reclining seatbacks. The lever used to  
operate them is located on the outboard side of the  
seats. Lift the lever to release the seatback. Move the  
seatback to where you want it and release the lever to  
lock the seatback in place. Press rearward on the  
seatback to be sure it is locked into place.  
If either seatback is not locked, it could move  
forward in a sudden stop or crash. That could  
cause injury to the person sitting there. Always  
push and pull on the seatbacks to be sure they  
are locked.  
2-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Sitting in a reclined position when the vehicle is in  
motion can be dangerous. Even when buckled up,  
the safety belts cannot do their job when reclined  
like this.  
The shoulder belt cannot do its job because it will  
not be against your body. Instead, it will be in front  
of you. In a crash, you could go into it, receiving  
neck or other injuries.  
The lap belt cannot do its job either. In a crash,  
the belt could go up over your abdomen. The belt  
forces would be there, not at your pelvic bones.  
This could cause serious internal injuries.  
For proper protection when the vehicle is in  
motion, have the seatback upright. Then sit well  
back in the seat and wear the safety belt properly.  
Do not have a seatback reclined if your vehicle is  
moving.  
2-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Passenger Folding Seatback  
Your vehicle has a front passenger seat that folds flat.  
WARNING:  
{
Things you put on this seatback can strike and  
injure people in a sudden stop or turn, or in a  
crash. Remove or secure all items before driving.  
WARNING:  
{
If you fold the seatback forward to carry longer  
objects, such as skis, be sure any such cargo is  
not near an airbag. In a crash, an inflating airbag  
might force that object toward a person. This  
could cause severe injury or even death. Secure  
objects away from the area in which an airbag  
would inflate. For more information, see Where  
Are the Airbags? on page 263 and Loading the  
Vehicle on page 524.  
To fold the seatback, do the following:  
1. Move the front passenger seat rearward to ensure  
there is enough room to fold the seatback forward.  
See Manual Seats on page 24 for more  
information. The head restraint may need to be  
removed if the seat is not able to be moved fully  
rearward. If removing the head restraint, store it so  
that it will not move while the vehicle is in motion.  
2. Make sure that the seatback is in an upright  
position. Use the recliner lever located on the  
outboard side of the seat to move the seatback  
to the upright position.  
2-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To raise the seatback to an upright position:  
1. Pull up on either lever.  
2. Push the seatback up until it is in a locked position.  
WARNING:  
{
If either seatback is not locked, it could move  
forward in a sudden stop or crash. That could  
cause injury to the person sitting there. Always  
push and pull on the seatbacks to be sure they  
are locked.  
3. Push and pull on the seatback to make sure it is  
locked.  
3. To fold the seat flat, pull up on either lever located  
toward the rear of the seatback. Fold the seat  
forward until the seatback disengages.  
4. Continue to fold the seat forward until it locks in  
the folded position. Pull up on the seatback to be  
sure it is locked.  
2-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rear Seats  
Split Folding Rear Seat  
The seatbacks can be folded flat.  
To lower the rear seatback(s):  
1. Move the front seat forward and/or put the front  
seatback in an upright position so it does not  
interfere with folding the rear seatback forward.  
2. Open the rear door while the vehicle is parked.  
3. The rear head restraint may need to be removed if  
it interferes with the front seat when the front seat  
is moved back in place. If removed, store the head  
restraint where it cannot move while the vehicle is  
in motion.  
4. Move the safety belt out of the way before lowering  
the seatback. Do not let the safety belt get caught  
between the seatback and seat cushion as the  
seatback is folded.  
Notice: Folding a rear seat with the safety belts  
still fastened may cause damage to the seat or the  
safety belts. Always unbuckle the safety belts and  
return them to their normal stowed position before  
folding a rear seat.  
2-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Pull up on the knob  
located on the top of  
the seatback on the  
outboard side to  
release the seatback.  
2-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To raise the rear seatback(s):  
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
If the seatback is not locked, it could move  
forward in a sudden stop or crash. That could  
cause injury to the person sitting there. Always  
pull forward on the top of the seatback at the area  
of the latch to be sure it is locked.  
A safety belt that is improperly routed, not  
properly attached, or twisted will not provide the  
protection needed in a crash. The person wearing  
the belt could be seriously injured. After raising  
the rear seatback, always check to be sure that  
the safety belts are properly routed and attached,  
and are not twisted.  
2. Push and pull on the seatback to make sure it is  
locked in place.  
1. Lift the seatback up and push rearward until you  
hear a click. Keep the safety belt clear of the seat  
and not twisted.  
The release knob on the top of the seatback has a  
red ring. If the seatback is not fully latched this ring  
will be visible. Push on the seatback until the ring  
is not visible.  
2-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety Belts  
WARNING:  
{
Safety Belts: They Are for Everyone  
It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,  
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision,  
people riding in these areas are more likely to  
be seriously injured or killed. Do not allow people  
to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not  
equipped with seats and safety belts. Be sure  
everyone in your vehicle is in a seat and using a  
safety belt properly.  
This section of the manual describes how to use safety  
belts properly. It also describes some things not to do  
with safety belts.  
WARNING:  
{
Do not let anyone ride where a safety belt cannot  
be worn properly. In a crash, if you or your  
passenger(s) are not wearing safety belts, the  
injuries can be much worse. You can hit things  
inside the vehicle harder or be ejected from the  
vehicle. You and your passenger(s) can be  
seriously injured or killed. In the same crash, you  
might not be, if you are buckled up. Always fasten  
your safety belt, and check that your passenger(s)  
are restrained properly too.  
This vehicle has indicators as a reminder to buckle the  
safety belts. See Safety Belt Reminders on page 426  
for additional information.  
In most states and in all Canadian provinces, the law  
requires wearing safety belts. Here is why:  
You never know if you will be in a crash. If you do have  
a crash, you do not know if it will be a serious one.  
2-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A few crashes are mild, and some crashes can be so  
serious that even buckled up, a person would not  
survive. But most crashes are in between. In many of  
them, people who buckle up can survive and sometimes  
walk away. Without safety belts, they could have been  
badly hurt or killed.  
Why Safety Belts Work  
When you ride in or on anything, you go as fast as  
it goes.  
After more than 40 years of safety belts in vehicles,  
the facts are clear. In most crashes buckling up does  
matter ... a lot!  
Take the simplest vehicle. Suppose it is just a seat on  
wheels.  
2-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Put someone on it.  
Get it up to speed. Then stop the vehicle. The rider  
does not stop.  
2-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The person keeps going until stopped by something. In  
a real vehicle, it could be the windshield...  
or the instrument panel...  
2-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Questions and Answers About Safety  
Belts  
Q: Will I be trapped in the vehicle after a crash if I  
am wearing a safety belt?  
A: You could be whether you are wearing a safety  
belt or not. But your chance of being conscious  
during and after an accident, so you can unbuckle  
and get out, is much greater if you are belted. And  
you can unbuckle a safety belt, even if you are  
upside down.  
Q: If my vehicle has airbags, why should I have to  
wear safety belts?  
A: Airbags are supplemental systems only; so they  
work with safety belts not instead of them.  
Whether or not an airbag is provided, all occupants  
still have to buckle up to get the most protection.  
That is true not only in frontal collisions, but  
especially in side and other collisions.  
or the safety belts!  
With safety belts, you slow down as the vehicle does.  
You get more time to stop. You stop over more distance,  
and your strongest bones take the forces. That is why  
safety belts make such good sense.  
2-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: If I am a good driver, and I never drive far from  
home, why should I wear safety belts?  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly  
This section is only for people of adult size.  
A: You may be an excellent driver, but if you are in a  
crash even one that is not your fault you and  
your passenger(s) can be hurt. Being a good driver  
does not protect you from things beyond your  
control, such as bad drivers.  
Be aware that there are special things to know about  
safety belts and children. And there are different rules  
for smaller children and infants. If a child will be riding in  
the vehicle, see Older Children on page 235 or Infants  
and Young Children on page 238. Follow those rules  
for everyone's protection.  
Most accidents occur within 25 miles (40 km) of  
home. And the greatest number of serious injuries  
and deaths occur at speeds of less than 40 mph  
(65 km/h).  
It is very important for all occupants to buckle up.  
Statistics show that unbelted people are hurt more often  
in crashes than those who are wearing safety belts.  
Safety belts are for everyone.  
Occupants who are not buckled up can be thrown out of  
the vehicle in a crash. And they can strike others in the  
vehicle who are wearing safety belts.  
First, before you or your passenger(s) wear a safety  
belt, there is important information you should know.  
2-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you slid under it, the belt would apply force on your  
abdomen. This could cause serious or even fatal  
injuries. The shoulder belt should go over the shoulder  
and across the chest. These parts of the body are best  
able to take belt restraining forces.  
The shoulder belt locks if there is a sudden stop or  
crash.  
Sit up straight and always keep your feet on the floor in  
front of you. The lap part of the belt should be worn low  
and snug on the hips, just touching the thighs. In a  
crash, this applies force to the strong pelvic bones and  
you would be less likely to slide under the lap belt.  
2-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously hurt if your shoulder belt is  
too loose. In a crash, you would move forward too  
much, which could increase injury. The shoulder  
belt should fit snugly against your body.  
A: The shoulder belt is too loose. It will not give as  
much protection this way.  
2-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously hurt if your lap belt is too  
loose. In a crash, you could slide under the lap  
belt and apply force on your abdomen. This could  
cause serious or even fatal injuries. The lap belt  
should be worn low and snug on the hips, just  
touching the thighs.  
A: The lap belt is too loose. It will not give nearly as  
much protection this way.  
2-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured if your belt is buckled  
in the wrong place like this. In a crash, the belt  
would go up over your abdomen. The belt forces  
would be there, not on the pelvic bones. This  
could cause serious internal injuries. Always  
buckle your belt into the buckle nearest you.  
A: The belt is buckled in the wrong buckle.  
2-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured if your belt goes over  
an armrest like this. The belt would be much too  
high. In a crash, you can slide under the belt. The  
belt force would then be applied on the abdomen,  
not on the pelvic bones, and that could cause  
serious or fatal injuries. Be sure the belt goes  
under the armrests.  
A: The belt is over an armrest.  
2-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured if you wear the  
shoulder belt under your arm. In a crash, your  
body would move too far forward, which would  
increase the chance of head and neck injury.  
Also, the belt would apply too much force to the  
ribs, which are not as strong as shoulder bones.  
You could also severely injure internal organs like  
your liver or spleen. The shoulder belt should go  
over the shoulder and across the chest.  
A: The shoulder belt is worn under the arm. It should  
be worn over the shoulder at all times.  
2-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured by not wearing the  
lap-shoulder belt properly. In a crash, you would  
not be restrained by the shoulder belt. Your body  
could move too far forward increasing the chance  
of head and neck injury. You might also slide  
under the lap belt. The belt force would then be  
applied right on the abdomen. That could cause  
serious or fatal injuries. The shoulder belt should  
go over the shoulder and across the chest.  
A: The belt is behind the body.  
2-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is wrong with this?  
WARNING:  
{
You can be seriously injured by a twisted belt. In a  
crash, you would not have the full width of the belt  
to spread impact forces. If a belt is twisted, make  
it straight so it can work properly, or ask your  
dealer/retailer to fix it.  
A: The belt is twisted across the body.  
2-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lap-Shoulder Belt  
All seating positions in the vehicle have a  
lap-shoulder belt.  
The following instructions explain how to wear a  
lap-shoulder belt properly.  
1. Adjust the seat, if the seat is adjustable, so you  
can sit up straight. To see how, see Seatsin the  
Index.  
2. Pick up the latch plate and pull the belt across you.  
Do not let it get twisted.  
The lap-shoulder belt may lock if you pull the belt  
across you very quickly. If this happens, let the belt  
go back slightly to unlock it. Then pull the belt  
across you more slowly.  
3. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.  
If the shoulder portion of a passenger belt is pulled  
out all the way, the child restraint locking feature  
may be engaged. If this happens, let the belt go  
back all the way and start again.  
Pull up on the latch plate to make sure it is secure.  
If the belt is not long enough, see Safety Belt  
Extender on page 234.  
Position the release button on the buckle so that  
the safety belt could be quickly unbuckled if  
necessary.  
Engaging the child restraint locking feature can  
affect the passenger sensing system, if equipped.  
See Passenger Sensing System on page 270.  
4. If equipped with a shoulder belt height adjuster,  
move it to the height that is right for you. See  
Shoulder Belt Height Adjustmentlater in this  
section for use and important safety information.  
2-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To unlatch the belt, push the button on the buckle. The  
belt should return to its stowed position.  
5. To make the lap part tight, pull up on the  
shoulder belt.  
Before a door is closed, be sure the safety belt is out of  
the way. If a door is slammed against a safety belt,  
damage can occur to both the safety belt and the  
vehicle.  
It may be necessary to pull stitching on the safety  
belt through the latch plate to fully tighten the lap  
belt on smaller occupants.  
2-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Shoulder Belt Height Adjuster  
Safety Belt Pretensioners  
The vehicle has a shoulder belt height adjuster for the  
driver and right front passenger seating positions.  
This vehicle has safety belt pretensioners for front  
outboard occupants. Although the safety belt  
pretensioners cannot be seen, they are part of the  
safety belt assembly. They can help tighten the safety  
belts during the early stages of a moderate to severe  
frontal or near frontal crash if the threshold conditions  
for pretensioner activation are met. And, if the vehicle  
has side impact airbags, safety belt pretensioners can  
help tighten the safety belts in a side crash and rear  
events.  
Adjust the height so that the shoulder portion of the belt  
is centered on the shoulder. The belt should be away  
from the face and neck, but not falling off the shoulder.  
Improper shoulder belt height adjustment could reduce  
the effectiveness of the safety belt in a crash.  
Push down on the release  
button (A) and move the  
height adjuster to the  
desired position. The  
adjuster can be moved up  
by pushing the release  
button up on the shoulder  
belt guide.  
Pretensioners work only once. If the pretensioners  
activate in a crash, They will need to be replaced, and  
probably other new parts for the vehicle's safety belt  
system. See Replacing Restraint System Parts After a  
Crash on page 279  
After the height adjuster is set to the desired position,  
try to move it down without pressing the release button  
to make sure it has locked into position.  
2-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Here is how to install a comfort guide to the safety belt:  
Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guides  
This vehicle may have rear shoulder belt comfort guides  
for each outboard passenger position in the rear seat.  
If not, they are available through your dealer/retailer.  
The guides may provide added safety belt comfort for  
older children who have outgrown booster seats and for  
some adults. When installed and properly adjusted, the  
comfort guide positions the shoulder belt away from the  
neck and head.  
1. Pull the elastic cord out from between the edge of  
the seatback and the interior body to remove the  
guide from its storage clip.  
2-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. Place the guide over the belt and insert the two  
edges of the belt into the slots of the guide.  
3. Be sure that the belt is not twisted and it lies flat.  
The elastic cord must be under the belt and the  
guide on top.  
2-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
A safety belt that is not properly worn may not  
provide the protection needed in a crash. The  
person wearing the belt could be seriously injured.  
The shoulder belt should go over the shoulder and  
across the chest. These parts of the body are best  
able to take belt restraining forces.  
4. Buckle, position, and release the safety belt as  
described previously in this section. Make sure that  
the shoulder belt crosses the shoulder.  
To remove and store the comfort guide, squeeze the  
belt edges together so that the safety belt can be  
removed from the guide. Pull the guide upward to  
expose its storage clip, and then slide the guide onto  
the clip. Turn the guide and clip inward and slide them  
in between the seatback and the interior body, leaving  
only the loop of the elastic cord exposed.  
2-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Safety Belt Use During Pregnancy  
Safety Belt Extender  
Safety belts work for everyone, including pregnant  
women. Like all occupants, they are more likely to be  
seriously injured if they do not wear safety belts.  
If the vehicle's safety belt will fasten around you, you  
should use it.  
But if a safety belt is not long enough, your dealer/  
retailer will order you an extender. When you go in to  
order it, take the heaviest coat you will wear, so the  
extender will be long enough for you. To help avoid  
personal injury, do not let someone else use it, and use  
it only for the seat it is made to fit. The extender has  
been designed for adults. Never use it for securing child  
seats. To wear it, attach it to the regular safety belt. For  
more information, see the instruction sheet that comes  
with the extender.  
A pregnant woman should wear a lap-shoulder belt,  
and the lap portion should be worn as low as possible,  
below the rounding, throughout the pregnancy.  
The best way to protect the fetus is to protect the  
mother. When a safety belt is worn properly, it is more  
likely that the fetus will not be hurt in a crash. For  
pregnant women, as for anyone, the key to making  
safety belts effective is wearing them properly.  
2-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The manufacturer's instructions that come with the  
booster seat state the weight and height limitations for  
that booster. Use a booster seat with a lap-shoulder belt  
until the child passes the below fit test:  
Child Restraints  
Older Children  
.
Sit all the way back on the seat. Do the knees  
bend at the seat edge? If yes, continue. If no,  
return to the booster seat.  
.
Buckle the lap-shoulder belt. Does the shoulder  
belt rest on the shoulder? If yes, continue. If no, try  
using the rear safety belt comfort guide. See Rear  
Safety Belt Comfort Guidesunder Lap-Shoulder  
Belt on page 228 for more information. If the  
shoulder belt still does not rest on the shoulder,  
then return to the booster seat.  
.
Does the lap belt fit low and snug on the hips,  
touching the thighs? If yes, continue. If no, return  
to the booster seat.  
.
Can proper safety belt fit be maintained for the  
length of the trip? If yes, continue. If no, return to  
the booster seat.  
Older children who have outgrown booster seats should  
wear the vehicle's safety belts.  
.
If you have the choice, a child should sit in a  
position with a lap-shoulder belt and get the  
additional restraint a shoulder belt can provide.  
2-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What is the proper way to wear safety belts?  
WARNING:  
A: An older child should wear a lap-shoulder belt  
and get the additional restraint a shoulder belt  
can provide. The shoulder belt should not cross  
the face or neck. The lap belt should fit snugly  
below the hips, just touching the top of the thighs.  
This applies belt force to the child's pelvic bones in  
a crash. It should never be worn over the abdomen,  
which could cause severe or even fatal internal  
injuries in a crash.  
{
Never do this.  
Never allow two children to wear the same safety  
belt. The safety belt can not properly spread the  
impact forces. In a crash, the two children can be  
crushed together and seriously injured. A safety  
belt must be used by only one person at a time.  
Also see Rear Safety Belt Comfort Guidesunder  
Lap-Shoulder Belt on page 228.  
According to accident statistics, children and infants  
are safer when properly restrained in a child restraint  
system or infant restraint system secured in a rear  
seating position.  
In a crash, children who are not buckled up can strike  
other people who are buckled up, or can be thrown out  
of the vehicle. Older children need to use safety belts  
properly.  
2-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Never do this.  
Never allow a child to wear the safety belt with the  
shoulder belt behind their back. A child can be  
seriously injured by not wearing the lap-shoulder  
belt properly. In a crash, the child would not be  
restrained by the shoulder belt. The child could  
move too far forward increasing the chance of  
head and neck injury. The child might also slide  
under the lap belt. The belt force would then be  
applied right on the abdomen. That could cause  
serious or fatal injuries. The shoulder belt should  
go over the shoulder and across the chest.  
2-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
infants and young children ride in vehicles, they  
should have the protection provided by appropriate  
child restraints.  
Infants and Young Children  
Everyone in a vehicle needs protection! This includes  
infants and all other children. Neither the distance  
traveled nor the age and size of the traveler changes  
the need, for everyone, to use safety restraints. In fact,  
the law in every state in the United States and in every  
Canadian province says children up to some age must  
be restrained while in a vehicle.  
Children who are not restrained properly can strike  
other people, or can be thrown out of the vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
Never do this.  
WARNING:  
{
Never hold an infant or a child while riding in a  
vehicle. Due to crash forces, an infant or a child  
will become so heavy it is not possible to hold it  
during a crash. For example, in a crash at only  
40 km/h (25 mph), a 5.5 kg (12 lb) infant will  
suddenly become a 110 kg (240 lb) force on a  
person's arms. An infant should be secured in an  
appropriate restraint.  
Children can be seriously injured or strangled if a  
shoulder belt is wrapped around their neck and  
the safety belt continues to tighten. Never leave  
children unattended in a vehicle and never allow  
children to play with the safety belts.  
Airbags plus lapshoulder belts offer protection for  
adults and older children, but not for young children  
and infants. Neither the vehicle's safety belt system  
nor its airbag system is designed for them. Every time  
2-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
in a rear seat. It is also better to secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in a rear seat.  
If you must secure a forward-facing child  
restraint in the right front seat, always move the  
front passenger seat as far back as it will go.  
WARNING:  
{
Never do this.  
Children who are up against, or very close to, any  
airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured or  
killed. Never put a rear-facing child restraint in the  
right front seat. Secure a rear-facing child restraint  
(Continued)  
2-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Q: What are the different types of add-on child  
restraints?  
WARNING:  
{
A: Add-on child restraints, which are purchased by the  
vehicle's owner, are available in four basic types.  
Selection of a particular restraint should take into  
consideration not only the child's weight, height,  
and age but also whether or not the restraint will be  
compatible with the motor vehicle in which it will  
be used.  
To reduce the risk of neck and head injury during  
a crash, infants need complete support. This is  
because an infant's neck is not fully developed  
and its head weighs so much compared with  
the rest of its body. In a crash, an infant in a  
rear-facing child restraint settles into the restraint,  
so the crash forces can be distributed across the  
strongest part of an infant's body, the back and  
shoulders. Infants should always be secured in  
rear-facing child restraints.  
For most basic types of child restraints, there are  
many different models available. When purchasing a  
child restraint, be sure it is designed to be used in a  
motor vehicle. If it is, the restraint will have a label  
saying that it meets federal motor vehicle safety  
standards.  
The restraint manufacturer's instructions that  
come with the restraint state the weight and height  
limitations for a particular child restraint. In addition,  
there are many kinds of restraints available for  
children with special needs.  
2-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Child Restraint Systems  
WARNING:  
{
A rear-facing infant  
seat (A) provides restraint  
with the seating surface  
against the back of the  
infant.  
A young child's hip bones are still so small that  
the vehicle's regular safety belt may not remain  
low on the hip bones, as it should. Instead, it may  
settle up around the child's abdomen. In a crash,  
the belt would apply force on a body area that is  
unprotected by any bony structure. This alone  
could cause serious or fatal injuries. To reduce  
the risk of serious or fatal injuries during a crash,  
young children should always be secured in  
appropriate child restraints.  
The harness system holds the infant in place and, in a  
crash, acts to keep the infant positioned in the restraint.  
A forward-facing child  
seat (B) provides restraint  
for the child's body with  
the harness.  
2-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Securing an Add-On Child Restraint in  
the Vehicle  
WARNING:  
{
A child can be seriously injured or killed in a crash  
if the child restraint is not properly secured in the  
vehicle. Secure the child restraint properly in the  
vehicle using the vehicle's safety belt or LATCH  
system, following the instructions that came with  
that child restraint and the instructions in this  
manual.  
A booster seat (C-D) is a child restraint designed to  
improve the fit of the vehicle's safety belt system.  
A booster seat can also help a child to see out the  
window.  
To help reduce the chance of injury, the child restraint  
must be secured in the vehicle. Child restraint systems  
must be secured in vehicle seats by lap belts or the lap  
belt portion of a lap-shoulder belt, or by the LATCH  
system. See Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children  
(LATCH) on page 245 for more information. A child  
can be endangered in a crash if the child restraint is not  
properly secured in the vehicle.  
2-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When securing an add-on child restraint, refer to the  
instructions that come with the restraint which may be  
on the restraint itself or in a booklet, or both, and to this  
manual. The child restraint instructions are important,  
so if they are not available, obtain a replacement copy  
from the manufacturer.  
Where to Put the Restraint  
According to accident statistics, children and infants  
are safer when properly restrained in a child restraint  
system or infant restraint system secured in a rear  
seating position.  
We recommend that children and child restraints be  
secured in a rear seat, including: an infant or a child  
riding in a rear-facing child restraint; a child riding in a  
forward-facing child seat; an older child riding in a  
booster seat; and children, who are large enough,  
using safety belts.  
Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can  
move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure  
people in the vehicle. Be sure to properly secure any  
child restraint in the vehicle even when no child  
is in it.  
Securing the Child Within the Child  
Restraint  
WARNING:  
{
A child can be seriously injured or killed in a crash  
if the child is not properly secured in the child  
restraint. Secure the child properly following the  
instructions that came with that child restraint.  
2-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A label on the sun visor says, Never put a rear-facing  
child restraint in the front.This is because the risk to  
the rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag deploys.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear  
seat, even if the airbag is off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger seat as far back  
as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
WARNING:  
{
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be  
seriously injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child restraint would be  
very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a  
forward-facing child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front passenger airbag  
inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
See Passenger Sensing System on page 270  
for additional information.  
If the vehicle does not have a rear seat that will  
accommodate a rear-facing child restraint, a rear-facing  
child restraint should not be installed in the vehicle,  
even if the airbag is off.  
The vehicle may have a passenger sensing  
system which is designed to turn off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag under certain conditions.  
When securing a child restraint in a rear seating  
position, study the instructions that came with your child  
restraint to make sure it is compatible with this vehicle.  
Even if the passenger sensing system,  
if equipped, has turned off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag, no system is fail-safe.  
No one can guarantee that an airbag will not  
deploy under some unusual circumstance, even  
though it is turned off.  
Wherever a child restraint is installed, be sure to secure  
the child restraint properly.  
Keep in mind that an unsecured child restraint can  
move around in a collision or sudden stop and injure  
people in the vehicle. Be sure to properly secure any  
child restraint in the vehicle even when no child  
is in it.  
(Continued)  
2-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lower Anchors  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for  
Children (LATCH)  
The LATCH system holds a child restraint during  
driving or in a crash. This system is designed to make  
installation of a child restraint easier. The LATCH  
system uses anchors in the vehicle and attachments on  
the child restraint that are made for use with the LATCH  
system.  
Make sure that a LATCH-compatible child restraint is  
properly installed using the anchors, or use the vehicle's  
safety belts to secure the restraint, following the  
instructions that came with that restraint, and also the  
instructions in this manual. When installing a child  
restraint with a top tether, you must also use either the  
lower anchors or the safety belts to properly secure the  
child restraint. A child restraint must never be attached  
using only the top tether and anchor.  
Lower anchors (A) are metal bars built into the vehicle.  
There are two lower anchors for each LATCH seating  
position that will accommodate a child restraint with  
lower attachments (B).  
In order to use the LATCH system in your vehicle,  
you need a child restraint that has LATCH attachments.  
The child restraint manufacturer will provide you with  
instructions on how to use the child restraint and its  
attachments. The following explains how to attach a  
child restraint with these attachments in your vehicle.  
Not all vehicle seating positions or child restraints have  
lower anchors and attachments or top tether anchors  
and attachments.  
2-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Your child restraint may have a single tether (A) or a  
dual tether (C). Either will have a single attachment (B)  
to secure the top tether to the anchor.  
Top Tether Anchor  
Some child restraints that have a top tether are  
designed for use with or without the top tether being  
attached. Others require the top tether always to  
be attached. In Canada, the law requires that  
forward-facing child restraints have a top tether, and  
that the tether be attached. Be sure to read and  
follow the instructions for your child restraint.  
If the child restraint does not have a top tether, one can  
be obtained, in kit form, for many child restraints. Ask  
the child restraint manufacturer whether or not a kit is  
available.  
A top tether (A, C) anchors the top of the child restraint  
to the vehicle. A top tether anchor is built into the  
vehicle. The top tether attachment (B) on the child  
restraint connects to the top tether anchor in the vehicle  
in order to reduce the forward movement and rotation of  
the child restraint during driving or in a crash.  
2-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
i (Top Tether Anchor):  
Seating position with a top  
tether anchor.  
Lower Anchor and Top Tether Anchor  
Locations  
j (Lower Anchor):  
Seating positions with two  
lower anchors.  
i (Top Tether Anchor):  
Seating positions with top  
tether anchors.  
Front Passenger  
Seat Panel and Rear  
Seat Delete Models  
Rear Seat  
To assist you in locating  
the lower anchors, each  
seating position with lower  
anchors has two labels  
near the crease between  
the seatback and the seat  
cushion.  
2-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To assist you in locating  
the top tether anchors,  
this symbol is located  
next to each top tether  
anchor.  
On vehicles equipped with rear seats, the top tether  
anchor symbols for the rear outboard positions are on  
the lower side of the quarter panels. The top tether  
anchor symbols for the rear center position are on the  
storage compartment and cargo mat, if equipped.  
Vehicles with Rear Seats  
The rear outboard top tether anchors are located on the  
cargo floor behind the rear seats.  
On vehicles without rear seats, the top tether anchor  
symbol is on the lower side of the quarter on the  
passenger side, behind the second row door.  
The rear center top tether anchor is located in a storage  
compartment behind the rear seats. Lift the lid of the  
storage compartment to access the anchor. You may  
have to fold back the cargo mat to access the storage  
compartment and the top tether anchor for the rear  
center seating position.  
If the vehicle is a panel van equipped with a cargo  
partition, see the Cargo Partition Owner Manual  
Supplementfor the top tether anchor location and  
routing instructions.  
Be sure to use an anchor located on the same side of  
the vehicle as the seating position where the child  
restraint will be placed.  
2-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the top tether anchor is being used for a child  
restraint, do not use the same anchor to secure cargo.  
If the vehicle is a panel van equipped with a cargo  
partition, see the Cargo Partition Owner Manual  
Supplementfor the top tether anchor location and  
routing instructions.  
Be sure to use an anchor located on the same side of  
the vehicle as the seating position where the child  
restraint will be placed.  
When the top tether anchor is being used for a child  
restraint, do not use the same anchor to secure cargo.  
Do not secure a child restraint in a position without a  
top tether anchor if a national or local law requires that  
the top tether be attached, or if the instructions that  
come with the child restraint say that the top tether must  
be attached.  
Accident statistics show that children are safer if they  
are restrained in the rear rather than the front seat. See  
Where to Put the Restraint on page 243 for additional  
information.  
Vehicles without Rear Seats Panel and Rear Seat  
Delete Models  
If the vehicle does not have a rear seat, there is an  
exposed top tether anchor for the front passenger  
position located on the rear passenger side cargo floor,  
behind the second row door.  
2-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Securing a Child Restraint Designed for the  
LATCH System  
WARNING:  
{
Do not attach more than one child restraint to a  
single anchor. Attaching more than one child  
restraint to a single anchor could cause the  
anchor or attachment to come loose or even  
break during a crash. A child or others could be  
injured. To reduce the risk of serious or fatal  
injuries during a crash, attach only one child  
restraint per anchor.  
WARNING:  
{
If a LATCH-type child restraint is not attached to  
anchors, the child restraint will not be able to  
protect the child correctly. In a crash, the child  
could be seriously injured or killed. Install a  
LATCH-type child restraint properly using the  
anchors, or use the vehicle's safety belts to  
secure the restraint, following the instructions that  
came with the child restraint and the instructions  
in this manual.  
WARNING:  
{
Children can be seriously injured or strangled if a  
shoulder belt is wrapped around their neck and  
the safety belt continues to tighten. Buckle any  
unused safety belts behind the child restraint so  
children cannot reach them. Pull the shoulder belt  
all the way out of the retractor to set the lock,  
if your vehicle has one, after the child restraint  
has been installed.  
2-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Do not let the LATCH attachments rub  
against the vehicles safety belts. This may damage  
these parts. If necessary, move buckled safety belts  
to avoid rubbing the LATCH attachments.  
2. If the child restraint manufacturer recommends that  
the top tether be attached, attach and tighten the  
top tether to the top tether anchor, if equipped.  
Refer to the child restraint instructions and the  
following steps:  
Do not fold the empty rear seat with a safety belt  
buckled. This could damage the safety belt or the  
seat. Unbuckle and return the safety belt to its  
stowed position, before folding the seat.  
2.1. To secure a child restraint in the rear  
center seating position, find the storage  
compartment behind the rear seats. You may  
have to fold back the cargo mat to access the  
storage compartment and the top tether  
anchor.  
1. Attach and tighten the lower attachments to the  
lower anchors. If the child restraint does not have  
lower attachments or the desired seating position  
does not have lower anchors, secure the child  
restraint with the top tether and the safety belts.  
Refer to your child restraint manufacturer  
Lift the lid of the storage compartment to  
access the top tether anchor for the rear  
center seating position.  
instructions and the instructions in this manual.  
2.2. To secure a child restraint in the rear  
outboard seating positions, find the top tether  
anchor located on the cargo floor behind the  
rear seats.  
1.1. Find the lower anchors for the desired  
seating position.  
1.2. Put the child restraint on the seat.  
Be sure to use an anchor located on the  
same side of the vehicle as the seating  
position where the child restraint will be  
placed.  
1.3. Attach and tighten the lower attachments on  
the child restraint to the lower anchors.  
2-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2.3. To secure a child restraint in the front  
passenger position, only if your vehicle  
does not have rear seats, find the top tether  
anchor located on the passenger side cargo  
floor behind the second row door.  
2.6. Route, attach, and tighten the top tether  
according to your child restraint instructions  
and the following instructions:  
If the position you are  
using does not have a  
headrest or head restraint  
and you are using a  
single tether, route the  
tether over the seatback.  
Be sure to use an anchor located on the  
same side of the vehicle as the seating  
position where the child restraint will be  
placed.  
2.4. If the vehicle is a panel van equipped with a  
cargo partition, see the Cargo Partition  
Owner Manual Supplementfor the top tether  
anchor location and routing instructions.  
2.5. If the position you are using has an  
adjustable headrest or head restraint,  
raise it.  
If the position you are  
using does not have a  
headrest or head restraint  
and you are using a dual  
tether, route the tether  
over the seatback.  
2-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the position you are  
using has an adjustable  
headrest or head restraint  
and you are using a  
single tether, raise the  
headrest or head restraint  
and route the tether under  
the headrest or head  
restraint and in between  
the headrest or head  
restraint posts.  
Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear  
Seat Position  
When securing a child restraint in a rear seating  
position, study the instructions that came with the child  
restraint to make sure it is compatible with this vehicle.  
If the child restraint has the LATCH system, see  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on  
page 245 for how and where to install the child  
restraint using LATCH. If a child restraint is secured in  
the vehicle using a safety belt and it uses a top tether,  
see Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH)  
on page 245 for top tether anchor locations.  
If the position you are  
using has an adjustable  
headrest or head restraint  
and you are using a dual  
tether, route the tether  
around the headrest or  
head restraint.  
Do not secure a child seat in a position without a top  
tether anchor if a national or local law requires that the  
top tether be anchored, or if the instructions that come  
with the child restraint say that the top strap must be  
anchored.  
In Canada, the law requires that forward-facing child  
restraints have a top tether, and that the tether be  
attached.  
If the child restraint does not have the LATCH system,  
you will be using the safety belt to secure the child  
restraint in this position. Be sure to follow the  
instructions that came with the child restraint. Secure  
the child in the child restraint when and as the  
instructions say.  
3. Push and pull the child restraint in different  
directions to be sure it is secure.  
2-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If more than one child restraint needs to be installed  
in the rear seat, be sure to read Where to Put the  
Restraint on page 243.  
1. Put the child restraint on the seat.  
2. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and  
shoulder portions of the vehicle's safety belt  
through or around the restraint. The child restraint  
instructions will show you how.  
4. Pull the rest of the shoulder belt all the way out of  
the retractor to set the lock.  
3. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.  
Position the release button on the buckle so that  
the safety belt could be quickly unbuckled if  
necessary.  
2-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. If the child restraint has a top tether, follow the  
child restraint manufacturer's instructions regarding  
the use of the top tether. See Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children (LATCH) on page 245 for  
more information.  
7. Push and pull the child restraint in different  
directions to be sure it is secure.  
To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the vehicle  
safety belt and let it return to the stowed position. If the  
top tether is attached to a top tether anchor,  
disconnect it.  
5. To tighten the belt, push down on the child  
restraint, pull the shoulder portion of the belt to  
tighten the lap portion of the belt and feed the  
shoulder belt back into the retractor. When  
installing a forward-facing child restraint, it may  
be helpful to use your knee to push down on the  
child restraint as you tighten the belt.  
2-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Securing a Child Restraint in the  
Right Front Seat Position  
WARNING: (Continued)  
This vehicle has airbags. A rear seat is a safer place to  
secure a forward-facing child restraint. See Where to  
Put the Restraint on page 243.  
injured or killed if the right front passenger airbag  
inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
In addition, the vehicle may have a passenger sensing  
system which is designed to turn off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag under certain conditions. See  
Passenger Sensing System on page 270 and  
The vehicle may have a passenger sensing  
system which is designed to turn off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag under certain conditions.  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 428 for  
more information, including important safety information.  
Even if the passenger sensing system,  
if equipped, has turned off the right front  
passenger frontal airbag, no system is fail-safe.  
No one can guarantee that an airbag will not  
deploy under some unusual circumstance, even  
though it is turned off.  
A label on the sun visor says, Never put a rear-facing  
child seat in the front.This is because the risk to the  
rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag deploys.  
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear  
seat, even if the airbag is off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger seat as far back  
as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
WARNING:  
{
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be  
seriously injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child restraint would be  
very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a  
forward-facing child restraint can be seriously  
See Passenger Sensing System on page 270  
for additional information.  
(Continued)  
2-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle does not have a rear seat that will  
accomodate a rearfacing child restraint, a rear-facing  
child restraint should not be installed in the vehicle,  
even if the airbag is off.  
In Canada, the law requires that forward-facing child  
restraints have a top tether, and that the tether be  
attached.  
You will be using the lap-shoulder belt to secure the  
child restraint in this position. Follow the instructions  
that came with the child restraint.  
If your child restraint has the LATCH system, see  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on  
page 245 for how and where to install the child  
restraint using LATCH. If a child restraint is secured  
using a safety belt and it uses a top tether, see Lower  
Anchors and Tethers for Children (LATCH) on  
page 245 for top tether anchor locations.  
1. Move the seat as far back as it will go before  
securing the forward-facing child restraint.  
2. Put the child restraint on the seat.  
3. Pick up the latch plate, and run the lap and  
shoulder portions of the vehicle's safety belt  
through or around the restraint. The child restraint  
instructions will show you how.  
Do not secure a child seat in a position without a top  
tether anchor if a national or local law requires that the  
top tether be anchored, or if the instructions that come  
with the child restraint say that the top strap must be  
anchored.  
2-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Push the latch plate into the buckle until it clicks.  
5. Pull the rest of the shoulder belt all the way out of  
the retractor to set the lock.  
Position the release button on the buckle so that  
the safety belt could be quickly unbuckled if  
necessary.  
2-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. If the vehicle does not have a rear seat and your  
child restraint has a top tether, follow the child  
restraint manufacturer's instructions regarding the  
use of the top tether. See Lower Anchors and  
Tethers for Children (LATCH) on page 245 for  
more information.  
8. Push and pull the child restraint in different  
directions to be sure it is secure.  
If the vehicle is equipped with the passenger sensing  
system, and the passenger sensing system has turned  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag, the off  
indicator on the passenger airbag status indicator  
should light and say lit when you start the vehicle.  
If a child restraint has been installed and the on  
indicator is lit, see If the On Indicator is Lit for a  
Child Restraintunder Passenger Sensing System on  
page 270 for more information.  
6. To tighten the belt, push down on the child  
restraint, pull the shoulder portion of the belt to  
tighten the lap portion of the belt and feed the  
shoulder belt back into the retractor. When  
installing a forward-facing child restraint, it may  
be helpful to use your knee to push down on the  
child restraint as you tighten the belt.  
To remove the child restraint, unbuckle the vehicle  
safety belt and let it return to the stowed position.  
If the top tether is attached to a top tether anchor,  
disconnect it.  
2-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Even if you do not have a right front passenger seat in  
your vehicle there is still an active frontal airbag in the  
right side of the instrument panel. Do not place cargo in  
front of this airbag.  
Airbag System  
The vehicle has the following airbags:  
.
A frontal airbag for the driver.  
.
A frontal airbag for the right front passenger.  
WARNING:  
{
The vehicle may have the following airbags:  
.
A roof-rail airbag for the driver and the passenger  
Be sure that cargo is not near an airbag. In a  
crash, an inflating airbag might force that object  
toward a person. This could cause severe injury  
or even death. Secure objects away from the  
area in which an airbag would inflate. For more  
information, see Where Are the Airbags? on  
page 263 and Loading the Vehicle on  
seated directly behind the driver.  
.
A roof-rail airbag for the right front passenger and  
the passenger seated directly behind that  
passenger.  
All of the airbags in your vehicle will have the word  
AIRBAG embossed in the trim or on an attached label  
near the deployment opening.  
page 524  
.
For frontal airbags, the word AIRBAG will appear on the  
middle part of the steering wheel for the driver and on  
the instrument panel for the right front passenger.  
Airbags are designed to supplement the protection  
provided by safety belts. Even though today's airbags  
are also designed to help reduce the risk of injury from  
the force of an inflating bag, all airbags must inflate very  
quickly to do their job.  
With roof-rail airbags, the word AIRBAG will appear  
along the headliner or trim.  
2-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Here are the most important things to know about the  
airbag system:  
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
Airbags inflate with great force, faster than the  
blink of an eye. Anyone who is up against, or  
very close to, any airbag when it inflates can be  
seriously injured or killed. Do not sit unnecessarily  
close to the airbag, as you would be if you were  
sitting on the edge of your seat or leaning forward.  
Safety belts help keep you in position before and  
during a crash. Always wear your safety belt,  
even with airbags. The driver should sit as far  
back as possible while still maintaining control of  
the vehicle.  
You can be severely injured or killed in a crash  
if you are not wearing your safety belt even if  
you have airbags. Airbags are designed to work  
with safety belts, but do not replace them. Also,  
airbags are not designed to deploy in every  
crash. In some crashes safety belts are your  
only restraint. See When Should an Airbag  
Inflate? on page 265.  
Wearing your safety belt during a crash helps  
reduce your chance of hitting things inside the  
vehicle or being ejected from it. Airbags are  
supplemental restraintsto the safety belts.  
Everyone in your vehicle should wear a safety  
belt properly whether or not there is an airbag  
for that person.  
Occupants should not lean on or sleep against the  
door or side windows in seating positions with  
roof-rail airbags.  
2-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
There is an airbag  
readiness light on the  
instrument panel cluster,  
which shows the airbag  
symbol.  
WARNING:  
{
Children who are up against, or very close to, any  
airbag when it inflates can be seriously injured or  
killed. Airbags plus lap-shoulder belts offer  
protection for adults and older children, but not for  
young children and infants. Neither the vehicle's  
safety belt system nor its airbag system is  
designed for them. Young children and infants  
need the protection that a child restraint system  
can provide. Always secure children properly in  
your vehicle. To read how, see Older Children on  
page 235 or Infants and Young Children on  
The system checks the airbag electrical system for  
malfunctions. The light tells you if there is an electrical  
problem. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 427 for  
more information.  
page 238  
.
2-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Where Are the Airbags?  
The right front passenger's airbag is in the instrument  
panel on the passenger's side.  
The driver's frontal airbag is in the middle of the  
steering wheel.  
2-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
If something is between an occupant and an  
airbag, the airbag might not inflate properly or it  
might force the object into that person causing  
severe injury or even death. The path of an  
inflating airbag must be kept clear. Do not put  
anything between an occupant and an airbag,  
and do not attach or put anything on the steering  
wheel hub or on or near any other airbag  
covering.  
Never secure anything to the roof of a vehicle with  
roof-rail airbags by routing a rope or tie down  
through any door or window opening. If you do,  
the path of an inflating roof-rail airbag will be  
blocked.  
Driver Side shown, Passenger Side similar  
If your vehicle has roof-rail airbags for the driver, right  
front passenger, and second row outboard passengers,  
they are in the ceiling above the side windows.  
2-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Frontal airbags may inflate at different crash speeds.  
For example:  
When Should an Airbag Inflate?  
Frontal airbags are designed to inflate in moderate to  
severe frontal or near-frontal crashes to help reduce the  
potential for severe injuries mainly to the driver's or right  
front passenger's head and chest. However, they are  
only designed to inflate if the impact exceeds a  
predetermined deployment threshold. Deployment  
thresholds are used to predict how severe a crash is  
likely to be in time for the airbags to inflate and help  
restrain the occupants.  
.
If the vehicle hits a stationary object, the airbags  
could inflate at a different crash speed than if the  
vehicle hits a moving object.  
.
If the vehicle hits an object that deforms, the  
airbags could inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle hits an object does not deform.  
.
If the vehicle hits a narrow object (like a pole), the  
airbags could inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle hits a wide object (like a wall).  
Whether your frontal airbags will or should deploy is not  
based on how fast your vehicle is traveling. It depends  
largely on what you hit, the direction of the impact, and  
how quickly your vehicle slows down.  
.
If the vehicle goes into an object at an angle, the  
airbags could inflate at a different crash speed  
than if the vehicle goes straight into the object.  
Thresholds can also vary with specific vehicle design.  
Frontal airbags are not intended to inflate during vehicle  
rollovers, rear impacts, or in many side impacts.  
2-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In addition, your vehicle has dual-stage frontal airbags.  
Dual-stage airbags adjust the restraint according to  
crash severity. Your vehicle has an electronic frontal  
sensor, which helps the sensing system distinguish  
between a moderate frontal impact and a more severe  
frontal impact. For moderate frontal impacts, dual-stage  
airbags inflate at a level less than full deployment. For  
more severe frontal impacts, full deployment occurs.  
Roof-rail airbags are not intended to inflate in frontal  
impacts, near-frontal impacts, or rear impacts.  
A roof-rail airbag is intended to deploy on the side  
of the vehicle that is struck or if the sensing system  
predicts that the vehicle is about to roll over.  
In any particular crash, no one can say whether an  
airbag should have inflated simply because of the  
damage to a vehicle or because of what the repair  
costs were. For frontal airbags, inflation is determined  
by what the vehicle hits, the angle of the impact, and  
how quickly the vehicle slows down. For roof-rail  
airbags, deployment is determined by the location and  
severity of the side impact. In a rollover event, roof-rail  
airbag deployment is determined by the direction of  
the roll.  
Your vehicle may or may not have roof-rail airbags.  
See Airbag System on page 260. Roof-rail airbags are  
intended to inflate in moderate to severe side crashes.  
In addition, these roof-rail airbags are intended to inflate  
during a rollover. Roof-rail airbags will inflate if the crash  
severity is above the system's designed threshold level.  
The threshold level can vary with specific vehicle  
design.  
2-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Airbags supplement the protection provided by safety  
belts. Frontal airbags distribute the force of the impact  
more evenly over the occupant's upper body, stopping  
the occupant more gradually. Roof-rail airbags distribute  
the force of the impact more evenly over the occupant's  
upper body.  
What Makes an Airbag Inflate?  
In a deployment event, the sensing system sends an  
electrical signal triggering a release of gas from the  
inflator. Gas from the inflator fills the airbag causing the  
bag to break out of the cover and deploy. The inflator,  
the airbag, and related hardware are all part of the  
airbag module.  
Rollover capable roof-rail airbags are designed to  
help contain the head and chest of occupants in the  
outboard seating positions in the first and second rows.  
The rollover capable roof-rail airbags are designed to  
help reduce the risk of full or partial ejection in rollover  
events, although no system can prevent all such  
ejections.  
Frontal airbag modules are located inside the steering  
wheel and instrument panel. For vehicles with roof-rail  
airbags, there are airbag modules in the ceiling of the  
vehicle, near the side windows that have occupant  
seating positions.  
But airbags would not help in many types of collisions,  
primarily because the occupant's motion is not toward  
those airbags. See When Should an Airbag Inflate? on  
page 265 for more information.  
How Does an Airbag Restrain?  
In moderate to severe frontal or near frontal collisions,  
even belted occupants can contact the steering wheel  
or the instrument panel. In moderate to severe side  
collisions, even belted occupants can contact the inside  
of the vehicle.  
Airbags should never be regarded as anything more  
than a supplement to safety belts.  
2-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
What Will You See After an Airbag  
Inflates?  
WARNING:  
{
After the frontal airbags inflate, they quickly deflate, so  
quickly that some people may not even realize an  
airbag inflated. Roof-rail airbags may still be at least  
partially inflated for some time after they deploy. Some  
components of the airbag module may be hot for  
several minutes. For location of the airbag modules,  
see What Makes an Airbag Inflate? on page 267.  
When an airbag inflates, there may be dust in the  
air. This dust could cause breathing problems for  
people with a history of asthma or other breathing  
trouble. To avoid this, everyone in the vehicle  
should get out as soon as it is safe to do so.  
If you have breathing problems but cannot get out  
of the vehicle after an airbag inflates, then get  
fresh air by opening a window or a door. If you  
experience breathing problems following an airbag  
deployment, you should seek medical attention.  
The parts of the airbag that come into contact with you  
may be warm, but not too hot to touch. There may be  
some smoke and dust coming from the vents in the  
deflated airbags. Airbag inflation does not prevent the  
driver from seeing out of the windshield or being able to  
steer the vehicle, nor does it prevent people from  
leaving the vehicle.  
The vehicle has a feature that may automatically unlock  
the doors, turn on the interior lamps and hazard warning  
flashers, and shut off the fuel system after the airbags  
inflate. You can lock the doors, turn off the interior  
lamps and hazard warning flashers by using the  
controls for those features.  
2-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In many crashes severe enough to inflate the airbag,  
windshields are broken by vehicle deformation.  
Additional windshield breakage may also occur from  
the right front passenger airbag.  
WARNING:  
{
A crash severe enough to inflate the airbags  
may have also damaged important functions in  
the vehicle, such as the fuel system, brake and  
steering systems, etc. Even if the vehicle appears  
to be drivable after a moderate crash, there may  
be concealed damage that could make it difficult  
to safely operate the vehicle.  
.
Airbags are designed to inflate only once. After an  
airbag inflates, you will need some new parts for  
the airbag system. If you do not get them, the  
airbag system will not be there to help protect you  
in another crash. A new system will include airbag  
modules and possibly other parts. The service  
manual for the vehicle covers the need to replace  
other parts.  
Use caution if you should attempt to restart the  
engine after a crash has occurred.  
.
The vehicle has a crash sensing and diagnostic  
module which records information after a crash.  
See Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy on  
page 815 and Event Data Recorders on  
page 816  
.
.
Let only qualified technicians work on the airbag  
systems. Improper service can mean that an  
airbag system will not work properly. See your  
dealer/retailer for service.  
2-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the system check is complete, either the word  
ON or the word OFF, or the symbol for on or off, will be  
visible. See Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on  
Passenger Sensing System  
If the vehicle has one of the passenger airbag status  
indicators pictured in the following illustrations, then the  
vehicle has a passenger sensing system for the right  
front passenger position. The passenger airbag status  
indicator, if equipped, is visible on the instrument panel  
when the vehicle is started.  
page 428  
.
The passenger sensing system will turn off the right  
front passenger frontal airbag under certain conditions.  
The driver airbag and roofrail airbags are not affected  
by the passenger sensing system.  
In addition, if the vehicle has a passenger sensing  
system for the right front passenger position, the label  
on the vehicle's sun visors refer to ADVANCED  
AIRBAGS.  
The passenger sensing system works with sensors  
that are part of the right front passenger seat. The  
sensors are designed to detect the presence of a  
properly-seated occupant and determine if the right  
front passenger frontal airbag should be enabled  
(may inflate) or not.  
According to accident statistics, children are safer when  
properly secured in a rear seat in the correct child  
restraint for their weight and size.  
We recommend that children be secured in a rear seat,  
including: an infant or a child riding in a rear-facing child  
restraint; a child riding in a forward-facing child seat; an  
older child riding in a booster seat; and children, who  
are large enough, using safety belts.  
United States  
Canada  
The words ON and OFF, or the symbol for on and off,  
will be visible during the system check. If you are using  
remote start, if equipped, to start the vehicle from a  
distance, you may not see the system check.  
A label on the sun visor says, Never put a rear-facing  
child seat in the front.This is because the risk to the  
rear-facing child is so great, if the airbag deploys.  
2-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle does not have a rear seat that will  
accommodate a rearfacing child restraint, a rearfacing  
child restraint should not be installed in the vehicle,  
even if the airbag is off.  
WARNING:  
{
A child in a rear-facing child restraint can be  
seriously injured or killed if the right front  
passenger airbag inflates. This is because the  
back of the rear-facing child restraint would be  
very close to the inflating airbag. A child in a  
forward-facing child restraint can be seriously  
injured or killed if the right front passenger airbag  
inflates and the passenger seat is in a forward  
position.  
The passenger sensing system is designed to turn off  
the right front passenger frontal airbag if:  
.
The right front passenger seat is unoccupied.  
.
The system determines that an infant is present in  
a child restraint.  
.
A right front passenger takes his/her weight off of  
the seat for a period of time.  
.
Or, if there is a critical problem with the airbag  
Even if the passenger sensing system has turned  
off the right front passenger frontal airbag, no  
system is fail-safe. No one can guarantee that  
an airbag will not deploy under some unusual  
circumstance, even though the airbag is  
turned off.  
system or the passenger sensing system.  
When the passenger sensing system has turned off the  
right front passenger frontal airbag, the off indicator will  
light and stay lit to remind you that the airbag is off. See  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator on page 428.  
Secure rear-facing child restraints in a rear  
seat, even if the airbag is off. If you secure a  
forward-facing child restraint in the right front seat,  
always move the front passenger seat as far back  
as it will go. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
2-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The passenger sensing system is designed turn on  
(may inflate) the right front passenger frontal airbag  
anytime the system senses that a person of adult size is  
sitting properly in the right front passenger seat. When  
the passenger sensing system has allowed the airbag  
to be enabled, the on indicator will light and stay lit to  
remind you that the airbag is active.  
WARNING:  
{
If the airbag readiness light ever comes on and  
stays on, it means that something may be wrong  
with the airbag system. To help avoid injury to  
yourself or others, have the vehicle serviced right  
away. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 427  
for more information, including important safety  
information.  
For some children, including children in child restraints,  
and for very small adults, the passenger sensing  
system may or may not turn off the right front passenger  
frontal airbag, depending upon the person's seating  
posture and body build. Everyone in the vehicle who  
has outgrown child restraints should wear a safety belt  
properly whether or not there is an airbag for that  
person.  
2-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. If, after reinstalling the child restraint and restarting  
the vehicle, the on indicator is still lit, turn the  
vehicle off. Then slightly recline the vehicle  
If the On Indicator is Lit for a Child  
Restraint  
seatback and adjust the seat cushion, if adjustable,  
to make sure that the vehicle seatback is not  
pushing the child restraint into the seat cushion.  
If a child restraint has been installed and the on  
indicator is lit:  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
Also make sure the child restraint is not trapped  
under the vehicle head restraint. If this happens,  
adjust the head restraint. See Head Restraints on  
2. Remove the child restraint from the vehicle.  
3. Remove any additional items from the seat such  
as blankets, cushions, seat covers, seat heaters,  
or seat massagers.  
page 22  
.
6. Restart the vehicle.  
4. Reinstall the child restraint following the directions  
provided by the child restraint manufacturer and  
refer to Securing a Child Restraint in the Right  
Front Seat Position on page 256.  
The passenger sensing system may or may not  
turn off the airbag for a child in a child restraint  
depending upon the child's seating posture and  
body build. It is better to secure the child restraint  
in a rear seat.  
If no rear seat is available, do not install a child  
restraint in this vehicle.  
2-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If this happens, use the following steps to allow the  
system to detect that person and enable the right front  
passenger frontal airbag:  
If the Off Indicator is Lit for an  
Adult-Size Occupant  
1. Turn the vehicle off.  
2. Remove any additional material from the seat,  
such as blankets, cushions, seat covers, seat  
heaters, or seat massagers.  
3. Place the seatback in the fully upright position.  
4. Have the person sit upright in the seat, centered  
on the seat cushion, with legs comfortably  
extended.  
5. Restart the vehicle and have the person remain in  
this position for two to three minutes after the on  
indicator is lit.  
If a person of adult-size is sitting in the right front  
passenger seat, but the off indicator is lit, it could be  
because that person is not sitting properly in the seat.  
2-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A wet seat can affect the performance of the passenger  
sensing system. Here is how:  
Additional Factors Affecting System  
Operation  
Safety belts help keep the passenger in position on the  
seat during vehicle maneuvers and braking, which helps  
the passenger sensing system maintain the passenger  
airbag status. See Safety Beltsand Child Restraints”  
in the Index for additional information about the  
importance of proper restraint use.  
.
The passenger sensing system may turn off the  
passenger airbag when liquid is soaked into the  
seat. If this happens, the off indicator will be lit,  
and the airbag readiness light on the instrument  
panel will also be lit.  
.
Liquid pooled on the seat that has not soaked in  
may make it more likely that the passenger  
sensing system will enable (turn on) the passenger  
airbag while a child restraint or child occupant is on  
the seat. If the passenger airbag is turned on, the  
on indicator will be lit.  
A thick layer of additional material, such as a blanket  
or cushion, or aftermarket equipment such as seat  
covers, seat heaters, and seat massagers can affect  
how well the passenger sensing system operates.  
We recommend that you not use seat covers or other  
aftermarket equipment except when approved by GM  
for your specific vehicle. See Adding Equipment to Your  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on page 277 for more  
information about modifications that can affect how  
the system operates.  
2-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the passenger seat gets wet, dry the seat  
immediately. If the airbag readiness light is lit, do  
not install a child restraint or allow anyone to occupy  
the seat. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 427 for  
important safety information.  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle  
Airbags affect how the vehicle should be serviced.  
There are parts of the airbag system in several places  
around the vehicle. Your dealer/retailer and the service  
manual have information about servicing the vehicle  
and the airbag system. To purchase a service manual,  
see Service Publications Ordering Information on  
The on indicator may be lit if an object, such as a  
briefcase, handbag, grocery bag, laptop or other  
electronic device, is put on an unoccupied seat. If this  
is not desired, remove the object from the seat.  
page 814  
.
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
Stowing of articles under the passenger seat or  
between the passenger seat cushion and  
seatback may interfere with the proper operation  
of the passenger sensing system.  
For up to 10 seconds after the ignition is turned off  
and the battery is disconnected, an airbag can still  
inflate during improper service. You can be injured  
if you are close to an airbag when it inflates. Avoid  
yellow connectors. They are probably part of the  
airbag system. Be sure to follow proper service  
procedures, and make sure the person performing  
work for you is qualified to do so.  
2-76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
sensing system. This could either prevent proper  
deployment of the passenger airbag(s) or prevent  
the passenger sensing system from properly turning  
off the passenger airbag(s). See Passenger Sensing  
Adding Equipment to Your  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle  
Q: Is there anything I might add to or change about  
the vehicle that could keep the airbags from  
working properly?  
System on page 270  
.
If you have questions, call Customer Assistance.  
The phone numbers and addresses for Customer  
Assistance are in Step Two of the Customer  
Satisfaction Procedure in this manual. See  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure on page 82.  
A: Yes. If you add things that change the vehicle's  
frame, bumper system, height, front end or side  
sheet metal, they may keep the airbag system from  
working properly. Changing or moving any parts of  
the front seats, safety belts, the airbag sensing and  
diagnostic module, steering wheel, instrument panel,  
roof-rail airbag modules, ceiling headliner or pillar  
garnish trim, front sensors, side impact sensors,  
rollover sensor module, or airbag wiring can affect  
the operation of the airbag system.  
If the vehicle has rollover roof-rail airbags, see  
Different Size Tires and Wheels on page 674 for  
additional important information.  
Q: Because I have a disability, I have to get my  
vehicle modified. How can I find out whether this  
will affect my airbag system?  
In addition, the vehicle may have a passenger  
sensing system for the right front passenger  
A: If you have questions, call Customer Assistance.  
The phone numbers and addresses for Customer  
Assistance are in Step Two of the Customer  
Satisfaction Procedure in this manual. See  
position, which includes sensors that are part of the  
passenger seat. The passenger sensing system  
may not operate properly if the original seat trim is  
replaced with non-GM covers, upholstery or trim,  
or with GM covers, upholstery or trim designed for a  
different vehicle. Any object, such as an aftermarket  
seat heater or a comfort enhancing pad or device,  
installed under or on top of the seat fabric, could  
also interfere with the operation of the passenger  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure on page 82.  
In addition, your dealer/retailer and the service manual  
have information about the location of the airbag  
sensors, sensing and diagnostic module and airbag  
wiring.  
2-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Airbags  
Restraint System Check  
The airbag system does not need regularly scheduled  
maintenance or replacement. Make sure the airbag  
readiness light is working. See Airbag Readiness Light  
on page 427 for more information.  
Checking the Restraint Systems  
Safety Belts  
Notice: If an airbag covering is damaged, opened,  
or broken, the airbag may not work properly. Do not  
open or break the airbag coverings. If there are any  
opened or broken airbag covers, have the airbag  
covering and/or airbag module replaced. For the  
location of the airbag modules, see What Makes an  
Airbag Inflate? on page 267. See your dealer/  
retailer for service.  
Now and then, check that the safety belt reminder light,  
safety belts, buckles, latch plates, retractors, and  
anchorages are all working properly.  
Look for any other loose or damaged safety belt system  
parts that might keep a safety belt system from doing its  
job. See your dealer/retailer to have it repaired. Torn or  
frayed safety belts may not protect you in a crash. They  
can rip apart under impact forces. If a belt is torn or  
frayed, get a new one right away.  
Make sure the safety belt reminder light is working.  
See Safety Belt Reminders on page 426 for more  
information.  
Keep safety belts clean and dry. See Care of Safety  
Belts on page 6113  
.
2-78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle has the LATCH system and it was being  
used during a crash, you may need new LATCH system  
parts.  
Replacing Restraint System Parts  
After a Crash  
New parts and repairs may be necessary even if the  
safety belt or LATCH system (if equipped), was not  
being used at the time of the crash.  
WARNING:  
{
If an airbag inflates, you will need to replace airbag  
system parts. See the part on the airbag system earlier  
in this section.  
A crash can damage the restraint systems in your  
vehicle. A damaged restraint system may not  
properly protect the person using it, resulting in  
serious injury or even death in a crash. To help  
make sure your restraint systems are working  
properly after a crash, have them inspected and  
any necessary replacements made as soon as  
possible.  
Have the safety belt pretensioners checked if the  
vehicle has been in a crash, if the airbag readiness light  
stays on after the vehicle is started, or while you are  
driving. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 427  
.
If the vehicle has been in a crash, do you need new  
safety belts or LATCH system (if equipped) parts?  
After a very minor crash, nothing may be necessary.  
But the safety belt assemblies that were used during  
any crash may have been stressed or damaged. See  
your dealer/retailer to have the safety belt assemblies  
inspected or replaced.  
2-79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
2-80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3 Features and Controls  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-3  
Starting and Operating Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22  
New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22  
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25  
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25  
Engine Coolant Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27  
Automatic Transmission Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28  
Manual Transmission Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31  
Parking Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Shifting Into Park (Automatic Transmission) . . . 3-36  
Shifting Out of Park  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4  
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7  
Doors and Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Power Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Automatic Door Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Programmable Automatic Door Unlock . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
Rear Side Cargo Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13  
(Automatic Transmission) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Parking the Vehicle  
(Manual Transmission) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Parking Over Things That Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Running the Vehicle While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-40  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16  
Power Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17  
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41  
Manual Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41  
Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41  
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41  
Outside Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43  
Outside Convex Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43  
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Content Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
3-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 3 Features and Controls  
Object Detection Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-44  
Rear Storage Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-48  
Rear Compartment Storage Panel/Cover . . . . . . 3-48  
Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-50  
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-51  
Hideaway Rear Storage Bins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-51  
Rear Vision Camera (RVC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-44  
Storage Areas . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Instrument Panel Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Floor Console Storage Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-52  
3-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keys  
WARNING:  
{
Leaving children in a vehicle with the ignition key  
is dangerous for many reasons, children or others  
could be badly injured or even killed. They could  
operate the power windows or other controls or  
even make the vehicle move. The windows will  
function with the keys in the ignition and children  
could be seriously injured or killed if caught in the  
path of a closing window. Do not leave the keys in  
a vehicle with children.  
The key can be used for the ignition and the driver's  
door lock.  
The key has a transponder in the key head that  
matches a decoder in the vehicle's steering column.  
If a replacement key or any additional keys are needed,  
you must purchase it from your dealer/retailer.  
3-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The key has a bar-coded key tag that the dealer/retailer  
or qualified locksmith can use to make new keys. Store  
this information in a safe place, not in your vehicle.  
If there is a decrease in the RKE operating range,  
try this:  
.
Check the distance. The transmitter may be too  
far from the vehicle. Stand closer during rainy or  
snowy weather.  
Notice: If you ever lock your keys in the vehicle,  
you may have to damage the vehicle to get in.  
Be sure you have spare keys.  
.
Check the location. Other vehicles or objects may  
be blocking the signal. Take a few steps to the left  
or right, hold the transmitter higher, and try again.  
If you are locked out of your vehicle, contact Roadside  
Assistance. See Roadside Assistance Program on  
page 86 for more information.  
.
Check the transmitter's battery. See Battery  
Replacementlater in this section.  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
.
If the transmitter is still not working correctly, see  
your dealer/retailer or a qualified technician for  
service.  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 817 for  
information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) Rules and  
RSS-210/211 of Industry Canada.  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
Operation  
The Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter functions  
work up to 60 feet (18 m) away from the vehicle.  
Changes or modifications to this system by other than  
an authorized service facility could void authorization to  
use this equipment.  
There are other conditions which can affect the  
performance of the transmitter. See Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) System on page 34.  
3-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Pressing Q may arm the content theft-deterrent system.  
See Content Theft-Deterrent on page 319.  
K (Unlock): Press once to unlock the driver door.  
If enabled through the DIC, the horn chirps to indicate  
unlocking has occurred. See UNLOCK HORNunder  
DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 454 for more  
information. If K is pressed again within five seconds,  
all remaining doors and the liftgate unlock. The interior  
lamps come on and stay on for 20 seconds or until the  
ignition is turned on. If enabled through the DIC, the  
parking lamps flash twice to indicate unlocking has  
occurred and the high beams and parking lamps may  
turn on and stay on for 20 seconds or until a door is  
opened. See LIGHT FLASH and EXT (Exterior) LIGHTS  
under DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 454 for  
additional information.  
With Remote Start  
and Remote Rear Doors  
Shown, Without Similar  
/ (Remote Vehicle Start): For vehicles with this  
feature, press to start the engine from outside the  
vehicle using the RKE transmitter. See Remote Vehicle  
Start on page 37 for additional information.  
L (Vehicle Locator/Panic Alarm): Press and release  
to activate the vehicle locate feature. The horn chirps  
three times and the headlamps and parking lamps flash  
three times.  
Q (Lock): Press to lock all the doors. The interior  
lamps turn off after all of the doors are closed.  
If enabled through the Driver Information Center (DIC),  
the parking lamps flash once to indicate locking has  
occurred. If enabled through the DIC, the horn chirps to  
indicate locking has occurred. See LOCK HORN”  
under DIC Vehicle Personalization on page 454 for  
more information.  
Press and hold L for three seconds to sound the panic  
alarm. The horn chirps and the headlamps and parking  
lamps flash for 30 seconds. Press L again to cancel  
the panic alarm.  
3-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Remote Rear Door Operation (Panel)  
* : Press and hold for about one second to open the  
rear driver side door.  
+ : Press and hold for about one second to open the  
rear passenger side door.  
Programming Transmitters to the  
Vehicle  
Only RKE transmitters programmed to the vehicle will  
work. If a transmitter is lost or stolen, a replacement  
can be purchased and programmed through your  
dealer/retailer. When the replacement transmitter is  
programmed to the vehicle, all remaining transmitters  
must also be programmed. Any lost or stolen  
transmitters no longer work once the new transmitter  
is programmed. Each vehicle can have up to four  
transmitters programmed to it.  
To replace the battery:  
1. Separate the transmitter with a flat, thin object  
inserted into the notch on the side.  
Battery Replacement  
2. Remove the old battery. Do not use a metal object.  
Replace the battery if the KEY FOB BATT LOW  
message displays in the DIC. See KEY FOB BATT  
LOWunder DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 448 for additional information.  
3. Insert the new battery, positive side facing up.  
Replace with a CR2032 or equivalent battery.  
4. Snap the transmitter back together.  
Notice: When replacing the battery, do not touch  
any of the circuitry on the transmitter. Static from  
your body could damage the transmitter.  
3-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
/ (Remote Vehicle Start): This button will be on the  
RKE transmitter if you have remote start.  
Remote Vehicle Start  
Your vehicle may have a remote start feature. This  
feature allows you to start the engine from outside the  
vehicle. It may also start the vehicle's heating or air  
conditioning systems. See Climate Control System on  
page 418 for additional information.  
To start the engine using the remote start feature:  
1. Aim the RKE transmitter at the vehicle.  
2. Press and release the transmitter's lock button,  
then immediately press and hold the remote  
vehicle start button for four seconds or until the  
vehicle's turn signal lamps flash.  
Laws in some local communities may restrict the use of  
remote starters. For example, some laws may require a  
person using remote start to have the vehicle in view  
when doing so. Check local regulations for any  
requirements on remote starting of vehicles.  
When the vehicle's engine starts, the parking  
lamps will turn on and remain on while the engine  
is running. The vehicle's doors will be locked.  
Do not use the remote start feature if your vehicle is low  
on fuel. Your vehicle may run out of fuel.  
3. If it is the first remote start since the vehicle has  
been driven, repeat these steps, while the engine  
is still running, to extend the engine running time  
by 10 minutes. Remote start can be extended  
one time.  
If your vehicle has the remote start feature, the RKE  
transmitter functions will have an increased range of  
operation. However, the range may be less while the  
vehicle is running.  
After entering the vehicle during a remote start, insert  
and turn the key to ON/RUN to drive the vehicle.  
There are other conditions which can affect the  
performance of the transmitter, see Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) System on page 34 for additional  
information.  
After a remote start, the engine will automatically shut  
off after 10 minutes unless a time extension has been  
done or the vehicle's key is inserted into the ignition  
switch and turned to ON/RUN.  
The maximum number of remote starts between ignition  
cycles with the key is two.  
3-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the remote start procedure is used again before  
the first 10 minute time frame has ended, the first  
10 minutes will immediately expire and the second  
10 minute time frame will start.  
The remote vehicle start feature will not operate if:  
.
The remote start system is disabled through  
the DIC.  
.
The vehicle's key is in the ignition.  
After your vehicle's engine has been started two times  
using the remote start button, the vehicle's ignition  
switch must be turned to ON/RUN and then back to  
LOCK/OFF using the key before the remote start  
procedure can be used again.  
.
The vehicle's hood is open  
.
The hazard warning flashers are on.  
.
There is an emission control system malfunction.  
See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 435.  
To manually shut off the engine after a remote start:  
.
The engine coolant temperature is too high.  
.
Aim the RKE transmitter at the vehicle and press  
.
The oil pressure is low.  
the remote start button until the parking lamps  
turn off.  
.
Two remote vehicle starts have already been  
provided.  
.
Turn on the hazard warning flashers. See Hazard  
Warning Flashers on page 43.  
.
Insert the vehicle's key into the ignition switch and  
turn the switch to ON/RUN and then back to  
LOCK/OFF.  
3-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Doors and Locks  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Door Locks  
.
Young children who get into unlocked vehicles  
may be unable to get out. A child can be  
overcome by extreme heat and can suffer  
permanent injuries or even death from heat  
stroke. Always lock the vehicle whenever  
leaving it.  
WARNING:  
{
Unlocked doors can be dangerous.  
.
Passengers, especially children, can easily  
.
Outsiders can easily enter through an  
open the doors and fall out of a moving  
vehicle. When a door is locked, the handle will  
not open it. The chance of being thrown out of  
the vehicle in a crash is increased if the doors  
are not locked. So, all passengers should  
wear safety belts properly and the doors  
should be locked whenever the vehicle is  
driven.  
unlocked door when you slow down or stop  
your vehicle. Locking your doors can help  
prevent this from happening.  
There are several ways to lock and unlock your vehicle.  
To lock the driver's door from the outside, turn the key  
clockwise. To unlock the door, turn the key  
counterclockwise.  
(Continued)  
You can also use the remote keyless entry transmitter  
to lock and unlock the doors.  
From the inside, use the manual lock knobs on each  
door or the power door lock switch to lock and unlock  
all doors.  
3-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Door Locks  
Delayed Locking  
This feature will delay the actual locking of the doors  
and liftgate when the power door lock switch or remote  
keyless entry transmitter is used to lock the vehicle.  
The power door lock  
switches are located on  
the driver's and front  
passenger's door next to  
the door handle.  
If any door is open when locking the vehicle, three  
chimes will sound signaling that the delayed locking  
feature is active. Five seconds after the last door is  
closed, all of the doors and liftgate will lock. The turn  
signal lamps will flash to indicate that the doors have  
been locked. To cancel the delay and lock the doors  
immediately, press the lock button a second time.  
If the key is in the ignition this feature will not lock  
the doors.  
Driver's side shown,  
Passenger's side similar  
If your vehicle has a Driver Information Center (DIC),  
you can disable this function. See DIC Vehicle  
Personalization on page 454.  
Press the top of the switch to unlock the doors. Press  
the bottom of the switch to lock the doors.  
3-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic Door Lock  
Rear Door Security Locks  
On vehicles with power door locks, the doors  
automatically lock when the shift lever is moved out  
of (P) Park for a vehicle with an automatic transmission.  
For a vehicle with a manual transmission, the speed  
must be greater than 5 mph (8 km/h).  
Vehicles with rear door security locks prevent  
passengers from opening the rear doors from the  
inside.  
On vehicles with this  
feature, the rear door  
security locks are located  
on the inside edge of  
each rear door. You must  
open the rear doors to  
access them.  
The automatic door locking feature cannot be disabled.  
Programmable Automatic Door  
Unlock  
Your vehicle will automatically unlock all doors when the  
shift lever is moved into (P) Park for a vehicle with an  
automatic transmission, and when the ignition is turned  
off for a vehicle with a manual transmission.  
If your vehicle has a Driver Information Center (DIC),  
the doors can be programmed to automatically  
unlock several ways for vehicles with an automatic  
transmission. See DIC Vehicle Personalization on  
page 454 for more information.  
To set the security locks, do the following:  
1. Insert the key into the lock below the rear door  
security lock label and turn it to the horizontal  
position.  
2. Close the door.  
3. Repeat the steps for the other rear door.  
3-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To open a rear door while the security lock is on, do the  
following:  
Lockout Protection  
If you press the power door lock switch when the key is  
in the ignition and any door is open, all the doors will  
lock and the driver's door will unlock. Be sure to remove  
the key from the ignition when locking your vehicle.  
1. Unlock the door using the remote keyless entry  
transmitter, the power door lock switch, or by lifting  
the rear door manual lock.  
2. Open the door from the outside.  
The lockout protection can be overridden by pressing  
and holding the power door lock in the lock position for  
three seconds.  
To cancel the rear door security lock, do the following:  
1. Unlock the door and open it from the outside.  
2. Insert the key into the lock below the rear door  
security lock label and turn it to the vertical  
position.  
Rear Side Cargo Door  
The rear side cargo doors can be opened by pressing  
the buttons located on the driver and passenger sides  
of the instrument panel, or by using the Remote Keyless  
Access (RKE) transmitter. See Instrument Panel on  
page 12, and Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System  
Operation on page 34 Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
System Operation for more information.  
3. Repeat the steps for the other lock.  
To use the buttons on the instrument panel, the driver  
side door must be unlocked.  
Push the door to close.  
3-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Liftgate  
WARNING:  
{
To lock the liftgate from the outside, press the lock  
button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter.  
To unlock the liftgate with the RKE, press the unlock  
button twice within five seconds. For more information,  
see Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on  
page 34. You can also use the power door lock  
switch to lock and unlock the liftgate.  
Exhaust gases can enter the vehicle if it is driven  
with the liftgate, trunk/hatch open, or with any  
objects that pass through the seal between the  
body and the trunk/hatch or liftgate. Engine  
exhaust contains Carbon Monoxide (CO) which  
cannot be seen or smelled. It can cause  
unconsciousness and even death.  
Open the liftgate by pressing the touchpad located in  
the handle above the license plate. Once slightly  
opened, the liftgate will rise by itself. Lamps in the rear  
of the vehicle will come on, illuminating the rear cargo  
area, unless the dome lamp lever is in the off position.  
For more information, see Dome Lamp on page 414.  
If the vehicle must be driven with the liftgate,  
or trunk/hatch open:  
.
Close all of the windows.  
.
Notice: If you open the liftgate without checking for  
overhead obstructions such as a garage door, you  
could damage the liftgate or the liftgate glass.  
Always check to make sure the area above and  
behind the liftgate is clear before opening it.  
Fully open the air outlets on or under the  
instrument panel.  
.
Adjust the Climate Control system to a setting  
that brings in only outside air and set the fan  
speed to the highest setting. See Climate  
Control System in the Index.  
.
If the vehicle is equipped with a power liftgate,  
disable the power liftgate function.  
For more information about carbon monoxide, see  
Engine Exhaust on page 339.  
3-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. Locate the release  
lever on the latch.  
Manual Liftgate Release  
To manually open the liftgate, do the following:  
The lever is located about three inches (7.62 cm)  
behind the trim in the access hole.  
1. Remove the trim plug, located on the inside of the  
liftgate near the center.  
3-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Push the release lever  
rearward.  
4. The liftgate will unlatch when the lever is pushed  
rearward. Push the liftgate to open.  
3. Insert a tool into the access hole.  
5. Reinstall the trim plug.  
3-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Windows  
WARNING:  
{
Leaving children, helpless adults, or pets in a  
vehicle with the windows closed is dangerous.  
They can be overcome by the extreme heat and  
suffer permanent injuries or even death from heat  
stroke. Never leave a child, a helpless adult, or a  
pet alone in a vehicle, especially with the windows  
closed in warm or hot weather.  
3-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power Windows  
WARNING:  
{
Leaving children in a vehicle with the keys is  
dangerous for many reasons, children or others  
could be badly injured or even killed. They could  
operate the power windows or other controls or  
even make the vehicle move. The windows will  
function and they could be seriously injured or  
killed if caught in the path of a closing window.  
Do not leave keys in a vehicle with children.  
Driver's Side Shown  
The power window controls are located on each of the  
side doors. The driver's door also has switches that  
control the passenger and rear windows.  
When there are children in the rear seat use the  
window lockout button to prevent unintentional  
operation of the windows.  
Press the switch to lower the window. Pull up on the  
front edge of the switch to raise the window.  
The power windows work when the ignition has been  
turned to ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN or when  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) is active. See  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) on page 325  
.
3-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Express-Down Window  
Sun Visors  
The driver's window switch has an express-down  
feature that allows the window to be lowered without  
holding the switch. Press the switch part way, and the  
driver's window will open a small amount. Press the  
switch down all the way, release it, and the window will  
go down automatically.  
To block out glare, swing down the visor(s). The sun  
visors can also be detached from the center mount and  
swung out to cover the side windows. They can also be  
slid along the rod to cover different areas of the front  
window.  
Visor Vanity Mirrors  
To stop the window while it is lowering, press and  
release the top of, or pull up on the switch.  
Your vehicle has visor vanity mirrors. Swing down the  
sun visor and lift the cover to expose the mirror.  
Window Lockout  
Theft-Deterrent Systems  
Vehicle theft is big business, especially in some cities.  
This vehicle has theft-deterrent features, however, they  
do not make it impossible to steal.  
o (Window Lockout): Your vehicle has a lockout  
feature to prevent rear seat passengers from operating  
the windows. Press the lockout button, located with the  
power window switches, to turn the feature on and off.  
When the red band on the button is showing, the  
lockout feature is off.  
3-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The security light turns on to indicate that arming has  
been initiated. Once the system is armed, the security  
light flashes once every three seconds.  
Content Theft-Deterrent  
Your vehicle may have a  
content theft-deterrent  
alarm system.  
If the security light flashes twice per second, a door  
is open.  
Locking the vehicle with the manual lock knobs on the  
doors will not arm the system.  
Disarming the System  
Disarm the system by doing any one of the following:  
Arming the System  
To arm the system:  
.
Press the RKE transmitter unlock button.  
.
Turn the ignition on.  
1. Turn the ignition off.  
Once the system is disarmed, the security light stops  
flashing.  
2. Press lock on the RKE transmitter.  
The system will arm after either of the following occur:  
How the System Alarm is Activated  
If the system is armed, it can be activated by either:  
.
30 seconds after all the doors are closed.  
.
60 seconds with any door open.  
.
Opening the driver's door or tailgate. This causes a  
Press the lock button on the RKE transmitter a second  
time, while all the doors are closed, to immediately arm  
the system. The system still arms in 60 seconds if a  
door is open. When the open door is closed, it  
also arms.  
10 second pre-alarm chirp followed by a 30 second  
full alarm of horn and lights.  
.
Opening any other door. This immediately causes  
a full alarm of horn and lights for 30 seconds.  
When an alarm event has finished, the system re-arms  
itself automatically.  
3-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
Immobilizer Operation  
How to Turn Off the System Alarm  
To turn off the system alarm, do one of the following:  
Your vehicle has PASS-Key® III+ (Personalized  
Automotive Security System) theft-deterrent system.  
PASS-Key® III+ is a passive theft-deterrent system.  
.
Press the lock button on the RKE transmitter.  
The system will then re-arm itself.  
.
Press the unlock button on the RKE transmitter.  
This will also disarm the system.  
The system is automatically armed when the key is  
removed from the ignition.  
.
Insert the key in the ignition and turn it on. This  
will also disarm the system.  
You do not have to manually arm or disarm the system.  
The security light will come on if there is a problem with  
arming or disarming the theft-deterrent system.  
How to Detect a Tamper Condition  
The content theft security system alarm was previously  
activated if three chirps sound when you press the lock  
or unlock buttons on the RKE transmitter.  
When the PASS-Key® III+ system senses that someone  
is using the wrong key, it prevents the vehicle from  
starting. Anyone using a trial-and-error method to start  
the vehicle will be discouraged because of the high  
number of electrical key codes.  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic  
Immobilizer  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 817  
for information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) Rules and  
RSS-210/211 of Industry Canada.  
When trying to start the vehicle if the engine does not  
start and the security light comes on, there may be a  
problem with your theft-deterrent system. Turn the  
ignition off and try again.  
3-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the engine still does not start, and the key appears to  
be undamaged, try another ignition key. At this time,  
you may also want to check the fuse, see Fuses and  
Circuit Breakers on page 6119. If the engine still does  
not start with the other key, your vehicle needs service.  
If your vehicle does start, the first key may be faulty.  
See your dealer/retailer who can service the  
PASS-Key® III+ to have a new key made. In an  
emergency, contact Roadside Assistance. See  
Roadside Assistance Program on page 86, for  
more information.  
It may be possible for the PASS-Key® III+ decoder to  
learnthe transponder value of a new or replacement  
key. Up to 10 keys may be programmed for the vehicle.  
The following procedure is for programming additional  
keys only. If all the currently programmed keys are lost  
or do not operate, you must see your dealer/retailer or a  
locksmith who can service PASS-Key® III+ to have keys  
made and programmed to the system.  
To program the new key:  
1. Verify that the new key has a 1 stamped on it.  
2. Insert the already programmed key in the ignition  
and start the engine. If the engine will not start,  
see your dealer/retailer for service.  
3. After the engine has started, turn the key to  
LOCK/OFF, and remove the key.  
4. Insert the key to be programmed and turn it to the  
ON/RUN position within five seconds of the original  
key being turned to the LOCK/OFF position.  
The security light will turn off once the key has  
been programmed.  
5. Repeat Steps 1 through 4 if additional keys are to  
be programmed.  
If you are ever driving and the security light comes on  
and stays on, you may be able to restart your engine  
if you turn it off. Your PASS-Key® III+ system, however,  
is not working properly and must be serviced by your  
dealer/retailer. Your vehicle is not protected by the  
PASS-Key® III+ system at this time.  
See your dealer/retailer or a locksmith who can service  
PASS-Key® III+ to get a new key blank that is cut  
exactly as the ignition key that operates the system.  
If you lose or damage your PASS-Key® III+ key, see  
your dealer/retailer or a locksmith who can service  
PASS-Key® III+ to have a new key made.  
Do not leave the key or device that disarms or  
deactivates the theft deterrent system in the vehicle.  
3-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Avoid making hard stops for the first  
200 miles (322 km) or so. During this time  
the new brake linings are not yet broken in.  
Hard stops with new linings can mean  
premature wear and earlier replacement.  
Follow this breaking-in guideline every time  
you get new brake linings.  
Starting and Operating Your  
Vehicle  
New Vehicle Break-In  
Notice: The vehicle does not need an elaborate  
break-in. But it will perform better in the long run  
if you follow these guidelines:  
.
Do not tow a trailer during break-in. See  
Towing a Trailer (Automatic Transmission)  
on page 532 or Towing a Trailer (Manual  
Transmission) on page 540 for the trailer  
towing capabilities of your vehicle and more  
information.  
.
Do not drive at any one constant speed,  
fast or slow, for the first 500 miles (805 km).  
Do not make full-throttle starts. Avoid  
downshifting to brake or slow the vehicle.  
Following breakin, engine speed and load can be  
gradually increased.  
3-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9 (LOCK/OFF): This position locks the steering column  
when the key is removed. The key can only be removed  
in LOCK/OFF.  
Ignition Positions  
On vehicles with an automatic transmission, the shift  
lever must be in P (Park) to turn the ignition switch to  
LOCK/OFF.  
On vehicles with a manual transmission, the ignition  
switch can be turned to LOCK/OFF in any shift lever  
position.  
The steering can bind with the wheel turned off center.  
If this happens, move it from right to left while turning  
the key to ACC/ACCESSORY. If this does not work,  
then the vehicle needs service.  
WARNING:  
The ignition switch has four different positions.  
{
In order to shift out of P (Park), the ignition must be in  
ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY and the brake pedal  
must be applied.  
If you have a manual transmission removing the  
key from the ignition switch will lock the steering  
column and result in a loss of ability to steer the  
vehicle. This could cause a collision. If you need  
to turn the engine off while the vehicle is moving,  
turn the key to ACC/ACCESSORY.  
Notice: Using a tool to force the key to turn in the  
ignition could cause damage to the switch or break  
the key. Use the correct key, make sure it is all the  
way in, and turn it only with your hand. If the key  
cannot be turned by hand, see your dealer/retailer.  
ACC (ACC/ACCESSORY): This position operates  
some of the electrical accessories. It unlocks the  
steering wheel and ignition.  
3-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
R (ON/RUN): This is the position in which you can  
operate the electrical accessories and to display some  
instrument panel cluster warning and indicator lights.  
The switch stays in this position when the engine is  
running.  
Column Lock Release  
For vehicles with an automatic transmission, the  
following procedure allows the ignition to be turned to  
LOCK/OFF and ignition key to be removed in case of a  
dead battery or low voltage battery.  
If you leave the key in the ACC/ACCESSORY or  
ON/RUN position with the engine off, the battery could  
be drained. You may not be able to start the vehicle if  
the battery is allowed to drain for an extended period  
of time.  
1. Make sure the shift lever is in P (Park).  
/ (START): This position starts the engine. When the  
engine starts, release the key. The ignition switch will  
return to ON/RUN for driving.  
A warning tone will sound when the driver door is  
opened, the ignition is in LOCK/OFF or ACC/  
ACCESSORY and the key is in the ignition.  
2. Remove the cover from the bottom of the steering  
column.  
3-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP)  
These vehicle accessories may be used for up to  
10 minutes after the engine is turned off.  
.
Audio System  
.
Power Windows, if equipped  
.
Sunroof, if equipped  
The power windows and sunroof will continue to work  
for up to 10 minutes or until any door is opened. The  
radio will work when the key is in ON/RUN or ACC/  
ACCESSORY. Once the key is turned from ON/RUN to  
OFF/LOCK, the radio will continue to work for  
10 minutes or until the driver's door is opened.  
Starting the Engine  
Place the transmission in the proper gear.  
3. Locate the plunger.  
4. Press and hold the plunger while turning the  
ignition key to LOCK/OFF. Remove the key.  
Automatic Transmission  
Have the vehicle serviced at your dealer/retailer as  
soon as possible.  
Move the shift lever to P (Park) or N (Neutral). The  
engine will not start in any other position. To restart the  
vehicle when it is already moving, use N (Neutral) only.  
Notice: Do not try to shift to P (Park) if the vehicle  
is moving. If you do, you could damage the  
transmission. Shift to P (Park) only when the vehicle  
is stopped.  
3-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Cranking the engine for long periods of  
time, by returning the key to the START position  
immediately after cranking has ended, can overheat  
and damage the cranking motor, and drain the  
battery. Wait at least 15 seconds between each try,  
to let the cranking motor cool down.  
Manual Transmission  
The shift lever should be in N (Neutral) and the parking  
brake engaged. Hold the clutch pedal down to the floor  
and start the engine. The vehicle will not start if the  
clutch pedal is not all the way down.  
Starting Procedure  
2. If the engine does not start after 510 seconds,  
especially in very cold weather (below 0°F or  
18°C), it could be flooded with too much gasoline.  
Push the accelerator pedal all the way to the floor  
and holding it there as you hold the key in START  
for a maximum of 15 seconds. Wait at least  
1. With your foot off the accelerator pedal, turn the  
ignition key to START. When the engine starts, let  
go of the key. The idle speed will go down as the  
engine warms. Do not race the engine immediately  
after starting it. Operate the engine and  
15 seconds between each try, to allow the cranking  
motor to cool. When the engine starts, let go of the  
key and accelerator. If the vehicle starts briefly but  
then stops again, repeat the procedure. This clears  
the extra gasoline from the engine. Do not race the  
engine immediately after starting it. Operate the  
engine and transmission gently until the oil warms  
up and lubricates all moving parts.  
transmission gently to allow the oil to warm up and  
lubricate all moving parts.  
The vehicle has a Computer-Controlled Cranking  
System. This feature assists in starting the engine  
and protects components. If the ignition key is  
turned to the START position, and then released  
when the engine begins cranking, the engine will  
continue cranking for a few seconds or until the  
vehicle starts. If the engine does not start and the  
key is held in START for many seconds, cranking  
will be stopped after 15 seconds to prevent  
cranking motor damage. To prevent gear damage,  
this system also prevents cranking if the engine is  
already running. Engine cranking can be stopped  
by turning the ignition switch to ACC/ACCESSORY  
or LOCK/OFF.  
Notice: The engine is designed to work with the  
electronics in the vehicle. If you add electrical parts  
or accessories, you could change the way the  
engine operates. Before adding electrical  
equipment, check with your dealer/retailer. If you  
do not, the engine might not perform properly.  
Any resulting damage would not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty.  
3-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Coolant Heater  
WARNING:  
{
The engine coolant heater can provide easier starting  
and better fuel economy during engine warmup in cold  
weather condition at or below 0°F (18°C). Vehicles  
with am engine coolant heater should be plugged in at  
least four hours before starting. An internal thermostat  
in the plug-end of the cord may exist which will prevent  
engine coolant heater operation at temperatures above  
0°F (18°C).  
Plugging the cord into an ungrounded outlet could  
cause an electrical shock. Also, the wrong kind of  
extension cord could overheat and cause a fire.  
You could be seriously injured. Plug the cord into  
a properly grounded three-prong 110-volt AC  
outlet. If the cord will not reach, use a heavy-duty  
three-prong extension cord rated for at least  
15 amps.  
To Use the Engine Coolant Heater  
1. Turn off the engine.  
2. Open the hood and unwrap the electrical cord. The  
electrical cord is located on the passenger side of  
the vehicle near the headlamp and the radiator.  
4. Before starting the engine, be sure to unplug and  
store the cord as it was before to keep it away from  
moving engine parts, to prevent damage.  
3. Plug it into a normal, grounded 110-volt AC outlet.  
The length of time the heater should remain plugged in  
depends on several factors. Ask a dealer/retailer in the  
area where you will be parking the vehicle for the best  
advice on this.  
3-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic Transmission Operation  
If the vehicle has an automatic transmission, the shift  
lever is located on the console between the seats.  
WARNING:  
{
It is dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the shift  
lever is not fully in P (Park) with the parking brake  
firmly set. The vehicle can roll.  
There are several  
different positions for the  
automatic transmission.  
Do not leave the vehicle when the engine is  
running unless you have to. If you have left the  
engine running, the vehicle can move suddenly.  
You or others could be injured. To be sure the  
vehicle will not move, even when you are on fairly  
level ground, always set the parking brake and  
move the shift lever to P (Park). See Shifting Into  
Park (Automatic Transmission) on page 336  
.
If you are pulling a trailer, see Towing a Trailer  
(Automatic Transmission) on page 532 or  
Towing a Trailer (Manual Transmission) on  
P (Park): This position locks the front wheels. It is the  
best position to use when starting the engine because  
the vehicle cannot move easily.  
page 540  
.
3-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Make sure the shift lever is fully in P (Park) before  
starting the engine. The vehicle has an automatic  
transmission shift lock control system. You have to fully  
apply the regular brakes first and then press the shift  
lever button before the vehicle can shift from P (Park)  
when the ignition key is in ON/RUN. If the vehicle  
cannot shift out of P (Park), ease pressure on the shift  
lever and push the shift lever all the way into P (Park)  
as you maintain brake application. Then press the shift  
lever button and then move the shift lever into another  
gear. See Shifting Out of Park (Automatic Transmission)  
N (Neutral): In this position, the engine does not  
connect with the wheels. To restart the engine when the  
vehicle is already moving, use N (Neutral) only. Also,  
use N (Neutral) when the vehicle is being towed.  
WARNING:  
{
Shifting into a drive gear while the engine is  
running at high speed is dangerous. Unless your  
foot is firmly on the brake pedal, the vehicle could  
move very rapidly. You could lose control and hit  
people or objects. Do not shift into a drive gear  
while the engine is running at high speed.  
on page 337  
.
R (Reverse): Use this gear to back up.  
Notice: Shifting to R (Reverse) while the vehicle is  
moving forward could damage the transmission.  
The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Shift to R (Reverse) only after the vehicle  
is stopped.  
Notice: Shifting out of P (Park) or N (Neutral) with  
the engine running at high speed may damage the  
transmission. The repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty. Be sure the engine is not  
running at high speed when shifting the vehicle.  
To rock your vehicle back and forth to get out of snow,  
ice, or sand without damaging the transmission, see If  
Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice, or Snow on  
page 523  
.
3-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
D (Drive): This position is for normal driving with the  
automatic transmission. It provides the best fuel  
economy. If you need more power for passing and  
you are:  
PERFORMANCE SHIFTING: If the vehicle has this  
feature, it can detect a change in driving patterns  
while in the Intermediate position. If you make an  
aggressive driving maneuver, the vehicle's transmission  
automatically shifts to the lowest possible gear to  
maximize vehicle performance. The vehicle will  
automatically return to normal operation when you  
return to normal driving patterns.  
.
Going less than about 35 mph (55 km/h), push  
the accelerator pedal about halfway down.  
.
Going about 35 mph (55 km/h), push the  
accelerator all the way down.  
L (Low): This position reduces vehicle speed more than  
I (Intermediate) without actually using the brakes. You  
can use it on very steep hills, or in deep snow or mud.  
If the shift lever is put in L (Low), the transmission will  
not shift into L (Low) until the vehicle is going slowly  
enough.  
Downshifting the transmission in slippery road  
conditions could result in skidding, see Skidding”  
under Loss of Control on page 515.  
I (Intermediate): This position is also used for normal  
driving. However, it reduces vehicle speed without using  
the brakes for slight downgrades where the vehicle  
would otherwise accelerate due to steepness of grade.  
If constant upshifting or downshifting occurs while  
driving up steep hills, this position can be used to  
prevent repetitive types of shifts. You might choose  
I (Intermediate) instead of D (Drive) when driving on  
hilly, winding roads and when towing a trailer, so that  
there is less shifting between gears.  
Notice: Spinning the tires or holding the vehicle in  
one place on a hill using only the accelerator pedal  
may damage the transmission. The repair will not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. If you are stuck, do  
not spin the tires. When stopping on a hill, use the  
brakes to hold the vehicle in place.  
3-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Manual Transmission Operation  
This is the shift pattern for SS models.  
Here is how to operate the manual transmission:  
This is the shift pattern for standard models.  
Notice: Do not rest your hand on the shift lever  
while driving. The pressure could cause premature  
wear in the transmission. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty.  
1 (First): Press the clutch pedal and shift into 1 (First).  
Then, slowly let up on the clutch pedal as you press the  
accelerator pedal.  
You can shift into 1 (First) when the vehicle is traveling  
less than 20 mph (32 km/h). If you have come to a  
complete stop and it is hard to shift into 1 (First), put the  
shift lever in N (Neutral) and let up on the clutch pedal.  
Press the clutch pedal back down. Then shift into  
1 (First).  
3-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 (Second): Press the clutch pedal as you let up on the  
accelerator pedal and shift into 2 (Second). Then, slowly  
let up on the clutch pedal as you press the accelerator  
pedal.  
Notice: Shifting to R (Reverse) while the vehicle is  
moving forward could damage the transmission.  
The repairs would not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Shift to R (Reverse) only after the vehicle  
is stopped.  
3 (Third), 4 (Fourth) and 5 (Fifth): Shift into 3 (Third),  
4 (Fourth) and 5 (Fifth) the same way you do for  
2 (Second). Slowly let up on the clutch pedal as  
you press the accelerator pedal down.  
Also, use R (Reverse), along with the parking brake, for  
parking the vehicle.  
Shift Speeds  
To stop, let up on the accelerator pedal and press the  
brake pedal. Just before the vehicle stops, press  
the clutch pedal and the brake pedal, and shift to  
N (Neutral).  
WARNING:  
{
N (Neutral): Use this position when you start or idle the  
engine.  
If you skip a gear when you downshift, you could  
lose control of the vehicle. You could injure  
yourself or others. Do not shift down more than  
one gear at a time when you downshift.  
R (Reverse): To back up, press down the clutch pedal  
and shift into R (Reverse).  
For SS models, lift upwards on the ring located on the  
underside of the shift knob to shift into R (Reverse).  
3-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Up-Shift Light  
NoLift Upshift (SS Models)  
If the vehicle has the 2.0L turbo engine and manual  
transmission, it has the capability of No-Lift Upshifts.  
This feature maximizes vehicle acceleration by allowing  
you to shift the transmission to a higher gear without  
taking your foot off the accelerator. NoLift Upshifting is  
enabled in all Electronic Stability Control modes. See  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on page 56 for  
more information. Use this feature only when the engine  
has reached normal operating temperature. Correct  
shifting allows the engine to maintain boost pressure  
during shifts, while also keeping the engine from  
over-revving.  
If the vehicle has a  
manual transmission,  
there may be an up-shift  
light. This light will show  
you when to shift to the  
next higher gear for the  
best fuel economy.  
When this light comes on, you can shift to the next  
higher gear if weather, road, and traffic conditions let  
you. For the best fuel economy, accelerate slowly and  
shift when the light comes on.  
While accelerating, it is normal for the light to go on and  
off if you quickly change the position of the accelerator.  
Ignore the light when downshifting.  
3-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To utilize this feature:  
Parking Brake  
1. Accelerate the vehicle by fully depressing the  
accelerator pedal.  
2. Just prior to reaching the maximum engine speed,  
quickly complete the upshift utilizing the clutch  
while keeping the accelerator pedal fully applied.  
A quicker shift maneuver gives the best  
performance. If the engine is operated at the  
maximum engine speed for greater than  
one second, the engine exits the NoLift Upshift  
mode and resumes normal engine overspeed  
protection.  
The parking brake lever is located between the front  
seats.  
3-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To release the parking brake, hold the brake pedal  
down. Pull the parking brake lever up until you can  
press the release button. Hold the release button in  
as you move the brake lever all the way down.  
WARNING:  
{
If the front passenger seat back is folded down,  
the armrest may make it awkward to grab and  
pull up the parking brake lever. If the lever is not  
pulled up far enough, the vehicle may roll and you  
or others could be injured. Move your hand lower  
on the lever or raise the seat back so that you can  
set the brake.  
If you forget to release your parking brake, a chime will  
sound and a warning message will be displayed when  
the parking brake is applied and the vehicle is moving  
faster than 5 mph (8 km/h). See DIC Warnings and  
Messages on page 448.  
Notice: Driving with the parking brake on can  
overheat the brake system and cause premature  
wear or damage to brake system parts. Make sure  
that the parking brake is fully released and the  
brake warning light is off before driving.  
To set the parking brake, hold the brake pedal down  
and pull up on the parking brake lever. If the ignition is  
on, the brake system warning light will come on. See  
Brake System Warning Light on page 430.  
3-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Leaving the Vehicle With the Engine  
Running (Automatic Transmission)  
Shifting Into Park  
(Automatic Transmission)  
WARNING:  
{
WARNING:  
{
It can be dangerous to leave the vehicle with the  
engine running. The vehicle could move suddenly  
if the shift lever is not fully in P (Park) with the  
parking brake firmly set. And, if you leave the  
vehicle with the engine running, it could overheat  
and even catch fire. You or others could be  
injured. Do not leave the vehicle with the engine  
running.  
It can be dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the  
shift lever is not fully in P (Park) with the parking  
brake firmly set. The vehicle can roll. If you have  
left the engine running, the vehicle can move  
suddenly. You or others could be injured. To be  
sure the vehicle will not move, even when you are  
on fairly level ground, use the steps that follow.  
If you are pulling a trailer, see Towing a Trailer  
(Automatic Transmission) on page 532 or  
Towing a Trailer (Manual Transmission) on  
If you have to leave an automatic transmission vehicle  
with the engine running, be sure the vehicle is in  
P (Park) and the parking brake is firmly set before  
you leave it. After you have moved the shift lever into  
P (Park), hold the brake pedal down. Then, see if you  
can move the shift lever away from P (Park) without first  
pushing the button. If you can, it means that the shift  
lever was not fully locked into P (Park).  
page 540  
.
To shift into P (Park):  
1. Hold the brake pedal down and set the parking  
brake. See Parking Brake on page 334 for more  
information.  
2. Move the shift lever into P (Park) by holding in the  
button on the shift lever and pushing the lever all  
the way toward the front of the vehicle.  
3. Turn the ignition key to LOCK/OFF.  
3-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Torque Lock (Automatic Transmission)  
Shifting Out of Park  
If you are parking on a hill and you do not shift into  
P (Park) properly, the weight of the vehicle may put too  
much force on the parking pawl in the transmission. You  
may find it difficult to pull the shift lever out of P (Park).  
This is called torque lock.To prevent torque lock, set  
the parking brake and then shift into P (Park) properly  
before you leave the driver seat. To find out how, see  
Shifting Into Park (Automatic Transmission) on  
(Automatic Transmission)  
This vehicle is equipped with an electronic shift lock  
release system. The shift lock release is designed to:  
.
Prevent ignition key removal unless the shift lever  
is in P (Park) with the shift lever button fully  
released, and  
.
Prevent movement of the shift lever out of  
page 336  
.
P (Park) unless the ignition is in ON/RUN or  
ACC/ACCESSORY and the regular brake pedal  
is applied.  
Move the shift lever out of P (Park) before you release  
the parking brake.  
The shift lock release is always functional except in the  
case of a an uncharged or low voltage (less than 9 volt)  
battery.  
If torque lock does occur, you may need to have  
another vehicle push yours a little uphill to take  
some of the pressure from the parking pawl in the  
transmission, so you can pull the shift lever out of  
P (Park).  
3-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle has an uncharged battery or a battery with  
low voltage, try charging or jump starting the battery.  
See Jump Starting on page 641 for more information.  
Parking the Vehicle  
(Manual Transmission)  
Before leaving the vehicle, fully press the clutch pedal  
down, move the shift lever into R (Reverse), and firmly  
apply the parking brake. Once the shift lever has been  
placed in R (Reverse) with the clutch pedal pressed  
down, the ignition key can be turned to LOCK/OFF, then  
remove the key and release the clutch pedal. See  
Manual Transmission Operation on page 331.  
To shift out of P (Park):  
1. Apply the brake pedal.  
2. Then press the shift lever button.  
3. Move the shift lever to the desired position.  
If you still are unable to shift out of P (Park):  
1. Fully release the shift lever button.  
Parking Over Things That Burn  
2. While holding down the brake pedal, press the  
shift lever button again.  
3. Move the shift lever to the desired position.  
WARNING:  
{
If you still cannot move the shift lever from P (Park),  
consult your dealer/retailer or a professional towing  
service.  
Things that can burn could touch hot exhaust  
parts under the vehicle and ignite. Do not park  
over papers, leaves, dry grass, or other things that  
can burn.  
3-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Exhaust  
WARNING:  
WARNING: (Continued)  
{
If unusual fumes are detected or if it is suspected  
that exhaust is coming into the vehicle:  
Engine exhaust contains Carbon Monoxide (CO)  
which cannot be seen or smelled. Exposure to CO  
can cause unconsciousness and even death.  
.
Drive it only with the windows  
completely down.  
.
Have the vehicle repaired immediately.  
Exhaust may enter the vehicle if:  
Never park the vehicle with the engine running in  
an enclosed area such as a garage or a building  
that has no fresh air ventilation.  
.
The vehicle idles in areas with poor ventilation  
(parking garages, tunnels, deep snow that  
may block underbody airflow or tail pipes).  
.
The exhaust smells or sounds strange or  
different.  
.
The exhaust system leaks due to corrosion or  
damage.  
.
The vehicles exhaust system has been  
modified, damaged or improperly repaired.  
.
There are holes or openings in the vehicle  
body from damage or after-market  
modifications that are not completely sealed.  
(Continued)  
3-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Running the Vehicle While Parked  
It is better not to park with the engine running. But if you  
ever have to, here are some things to know.  
WARNING:  
{
It can be dangerous to get out of the vehicle if the  
automatic transmission shift lever is not fully in  
P (Park) with the parking brake firmly set. The  
vehicle can roll. Do not leave the vehicle when the  
engine is running unless you have to. If you have  
left the engine running, the vehicle can move  
suddenly. You or others could be injured. To be  
sure the vehicle will not move, even when you are  
on fairly level ground, always set the parking  
brake and move the shift lever to P (Park).  
WARNING:  
{
Idling a vehicle in an enclosed area with poor  
ventilation is dangerous. Engine exhaust may  
enter the vehicle. Engine exhaust contains  
Carbon Monoxide (CO) which cannot be seen or  
smelled. It can cause unconsciousness and even  
death. Never run the engine in an enclosed area  
that has no fresh air ventilation. For more  
information, see Engine Exhaust on page 339.  
Follow the proper steps to be sure the vehicle will not  
move. See Shifting Into Park (Automatic Transmission)  
on page 336  
.
If parking on a hill and pulling a trailer, see Towing a  
Trailer (Automatic Transmission) on page 532 or  
Towing a Trailer (Manual Transmission) on page 540.  
3-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Automatic Dimming Mirror Operation  
Mirrors  
Automatic dimming reduces the glare of lights from  
behind the vehicle. The dimming feature comes on and  
the indicator light illuminates each time the vehicle is  
started.  
Manual Rearview Mirror  
Hold the inside rearview mirror in the center to move it  
for a clearer view behind your vehicle. Adjust the mirror  
to avoid glare from the headlamps behind you. Push the  
tab forward for daytime use and pull it for nighttime use.  
Cleaning the Mirror  
Do not spray glass cleaner directly on the mirror. Use a  
soft towel dampened with water.  
If the vehicle has map lamps, press the buttons located  
at the bottom of the mirror to turn them on or off.  
Compass  
Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror  
The vehicle may have an automatic dimming inside  
rearview mirror with a compass and map lights and/or  
OnStar®.  
Compass Operation  
Y / O (On/Off): If the vehicle has one of these buttons,  
press to turn the compass on or off.  
Vehicles with OnStar have three additional control  
buttons located at the bottom of the mirror. See your  
dealer/retailer for more information on the system and  
how to subscribe to OnStar®. See the OnStar® owners  
guide for more information about the services OnStar  
provides.  
With the compass feature on, each time the vehicle is  
started, the compass displays the current compass  
direction after a few seconds.  
Press the buttons located at the bottom of the mirror to  
turn the map lights on or off.  
O (On/Off): Press to turn the dimming feature on or off.  
3-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To adjust for compass variance:  
Compass Calibration  
1. Find the current location and variance zone  
number on the following zone map.  
If after a few seconds the display does not show a  
compass direction, (N for North for example), there may  
be a strong magnetic field interfering with the compass.  
Interference can be caused by a magnetic antenna  
mount, note pad holder, or similar object. If CAL  
appears in the compass window, the compass may  
need to be reset or calibrated.  
To calibrate the compass:  
1. Make sure CAL is displayed. If CAL is not  
displayed, press and hold the compass button until  
CAL displays.  
2. While CAL displays, drive the vehicle in circles at  
5 mph (8 km/h) or less until the display reads a  
direction.  
Compass Variance  
The mirror is set to zone eight. If you do not live in zone  
eight or drive out of the area, the compass variance  
needs to be changed to the appropriate zone.  
2. Press and hold the compass button until a Z and a  
zone number displays.  
3. Once the zone number displays, press the  
compass button repeatedly until the correct zone  
number is reached. If CAL displays in the compass  
window, the compass may need calibration. See  
Compass Calibrationlisted previously.  
3-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Outside Power Mirrors  
Outside Convex Mirror  
WARNING:  
Controls for the outside  
power mirrors are located  
on the driver door  
armrest.  
{
A convex mirror can make things, like other  
vehicles, look farther away than they really are.  
If you cut too sharply into the right lane, you could  
hit a vehicle on the right. Check the inside mirror  
or glance over your shoulder before changing  
lanes.  
The passenger side mirror is convex shaped. A convex  
mirror's surface is curved so more can be seen from the  
driver seat.  
1. Press the left or right side of the selector switch  
located beneath the control pad, to select the  
driver or passenger mirror.  
2. Press one of the four buttons located on the  
control pad to move the mirror to the desired  
direction.  
3. Adjust each outside mirror so that a little of the  
vehicle and the area behind it can be seen.  
Keep the selector switch in the center position when not  
adjusting either outside mirror.  
Manually fold the mirrors inward to prevent damage  
when going through an automatic car wash. To fold,  
push the mirror toward the vehicle. Push the mirror  
outward, to return to its original position.  
3-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Object Detection Systems  
WARNING: (Continued)  
Rear Vision Camera (RVC)  
So if you do not use proper care before backing  
up, you could hit a vehicle, child, pedestrian,  
bicyclist, or pet, resulting in vehicle damage,  
injury, or death. Even though the vehicle has  
the RVC system, always check carefully before  
backing up by checking behind and around the  
vehicle.  
The vehicle may have a Rear Vision Camera system.  
Read this entire section before using it.  
WARNING:  
{
The Rear Vision Camera (RVC) system does not  
replace driver vision. RVC does not:  
The rear vision camera system is designed to help  
the driver when backing up by displaying a view of  
the area behind the vehicle. When the key is in the  
ON/RUN position and the driver shifts the vehicle into  
R (Reverse), the video image automatically appears on  
the inside rear view mirror. Once the driver shifts out of  
R (Reverse), the video image automatically disappears  
from the inside rear view mirror.  
.
Detect objects that are outside the camera's  
field of view, below the bumper, or underneath  
the vehicle.  
.
Detect children, pedestrians, bicyclists,  
or pets.  
Do not back the vehicle by only looking at the  
RVC screen, or use the screen during longer,  
higher speed backing maneuvers or where there  
could be cross-traffic. Your judged distances using  
the screen will differ from actual distances.  
(Continued)  
3-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turning the Rear Vision Camera System  
Off or On  
Rear Vision Camera Location  
The camera is located in the rear of the vehicle.  
To turn off the rear vision camera system, press and  
hold z , located on the inside rearview mirror, until the  
left indicator light turns off. The rear vision camera  
display is now disabled.  
To turn the rear vision camera system on again, press  
and hold z until the left indicator light illuminates. The  
rear vision camera system display is now enabled and  
the display will appear in the mirror normally.  
The area displayed by the camera is limited and does  
not display objects that are close to either corner or  
under the bumper. The area displayed can vary  
depending on vehicle orientation or road conditions.  
The distance of the image that appears on the screen  
differs from the actual distance.  
The following illustration shows the field of view that the  
camera provides.  
3-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. View displayed by the camera.  
B. Corner of the rear bumper.  
When the System Does Not Seem To  
Work Properly  
The rear vision camera system might not work properly  
or display a clear image if:  
.
The RVC is turned off. See Turning the Rear  
Camera System On or Offearlier in this section.  
.
It is dark.  
.
The sun or the beam of headlights is shining  
directly into the camera lens.  
.
Ice, snow, mud, or anything else builds up on the  
camera lens. Clean the lens, rinse it with water,  
and wipe it with a soft cloth.  
.
The back of the vehicle is in an accident, the  
position and mounting angle of the camera can  
change or the camera can be affected. Be sure to  
have the camera and its position and mounting  
angle checked at your dealer/retailer.  
.
There are extreme temperature changes.  
3-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The rear vision camera system display in the rearview  
mirror may turn off or not appear as expected due to  
one of the following conditions. If this occurs the left  
indicator light on the mirror will flash.  
Storage Areas  
Glove Box  
Lift up on the glove box lever to open it.  
.
A slow flash may indicate a loss of video signal,  
or no video signal present during the reverse cycle.  
.
Cupholders  
A fast flash may indicate that the display has  
been on for the maximum allowable time during  
a reverse cycle, or the display has reached an  
Over Temperature limit.  
There are two cupholders located in the floor console  
between the front seats. There is also a cupholder for  
the rear seat passenger located at the rear of the floor  
console.  
The fast flash conditions are used to protect the  
video device from high temperature conditions.  
Once conditions return to normal the device will  
reset and the green indicator will stop flashing.  
Automatic transmission vehicles have a cupholder in  
front of the shift lever.  
During any of these fault conditions, the display will be  
blank and the indicator will continue to flash as long as  
the vehicle is in R (Reverse) or until the conditions  
return to normal.  
Instrument Panel Storage  
The vehicle has a storage compartment on the  
instrument panel above the air vents. Push the button  
on the compartment to open the cover.  
Pressing and holding z when the left indicator light is  
flashing will turn off the video display along with the left  
indicator light.  
Floor Console Storage Area  
There are two small storage compartments on the floor  
console.  
3-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rear Storage Area  
Rear Compartment Storage  
Panel/Cover  
The vehicle could have an adjustable panel/cargo cover  
feature. The panel/cargo cover can be adjusted into four  
positions.  
The vehicle could also have two rear storage areas that  
can be used for small items.  
3-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To use the panel in the lowest position:  
The panel can be used in this position if additional  
space above the panel is needed. Cargo can be placed  
on top of the panel in this position.  
1. Insert the front corners of the panel into the lower  
guides.  
2. Slide the panel forward.  
3. Press down on the back of the panel to lock it in  
place.  
WARNING:  
{
If you were to carry things on the adjustable panel  
when it is in the upper (cargo cover) or center  
positions, during a sudden vehicle movement or a  
crash, those things could be thrown around in the  
vehicle. You or others could be injured. When it is  
in the upper or center position, always secure any  
cargo on the floor beneath the panel/cover.  
To use the panel in the upper position as a cargo cover:  
1. Insert the front corners of the panel into the top  
guides.  
2. Slide the panel forward.  
3. Press down on the back of the panel to lock  
it in place.  
3-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The center position is with the front corners placed in  
the lower guides and the rear corners placed in the  
upper guides. Do not load cargo on the panel in this  
position.  
Roof Rack System  
The vehicle may have a roof rack system.  
The last position is with the front corners in the lower  
guides, panel sideways, closest to the rear seat for  
subfloor access. Do not drive while the panel is in this  
position.  
WARNING:  
{
If something is carried on top of the vehicle that is  
longer or wider than the roof racklike paneling,  
plywood, or a mattressthe wind can catch it  
while the vehicle is being driven. The item being  
carried could be violently torn off, and this could  
cause a collision, and damage the vehicle. Never  
carry something longer or wider than the roof rack  
on top of the vehicle unless using a GM Certified  
accessory carrier.  
There are storage hooks on the bottom of the panel.  
The vehicle might have a cargo mat that covers the  
panel/cargo cover.  
3-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For vehicles with a roof rack, the rack can be used to  
load items. For roof racks that do not have crossrails  
included, GM Certified crossrails can be purchased as  
an accessory. See your dealer/retailer for additional  
information.  
Convenience Net  
The vehicle may have a convenience net. The metal  
rings in the cargo area can be used to attach the  
convenience net for several uses. The net can be used  
to attach items secured to the floor, to the rear liftgate or  
liftgate glass. The net is not for larger, heavier loads.  
Notice: Loading cargo on the roof rack that weighs  
more than 75 kg (165 lbs) or hangs over the rear or  
sides of the vehicle may damage the vehicle. Load  
cargo so that it rests evenly between the crossrails,  
making sure to fasten cargo securely.  
Hideaway Rear Storage Bins  
Notice: Loading cargo directly on the roof of the  
vehicle may cause damage to the vehicle and would  
not be covered under warranty. Do not place cargo  
on the roof the vehicle.  
To prevent damage or loss of cargo when driving, check  
to make sure crossrails and cargo are securely  
fastened. Loading cargo on the roof rack will make the  
vehicles center of gravity higher. Avoid high speeds,  
sudden starts, sharp turns, sudden braking or abrupt  
maneuvers, otherwise it may result in loss of control.  
If driving for a long distance, on rough roads, or at high  
speeds, occasionally stop the vehicle to make sure the  
cargo remains in its place.  
Do not exceed the maximum vehicle capacity when  
loading the vehicle. For more information on vehicle  
capacity and loading, see Loading the Vehicle on  
The vehicle may have two storage bins located in the  
rear of the vehicle. Pull up on the handles to open and  
lift the lid. Use the key to lock/unlock the bins.  
page 524  
.
3-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sunroof  
The vehicle may have a power sunroof.  
The switches that operate  
the sunroof are located in  
the headliner.  
There is a rod that hooks into place to prop open the lid.  
Push the rod towards the lid to unhook it and lower  
the lid.  
To open or close the sunroof, the ignition must be in  
ON/RUN, ACC/ACCESSORY, or Retained Accessory  
Power (RAP) must be active. See Retained Accessory  
Power (RAP) on page 325.  
3-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Express Open: To express open the power sunroof,  
fully press the driver's side switch rearward once. To  
stop the sunroof glass in a desired position other than  
to the express-open position, press the switch again, in  
either direction, to stop the movement. If the sunshade  
is in the closed position, it will open with the sunroof,  
or it can be opened manually.  
Close: To close the power sunroof, operate the controls  
according to one of the following:  
.
From the open position, press and hold the driver's  
side sunroof switch forward. The sunshade must  
be closed manually.  
.
From the vent position, press and hold the  
passenger's side sunroof switch rearward.  
Vent Open: To open to the vent position from the  
closed position, press and hold the passenger's side  
sunroof switch forward. The rear of the sunroof panel  
will tilt upward to the full vent position. The sunshade  
must be opened manually.  
Anti-Pinch: If an object is in the path of the sunroof  
while it is closing, the anti-pinch feature will detect the  
object and stop the sunroof from closing at the point of  
the obstruction. The sunroof will then return to the  
full-open or vent position. To close the sunroof once it  
has re-opened, refer to the two options previously  
described under the Closefeature instructions.  
Express Close: To express close the power sunroof,  
fully press the driver's side switch forward once. To stop  
the sunroof glass in a desired position other than  
closed, press the switch again in either direction. The  
sunshade must be closed manually.  
3-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
3-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4 Instrument Panel  
Instrument Panel Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18  
Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18  
Outlet Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21  
Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Tilt Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4  
Turn and Lane-Change Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-4  
Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Windshield Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Windshield Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
Rear Window Wiper/Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-8  
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Wiper Activated Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Headlamps on Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Automatic Headlamp System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Instrument Panel Brightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Dome Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Entry/Exit Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Electric Power Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15  
Battery Run-Down Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15  
Accessory Power Outlet(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16  
Ashtray(s) and Cigarette Lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Instrument Panel Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24  
Speedometer and Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Safety Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26  
Airbag Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Charging System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Up-Shift Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Brake System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning Light . . . 4-31  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS)  
Indicator/Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Electronic Stability Control  
(ESC)/Traction Control System  
(TCS) Indicator/Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-33  
Engine Coolant Temperature Warning Light . . . . 4-34  
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Tire Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Oil Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38  
Security Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
4-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 4 Instrument Panel  
Fog Lamp Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
Audio System(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-60  
Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61  
Radio(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-62  
Using an MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-74  
XM Radio Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-80  
Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-82  
Theft-Deterrent Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-92  
Audio Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-92  
Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-94  
Fixed Mast Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-95  
XMSatellite Radio Antenna System . . . . . . . . . 4-95  
Chime Level Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-95  
Highbeam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
Fuel Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Boost Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Reconfigurable Performance  
Display (RPD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-41  
Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
DIC Operation and Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
DIC Warnings and Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48  
DIC Vehicle Personalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54  
4-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tilt Wheel  
Instrument Panel Overview  
A tilt wheel lets the steering wheel be adjusted before  
driving.  
Hazard Warning Flashers  
| (Hazard Warning Flasher): Press this button  
located on the instrument panel, to make the front and  
rear turn signal lamps flash on and off. This warns  
others that you are having trouble.  
Press | again to turn the flashers off.  
Horn  
To sound the horn, press the horn symbols located on  
the steering wheel.  
The tilt lever is located on the left side of the steering  
column.  
To tilt the wheel, pull the lever down. Then, move the  
wheel to a comfortable position and raise the lever to  
lock the wheel in place.  
Do not adjust the steering wheel while driving.  
4-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever  
Turn and Lane-Change Signals  
An arrow on the  
instrument panel cluster  
flashes in the direction of  
the turn or lane change.  
Move the lever all the way up or down to signal a turn.  
Raise or lower the lever until the arrow starts to flash to  
signal a lane change. Hold it there until the lane change  
is complete.  
The lever on the left side of the steering column  
operates the following:  
The lever returns to its starting position when it is  
released.  
G : Turn and Lane-Change Signals  
5 3 : Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer  
O : Exterior Lamp Control  
If after signaling a turn or a lane change the arrows  
flash rapidly or do not come on, a signal bulb could be  
burned out.  
Flash-to-Pass.  
Have the bulbs replaced. If the bulb is not burned out,  
check the fuse. See Fuses and Circuit Breakers on  
Information for these features is on the pages following.  
page 6119  
.
4-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer  
Windshield Wipers  
To change the headlamps from low beam to high beam,  
push the turn signal lever away from you.  
This indicator light  
appears on the instrument  
panel cluster when the  
high beams are on.  
To change the headlamps from high beam to low beam,  
pull the turn signal lever toward you.  
The windshield wiper lever is on the right side of the  
steering wheel.  
Move the lever to one of the following positions:  
1 (High Speed): Fast wipes.  
Flash-to-Pass  
To signal to a driver in front of you that you want to  
pass, pull the turn signal/multifunction lever until the  
high-beam headlamps come on. Then release the lever  
to turn them off.  
6 (Low Speed): Slow wipes.  
& (Delay): Sets a delay between wipes.  
4-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6 (Delay/Intermittent Speed Sensitive): When the  
lever is in the delay position, turn the band up for more  
frequent wipes or down for less frequent wipes.  
Windshield Washer  
To wash the windshield, press the button at the end of  
the lever until the washers begin.  
During intermittent wiping mode, the delay cycle time is  
sensitive to vehicle speed. As the vehicle speed  
increases the delay cycle time decreases and wiper  
movement occurs more frequently.  
WARNING:  
{
9 (Off): Turns the windshield wipers off.  
In freezing weather, do not use your washer until  
the windshield is warmed. Otherwise the washer  
fluid can form ice on the windshield, blocking your  
vision.  
8(Mist): Single wipe, move the lever to z and then  
release it. Several wipes, hold lever on z longer.  
As an added safety feature, if the wipers are on for  
more than 15 seconds, the vehicle's headlamps turn on  
automatically. They turn off 15 seconds after the wipers  
are turned off.  
When the button is released, the washers will stop, but  
the wipers will continue to wipe for about three times or  
will resume the speed being used before.  
Clear snow and ice from the wiper blades before using  
them. If frozen to the windshield, carefully loosen or  
thaw them. Damaged wiper blades should be replaced.  
See Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement on  
page 653  
.
Heavy snow or ice can overload the wiper motor.  
A circuit breaker will stop the motor until it cools down.  
4-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5 (Delay): Press to turn on the intermittent wiping  
setting that has a longer delay.  
Rear Window Wiper/Washer  
The rear window  
Y (Washer Fluid): Press to wash and wipe the  
window.  
washer/wiper button is  
located on the instrument  
panel below the climate  
controls.  
The rear window washer uses the same fluid reservoir  
as the windshield washer. However, the rear window  
washer will run out of fluid before the windshield  
washer. If the windshield can be washed, but not the  
rear windows, check the fluid level.  
Z (Rear Wiper): Press to turn on an intermittent  
setting that has a shorter delay.  
To turn either of the intermittent wiper settings off,  
press the opposite side of the button to turn it to the  
off position. Press the button all the way down on either  
side to activate an intermittent wiper setting.  
WARNING:  
{
In freezing weather, do not use your washer until  
the windshield is warmed. Otherwise the washer  
fluid can form ice on the windshield, blocking your  
vision.  
4-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Setting Cruise Control  
Cruise Control  
With cruise control, a speed of about 40 km (25 mph) or  
more can be maintained without keeping your foot on  
the accelerator. Cruise control does not work at speeds  
below 40 km (25 mph).  
WARNING:  
{
If you leave your cruise control on when you are  
not using cruise, you might hit a button and go  
into cruise when you do not want to. You could be  
startled and even lose control. Keep the cruise  
control switch off until you want to use cruise  
control.  
The brake must be applied at least one time, after the  
vehicle has been started, before cruise control will  
function.  
WARNING:  
{
Cruise control can be dangerous where you  
cannot drive safely at a steady speed. So, do  
not use the cruise control on winding roads or in  
heavy traffic.  
The cruise control buttons  
are located on the left  
side of the steering wheel.  
Cruise control can be dangerous on slippery  
roads. On such roads, fast changes in tire traction  
can cause excessive wheel slip, and you could  
lose control. Do not use cruise control on slippery  
roads.  
4-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
J (On/Off): Press to turn the cruise control system  
on and off. The indicator light on the button comes on  
when the cruise control is on and goes off when the  
cruise control is turned off.  
When the brakes are applied or the clutch pedal is  
used, the cruise control shuts off.  
If the vehicle is in cruise control and the Traction  
Control System (TCS) begins to limit wheel spin, the  
cruise control automatically disengages. See Traction  
Control System (TCS) on page 59 and Enhanced  
Traction System (ETS) on page 511. When road  
conditions allow, the cruise control can be used again.  
RES+ (Resume): Press to resume a set speed and to  
accelerate the speed.  
SET(Set): Press to set a speed and to decrease the  
speed.  
Resuming a Set Speed  
To set a speed:  
Suppose the cruise control is set at a desired speed  
and then the brake is applied. This disengages the  
cruise control. To return to the previously set speed,  
it is not necessary to go through the set process again.  
Once the vehicle is going about 40 km (25 mph) or  
more, press the RES+ part of the button briefly.  
1. Press I to turn cruise control on. The indicator  
light on the button comes on.  
2. Get to the desired speed.  
3. Press the SETcontrol button and release it.  
The CRUISE ENGAGED message appears on  
the Driver Information Center (DIC) to show the  
system is engaged.  
The vehicle goes back to the previously set speed.  
4. Take your foot off the accelerator pedal.  
4-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Increasing Speed While Using Cruise  
Control  
Passing Another Vehicle While Using  
Cruise Control  
There are two ways to go to a higher speed.  
Use the accelerator pedal to increase the vehicle  
speed. When you take your foot off the pedal, the  
vehicle slows down to the cruise control speed you  
set earlier.  
1. Disengage the cruise control by applying the brake  
pedal, but do not turn it off. Accelerate to a higher  
speed and reset the cruise control.  
2. If the cruise control system is already engaged,  
press the RES+ button. Hold it there until the  
desired speed is reached, and then release the  
button. To increase the vehicle speed in small  
amounts, press the RES+ button briefly and then  
release it. Each time this is done, the vehicle goes  
about 1.6 km/h (1 mph) faster.  
Using Cruise Control on Hills  
How well the cruise control works on hills depends upon  
the vehicle speed, load and the steepness of the hills.  
When going up steep hills, the accelerator pedal might  
need to be applied to maintain the vehicle speed. When  
going downhill, the brake might need to be applied or  
the vehicle might have to be shifted to a lower gear to  
keep the vehicle speed down. When the brakes are  
applied the cruise control turns off.  
Reducing Speed While Using Cruise  
Control  
Ending Cruise Control  
If the cruise control system is already engaged,  
.
To end cruise control, step lightly on the brake pedal or  
the clutch pedal if the vehicle has a manual  
transmission.  
Push and hold the SETbutton until the lower  
speed desired is reached, then release it.  
.
To slow down in small amounts, push the  
Stepping on the brake pedal or clutch pedal will only  
end the current cruise control session.  
SETbutton briefly. Each time this is done, the  
vehicle goes about 1.6 km/h (1 mph) slower.  
Press I to turn the system completely off.  
4-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTO (Automatic Headlamp System): Automatically  
turns on the Daytime Running Lamps during daytime,  
and the headlamps, parking lamps, and taillamps at  
night.  
Erasing Speed Memory  
The cruise control set speed memory is erased when  
the cruise control or the ignition is turned off.  
P (Off/On): This position is the momentary Off/On  
switch for the Automatic Headlamp System. In Canada,  
this only works when the vehicles with an automatic  
transmission are in P (Park) and vehicles with a manual  
transmission have the parking brake set and the vehicle  
is not moving.  
Headlamps  
When operating in AUTO, a momentary turn of the  
switch to off/on will turn off the Automatic Headlamp  
System. An AUTO LIGHTS OFF message displays on  
the Driver Information Center (DIC) and a chime will  
sound. Turning the switch to off/on again will turn the  
Automatic Headlamp System back on. An AUTO  
LIGHTS ON message displays on the DIC. The  
Automatic Headlamp System is always turned on at the  
beginning of an ignition cycle for vehicles with manual  
transmission.  
The lever on the left side of the steering column  
operates the exterior lamps.  
The exterior lamp switch has the following four  
positions:  
Wiper Activated Headlamps  
2 (Headlamps): Turns on the headlamps, parking  
lamps, and taillamps.  
The headlamps and parking lamps are activated  
15 seconds after the windshield wipers are turned on.  
For this feature to work, automatic lighting must be  
enabled. See Headlamps on page 411 for additional  
information.  
; (Parking Lamps): Turns on the parking lamps and  
taillamps only.  
4-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the ignition is turned off, the wiper-activated  
headlamps will immediately turn off. They also turn  
off 15 seconds after the windshield wiper control is  
turned off.  
While the DRL system is on, the taillamps, sidemarker  
lamps, and instrument panel lights will not be on.  
For vehicles with an Automatic Transmission, the DRL  
system is off any time the vehicle is in P (Park). For  
vehicles with a Manual Transmission, the DRL system  
will be off when the vehicle is first started, the park  
brake is applied, and the vehicle has not moved. The  
DRL system on U.S. vehicles can also be turned off by  
using the off/on switch for one ignition cycle.  
Headlamps on Reminder  
If the drivers door is opened with the ignition off and the  
lamps on, a warning chime will sound. This indicates  
that the headlamps are still on.  
The regular headlamp system should be turned on  
when needed.  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL)  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) can make it easier for  
others to see the front of your vehicle during the day.  
Fully functional daytime running lamps are required on  
all vehicles first sold in Canada.  
Automatic Headlamp System  
When it is dark enough outside, the automatic system  
turns on the headlamps at the normal brightness along  
with other lamps such as the taillamps, sidemarker,  
parking lamps, instrument panel lights, and interior  
switch backlighting.  
The vehicle has a light sensor on top of the instrument  
panel. Do not cover this sensor or the headlamps will  
come on when they are not needed.  
Do not cover the light sensor, located on top of the  
instrument panel. If the sensor is covered the  
headlamps may remain on when they are not needed.  
The DRL system will make the headlamps come on at  
reduced brightness when the following conditions  
are met:  
If the vehicle is driven through a parking garage,  
overcast weather or a tunnel, the automatic headlamp  
system may turn on.  
.
The ignition is on.  
.
The exterior lamp control is turned to AUTO.  
.
The light sensor detects daytime light.  
.
The shift lever is not in P (Park).  
4-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
There is a delay in the transition between the daytime  
and nighttime operation of the automatic lamp control  
system so that driving under bridges or bright overhead  
street lights does not affect the system. The automatic  
lamp control system will only be affected when the light  
sensor sees a change in lighting lasting longer than  
this delay.  
Fog Lamps  
For vehicles with fog lamps, the button is located on the  
instrument panel, to the right of the steering wheel.  
The ignition must be on to use the fog lamps.  
# : Press to turn the fog lamps on and off. An indicator  
light on the button comes on when the fog lamps  
are on.  
If the vehicle is started in a dark garage, the automatic  
lamp system turns on immediately. Once the vehicle  
exits the garage, it will take about 20 seconds for the  
automatic lamp system to change to DRL if it is light  
outside. During that delay, the instrument panel  
cluster may not be as bright as usual. Make sure the  
instrument panel brightness control is in the full bright  
position. See Instrument Panel Brightness on  
The parking lamps automatically turn on and off when  
the fog lamps are turned on and off.  
The fog lamps will turn off while the high-beam  
headlamps are turned on.  
Some localities have laws that require the headlamps to  
be on along with the fog lamps.  
page 414  
.
To idle the vehicle with the system off, turn the ignition  
on and turn the exterior light switch to the off/on  
position. For vehicles first sold in Canada, the  
transmission must stay in P (Park) for this function  
or the parking brake must be set for vehicles with  
manual transmissions.  
Turn on the regular headlamps when they are needed.  
4-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel Brightness  
Entry/Exit Lighting  
The lamps inside the vehicle turn on when any door  
is opened. These lamps will fade out after about  
20 seconds after all of the doors have been closed or  
when the ignition is turned to ON/RUN. These lamps  
will also turn on when pressing the unlock symbol  
button or the horn symbol on the keyless entry system  
transmitter.  
The control for this feature  
is located to the right of  
the steering wheel and  
above the radio.  
The lamps inside the vehicle will stay on for about  
20 seconds after the key is removed from the ignition  
to provide an illuminated exit.  
Move the thumbwheel to the left to dim the lights or to  
the right to brighten the lights.  
The dome lamps will turn on when the thumbwheel is  
moved completely to the right.  
Reading Lamps  
There are reading lamps located on the front and rear  
dome lamps.  
Dome Lamp  
To turn the front reading lamps on or off, press the lamp  
lens. To turn the rear reading lamps on or off, press the  
button next to the lamp.  
The dome lamps turn on when any door is opened.  
To turn on all dome lamps with the doors closed, turn  
the instrument panel brightness thumbwheel completely  
to the right. See Instrument Panel Brightness on  
page 414  
.
4-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EPM works to prevent excessive discharge of the  
battery. It does this by balancing the generator's output  
and the vehicle's electrical needs. It can increase  
engine idle speed to generate more power, whenever  
needed. It can temporarily reduce the power demands  
of some accessories.  
Electric Power Management  
This vehicle has Electric Power Management (EPM),  
an advanced control system. It estimates the battery's  
temperature and state of charge and then adjusts the  
voltage for best performance and extended life of the  
battery.  
Normally, these actions occur in steps or levels, without  
being noticeable. In rare cases at the highest levels of  
corrective action, this action may be noticeable to the  
driver.  
When the battery's state of charge is low, the voltage is  
raised slightly to quickly put the charge back in. When  
the state of charge is high, the voltage is lowered  
slightly to prevent overcharging. If the vehicle has a  
voltmeter gauge or voltage display on the Driver  
Information Center (DIC), you may see the voltage  
move up or down. This is normal. If there is a problem,  
an alert will be displayed.  
Battery Run-Down Protection  
The vehicle has a battery saver feature designed to  
protect the vehicle's battery.  
When any interior lamp is left on and the ignition is  
turned off, the battery rundown protection system  
automatically turns the lamp off after 20 minutes.  
This prevents draining of the battery.  
The battery can be discharged at idle if the electrical  
loads are very high. This is true for all vehicles. This is  
because the generator (alternator) may not be spinning  
fast enough at idle to produce all the power that is  
needed for very high electrical loads.  
A high electrical load occurs when several of the  
following loads are on: headlamps, high beams, fog  
lamps, rear window defogger, climate control fan at high  
speed, heated seats, engine cooling fans, trailer loads,  
and loads plugged into accessory power outlets.  
4-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Certain electrical accessories may not be compatible  
with the accessory power outlet and could result in  
blown vehicle or adapter fuses. If you experience a  
problem, see your dealer/retailer for additional  
information on the accessory power outlet.  
Accessory Power Outlet(s)  
Accessory power outlets can be used to connect  
electrical equipment, such as a cellular phone.  
The accessory power outlets are located on the  
instrument panel below the climate controls and at the  
rear of the center console. There may be an outlet in  
the rear cargo area on the passenger side.  
Notice: Adding any electrical equipment to the  
vehicle can damage it or keep other components  
from working as they should. The repairs would not  
be covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not use  
equipment exceeding maximum amperage rating of  
20 amperes. Check with your dealer/retailer before  
adding electrical equipment.  
To use the outlet, remove the cover. While not in use,  
always cover the outlet with the protective cap.  
Notice: Leaving electrical equipment plugged in for  
an extended period of time while the vehicle is off  
will drain the battery. Power is always supplied to  
the outlets. Always unplug electrical equipment  
when not in use and do not plug in equipment that  
exceeds the maximum 20 ampere rating.  
When adding electrical equipment, be sure to follow the  
installation instructions included with the equipment.  
Notice: Improper use of the power outlet can cause  
damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not  
hang any type of accessory or accessory bracket  
from the plug because the power outlets are  
designed for accessory power plugs only.  
4-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This plug can be used to supply power to commercial  
converters and contains four different circuits. The  
functions of these circuits are as follows; a 40 Amp  
battery service, a 10 Amp Accessory or Run service,  
a 15 Amp Delayed Accessory service and a Ground  
circuit.  
Rear Power Plug for Converters  
Notice: Adding any electrical equipment to your  
vehicle may damage it or keep other components  
from working as they should. The repairs would  
not be covered by your warranty. Do not use  
equipment exceeding maximum amperage rating  
of 40 amperes. Check with your dealer/retailer  
before adding electrical equipment.  
When adding electrical equipment, be sure to follow the  
installation instructions included with the equipment.  
Notice: Improper use of the power outlet can cause  
damage not covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not  
hang any type of accessory or accessory bracket  
from the plug because the power outlets are  
designed for accessory power plugs only.  
The vehicle may have a power plug connector located  
in the rear cargo area on the passenger side behind  
the service panel. The power connector wiring can be  
accessed by removing the service panel to begin  
installation.  
Notice: Leaving electrical equipment plugged in for  
an extended period of time while the vehicle is off  
will drain the battery. Power is always supplied to  
the outlets. Always unplug electrical equipment  
when not in use and do not plug in equipment  
that exceeds the maximum 40 ampere rating.  
4-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ashtray(s) and Cigarette Lighter  
Climate Controls  
The vehicle may have an ashtray and cigarette lighter.  
To use the lighter, located on the instrument panel  
below the climate controls, push it in all the way and  
let go. When it is ready, it will pop back out by itself.  
Climate Control System  
The heating, cooling, and ventilation for the vehicle can  
be controlled with this system.  
Notice: Holding a cigarette lighter in while it is  
heating will not allow the lighter to back away from  
the heating element when it is hot. Damage from  
overheating may occur to the lighter or heating  
element, or a fuse could be blown. Do not hold a  
cigarette lighter in while it is heating. Do not use  
equipment exceeding maximum amperage rating  
of 15 amperes.  
For vehicles with remote start, the climate control  
system comes on and uses the prior temperature  
settings selected before exiting the vehicle.  
To clean the center console ashtray, remove the entire  
ashtray and empty it.  
Notice: If papers, pins, or other flammable items are  
put in the ashtray, hot cigarettes or other smoking  
materials could ignite them and possibly damage  
the vehicle. Never put flammable items in the  
ashtray.  
A. Temperature  
Control  
D. Air Conditioning  
E. Outside Air  
B. Fan Control  
F. Air Recirculation  
C. Air Delivery Mode  
Control  
G. Rear Window  
Defogger  
4-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9 (Off): Turn the fan control to this position to turn  
6 (Floor): Air is directed to the floor outlets, with some  
the fan off.  
air directed to the windshield and side windows.  
Temperature Control: Turn clockwise or  
counterclockwise to increase or decrease the  
temperature.  
- (Defog): This mode clears the windows of fog or  
moisture. Air is directed to the windshield, side window,  
and floor outlets. In this mode, the system runs the air  
conditioning compressor. To defog the windows faster,  
turn the temperature control knob clockwise to the  
warmest setting.  
9 (Fan): Turn clockwise or counterclockwise to  
increase or decrease the fan speed. In any setting other  
than off, the fan runs continuously while the ignition is in  
ON/RUN. The fan must be turned on to run the air  
conditioning (AC) compressor.  
0 (Defrost): This mode removes fog or frost from  
the windshield more quickly. Air is directed to the  
windshield, with some air directed to the side window  
and floor outlets. In this mode, the system runs the air  
conditioning compressor. To defrost the windows faster,  
turn the temperature control knob clockwise to the  
warmest setting.  
Air Delivery Mode Control: Turn clockwise or  
counterclockwise to change the direction of the airflow  
inside the vehicle.  
To change the current mode, select:  
H (Vent): Air is directed to the instrument panel  
# (Air Conditioning): Press to turn the air  
conditioning system on or off. An indicator light comes  
on to show that the air conditioning is on.  
outlets.  
) (Bi-Level): Air is divided between the instrument  
panel outlets and the floor outlets.  
On hot days, open the windows to let hot inside air  
escape; then close them. This helps to reduce the time  
it takes for your vehicle to cool down. It also helps the  
system to operate more efficiently.  
4-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For quick cool down on hot days:  
1. Select H .  
This mode recirculates and helps to quickly cool the  
air inside the vehicle. It can be used to help prevent  
outside air and odors from entering the vehicle.  
2. Select @ .  
The air conditioning compressor also comes on.  
Recirculation is not available in floor, defog and defrost  
modes. If the recirculation button is pressed, the  
indicator light flashes five times and outside air is  
delivered. Operation in this mode during periods of high  
humidity and cool outside temperatures can result in  
increased window fogging. If window fogging is  
experienced, select the defrost mode.  
3. Select # .  
4. Select the coolest temperature.  
5. Select the highest fan speed.  
Using these settings together for long periods of time  
can cause the air inside of the vehicle to become too  
dry. To prevent this from happening, after the air in the  
vehicle has cooled, turn off the recirculation by pressing  
the outside air button.  
; (Outside Air): Press to allow outside air to circulate  
through the vehicle. An indicator light comes on to show  
that outside air is on.  
The air conditioning system removes moisture from the  
air, so a small amount of water might drip under the  
vehicle while idling or after turning off the engine. This  
is normal.  
Rear Window Defogger  
The rear window defogger uses a warming grid to  
remove fog from the rear window.  
The air conditioning compressor cannot be turned on  
when the fan is off.  
The rear window defogger only works when the ignition  
is in ON/RUN.  
@ (Recirculation): Press to turn the recirculation  
mode on. An indicator light comes on to show that  
recirculation is on.  
< (Rear): Press to turn the rear window defogger on  
or off. Be sure to clear as much snow from the rear  
window as possible. An indicator light comes on to  
show that the rear window defogger is on.  
4-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The rear window defogger turns off approximately  
15 minutes after the button is pressed. If turned on  
again, the defogger only runs for approximately seven  
minutes before turning off.  
Outlet Adjustment  
Turn the outlets and move the outlet vanes to change  
the direction of the airflow and to open and close the  
outlets.  
If the vehicle speed is greater than 80 km/h (50 mph)  
and the rear defogger is on, it remains on as long as the  
speed is greater than 80 km/h (50 mph). The defogger  
can also be turned off by turning off the engine.  
Operation Tips  
.
Clear away any ice, snow or leaves from the air  
inlets at the base of the windshield that may block  
the flow of air into the vehicle.  
For vehicles with the remote start feature, the rear  
defogger automatically turns on if it is cold outside.  
When the vehicle transitions out of the remote start  
mode, the rear defogger turns off. See Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) System Operation on page 34  
.
Use of non-GM approved hood deflectors may  
adversely affect the performance of the system.  
.
Keep the path under the front seats clear of  
objects to help circulate the air inside of the vehicle  
more effectively.  
Notice: Do not use anything sharp on the inside of  
the rear window. If you do, you could cut or damage  
the warming grid, and the repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not attach a  
temporary vehicle license, tape, a decal or anything  
similar to the defogger grid.  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter  
The filter removes dust and pollen from the air which is  
drawn into the vehicle. Airflow reduction is an indication  
that the filter needs to be replaced.  
The filter should be replaced as part of routine  
scheduled maintenance. See Scheduled Maintenance  
on page 73 for replacement intervals. To find out  
what type of filter to use, see Maintenance  
Replacement Parts on page 712.  
4-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To access the passenger compartment air filter:  
1. Open and empty the glove box.  
3. Pull the three tabs of the filter access door down  
and open the access door downward.  
2. Press both glove box stops outward to let the glove  
box drop open completely.  
4-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and  
Indicators  
Warning lights and gauges can signal that something is  
wrong before it becomes serious enough to cause an  
expensive repair or replacement. Paying attention to the  
warning lights and gauges could prevent injury.  
Warning lights come on when there might be or there is  
a problem with one of the vehicle's functions. Some  
warning lights come on briefly when the engine is  
started to indicate they are working.  
Gauges can indicate when there might be or there is  
a problem with one of the vehicle's functions. Often  
gauges and warning lights work together to indicate a  
problem with the vehicle.  
4. Pull the filter out, keeping it upwards.  
When one of the warning lights comes on and stays on  
while driving, or when one of the gauges shows there  
could be a problem, check the section that explains  
what to do. Follow this manual's advice. Waiting to do  
repairs can be costly and even dangerous.  
Install the new air filter with the AIR FLOW arrow  
pointing downward. Reverse Steps 1 through 4 to  
reassemble.  
4-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Panel Cluster  
United States Manual Transmission Cluster shown, Automatic, SS and Canada similar  
4-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Speedometer and Odometer  
Tachometer  
The speedometer shows the speed in both kilometers  
per hour (km/h) and miles per hour (mph).  
The tachometer  
displays the engine  
speed in revolutions  
per minute (rpm).  
The vehicle's odometer works together with the Driver  
Information Center (DIC). Trip A and Trip B can be set  
on the odometer. See Trip Informationunder DIC  
Operation and Displays on page 446.  
The vehicle does not have to be running to check the  
odometer mileage. Simply open the driver's door and  
the mileage briefly displays.  
If the vehicle ever needs a new odometer installed, the  
new one will be set to the correct total mileage of the  
old odometer.  
Notice: If the engine is operated with the  
tachometer in the red warning area, the vehicle  
could be damaged and the damages would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Do not operate the  
engine with the tachometer in the red warning area.  
4-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Passenger Safety Belt Reminder Light  
Safety Belt Reminders  
For vehicles equipped with the passenger safety belt  
reminder light, several seconds after the engine is  
started, a chime sounds for several seconds to remind  
the front passenger to buckle their safety belt. The  
passenger safety belt light, located on the instrument  
panel, comes on and stays on for several seconds and  
then flashes for several more.  
Driver Safety Belt Reminder Light  
When the engine is started, a chime sounds for several  
seconds to remind a driver to fasten the safety belt,  
unless the driver safety belt is already buckled.  
The safety belt light  
comes on and stays on  
for several seconds, then  
flashes for several more.  
This chime and light are  
repeated if the passenger  
remains unbuckled and  
the vehicle is in motion.  
This chime and light are repeated if the driver remains  
unbuckled and the vehicle is in motion. If the driver  
safety belt is already buckled, neither the chime nor the  
light comes on.  
If the passenger safety belt is buckled, neither the  
chime nor the light comes on.  
The front passenger safety belt warning light and chime  
may turn on if an object is put on the seat such as a  
briefcase, handbag, grocery bag, laptop or other  
electronic device. To turn off the warning light and or  
chime, remove the object from the seat or buckle the  
safety belt.  
4-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Airbag Readiness Light  
WARNING:  
{
The system checks the airbag's electrical system for  
possible malfunctions. If the light stays on it indicates  
there is an electrical problem. The system check  
includes the airbag sensor, the pretensioners, the  
airbag modules, the wiring and the crash sensing and  
diagnostic module. For more information on the airbag  
system, see Airbag System on page 260.  
If the airbag readiness light stays on after the  
vehicle is started or comes on while driving, it  
means the airbag system might not be working  
properly. The airbags in the vehicle might not  
inflate in a crash, or they could even inflate  
without a crash. To help avoid injury, have the  
vehicle serviced right away.  
The airbag readiness  
light flashes for a few  
seconds when the engine  
is started. If the light does  
not come on then, have it  
fixed immediately.  
If there is a problem with the airbag system, an airbag  
Driver Information Center (DIC) message can also  
come on. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 448 for more information.  
4-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Then, after several more seconds, the status indicator  
will light either ON or OFF, or either the on or off symbol  
to let you know the status of the right front passenger  
frontal airbag.  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator  
If the vehicle has one of the passenger airbag status  
indicators pictured in the following illustrations, then the  
vehicle has a passenger sensing system for the right  
front passenger position. The passenger airbag status  
indicator, if equipped, is on the instrument panel. See  
Passenger Sensing System on page 270 for important  
safety information.  
If the word ON or the on symbol is lit on the passenger  
airbag status indicator, it means that the right front  
passenger frontal airbag is enabled (may inflate).  
If the word OFF or the off symbol is lit on the airbag  
status indicator, it means that the passenger sensing  
system has turned off the right front passenger frontal  
airbag.  
In addition, if the vehicle has a passenger sensing  
system for the right front passenger position, the label  
on the vehicle's sun visors refer to ADVANCED  
AIRBAGS.  
If, after several seconds, both status indicator lights  
remain on, or if there are no lights at all, there may be a  
problem with the lights or the passenger sensing  
system. See your dealer/retailer for service.  
WARNING:  
{
If the airbag readiness light ever comes on and  
stays on, it means that something may be wrong  
with the airbag system. To help avoid injury to  
yourself or others, have the vehicle serviced right  
away. See Airbag Readiness Light on page 427  
for more information, including important safety  
information.  
United States  
Canada  
When the vehicle is started, the passenger airbag  
status indicator will light ON and OFF, or the symbol for  
on and off, for several seconds as a system check.  
If using remote start, if equipped, to start the vehicle  
from a distance, you may not see the system check.  
4-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Charging System Light  
Up-Shift Light  
This light comes on briefly  
The vehicle may have an  
up-shift light.  
when the ignition key is  
turned on, but the engine  
is not running, as a check  
to show it is working.  
It should go out once the engine is running. If it stays  
on, or comes on while driving, there could be a problem  
with the charging system or it could indicate that there  
are problems with a generator drive belt, or that there is  
an electrical problem. Have it checked right away. If the  
vehicle must be driven a short distance with the light on,  
to turn off the accessories, such as the radio and air  
conditioner.  
When this light comes on, shift to the next higher gear if  
weather, road, and traffic conditions allow.  
See Manual Transmission Operation on page 331 for  
more information.  
4-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the ignition is on, the brake system warning light  
also comes on when the parking brake is set. The light  
stays on if the parking brake does not fully release. If it  
stays on after the parking brake is fully released, it  
means the vehicle has a brake problem.  
Brake System Warning Light  
The vehicle's hydraulic brake system is divided into two  
parts. If one part is not working, the other part can still  
work and stop the vehicle. For good braking both parts  
need to be working well.  
If the light comes on while driving, pull off the road and  
stop carefully. Make sure the parking brake is fully  
released. The pedal might be harder to push or, the  
pedal could go closer to the floor. It can take longer to  
stop. Try turning off and restarting the vehicle one or  
two times, if the light is still on, have the vehicle towed  
for service. See Towing Your Vehicle on page 529.  
If the warning light comes on, there is a brake problem.  
Have the brake system inspected right away.  
WARNING:  
{
The brake system might not be working properly if  
the brake system warning light is on. Driving with  
the brake system warning light on can lead to a  
crash. If the light is still on after the vehicle has  
been pulled off the road and carefully stopped,  
have the vehicle towed for service.  
United States  
Canada  
This light should come on briefly when the engine is  
started. If it does not come on then, have it fixed so it  
will be ready to warn if there is a problem.  
4-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the ABS light stays on, turn the ignition off. If the light  
comes on while driving, stop as soon as it is safely  
possible and turn the ignition off. Then start the engine  
again to reset the system. If the ABS light stays on,  
or comes on again while driving, the vehicle needs  
service. If the regular brake system warning light is not  
on, the vehicle still has brakes, but not antilock brakes.  
If the regular brake system warning light is also on, the  
vehicle does not have antilock brakes and there is a  
problem with the regular brakes. See Brake System  
Warning Light on page 430.  
Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
Warning Light  
For vehicles with the  
Antilock Brake System  
(ABS), this light comes  
on briefly when the  
engine is started.  
For vehicles with a Driver Information Center (DIC),  
see DIC Warnings and Messages on page 448 for  
all brake related DIC messages.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your  
dealer/retailer. If the system is working normally the  
indicator light then goes off.  
4-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the indicator/warning light is on and not flashing, the  
ETS system could have been disabled. Check all  
related Driver Information Center (DIC) messages to  
determine whether the system has been turned off or if  
the system is not working properly and the vehicle  
requires service. If the ETS has been disabled, wheel  
spin is not limited.  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS)  
Indicator/Warning Light  
For vehicles with the  
Enhanced Traction  
System (ETS), this light  
serves as an indicator  
and warning light.  
If the indicator/warning light is on and flashing, the ETS  
is actively working. The LOW TRACTION DIC message  
also appears when the system is actively limiting  
wheel spin.  
See Enhanced Traction System (ETS) on page 511  
and DIC Warnings and Messages on page 448 for  
more information.  
This light comes on briefly while the engine is started.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer/  
retailer. If the system is working normally the indicator  
light then goes off.  
4-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the light comes on and stays on, the TCS and  
potentially the ESC system have been disabled.  
Check the DIC messaging to determine which system  
is turned off, or not working. If the system is not  
working, the vehicle needs service. See your  
dealer/retailer.  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)/  
Traction Control System (TCS)  
Indicator/Warning Light  
The Electronic Stability  
Control (ESC) system  
or the Traction Control  
System (TCS)  
indicator/warning light  
comes on briefly when  
the engine is started.  
When the TCS is disabled, wheel spin is not limited.  
When the ESC system is disabled, the system does  
not aid in maintaining vehicle directional control.  
If the light comes on and flashes, the TCS or the ESC  
system is actively working. When the LOW TRACTION  
message appears, the system is limiting wheel spin.  
When the ESC ACTIVE message appears, the system  
is aiding in maintaining vehicle directional control.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by the dealer/  
retailer. If the system is working normally the indicator  
light goes off.  
See Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on page 56  
and Traction Control System (TCS) on page 59 for  
more information.  
This light, along with the appropriate Driver Information  
Center (DIC) messages, indicates when the ESC  
system and the TCS are working or are disabled.  
See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 448 for  
more information on the messages associated with  
this light.  
4-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Coolant Temperature  
Warning Light  
Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge  
The vehicle has an  
engine coolant  
This light comes on briefly  
while starting the vehicle.  
temperature gauge.  
With the ignition turned  
to ON/RUN, this gauge  
shows the engine coolant  
temperature.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by the dealer/  
retailer. If the system is working normally the indicator  
light goes off.  
If the gauge pointer moves into the red area, the engine  
is too hot because the engine coolant has overheated.  
Notice: Driving with the engine coolant temperature  
warning light on could cause the vehicle to  
overheat. See Engine Overheating on page 634  
The vehicle's engine could be damaged, and it  
might not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Never  
drive with the engine coolant temperature warning  
light on.  
If the vehicle is operating under normal driving  
conditions, pull off the road, stop the vehicle and  
turn off the engine as soon as possible.  
.
See Engine Overheating on page 634.  
The engine coolant temperature warning light comes on  
when the engine has overheated.  
If this happens pull over and turn off the engine as soon  
as possible. See Engine Overheating on page 634 for  
more information.  
4-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the Light Flashes First and Then is  
On Steady  
Tire Pressure Light  
For vehicles with a tire  
pressure monitoring  
system, this light comes  
on briefly when the engine  
is started. It provides  
information about tire  
pressures and the Tire  
Pressure Monitoring  
System.  
This indicates that there may be a problem with the Tire  
Pressure Monitor System. The light flashes for about a  
minute and stays on steady for the remainder of the  
ignition cycle. This sequence repeats with every ignition  
cycle. See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on  
page 665 for more information.  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp  
Check Engine Light  
A computer system called OBD II (On-Board  
Diagnostics-Second Generation) monitors operation  
of the fuel, ignition, and emission control systems.  
It ensures that emissions are at acceptable levels for  
the life of the vehicle, helping to produce a cleaner  
environment.  
When the Light is On Steady  
This indicates that one or more of the tires is  
significantly underinflated.  
A tire pressure message in the Driver Information  
Center (DIC), can accompany the light. See Driver  
Information Center (DIC) on page 446 for more  
information. Stop and check the tires as soon as it is  
safe to do so. If underinflated, inflate to the proper  
pressure. See Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 663  
for more information.  
This light should come  
on when the ignition is  
on, but the engine is not  
running, as a check to  
show it is working. If it  
does not, have the vehicle  
serviced by your dealer/  
retailer.  
4-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This light comes on during a malfunction in one of  
two ways:  
If the check engine light comes on and stays on, while  
the engine is running, this indicates that there is an  
OBD II problem and service is required.  
Light Flashing: A misfire condition has been detected.  
A misfire increases vehicle emissions and could  
damage the emission control system on the vehicle.  
Diagnosis and service might be required.  
Malfunctions often are indicated by the system before  
any problem is apparent. Being aware of the light can  
prevent more serious damage to the vehicle. This  
system assists the service technician in correctly  
diagnosing any malfunction.  
To prevent more serious damage to the vehicle:  
.
Reduce vehicle speed.  
Notice: If the vehicle is continually driven with this  
light on, after a while, the emission controls might  
not work as well, the vehicle's fuel economy might  
not be as good, and the engine might not run as  
smoothly. This could lead to costly repairs that  
might not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
.
Avoid hard accelerations.  
.
Avoid steep uphill grades.  
.
If towing a trailer, reduce the amount of cargo  
being hauled as soon as it is possible.  
If the light continues to flash, when it is safe to do so,  
stop the vehicle. Find a safe place to park the vehicle.  
Turn the key off, wait at least 10 seconds, and restart  
the engine. If the light is still flashing, follow the  
previous steps and see your dealer/retailer for  
service as soon as possible.  
Notice: Modifications made to the engine,  
transmission, exhaust, intake, or fuel system of  
the vehicle or the replacement of the original tires  
with other than those of the same Tire Performance  
Criteria (TPC) can affect the vehicle's emission  
controls and can cause this light to come on.  
Modifications to these systems could lead to  
costly repairs not covered by the vehicle warranty.  
This could also result in a failure to pass a  
required Emission Inspection/Maintenance test.  
See Accessories and Modifications on page 63.  
4-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Make sure to fuel the vehicle with quality fuel.  
Poor fuel quality causes the engine not to run  
as efficiently as designed and can cause: stalling  
after start-up, stalling when the vehicle is changed  
into gear, misfiring, hesitation on acceleration,  
or stumbling on acceleration. These conditions  
might go away once the engine is warmed up.  
Light On Steady: An emission control system  
malfunction has been detected on the vehicle.  
Diagnosis and service might be required.  
An emission system malfunction might be corrected by  
doing the following:  
.
Make sure the fuel cap is fully installed. See Filling  
the Tank on page 610. The diagnostic system  
can determine if the fuel cap has been left off or  
improperly installed. A loose or missing fuel cap  
allows fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere. A few  
driving trips with the cap properly installed should  
turn the light off.  
If one or more of these conditions occurs, change  
the fuel brand used. It will require at least one full  
tank of the proper fuel to turn the light off.  
See Gasoline Octane on page 66.  
If none of the above have made the light turn off, your  
dealer/retailer can check the vehicle. The dealer/retailer  
has the proper test equipment and diagnostic tools to fix  
any mechanical or electrical problems that might have  
developed.  
.
If the vehicle has been driven through a deep  
puddle of water, the vehicle's electrical system  
might be wet. The condition is usually corrected  
when the electrical system dries out. A few driving  
trips should turn the light off.  
4-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Emissions Inspection and Maintenance  
Programs  
Oil Pressure Light  
Some state/provincial and local governments have or  
might begin programs to inspect the emission control  
equipment on the vehicle. Failure to pass this  
inspection could prevent getting a vehicle registration.  
Here are some things to know to help the vehicle pass  
an inspection:  
.
The vehicle will not pass this inspection if the  
check engine light is on with the engine running,  
or if the key is in ON/RUN and the light is not on.  
WARNING:  
{
.
The vehicle will not pass this inspection if the  
OBD II (on-board diagnostic) system determines  
that critical emission control systems have not  
been completely diagnosed by the system. The  
vehicle would be considered not ready for  
inspection. This can happen if the battery has  
recently been replaced or if the battery has run  
down. The diagnostic system is designed to  
evaluate critical emission control systems during  
normal driving. This can take several days of  
routine driving. If this has been done and the  
vehicle still does not pass the inspection for lack of  
OBD II system readiness, your dealer/retailer can  
prepare the vehicle for inspection.  
Do not keep driving if the oil pressure is low.  
The engine can become so hot that it catches fire.  
Someone could be burned. Check the oil as soon  
as possible and have the vehicle serviced.  
4-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Lack of proper engine oil maintenance  
can damage the engine. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Always follow the  
maintenance schedule in this manual for changing  
engine oil.  
Fog Lamp Light  
The fog lamp light comes  
on when the fog lamps  
are in use.  
This light comes on briefly while starting the engine.  
If it does not, have the vehicle serviced by your dealer/  
retailer. If the system is working normally the indicator  
light then goes off.  
If the light comes on and stays on, it means that oil is  
not flowing through the engine properly. The vehicle  
could be low on oil and it might have some other  
system problem.  
The light goes out when the fog lamps are turned off.  
See Fog Lamps on page 413 for more information.  
Highbeam On Light  
Security Light  
This light comes on when  
the high-beam headlamps  
are in use.  
For information regarding  
this light and the vehicle's  
security system, see  
Content Theft-Deterrent  
on page 319  
.
See Headlamp High/Low-Beam Changer on page 45  
for more information.  
4-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
The gauge moves a little when the vehicle turns a  
corner or speeds up.  
Fuel Gauge  
The fuel gauge indicates  
about how much fuel is  
left in the fuel tank.  
The gauge does not go back to empty when the  
ignition is turned off.  
For the fuel tank capacity, see Capacities and  
Specifications on page 6125.  
Boost Gauge  
An arrow on the fuel gauge indicates the side of the  
vehicle the fuel door is on.  
Here are four things that some owners ask about. None  
of these show a problem with the fuel gauge:  
.
At the service station, the gas pump shuts off  
before the gauge reads full.  
United States  
Canada  
.
It takes a little more or less fuel to fill up than the  
gauge indicated. For example, the gauge may  
have indicated the tank was half full, but it actually  
took a little more or less than half the fuel tank's  
capacity to fill it.  
For vehicles with this gauge, it indicates vacuum during  
light to moderate throttle and boost under heavier  
throttle.  
4-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
This gauge displays the air pressure level in the intake  
manifold before it enters the engine's combustion  
chamber.  
It is automatically centered at zero every time the  
engine is started. Actual vacuum or boost is displayed  
from this zero point. Changes in ambient pressure, such  
as driving in mountains and changing weather, will  
slightly change the zero reading.  
Reconfigurable Performance  
Display (RPD)  
For vehicles with the RPD, the screen displays  
information that can be used to monitor vehicle  
performance. The RPD knob located next to the screen  
is used to configure the display and select information  
to be viewed.  
RPD Screen Example US Version Shown, Canada  
Similar (French Display Currently Not Available)  
The RPD screen displays two divided areas (A, B) of  
information called Regions. Advance through Region A  
screens to show various gauges and speedometer  
displays. Advance through Region B screens to show  
digital readouts and indicator information.  
A short video plays whenever the ignition key is turned  
on. Press the RPD knob to stop the video and go  
directly to RPD displays.  
The position of these regions can be reversed. See the  
SETUP MENU for more information.  
When the ignition is turned off and then back on, the  
RPD shows the last screen displayed.  
4-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SPEEDOMETER & G FORCE : The G FORCE meter  
displays lateral acceleration. While turning right,  
G forces are felt on the left, and vice versa. PEAK  
values are stored indefinitely, and can be reset with  
a press and hold of the RPD knob while viewing the  
G FORCE meter.  
Region A Gauge and Speedometer  
Displays  
Change the information displayed in Region A by  
turning the knob either clockwise or counterclockwise.  
The available gauges are:  
SETUP MENU: Press the RPD knob to enter this  
menu. The vehicle should be stopped while configuring  
the setup menu selections.  
BOOST: Displays positive boost pressure as  
determined by the manifold air pressure (MAP) sensor.  
AIR/FUEL RATIO: Displays the mass ratio of air to fuel.  
SCREEN OFF: Turns the screen off.  
CAM PHASER ANGLES: Displays orientation of the  
intake and exhaust cam shafts relative to their park  
positions as commanded by the engine control module.  
OVERLAP represents the total distance the intake and  
exhaust cam shafts have phased.  
Region B Readout Displays  
Press the RPD knob to highlight Region B. The  
information displayed can be changed by turning the  
RPD knob either clockwise or counterclockwise.  
Press the RPD knob again, to store the selection. The  
selection will also be stored after a few seconds of no  
activity. Available modes are:  
SPARK ADVANCE/ KNOCK RETARD: The spark  
advance gauge displays ignition timing. Knock retard  
indicates the amount of ignition delay to reduce spark  
knock.  
Readouts #1  
ENGINE POWER & TORQUE : Displayed engine  
power and torque are engine flywheel output values  
calculated by the engine control module. These  
values are approximate and may change with the air  
conditioning load, generator output, air temperature, air  
pressure, and fuel octane.  
SHIFT LIGHTS/GEAR INDICATION: The shift lights  
provide visual identification of engine speed for a  
transmission gear. Shift light minimum and maximum  
RPM settings can be viewed and configured in the  
SETUP screen. The gear indication on manual  
transmission vehicles is calculated by the engine  
control module. The gear is only displayed when  
enough torque is available to determine the selected  
forward gear.  
4-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FUEL PRESSURE: Displays fuel pressure as  
measured by a sensor on the output of the  
high-pressure fuel pump.  
Readouts #2  
TIRE PRESSURES: Displays the last gauge tire  
pressures recorded from each of the wheel mounted tire  
pressure sensors.  
INDICATORS  
The indicators come on when the corresponding  
function is actively working to stabilize or control the  
vehicle. Each indicator light on the RPD display can be  
turned on and off using the SETUP MENU. These  
indicators work independently of the telltales on the  
instrument panel cluster. Turning the indicator on the  
RPD display on or off does not enable or disable the  
functions on the vehicle.  
Readouts #3  
BAROMETER: Displays ambient air pressure as  
measured by the engines ambient pressure sensor.  
OUTSIDE TEMPERATURE: Displays ambient  
temperature as measured by an outside air temperature  
sensor.  
BATTERY VOLTAGE: Displays the vehicles battery  
voltage.  
Readouts #4  
COOLANT TEMPERATURE: Displays engine coolant  
temperature as measured by a coolant temperature  
sensor.  
INLET AIR TEMPERATURE: Displays the  
instantaneous temperature of the air at the inlet to the  
induction system.  
This indicator comes on whenever the vehicle  
StabiliTrak® is actively working.  
4-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SETUP MENU  
The SETUP MENU allows for the appearance of each  
display screen to be customized. Turn the knob to scroll  
through the screens to reach the SETUP MENU. Press  
and release the knob to activate the SETUP MENU.  
This indicator comes on when Competitive Driving  
Mode (A) has been set using the traction control switch.  
This telltale comes on whenever conditions are right for  
the Launch Mode (B) to activate.  
See Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on page 56 for  
more information on Competitive Driving Mode and  
Launch Control.  
Selecting a SETUP MENU Option  
1. Under SETUP MENU there are six menu options  
to choose. Turn the RPD knob to highlight an  
option.  
This indicator comes on whenever the vehicle Traction  
Control system is actively working.  
2. Press and release the RPD knob to select the  
highlighted menu option.  
4-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CONTRAST: While the contrast slider is highlighted,  
press the knob to allow adjustment. Turn the knob to  
adjust the contrast of the screen. Press the knob again  
when the desired contrast is reached.  
SETUP MENU Options  
GAUGE APPEARANCE: While the gauge is  
highlighted, press the RPD knob. Then turn the  
knob to choose the background color for a gauge.  
Press the knob again when gauge color is chosen.  
RESTORE DEFAULTS: Restores the original factory  
screen defaults.  
SHIFT LIGHT SETUP: This screen establishes a RPM  
range where the shift light comes on for each gear. Turn  
the RPD knob to highlight a shift light setting. Press the  
knob to allow adjustment of the highlighted setting. Turn  
the knob to adjust the value up or down, then press the  
knob again to allow the selection of another item. The  
number above each gear shows the highest RPM the  
light comes on for a gear range. The number below  
each gear indicates the lowest RPM the light comes on  
for a gear range.  
Applying a SETUP MENU Option  
After each screen is customized, use this procedure to  
apply the change and return to the SETUP MENU.  
SET: Applies the changes to the display.  
1. Turn until SET is highlighted.  
2. Press and release while SET is highlighted to lock  
in the setting and return to the previous screen.  
RETURN /RET: Returns the display to the previous  
screen without saving changes.  
INDICATORS ON/OFF: Select on or off for each  
indicator by turning the RPD knob to highlight ON or  
OFF. Press and Release the RPD knob to apply the  
choice. The actual Traction Control, StabiliTrak®,  
Competitive Mode, Launch Control functions and  
instrument panel cluster telltales are not enabled or  
disabled by these indicators.  
1. Turn to highlight the RETURN/RET option.  
2. Press and release knob to return to the  
previous menu.  
SCREEN ORDER: While the screen order is  
highlighted, press the knob to allow adjustment. Turn  
the knob to reverse the displayed order of Region A and  
Region B. Press the knob again once the screen is  
chosen.  
4-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Press and hold the information and reset buttons at the  
same time for one second, then release the buttons to  
enter the personalization menu. See DIC Vehicle  
Personalization on page 454 for more information.  
Driver Information Center (DIC)  
Your vehicle has a Driver Information Center (DIC). The  
DIC display gives you the status of many of your  
vehicle's systems. The DIC is also used to display  
driver personalization menu modes and warning/status  
messages. All messages will appear in the DIC display,  
located at the bottom of the instrument panel cluster.  
DIC Operation and Displays  
The DIC comes on when the ignition is on. The DIC has  
different modes which can be accessed by pressing the  
DIC buttons. The button functions are detailed in the  
following.  
The DIC buttons are  
located on the left side of  
the steering wheel.  
Information Modes  
INFO (Information): Press this button to scroll through  
the following vehicle information modes:  
Outside Air Temperature and Odometer  
Press the information button until the outside air  
temperature and the odometer display. This mode  
shows the temperature outside of the vehicle in either  
degrees Fahrenheit (°F) or degrees Celsius (°C) and  
the total distance the vehicle has been driven in  
either miles (mi) or kilometers (km). The outside air  
temperature appears on the left side of the DIC display  
and the odometer appears on the right side of the  
display.  
INFO (Information): Press this button to scroll through  
the vehicle information mode displays.  
r (Reset): Press this button to reset some vehicle  
information mode displays, select a personalization  
menu mode setting, or acknowledge a warning  
message.  
To change the DIC display to English or metric units,  
see UNITSunder DIC Vehicle Personalization on  
page 454  
.
4-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
TRIPA or TRIP B  
MPG (L/100 KM) AVG (Average)  
Press the information button until TRIPA or TRIP B  
display. These modes show the current distance  
traveled since the last reset for each trip odometer in  
either miles (mi) or kilometers (km). Both odometers  
can be used at the same time.  
Press the information button until MPG (L/100 KM)  
AVG displays. This mode shows how many miles per  
gallon (mpg) or liters per 100 kilometers (L/100 km) your  
vehicle is getting based on current and past driving  
conditions.  
To reset the trip odometer to zero, press and hold the  
reset button for a few seconds while the desired trip  
odometer is displayed.  
To reset the average fuel economy, press and hold the  
reset button while MPG (L/100 KM) AVG is displayed.  
Average fuel economy is then calculated starting from  
that point. If the average fuel economy is not reset, it is  
continually updated each time you drive.  
FUEL RANGE  
Press the information button until FUEL RANGE  
displays. This mode shows the remaining distance  
you can drive without refueling in either miles (mi) or  
kilometers (km). It is based on fuel economy and the  
fuel remaining in the tank.  
MPG (L/100 KM) INST (Instantaneous)  
Press the information button until MPG (L/100 KM) INST  
displays. This mode shows the current fuel economy at  
a particular moment and changes frequently as driving  
conditions change. This mode shows the instantaneous  
fuel economy in miles per gallon (mpg) or liters per  
100 kilometers (L/100 km). Unlike average fuel  
economy, this screen cannot be reset.  
When the fuel level is low, FUEL RANGE LOW  
displays.  
The fuel economy data used to determine fuel range is  
an average of recent driving conditions. As your driving  
conditions change, this data is gradually updated. The  
FUEL RANGE mode cannot be reset.  
4-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AV (Average) SPEED  
Tire Pressure  
Press the information button until AV SPEED displays.  
This mode shows the vehicle's average speed in miles  
per hour (mph) or kilometers per hour (km/h).  
If your vehicle has a Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS), the pressure for each tire can be viewed in the  
DIC. The tire pressure is shown in either pounds per  
square inch (psi) or kilopascals (kPa). Press the  
information button until LF ## PSI (kPa) ## RF displays  
for the front tires. Press the information button again  
until LR ## PSI (kPa) ## RR displays for the rear tires.  
To reset the average vehicle speed, press and hold the  
reset button while AV SPEED is displayed.  
OIL LIFE  
If a low tire pressure condition is detected by the  
system while driving, a message advising you to  
check the tire pressure appears in the display. See  
Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 663 and DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 448 for more  
information.  
Press the information button until OIL LIFE displays.  
The engine oil life system shows an estimate of the oil's  
remaining useful life. It shows 100% when the system is  
reset after an oil change. It alerts you to change the oil  
on a schedule consistent with your driving conditions.  
In addition to the engine oil life system monitoring the  
oil life, additional maintenance is recommended in the  
Maintenance Schedule in this manual. See Engine Oil  
on page 619 and Scheduled Maintenance on  
DIC Warnings and Messages  
These messages appear if there is a problem detected  
in one of your vehicle's systems.  
page 73  
.
Always reset the engine oil life system after an oil  
change. See How to Reset the Engine Oil Life  
Systemunder Engine Oil Life System on page 623.  
A message clears when the vehicle's condition is no  
longer present. To acknowledge a message and clear it  
from the display, press and hold any of the DIC buttons.  
If the condition is still present, the warning message  
comes back on the next time the vehicle is turned off  
and back on. With most messages, a warning chime  
sounds when the message displays. Your vehicle may  
have other warning messages.  
COOLANT  
Press the information button until COOLANT displays.  
This mode shows the temperature of the engine  
coolant in either degrees Fahrenheit (°F) or degrees  
Celsius (°C).  
4-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTO (Automatic) LIGHTS OFF  
CHECK GAS CAP  
This message displays if the automatic headlamp  
system is disabled with the headlamp switch. See  
Automatic Headlamp System on page 412 for more  
information.  
This message displays if the fuel cap has not been fully  
tightened. Recheck the fuel cap to make sure that it is  
on properly. A few driving trips with the cap properly  
installed should turn the message off.  
AUTO (Automatic) LIGHTS ON  
COMPETITIVE MODE  
This message displays if the automatic headlamp  
system is enabled with the headlamp switch. See  
Automatic Headlamp System on page 412 for more  
information.  
If your vehicle has this feature, this message displays  
when the Competitive Driving mode is selected. The  
Traction Control System (TCS) will not be operating  
while in the Competitive Driving mode and the ESC/  
TCS light on the instrument panel cluster will be on  
solid. Adjust your driving accordingly. See Traction  
Control System (TCS) on page 59, Electronic  
Stability Control (ESC) on page 56, and Electronic  
Stability Control (ESC)/Traction Control System (TCS)  
Indicator/Warning Light on page 433 for more  
information.  
BRAKE FLUID  
This message displays, while the ignition is on, when  
the brake fluid level is low. The brake system warning  
light on the instrument panel cluster also comes on.  
See Brake System Warning Light on page 430 for  
more information. Have the brake system serviced by  
your dealer/retailer as soon as possible.  
COOLING MODE ON  
CHANGE OIL SOON  
This message may display on some vehicles. Under  
severe conditions, hot ambient temperatures, steep  
grades, and towing, your vehicle may experience more  
transmission shifting. This is temporary and normal  
under these conditions. This does not require engine or  
transmission service.  
This message displays when the life of the engine oil  
has expired and it should be changed.  
When this message is acknowledged and cleared from  
the display, the engine oil life system must still be reset  
separately. See Engine Oil Life System on page 623  
and Scheduled Maintenance on page 73 for more  
information.  
4-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CRUISE ENGAGED  
ESC (Electronic Stability Control) ACTIVE  
This message displays when the cruise control system  
is active. See Cruise Control on page 48 for more  
information.  
If your vehicle has Electronic Stability Control (ESC),  
this message displays and the ESC/TCS light on the  
instrument panel cluster flashes when ESC is assisting  
you with directional control of the vehicle. You may  
feel or hear the system working and see this message  
displayed in the DIC. Slippery road conditions may exist  
when this message is displayed, so adjust your driving  
accordingly. This message may stay on for a few  
seconds after ESC stops assisting you with directional  
control of the vehicle. This is normal when the system  
is operating. See Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on  
page 56 and Electronic Stability Control (ESC)/  
Traction Control System (TCS) Indicator/Warning Light  
on page 433 for more information.  
DOOR AJAR  
This message displays if one or more of the vehicle's  
doors are open. Make sure that the door(s) are closed  
completely.  
ENGINE DISABLED  
This message displays if the starting of the engine is  
disabled. Have your vehicle serviced by your dealer/  
retailer immediately.  
ENG (Engine) PWR (Power) REDUCED  
ESC (Electronic Stability Control)  
NOT READY  
This message displays to inform you that the vehicle  
has reduced engine power to avoid damaging the  
engine. Reduced engine power can affect the vehicle's  
ability to accelerate. If this message is on, but there  
is no reduction in performance, proceed to your  
destination. The performance may be reduced the  
next time the vehicle is driven. The vehicle may be  
driven at a reduced speed while this message is on,  
but acceleration and speed may be reduced. Anytime  
this message stays on, the vehicle should be taken to  
your dealer/retailer for service as soon as possible.  
If your vehicle has Electronic Stability Control (ESC),  
this message may display briefly after starting the  
vehicle if the system's sensors are not yet calibrated.  
The system is not functional until the message stops  
displaying. Adjust your driving accordingly. When  
the message is no longer displayed, the system is  
functional. See Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on  
page 56 for more information.  
4-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
ESC (Electronic Stability Control) OFF  
KEY FOB BATT (Battery) LOW  
If your vehicle has Electronic Stability Control (ESC),  
this message displays and the ESC/TCS light on the  
instrument panel cluster comes on solid when ESC  
is turned off. Adjust your driving accordingly. See  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on page 56 and  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)/Traction Control  
System (TCS) Indicator/Warning Light on page 433  
for more information.  
This message displays if the Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) transmitter battery is low. Replace the battery in  
the transmitter. See Battery Replacementunder  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on  
page 34  
.
LAUNCH CONTROL  
If your vehicle has this feature, this message displays  
after the COMPETITIVE MODE message when the  
vehicle is stopped. Launch control is a form of traction  
control to control wheel spin while launching the vehicle  
during closed track events and competitive driving  
venues. The system will exit to COMPETITIVE MODE  
after the vehicle is launched. See COMPETITIVE  
MODEearlier in this section. See Launch Control”  
under Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on page 56  
for more information.  
GATE AJAR  
This message displays when the liftgate is open. Make  
sure that the liftgate is closed completely. See Liftgate  
on page 313 for more information.  
ICE POSSIBLE  
This message displays when the outside air  
temperature is cold enough to create icy road  
conditions. Adjust your driving accordingly.  
LOW FUEL  
This message displays when your vehicle is low on fuel.  
Refill the fuel tank as soon as possible. See Fuel  
Gauge on page 440, Fuel on page 65, and Filling  
the Tank on page 610 for more information.  
4-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LOW TRACTION  
SERVICE AIR BAG  
If your vehicle has the Enhanced Traction System  
(ETS) or Traction Control System (TCS), this message  
displays and the ETS light or the ESC/TCS light on the  
instrument panel cluster flashes when the system is  
actively limiting wheel spin. Slippery road conditions  
may exist if this message is displayed, so adjust your  
driving accordingly. This message stays on for a few  
seconds after the system stops limiting wheel spin.  
See Enhanced Traction System (ETS) on page 511  
or Traction Control System (TCS) on page 59 and  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) Indicator/Warning  
Light on page 432 or Electronic Stability Control  
(ESC)/Traction Control System (TCS) Indicator/Warning  
Light on page 433 for more information.  
This message displays when there is a problem with  
the airbag system. Have your vehicle serviced by your  
dealer/retailer immediately.  
SERVICE ESC (ELECTRONIC STABILITY  
CONTROL)  
If your vehicle has Electronic Stability Control (ESC),  
this message displays and a chime sounds if there has  
been a problem detected with ESC. The ESC/TCS light  
also appears on the instrument panel cluster. This light  
stays on solid as long as the detected problem remains  
present. When this message displays, the system is not  
working. Adjust your driving accordingly. See Electronic  
Stability Control (ESC) on page 56 and Electronic  
Stability Control (ESC)/Traction Control System (TCS)  
Indicator/Warning Light on page 433 for more  
information.  
PARKING BRAKE  
This message displays if the parking brake is left  
engaged. See Parking Brake on page 334 for  
more information.  
If this message turns on while you are driving, pull off  
the road as soon as possible and stop carefully. Try  
resetting the system by turning the ignition off and then  
back on. If this message still stays on or turns back on  
again while you are driving, your vehicle needs service.  
Have the ESC inspected by your dealer/retailer as soon  
as possible.  
POWER STEERING  
This message displays if a problem has been detected  
with the electric power steering. Have your vehicle  
serviced by your dealer/retailer immediately.  
4-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
SERVICE TRACTION  
SVC (Service) TIRE MONITOR  
If your vehicle has the Enhanced Traction System  
(ETS) or Traction Control System (TCS), this message  
displays and a chime sounds when the system is not  
functioning properly. The ETS light or the ESC/TCS light  
also appears on the instrument panel cluster. This light  
stays on solid as long as the detected problem remains  
present. When this message displays, the system is not  
working. Adjust your driving accordingly. See Enhanced  
Traction System (ETS) on page 511 or Traction  
Control System (TCS) on page 59 and Enhanced  
Traction System (ETS) Indicator/Warning Light on  
page 432 or Electronic Stability Control (ESC)/Traction  
Control System (TCS) Indicator/Warning Light on  
page 433 for more information. Have the system  
serviced by your dealer/retailer as soon as possible.  
If your vehicle has a Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS), this message displays if a part on the TPMS is  
not working properly. The tire pressure light also flashes  
and then remains on during the same ignition cycle.  
See Tire Pressure Light on page 435. Several  
conditions may cause this message to appear. See  
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on page 665 for  
more information. If the warning comes on and stays  
on, there may be a problem with the TPMS. See your  
dealer/retailer.  
TIRE LOW ADD AIR  
If your vehicle has a Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS), this message displays when the pressure in  
one or more of the vehicle's tires is low. The low tire  
pressure warning light will also come on. See Tire  
Pressure Light on page 435. If a tire pressure  
SVC (Service) BRAKE SYSTEM  
This message may display if you have a turbocharged  
vehicle with Electronic Stability Control (ESC) and if the  
hydraulic brake boost is not working or is working  
improperly. Have the brake system serviced by your  
dealer/retailer as soon as possible.  
message appears on the DIC, stop as soon as you can.  
Have the tire pressures checked and set to those  
shown on the Tire Loading Information label. See Tires  
on page 654, Loading the Vehicle on page 524, and  
Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 663. The DIC also  
shows the tire pressure values. See DIC Operation and  
Displays on page 446  
.
4-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To change feature settings, use the following procedure:  
TRACTION OFF  
If your vehicle has the Enhanced Traction System  
(ETS) or Traction Control System (TCS), this message  
displays and the ETS light or the ESC/TCS light on the  
instrument panel cluster comes on solid when the  
system is turned off. Adjust your driving accordingly.  
See Enhanced Traction System (ETS) on page 511 or  
Traction Control System (TCS) on page 59 and  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) Indicator/Warning  
Light on page 432 or Electronic Stability Control  
(ESC)/Traction Control System (TCS) Indicator/Warning  
Light on page 433 for more information.  
Entering Personalization Menu  
1. Turn the ignition on while the vehicle is stopped.  
To avoid excessive drain on the battery, it is  
recommended that the headlamps are turned off.  
2. Press and hold the information and reset buttons at  
the same time for one second, then release to  
enter the personalization menu.  
If the vehicle speed is greater than 2 mph (3 km/h),  
only the UNITS menu will be accessible.  
3. Press the information button to scroll through the  
available personalization menu modes.  
DIC Vehicle Personalization  
Press the reset button to scroll through the  
available settings for each mode.  
Your vehicle has personalization capabilities that allow  
you to program certain features to a preferred setting.  
All of the features listed may not be available on your  
vehicle. Only the features available will be displayed on  
the DIC.  
If you do not make a selection within ten seconds,  
the display will go back to the previous information  
displayed.  
The default settings for the features were set when your  
vehicle left the factory, but may have been changed  
from their default state since that time.  
4-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
REMOTE START  
Personalization Menu Modes  
OIL LIFE RESET  
If your vehicle has remote start, this feature allows  
remote start to be turned off or on. Remote start allows  
you to start the engine from outside of the vehicle using  
your Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter. When  
REMOTE START appears on the display, press and  
hold the reset button for at least one second to scroll  
through the available settings:  
When this feature is displayed, you can reset the  
engine oil life system. To reset the system, see Engine  
Oil Life System on page 623. See OIL LIFEunder  
DIC Operation and Displays on page 446 for more  
information.  
OFF: The remote start feature will be disabled.  
UNITS  
ON (default): The remote start feature will be enabled.  
This feature allows you to select the units of  
measurement in which the DIC will display the vehicle  
information. When UNITS appears on the display, press  
and hold the reset button for at least one second to  
scroll through the available settings:  
See Remote Vehicle Start on page 37 for more  
information.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
ENGLISH (default in United States): All information  
will be displayed in English units.  
METRIC (default in Canada): All information will be  
displayed in metric units.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
4-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LOCK HORN  
UNLOCK HORN  
This feature, which allows the vehicle's horn to chirp  
every time the lock button on the Remote Keyless  
Entry (RKE) transmitter is pressed, can be enabled or  
disabled. When LOCK HORN appears on the display,  
press and hold the reset button for at least one second  
to scroll through the available settings:  
This feature, which allows the vehicle's horn to chirp  
on the first press of the unlock button on the Remote  
Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter, can be enabled or  
disabled. When UNLOCK HORN appears on the  
display, press and hold the reset button for at least  
one second to scroll through the available settings:  
OFF (default): The horn will not chirp on the first press  
of the lock button on the RKE transmitter. The horn will  
still chirp on the second press.  
OFF (default): The horn will not chirp when the unlock  
button on the RKE transmitter is pressed.  
ON: The horn will chirp on the first press of the unlock  
ON: The horn will chirp on the first press of the lock  
button on the RKE transmitter.  
button on the RKE transmitter.  
See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on  
page 34 for more information.  
See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on  
page 34 for more information.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
4-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
LIGHT FLASH  
DELAY LOCK  
This feature, which allows the vehicle's exterior hazard/  
turn signal lighting to flash every time the lock or unlock  
button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter  
is pressed, can be enabled or disabled. When LIGHT  
FLASH appears on the display, press and hold the reset  
button for at least one second to scroll through the  
available settings:  
This feature, which delays the actual locking of the  
vehicle, can be enabled or disabled. When DELAY  
LOCK appears on the display, press and hold the  
reset button for at least one second to scroll through  
the available settings:  
ON (default): The doors will not lock until five seconds  
after the last door is closed. You can temporarily  
override delayed locking by pressing the power lock  
switch or the lock button on the Remote Keyless Entry  
(RKE) transmitter a second time.  
OFF: The exterior hazard/turn signal lighting will not  
flash when the lock or unlock button on the RKE  
transmitter is pressed.  
ON (default): The exterior hazard/turn signal lighting  
will flash when the lock or unlock button on the RKE  
transmitter is pressed.  
OFF: The doors will lock immediately when pressing  
the power lock switch or the lock button on the RKE  
transmitter.  
See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on  
page 34 for more information.  
See Power Door Locks on page 310, Delayed Locking  
on page 310, and Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
System Operation on page 34 for more information.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
4-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
AUTO UNLK (Unlock)  
UNLK (Unlock) (Automatic  
Transmission Only)  
This feature, which allows the vehicle to automatically  
unlock certain doors, can be enabled or disabled. When  
AUTO UNLK appears on the display, press and hold the  
reset button for at least one second to scroll through the  
available settings:  
This screen displays only if your vehicle has an  
automatic transmission and DRIVER or ALL is selected  
for the AUTO UNLK feature. This feature determines  
when the automatic door unlocking will occur. When  
UNLK appears on the display, press and hold the reset  
button for at least one second to scroll through the  
available settings:  
ALL (default): All of the doors will automatically unlock.  
DRIVER: The driver's door will automatically unlock.  
NONE: None of the doors will automatically unlock.  
You will need to manually unlock the doors.  
KEY OFF: The door(s) will unlock when the key is  
turned off.  
If you have a manual transmission vehicle, the door(s)  
will automatically unlock when the key is turned off.  
SHIFT TO P (Park) (default): The door(s) will unlock  
when the vehicle is shifted into P (Park).  
If you have an automatic transmission vehicle, you can  
select when the automatic unlocking will occur. See  
UNLK (Unlock) (Automatic Transmission Only)”  
following.  
See Programmable Automatic Door Unlock on  
page 311 for more information.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
See Programmable Automatic Door Unlock on  
page 311 for more information.  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting is  
displayed on the DIC.  
4-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
EXT (Exterior) LIGHTS  
LANGUAGE  
This feature, which allows the vehicle's exterior  
perimeter lighting to turn on each time the unlock  
button on the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) transmitter  
is pressed, can be enabled or disabled. When EXT  
LIGHTS appears on the display, press and hold the  
reset button for at least one second to scroll through the  
available settings:  
This feature allows you to select the language in which  
the DIC will display. When LANGUAGE appears on the  
display, press and hold the reset button for at least  
one second to scroll through the available settings:  
ENGLISH (default): All messages will appear in  
English.  
FRENCH: All messages will appear in French.  
SPANISH: All messages will appear in Spanish.  
GERMAN: All messages will appear in German.  
OFF: The exterior perimeter lighting will not turn on  
when the unlock button on the RKE transmitter is  
pressed.  
ON (default): The exterior perimeter lighting will turn  
on when the unlock button on the RKE transmitter is  
pressed.  
To select a setting and exit out of the personalization  
menu mode, press the information button while the  
desired setting is displayed on the DIC.  
See Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System Operation on  
page 34 for more information.  
Exiting Personalization Menu  
The personalization menu will be exited when any of  
the following conditions occur:  
To select a setting and move on to the next feature,  
press the information button while the desired setting  
is displayed on the DIC.  
.
A ten second time period has elapsed.  
.
The ignition is turned off.  
.
The end of the personalization menu list is  
reached.  
4-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Contact your dealer/retailer before adding  
any equipment.  
Audio System(s)  
Determine which radio the vehicle has and read the  
following pages to become familiar with its features.  
Adding audio or communication equipment could  
interfere with the operation of the vehicle's engine,  
radio, or other systems, and could damage them.  
Follow federal rules covering mobile radio and  
telephone equipment.  
WARNING:  
{
Notice: The chime signals related to safety belts,  
parking brake, and other functions of your vehicle  
operate through the radio/entertainment system.  
If that equipment is replaced or additional  
equipment is added to your vehicle, the chimes  
may not work. Make sure that replacement or  
additional equipment is compatible with your  
vehicle before installing it. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 63.  
Taking your eyes off the road for extended periods  
could cause a crash resulting in injury or death to  
you or others. Do not give extended attention to  
entertainment tasks while driving.  
This system provides access to many audio and non  
audio listings.  
To minimize taking your eyes off the road while driving,  
do the following while the vehicle is parked:  
The vehicle has Retained Accessory Power (RAP).  
With RAP, the audio system can be played even after  
the ignition is turned off. See Retained Accessory  
Power (RAP) on page 325 for more information.  
.
Become familiar with the operation and controls of  
the audio system.  
.
Set up the tone, speaker adjustments, and preset  
radio stations.  
For more information, see Defensive Driving on  
page 52  
.
4-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
With Date Display  
Setting the Clock  
Radio with CD (MP3) and USB Port, and  
Radio with Single CD (MP3) Player  
Without Date Display  
AM/FM Base Radio with a Single CD Player  
To set the time and date:  
To set the time:  
1. Turn the ignition key to ACC/ACCESSORY or  
1. Turn the ignition key to ACC/ACCESSORY or  
ON/RUN. Press O to turn the radio on.  
ON/RUN. Press O to turn the radio on.  
2. Press H and the HR, MIN, MM, DD, YYYY  
2. Press H until the hour begins flashing on the  
(hour, minute, month, day, and year) displays.  
display. Press H a second time and the minute  
begins flashing on the display.  
3. Press the softkey located below any one of the  
tabs that you want to change.  
3. While either the hour or the minute numbers are  
4. To increase the time or date do one of the  
following:  
flashing, turn f to increase or decrease the time.  
.
Press the softkey located below the  
selected tab.  
4. Press H again until the clock display stops flashing  
to set the currently displayed time; otherwise, the  
flashing stops after five seconds and the current  
time displayed is automatically set.  
.
Press ¨ SEEK, or \ FWD.  
.
Turn f clockwise.  
To change the time default setting from 12 hour to  
5. To decrease the time or date do one of the  
following:  
24 hour, press the H button until 12H or 24H is  
displayed. Once 12H or 24H is displayed, turn  
.
the f knob to the desired option to select the setting.  
Press © SEEK or s REV.  
Press the H button again to apply the setting, or let the  
screen time out.  
.
Turn f counterclockwise.  
4-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The date does not automatically display. To see the  
Radio(s)  
date press H while the radio is on. The date with  
display times out after a few seconds and goes back  
to the normal radio and time display.  
To change the time default setting from 12 hour to  
24 hour or to change the date default setting from  
month/day/year to day/month/year:  
1. Press H and then the softkey located below the  
forward arrow label. Once the time 12H and 24H,  
and the date MM/DD/YYYY (month, day, and year)  
and DD/MM/YYYY (day, month, and year) displays.  
2. Press the softkey located below the desired option.  
3. Press H again to apply the selected default, or let  
the screen time out.  
Radio with CD (Base)  
4-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radio Data System (RDS)  
The radio may have RDS. The RDS feature is available  
for use only on FM stations that broadcast RDS  
information. This system relies upon receiving specific  
information from these stations and only works when  
the information is available. While the radio is tuned to  
an FM-RDS station, the station name or call letters  
display. In rare cases, a radio station could broadcast  
incorrect information that causes the radio features to  
work improperly. If this happens, contact the radio  
station.  
Radio with CD (MP3) and USB Port shown,  
Radio with CD (MP3) similar  
The vehicle has one of these radios as its audio  
system.  
4-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Playing the Radio  
Finding a Station  
O (Power/Volume): Press to turn the system on and  
BAND: Press to choose between FM1, FM2, AM,  
or XM(if equipped) on the Radio with CD (Base).  
Press to choose between FM, AM, XM (if equipped) on  
the Radio with CD (MP3) and USB Port or the Radio  
with CD (MP3).  
off. Turn to increase or decrease the volume.  
Speed Compensated Volume (SCV): Radios with  
the Speed Compensated Volume (SCV) feature  
automatically adjust the radio volume to compensate  
for road and wind noise as the vehicle speeds up or  
slows down, so that the volume level is consistent.  
f (Tune): Turn to select radio stations.  
© SEEK: Press to seek or scan stations with a strong  
To activate SCV:  
signal in the selected band.  
1. Set the radio volume to the desired level.  
2. Press MENU to display the radio setup menu.  
.
To seek stations, press and release © SEEK to  
go to the previous station and stay there.  
.
3. Press the softkey under the AUTO VOLUM tab on  
the radio display.  
To scan stations, press and hold © SEEK for a  
few seconds until the radio beeps once. The radio  
goes to a station, plays for a few seconds, then  
4. Press the softkey under the desired Speed  
Compensated Volume setting (OFF, Low, Med,  
or High) to select the level of radio volume  
compensation. The display times out after  
approximately 10 seconds. Each higher setting  
allows for more radio volume compensation at  
faster vehicle speeds.  
goes to the next station. Press © SEEK again to  
stop scanning.  
.
To scan preset stations in the selected band, press  
and hold © SEEK for four seconds until a double  
beep sounds. The radio goes to a stored preset,  
plays for a few seconds, then goes to the next  
stored preset. Press © SEEK again to stop  
scanning preset stations.  
4-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For vehicles with XM, MP3, WMA, or RDS features,  
¨ SEEK: Press to seek or scan stations with a strong  
signal in the selected band.  
press 4 to display additional text information related to  
the current FM-RDS or XM station; or CD, MP3, WMA  
song. Song title information will be displayed on the  
top line of the display while the artist information will  
be displayed on the bottom line, it the information is  
available during XM, CD, MP3, or WMA playback.  
When information is not available, No Infodisplays.  
.
To seek stations, press and release ¨ SEEK to  
go to the next station and stay there.  
.
To scan stations, press and hold ¨ SEEK for a  
few seconds until the radio beeps once. The radio  
goes to a station, plays for a few seconds, then  
goes to the next station. Press ¨ SEEK again to  
Storing Radio Stations  
Depending on which radio the vehicle has, radio  
stations are stored as either favorites or presets.  
stop scanning.  
.
To scan preset stations in the selected band, press  
and hold ¨ SEEK for four seconds until a double  
beep sounds. The radio goes to a stored preset,  
plays for a few seconds, then goes to the next  
Storing a Radio Station as a Favorite  
Radio that have a FAV button store radio stations as  
favorites.  
stored preset. Press ¨ SEEK again to stop  
scanning preset stations.  
Drivers are encouraged to set up radio station favorites  
while the vehicle is in P (Park). Tune to favorite stations  
using the softkeys, favorites button, and steering wheel  
controls. See Defensive Driving on page 52.  
4 (Information): For vehicles with the Radio with CD  
(Base), press to switch the display between the radio  
station frequency and the time. While the ignition is off,  
press 4 to display the time.  
4-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FAV (Favorites): A maximum of 36 stations can be  
stored as favorites using the six softkeys located below  
the radio station frequency tabs and by using the radio  
favorites page button (FAV button). Press FAV to go  
through up to six pages of favorites, each having six  
favorite stations available per page. Each page of  
favorites can contain any combination of AM, FM, or  
XM stations. The current balance/fade and tone settings  
are also stored with the favorite stations.  
3. Select the desired number of favorites pages by  
pressing the softkey located below the displayed  
page numbers.  
4. Press FAV, or let the menu time out, to return to  
the original main radio screen showing the radio  
station frequency tabs and to begin programming  
favorites.  
Auto Text (Satellite Radio Service, CD, MP3, and  
WMA features): If additional information is available  
for the current song being played, Auto Text will  
automatically page/scroll the information every  
three seconds above the FAV presets on the radio  
display. By default, Auto Text is enabled.  
To store a station as a favorite:  
1. Tune to the desired radio station and set the  
balance/fade and tone settings to the desired  
levels.  
2. Press FAV to display the page where to store the  
station.  
To change the Auto Text setting:  
1. Press MENU to display the radio setup menu.  
3. Press and hold one of the six softkeys until a beep  
sounds.  
2. Press the softkey under AUTO TXT tab on the  
radio display.  
4. Repeat the steps for each radio station to be  
stored as a favorite.  
3. Press the softkey under the ON or OFF tab on the  
radio display.  
To setup the number of favorites pages:  
If 4 is pressed and the song title or artist information is  
longer than what can be displayed, the extra information  
will page every three seconds when Auto Text is  
activated.  
1. Press MENU to display the radio setup menu.  
2. Press the softkey located below the FAV 1-6 tab.  
4-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To adjust the tone settings on the Radio with CD (MP3)  
and USB Port or the Radio with CD (MP3):  
Storing a Radio Station as a Preset  
Radios that have numbered pushbuttons store radio  
stations as presets.  
1. Press f until the tone control tabs display.  
Up to 18 stations (six FM1, six FM2, and six AM), can  
be programmed on the six numbered buttons.  
2. Press the softkey below the desired tab to be  
adjusted.  
3. To increase the level of the bass, midrange,  
or treble:  
To store preset stations:  
1. Tune in the desired station.  
.
Press ¨ SEEK, or \ FWD.  
2. Press and hold one of the six numbered buttons  
for three seconds until a beep sounds.  
.
Turn f clockwise.  
3. Repeat the Steps 1 and 2 for each numbered  
button.  
4. To decrease the level of the bass, midrange,  
or treble:  
Setting the Tone (Bass/Midrange/Treble)  
.
Press © SEEK, or s REV.  
BASS/MID/TREB (Bass, Midrange, or Treble): The  
radio may display some or all tones such as BASS,  
MID, and TREB.  
.
Turn f counterclockwise.  
The radio may be capable of adjusting bass, midrange,  
or treble to the middle position by pressing the softkey  
below the BASS, MID, or TREB tab for more than  
two seconds. The radio beeps once and the level  
adjusts to the middle position.  
To adjust the tone settings on the Radio with  
CD (Base):  
Press f until the tone control labels display, then  
turn f to change the setting.  
4-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The radio may also be capable of adjusting all tone  
and speaker controls to the middle position by  
3. Turn f to adjust the highlighted setting. The  
highlighted setting can also be adjusted by  
pressing either SEEK arrow.  
pressing f for more than two seconds until the radio  
beeps once.  
On some radios, \ FWD and s REV can also  
be used to adjust the highlighted level.  
If a station's frequency is weak, or has static, decrease  
the treble.  
To adjust balance or fade using ` :  
EQ (Equalization): Press this button to select preset  
equalization settings.  
1. Press ` until the speaker control labels display.  
To return to the manual mode, press EQ until Manual  
displays or start to manually adjust the bass, midrange,  
2. Continue pressing ` until the desired speaker  
control label displays.  
or treble by pressing f .  
3. Turn f to adjust the setting. The setting can  
Adjusting the Speakers (Balance/Fade)  
Depending on which radio the vehicle has, the Balance/  
also be adjusted by pressing either SEEK  
arrow, \ FWD, or s REV.  
Fade can be adjusted using f or ` .  
The radio may be capable of adjusting balance or fade  
to the middle position by pressing the softkey below the  
BAL or FADE tab for more than two seconds. The radio  
beeps once and the level adjusts to the middle position.  
To adjust balance or fade using f :  
1. Press f until the speaker control tabs display.  
The radio may also be capable of adjusting all tone  
and speaker controls to the middle position by  
2. Press the softkey under the desired tab,  
or continue pressing f to highlight the desired tab.  
pressing f for more than two seconds until the radio  
beeps once.  
4-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Undesired XM categories can be removed through the  
setup menu. To remove an undesired category:  
Finding a Category (CAT) Station  
(XM Satellite Radio Service Only)  
CAT (Category): The radio may have the CAT button  
feature.  
1. Press MENU to display the radio setup menu.  
2. Press the softkey below the XM CAT tab.  
3. Turn f to display the category to be removed.  
To select and find a desired category:  
4. Press the softkey below the Remove tab until the  
category name along with the word Removed  
displays.  
1. Press BAND until the XM frequency displays.  
2. Press CAT to display the category tabs on the  
radio display. Continue pressing the CAT button  
until the desired category name displays.  
5. Repeat the steps to remove additional categories.  
3. Press either of the two softkeys below the desired  
category tab to immediately tune to the first XM  
station associated with that category.  
Removed categories can be restored by pressing the  
softkey under the Add tab when a removed category  
displays or by pressing the softkey below the Restore  
All tab.  
4. To go to the previous or to the next XM station  
within the selected category, do one of the  
following:  
Categories cannot be removed or added while the  
vehicle is moving faster than 5 mph (8 km/h).  
.
Turn f .  
.
Press the softkeys below the right or left arrows  
on the radio display.  
.
Press © SEEK or ¨ SEEK.  
5. To exit the category search mode, press the  
FAV button or BAND button to display the favorites  
again.  
4-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Radio Messages  
Loading a CD  
Calibration Error: Displays if the radio is no longer  
calibrated properly for the vehicle. The vehicle must be  
returned to your dealer/retailer for service.  
Loc or Locked: Displays when the THEFTLOCK®  
system has activated. Take the vehicle to your dealer/  
retailer for service.  
Insert a CD partway into the slot, label side up. The  
player pulls it in and the CD begins playing.  
When the CD is inserted, the CD symbol displays. As  
each new track starts to play, the track number displays.  
The CD player can play the smaller 3 inch (8 cm) single  
CDs with an adapter ring. Full-size CDs and the smaller  
CDs are loaded in the same manner.  
If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be  
corrected, contact your dealer/retailer.  
Ejecting a CD  
Z EJECT: Press to eject the CD. If the CD is not  
removed, after several seconds, the CD automatically  
pulls back into the player.  
XM Satellite Radio Service  
XM is a satellite radio service that is based in the  
48 contiguous United States and 10 Canadian  
provinces. XM Satellite Radio has a wide variety of  
programming and commercial-free music,  
Playing a CD  
coast-to-coast, and in digital-quality sound. A service  
fee is required to receive the XM service. For more  
information, contact XM at www.xmradio.com or call  
1-800-929-2100 in the U.S. and www.xmradio.ca or call  
1-877-438-9677 in Canada.  
If the ignition or radio is turned off with a CD in the  
player it stays in the player. When the ignition or radio is  
turned on, the CD starts to play where it stopped, if it  
was the last selected audio source.  
f (Tune): Turn to select tracks on the CD currently  
playing.  
Radio Messages for XM Only  
© SEEK: Press to go to the start of the current track,  
if more than ten seconds have played. Press and hold  
or press multiple times to continue moving backward  
through the tracks on the CD.  
See XM Radio Messages on page 480 for more  
information.  
4-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
BAND: Press to listen to the radio while a CD is  
playing. The CD remains inside the radio for future  
listening.  
¨ SEEK: Press to go to the next track. Press and hold  
or press multiple times to continue moving forward  
through the tracks on the CD.  
CD/AUX (CD/Auxiliary): Press to play a CD while  
listening to the radio. The CD icon and a message  
showing the track number displays when a CD is in  
the player. Press this button again and the system  
automatically searches for an auxiliary input device,  
such as a portable audio player. If a portable audio  
player is not connected, No Aux Input Device Found  
may display.  
s REV (Reverse): Press and hold to reverse  
playback quickly within a track. Sound is heard at a  
reduced volume and the elapsed time of the track  
displays. Release to resume playing the track.  
\ FWD (Fast Forward): Press and hold to advance  
playback quickly within a track. Sound is heard at a  
reduced volume and the elapsed time of the track  
displays. Release to resume playing the track.  
Playing an MP3 CD-R or CD-RW Disc  
The radio may have the ability to play an MP3 CD-R or  
CD-RW disc. See Using an MP3 on page 474 for  
more information.  
RDM (Random): Tracks can be listened to in random,  
rather than sequential order.  
To use random:  
1. Press the softkey below RDM tab until Random  
Current Disc displays.  
2. Press the softkey again to turn off random play.  
4-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
CD Messages  
Care of CDs  
CHECK DISC: If an error message displays and/or the  
CD comes out, it could be for one of the following  
reasons:  
Store CD(s) in their original cases or other protective  
cases and away from direct sunlight and dust. The  
CD player scans the bottom of the disc. If the bottom of  
a CD is damaged it may not play properly or at all.  
Do not touch the bottom of a CD while handling it. Pick  
up CDs by grasping the outer edges or the edge of the  
hole and the outer edge.  
.
The CD player is very hot. When the temperature  
returns to normal, the CD should play.  
.
The road is very rough. When the road becomes  
smoother, the CD should play.  
If the surface of a CD is dirty, take a soft, lint free cloth  
or dampen a clean, soft cloth in a mild, neutral  
detergent solution mixed with water, and clean it. Make  
sure the wiping process starts from the center to  
the edge.  
.
The CD is dirty, scratched, wet, or upside down.  
.
The air is very humid. If so, wait about an hour and  
try again.  
.
A problem may have occurred while burning  
the CD.  
Care of the CD Player  
Do not add labels to a CD, it could get caught in the  
CD player. Use a marking pen to write on the top of the  
CD if a description is needed.  
.
The label could be caught in the CD player.  
If the CD is not playing correctly, for any other reason,  
try a known good CD.  
If any error occurs repeatedly or if an error cannot be  
corrected, contact your dealer/retailer. If the radio  
displays an error message, write it down and provide it  
to your dealer/retailer when reporting the problem.  
Do not use CD lens cleaners, they could damage the  
CD player.  
4-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: If a label is added to a CD, or more than  
one CD is inserted into the slot at a time, or an  
attempt is made to play scratched or damaged CDs,  
the CD player could be damaged. While using the  
CD player, use only CDs in good condition without  
any label, load one CD at a time, and keep the  
CD player and the loading slot free of foreign  
materials, liquids, and debris.  
To use a portable audio player, connect a 3.5 mm  
(1/8 in) cable to the radio's front auxiliary input jack.  
When a device is connected, press the radio CD/AUX  
button to begin playing audio from the device over the  
vehicle speakers.  
O (Power/Volume): Turn to adjust the volume.  
Additional volume adjustments may have to be made  
from the portable device if the volume is too quiet or  
not loud.  
If an error displays, see CD Messagesearlier in this  
section.  
BAND: Press to listen to the radio while a portable  
audio device is connected to the auxiliary input. The  
portable audio device continues playing until it is  
stopped or turned off.  
Using the Auxiliary Input Jack  
The radio system may have an auxiliary input jack  
located on the lower right side of the faceplate. This  
is not an audio output; do not plug the headphone set  
into the front auxiliary input jack. An external audio  
device such as an iPod®, laptop computer, MP3 player,  
CD changer, etc. can be connected to the auxiliary input  
jack for use as another audio source.  
CD/AUX (CD/Auxiliary): Press to play a CD while a  
portable audio device is connected to the auxiliary  
input. Press again and the system begins playing audio  
from the connected portable audio player. If a portable  
audio player is not connected, No Aux Input Device  
may display.  
Drivers are encouraged to set up any auxiliary device  
while the vehicle is in P (Park). See Defensive Driving  
on page 52 for more information on driver distraction.  
4-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the USB Port  
Using an MP3  
Format  
Radios that have the capability of playing MP3's can  
play.mp3 or .wma files that were recorded onto a CD-R  
or CD-RW disc. Radios that have a USB port can  
play.mp3 and .wma files that are stored on a USB  
storage device as well as AAC files that are stored on  
an iPod®.  
Radio's with a USB port can control a USB storage  
device or an iPod® using the radio buttons and knobs.  
See Using an MP3 on page 474 for information about  
how to connect and control a USB storage device or  
an iPod.  
USB Support  
The USB connector is located on the front of the radio  
and uses the USB 2.0 standard.  
Compressed Audio  
USB Supported Devices  
The radio can play discs that contain both  
.
uncompressed CD audio and MP3 files. If both formats  
are on the disc, the radio reads all MP3 files first, then  
the uncompressed CD audio files.  
USB Flash Drives  
.
Portable USB Hard Drives  
.
Fifth generation or later iPod  
CDR or CDRW Supported File and Folder  
Structure  
.
First , Second, or Third generation iPod nano  
.
iPod touch  
The radio supports:  
.
iPod classic  
.
Up to 50 folders.  
Make sure the iPod has the latest firmware from Apple®  
for proper operation. iPod firmware can be updated  
using the latest iTunes® application. See  
www.apple.com/itunes.  
.
Up to 8 folders in depth.  
.
Up to 50 playlists.  
.
Up to 255 files.  
For help with identifying your iPod, go to  
www.apple.com/support.  
.
Playlists with an .m3u or .wpl extension.  
.
Files with an .mp3, .wma, or .cda file extension.  
4-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
USB Supported File and Folder Structure  
Order of Play  
The radio supports:  
Tracks are played in the following order:  
.
.
Up to 700 folders.  
Play begins from the first track in the first playlist  
and continues sequentially through all tracks in  
each playlist. When the last track of the last playlist  
has played, play continues from the first track of  
the first playlist.  
.
Up to 8 folders in depth.  
.
Up to 65,535 files.  
.
Folder and file names up to 64 bytes.  
.
.
Play begins from the first track in the first folder  
Files with an .mp3 or .wma file extension.  
and continues sequentially through all tracks in  
each folder. When the last track of the last folder  
has played, play continues from the first track of  
the first folder.  
.
AAC files stored on an iPod.  
.
FAT16  
.
FAT32  
When play enters a new folder, the display does not  
automatically show the new folder name unless the  
folder mode has been chosen as the default display.  
The new track name displays.  
Root Directory  
The root directory is treated as a folder. Files are stored  
in the root directory when the disc or storage device  
does not contain folders. Files accessed from the root  
directory of a CD display as F1 ROOT.  
File System and Naming  
The song name that displays is the song name that is  
contained in the ID3 tag. If the song name is not  
present in the ID3 tag, then the radio displays the file  
name without the extension (such as .mp3) as the  
track name.  
Empty Folder  
Folders that do not contain files are skipped, and the  
player advances to the next folder that contains files.  
Track names longer than 32 characters or four pages  
are shortened. The display does not show parts of  
words on the last page of text and the extension of the  
filename is not displayed.  
4-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Preprogrammed Playlists  
\ FWD (Fast Forward): Press and hold to advance  
playback quickly. Sound is heard at a reduced  
volume and the elapsed time of the file displays.  
CDs that have preprogrammed playlists that were  
created using WinAmp, MusicMatch, or Real  
Jukeboxsoftware can be accessed, however, there  
is no playlist editing capability using the radio. These  
playlists are treated as special folders containing  
compressed audio song files.  
Release \ FWD to resume playing. The elapsed  
time of the file displays.  
S c (Previous Folder): Press the softkey  
below S c to go to the first track in the previous  
folder.  
Playlists that have an .m3u or .pls file extension and are  
stored on a USB device may be supported by the radio  
with a USB port.  
c T (Next Folder): Press the softkey below c T to  
go to the first track in the next folder.  
Playing a CD-R or CD-RW MP3  
f (Tune): Turn to select MP3 files on the CD currently  
playing.  
RDM (Random): MP3 files can be listened to on a CD  
in random, rather than sequential order. To use random,  
press the softkey under the RDM tab until Random  
Current Disc displays to play songs from the current CD  
in random order. Press the same softkey again to turn  
off random play.  
© SEEK: Press to go to the start of the track, if more  
than ten seconds have played. Press and hold or press  
multiple times to continue moving backward through  
tracks.  
h (Music Navigator): Press the softkey  
below h to have the files played in order by  
artist or album. The player scans the disc to sort the  
files by artist and album ID3 tag information. It can  
take several minutes to scan the disc depending on the  
number of files on the disc. The radio may begin playing  
while it is scanning in the background.  
¨ SEEK: Press to go to the next track. Press and  
hold or press multiple times to continue moving forward  
through tracks.  
s REV (Reverse): Press and hold to reverse  
playback quickly. Sound is heard at a reduced  
volume and the elapsed time of the file displays.  
Release s REV to resume playing.  
4-76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the scan is finished, the disc begins playing files  
in order by artist. The current artist playing is shown on  
the second line of the display. Once all songs by that  
artist are played, the player moves to the next artist in  
alphabetical order and begins playing files by that artist.  
Connecting a USB Storage Device  
or iPod®  
The USB Port can be used to control an iPod or a USB  
storage device.  
To listen to files by another artist, press the softkey  
located below either arrow tab. The disc goes to the  
next or previous artist in alphabetical order. Continue  
pressing either softkey below the arrow tab until the  
desired artist displays.  
To connect a USB storage device, connect the device to  
the USB port located on the front of the radio.  
To connect an iPod, connect one end of the USB cable  
that came with the iPod to the iPods dock connector  
and connect the other end to the USB port located on  
the front of the radio. If the vehicle is on and the USB  
connection works, OK to disconnectand a GM logo  
may appear on the iPod and iPod appears on the  
radio's display. The iPod music appears on the radios  
display and begins playing.  
To change from playback by artist to playback by  
album:  
1. Press the softkey located below the Sort By tab.  
2. Press one of the softkeys below the album tab  
from the sort screen.  
The iPod charges while it is connected to the vehicle if  
the vehicle is in the ACC/ACCESSORY or ON/RUN  
position. When the vehicle is turned off, the iPod  
automatically powers off and will not charge or draw  
power from the vehicle's battery.  
3. Press the softkey below the back tab to return to  
the main music navigator screen.  
The album name displays on the second line between  
the arrows and songs from the current album begins to  
play. Once all songs from that album have played, the  
player moves to the next album in alphabetical order on  
the CD and begins playing MP3 files from that album.  
If you have an older iPod model that is not supported, it  
can still be used by connecting it to the Auxiliary Input  
Jack using a standard 3.5 mm (1/8 in) stereo cable. See  
Using the Auxiliary Input Jackearlier for more  
information.  
To exit music navigator mode, press the softkey below  
the Back tab to return to normal MP3 playback.  
4-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Using the Radio to Control a USB  
Storage Device or iPod  
Using Softkeys to Control a USB  
Storage Device or iPod  
The radio can control a USB storage device or an iPod  
using the radio buttons and knobs and display song  
information on the radios display.  
The five softkeys below the radio display are used to  
control the functions listed below.  
To use the softkeys:  
f (Tune): Turn to select files.  
1. Press the first or fifth softkey below the radio  
display to display the functions listed below,  
or press the softkey below the function if it is  
currently displayed.  
© SEEK: Press to go to the start of the track, if more  
than ten seconds have played. Press and hold or press  
multiple times to continue moving backward through  
tracks.  
2. Press the softkey below the tab with the function  
on it to use that function.  
¨ SEEK: Press to go to the next track. Press and hold  
or press multiple times to continue moving forward  
through tracks.  
j (Pause): Press the softkey below j to pause the  
track. The tab appears raised when pause is being  
s REV (Reverse): Press and hold to reverse  
used. Press the softkey below j again to resume  
playback.  
playback quickly. Sound is heard at a reduced volume.  
Release s REV to resume playing. The elapsed time  
Back: Press the softkey below the back tab to go back  
to the main display screen on an iPod, or the root  
directory on a USB storage device.  
of the file displays.  
\ FWD (Fast Forward): Press and hold to advance  
playback quickly. Sound is heard at a reduced volume.  
c (Folder View): Press the softkey below c to  
view the contents of the current folder on the USB drive.  
To browse and select files:  
Release \ FWD to resume playing. The elapsed time  
of the file displays.  
4 (Information): Press to display additional information  
about the selected track.  
1. Press the softkey below c .  
2. Turn f to scroll through the list of folders.  
4-78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
.
Genres  
3. Press f to select the desired folder. If there is  
more then one folder, repeat Steps 1 and 2 until  
the desired folder is reached.  
Songs  
Composers  
4. Turn f to scroll through the files in the selected  
To select files:  
folder.  
1. Press the softkey below h .  
2. Turn f to scroll through the list of menus.  
3. Press f to select the desired menu.  
5. Press f to select the desired file to be played.  
To skip through large lists, the five softkeys can be used  
to navigate in the following order:  
.
First softkey, first item in the list.  
4. Turn f to scroll through the folders or files in the  
.
selected menu.  
Second softkey, 1% through the list each time the  
softkey is pressed.  
5. Press f to select the desired file to be played.  
.
Third softkey, 5% through the list each time the  
softkey is pressed.  
To skip through large lists, the five softkeys can be used  
to navigate in the following order:  
.
Fourth softkey, 10% through the list each time the  
softkey is pressed.  
.
First softkey, first item in the list.  
.
Second softkey, 1% through the list each time the  
.
Fifth softkey, end of the list.  
softkey is pressed.  
h (Music Navigator): Press the softkey  
.
Third softkey, 5% through the list each time the  
below h to view and select a file on an iPod,  
using the iPod's menu system. Files are sorted by:  
softkey is pressed.  
.
Fourth softkey, 10% through the list each time the  
.
Playlists  
softkey is pressed.  
.
.
Artists  
Fifth softkey, end of the list.  
.
Albums  
4-79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Repeat Functionality  
2 (Shuffle All Songs / Shuffle Songs): Press the  
softkey below = or < to shuffle all songs on the  
To use Repeat:  
USB storage device or iPod.  
Press the softkey below " or ' to select between  
Repeat All and Repeat Track.  
< (Shuffle Album): Press the softkey below > to  
shuffle all songs in the current album on an iPod.  
" (Repeat All): Press the softkey below " to repeat  
all tracks. The tab appears lowered when Repeat All is  
being used. This is the default mode when a USB  
storage device or iPod is first connected.  
= (Shuffle Folder): Press the softkey below > to  
shuffle all songs in the current folder on a USB storage  
device.  
' (Repeat Track): Press the softkey below ' to  
repeat one track. The tab appears raised when Repeat  
Track is being used.  
XM Radio Messages  
XL (Explicit Language Channels): These channels,  
or any others, can be blocked at a customer's request,  
by calling 1-800-852-XMXM (9696).  
Shuffle Functionality  
To use Shuffle:  
XM Updating: The encryption code in the receiver is  
being updated, and no action is required. This process  
should take no longer than 30 seconds.  
Press the softkey below > , 2 , < or = to  
select between Shuffle Off, Shuffle All Songs/Shuffle  
Songs, Shuffle Album, or Shuffle Folder.  
No XM Signal: The system is functioning correctly, but  
the vehicle is in a location that is blocking the XM™  
signal. When the vehicle is moved into an open area,  
the signal should return.  
> (Shuffle Off): Press the softkey below 2 to turn  
shuffle off. This is the default mode when a USB  
storage device or iPod is first connected.  
4-80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Loading XM: The audio system is acquiring and  
processing audio and text data. No action is needed.  
This message should disappear shortly.  
CAT Not Found: There are no channels available for  
the selected category. The system is working properly.  
XM Theftlocked: The XM receiver in the vehicle could  
have previously been in another vehicle. For security  
purposes, XM receivers cannot be swapped between  
vehicles. If this message is received after having the  
vehicle serviced, check with your dealer/retailer.  
Channel Off Air: This channel is not currently in  
service. Tune in to another channel.  
Channel Unauth: This channel is blocked or cannot be  
received with your XM Subscription package.  
XM Radio ID: If tuned to channel 0, this message  
alternates with the XMRadio 8 digit radio ID label.  
This label is needed to activate the service.  
Channel Unavail: This previously assigned channel is  
no longer assigned. Tune to another station. If this  
station was one of the presets, choose another station  
for that preset button.  
Unknown: If this message is received when tuned to  
channel 0, there could be a receiver fault. Consult with  
your dealer/retailer.  
No Artist Info: No artist information is available at this  
time on this channel. The system is working properly.  
Check Antenna: If this message does not clear within  
a short period of time, the receiver or antenna could  
have a fault. Consult with your dealer/retailer.  
No Title Info: No song title information is available at  
this time on this channel. The system is working  
properly.  
Check XM Receivr: If this message does not clear  
within a short period of time, the receiver could have a  
fault. Consult with your dealer/retailer.  
No CAT Info: No category information is available at  
this time on this channel. The system is working  
properly.  
XM Not Available: If this message does not clear  
within a short period of time, the receiver could have a  
fault. Consult with your dealer/retailer.  
No Information: No text or informational messages are  
available at this time on this channel. The system is  
working properly.  
4-81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Bluetooth®  
Audio System  
When using the invehicle Bluetooth system, sound  
comes through the vehicle's front audio system  
speakers and overrides the audio system. Use the  
audio system volume knob, during a call, to change  
the volume level. The adjusted volume level remains in  
memory for later calls. To prevent missed calls, a  
minimum volume level is used if the volume is turned  
down too low.  
Vehicles with a Bluetooth system can use a Bluetooth  
capable cell phone with a Hands Free Profile to make  
and receive phone calls. The system can be used while  
the key is in ON/RUN or ACC/ACCESSORY position.  
The range of the Bluetooth system can be up to 9.1 m  
(30 ft). Not all phones support all functions, and not all  
phones are guaranteed to work with the in-vehicle  
Bluetooth system. See www.gm.com/bluetooth for  
more information on compatible phones.  
Bluetooth Controls  
Voice Recognition  
The Bluetooth system uses voice recognition to  
interpret voice commands to dial phone numbers  
and name tags.  
Use the buttons located on the steering wheel to  
operate the invehicle Bluetooth system. See Audio  
Steering Wheel Controls on page 492 for more  
information.  
b g (Push To Talk) : Press to answer incoming calls,  
to confirm system information, and to start speech  
recognition.  
Noise: Keep interior noise levels to a minimum. The  
system may not recognize voice commands if there is  
too much background noise.  
c x (Phone On Hook): Press to end a call, reject a  
When to Speak: A short tone sounds after the system  
responds indicating when it is waiting for a voice  
command. Wait until the tone and then speak.  
call, or to cancel an operation.  
How to Speak: Speak clearly in a calm and natural  
voice.  
4-82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Pairing a Phone  
Pairing  
A Bluetooth enabled cell phone must be paired to the  
invehicle Bluetooth system first and then connected to  
the vehicle before it can be used. See the cell phone  
manufacturers user guide for Bluetooth functions  
before pairing the cell phone. If a Bluetooth phone is  
not connected, calls will be made using OnStar®  
HandsFree Calling, if available. Refer to the OnStar  
owner's guide for more information.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system responds with  
Bluetooth readyfollowed by a tone.  
3. Say Pair. The system responds with instructions  
and a four digit PIN number. The PIN number will  
be used in Step 4.  
4. Start the Pairing process on the cell phone that will  
be paired to the vehicle. Reference the cell phone  
manufacturers user guide for information on this  
process.  
Pairing Information:  
.
Up to five cell phones can be paired to the  
invehicle Bluetooth system.  
.
The pairing process is disabled when the vehicle  
Locate the device named General Motorsin  
the list on the cellular phone and follow the  
instructions on the cell phone to enter the  
four digit PIN number that was provided in Step 3.  
is moving.  
.
The invehicle Bluetooth system automatically links  
with the first available paired cell phone in the  
order the phone was paired.  
5. The system prompts for a name for the phone. Use  
a name that best describes the phone. This name  
will be used to indicate which phone is connected.  
The system then confirms the name provided.  
.
Only one paired cell phone can be connected to  
the invehicle Bluetooth system at a time.  
.
Pairing should only need to be completed once,  
unless changes to the pairing information have  
been made or the phone is deleted.  
6. The system responds with <Phone name> has  
been successfully pairedafter the pairing process  
is complete.  
To link to a different paired phone, see Linking to a  
Different Phone later in this section.  
7. Repeat Steps 1 through 7 for additional phones to  
be paired.  
4-83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Listing All Paired and Connected Phones  
Linking to a Different Phone  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system responds with  
Bluetooth readyfollowed by a tone.  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system responds with  
Bluetooth readyfollowed by a tone.  
3. Say List. The system lists all the paired Bluetooth  
devices. If a phone is connected to the vehicle, the  
system will say Is connectedafter the connected  
phone.  
3. Say Change phone. The system responds with  
Please wait while I search for other phones.  
.
If another phone is found, the response will  
be <Phone name> is now connected.  
.
Deleting a Paired Phone  
If another phone is not found, the original  
phone remains connected.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
Storing Name Tags  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system responds with  
Bluetooth readyfollowed by a tone.  
The system can store up to thirty phone numbers as  
name tags that are shared between the Bluetooth and  
OnStar systems.  
3. Say Delete. The system asks which phone to  
delete followed by a tone.  
The system uses the following commands to store and  
retrieve phone numbers:  
4. Say the name of the phone to be deleted. If the  
phone name is unknown, use the Listcommand  
for a list of all paired phones. The system responds  
with Would you like to delete <phone name>?  
Yes or Nofollowed by a tone.  
.
Store  
.
Digit Store  
.
Directory  
5. Say Yesto delete the phone. The system  
responds with OK, deleting <phone name>.  
4-84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Say a name tag for the phone number. The name  
tag is recorded and the system responds with  
About to store <name tag>. Does that  
sound OK?.  
Using the Store Command  
The store command allows a phone number to be  
stored without entering the digits individually.  
.
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
If the name tag does not sound correct, say  
Noand repeat Step 5.  
.
2. Say Store. The system responds with Store,  
number pleasefollowed by a tone.  
If the name tag sounds correct, say Yesand  
the name tag is stored. After the number is  
stored the system returns to the main menu.  
3. Say the complete phone number to be stored at  
once with no pauses.  
Using the Digit Store Command  
.
If the system recognizes the number it  
The digit store command allows a phone number to be  
stored by entering the digits individually.  
responds with OK, Storingand repeats the  
phone number.  
.
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
If the system is unsure it recognizes the phone  
number, it responds with Storeand repeats  
the number followed by Please say yes or no.  
If the number is correct, say Yes. If the  
number is not correct, say No. The system will  
ask for the number to be reentered.  
2. Say Digit Store. The system responds with  
Please say the first digit to storefollowed by  
a tone.  
4. After the system stores the phone number, it  
responds with Please say the name tagfollowed  
by a tone.  
4-85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Say the first digit to be stored. The system will  
repeat back the digit it heard followed by a tone.  
Continue entering digits until the number to be  
stored is complete.  
Using the Directory Command  
The directory command lists all of the name tags stored  
by the system. To use the directory command:  
.
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
If an unwanted number is recognized by the  
system, say Clearat any time to clear the last  
number.  
2. Say Directory. The system responds with  
Directoryand then plays back all of the stored  
name tags. When the list is complete, the system  
returns to the main menu.  
.
To hear all of the numbers recognized by the  
system, say Verifyat any time and the system  
will repeat them.  
4. After the complete number has been entered, say  
Store. The system responds with Please say the  
name tagfollowed by a tone.  
Deleting Name Tags  
The system uses the following commands to delete  
name tags:  
5. Say a name tag for the phone number. The name  
tag is recorded and the system responds with  
About to store <name tag>. Does that  
sound OK?.  
.
Delete  
.
Delete all name tags  
Using the Delete Command  
.
If the name tag does not sound correct, say  
Noand repeat Step 5.  
The delete command allows specific name tags to be  
deleted.  
.
If the name tag sounds correct, say Yesand  
the name tag is stored. After the number is  
stored the system returns to the main menu.  
To use the delete command:  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
2. Say Delete. The system responds with Delete,  
please say the name tagfollowed by a tone.  
4-86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Say the name tag to be deleted. The system  
responds with Would you like to delete,  
<name tag>? Please say yes or no.  
Making a Call  
Calls can be made using the following commands:  
.
Dial  
.
If the name tag is correct, say Yesto delete  
.
the name tag. The system responds with OK,  
deleting <name tag>, returning to the  
main menu.”  
Digit Dial  
.
Call  
.
Redial  
.
If the name tag is incorrect, say No. The  
system responds with No. OK, let's try again,  
please say the name tag.”  
Using the Dial Command  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
Using the Delete All Name Tags Command  
The delete all name tags command deletes all stored  
phone book name tags and route name tags for OnStar,  
if present.  
2. Say Dial. The system responds with Dial  
using <phone name>. Number pleasefollowed  
by a tone.  
To use the delete all name tags command:  
3. Say the entire number without pausing.  
.
If the system recognizes the number, it  
responds with OK, Dialingand dials the  
number.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
2. Say Delete all name tags. The system responds  
with You are about to delete all name tags stored  
in your phone directory and your route destination  
directory. Are you sure you want to do this? Please  
say yes or no.”  
.
If the system does not recognize the number, it  
confirms the numbers followed by a tone. If the  
number is correct, say Yes. The system  
responds with OK, Dialingand dials the  
number. If the number is not correct, say No.  
The system will ask for the number to be  
reentered.  
.
Say Yesto delete all name tags.  
.
Say Noto cancel the function and return to  
the main menu.  
4-87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Say the name tag of the person to call.  
Using the Digit Dial Command  
.
If the system clearly recognizes the name tag it  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
responds with OK, calling, <name tag>and  
dials the number.  
2. Say Digit Dial. The system responds with Digit  
dial using <phone name>, please say the first digit  
to dialfollowed by a tone.  
.
If the system is unsure it recognizes the right  
name tag, it confirms the name tag followed by  
a tone. If the name tag is correct, say Yes.  
The system responds with OK, calling, <name  
tag>and dials the number. If the name tag is  
not correct, say No. The system will ask for  
the name tag to be reentered.  
3. Say the digit to be dialed one at a time. Following  
each digit, the system will repeat back the digit it  
heard followed by a tone.  
4. Continue entering digits until the number to be  
dialed is complete. After the whole number has  
been entered, say Dial. The system responds  
with OK, Dialingand dials the number.  
Once connected, the person called will be heard  
through the audio speakers.  
Using the Redial Command  
.
If an unwanted number is recognized by the  
system, say Clearat any time to clear the last  
number.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
.
To hear all of the numbers recognized by the  
system, say Verifyat any time and the system  
will repeat them.  
2. After the tone, say Redial. The system responds  
with Redial using <phone name>and dials the  
last number called from the connected Bluetooth  
phone.  
Using the Call Command  
Once connected, the person called will be heard  
through the audio speakers.  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
2. Say Call. The system responds with Call using  
<phone name>. Please say the name tagfollowed  
by a tone.  
4-88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Receiving a Call  
ThreeWay Calling  
When an incoming call is received, the audio system  
mutes and a ring tone is heard in the vehicle.  
ThreeWay Calling must be supported on the Bluetooth  
phone and enabled by the wireless service carrier  
to work.  
.
Press b g and begin speaking to answer the call.  
1. While on a call press b g . The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
.
Press c x to ignore a call.  
2. Say Threeway call. The system responds with  
Threeway call, please say dial or call.  
Call Waiting  
Call waiting must be supported on the Bluetooth phone  
and enabled by the wireless service carrier to work.  
3. Use the dial or call command to dial the number of  
the third party to be called.  
.
Press b g to answer an incoming call when  
another call is active. The original call is placed  
on hold.  
4. Once the call is connected, press b g to link all  
the callers together.  
.
Ending a Call  
Press b g again to return to the original call.  
To ignore the incoming call, continue with the  
original call with no action.  
.
Press c x to end a call.  
Muting a Call  
During a call, all sounds from inside the vehicle can be  
muted so that the person on the other end of the call  
cannot hear them.  
.
Press c x to disconnect the current call and  
switch to the call on hold.  
4-89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To Mute a call  
To Transfer Audio to the In-Vehicle  
Bluetooth System  
1. Press b g . The system responds with Ready”  
The cellular phone must be paired and connected with  
the Bluetooth system before a call can be transferred.  
The connection process can take up to two minutes  
after the key is turned to the ON/RUN or ACC/  
ACCESSORY position.  
followed by a tone.  
2. Say Mute Call. The system responds  
with Call muted.  
To Cancel Mute  
During a call with the audio on the cell phone,  
1. Press b g . The system responds with Ready”  
press b g for more than two seconds. The audio  
switches from the cell phone to the vehicle.  
followed by a tone.  
2. After the tone, say Mute Call. The system  
responds with Resuming call.  
Voice Pass-Thru  
Transferring a Call  
Audio can be transferred between the invehicle  
Voice PassThru allows access to the voice recognition  
commands on the cell phone. See the cell phone  
manufacturers user guide to see if the cell phone  
supports this feature. This feature can be used to  
verbally access contacts stored in the cell phone.  
Bluetooth system and the cell phone.  
To Transfer Audio to the Cell Phone  
1. Press and hold b g for two seconds. The system  
responds with Readyfollowed by a tone.  
During a call with the audio in the vehicle:  
1. Press b g . The system responds with Ready”  
2. Say Bluetooth. The system responds with  
Bluetooth readyfollowed by a tone.  
followed by a tone.  
2. Say Transfer Call.The system responds with  
Transferring calland the audio will switch from  
the vehicle to the cell phone.  
3. Say Voice. The system responds with OK,  
accessing <phone name>.  
.
The cell phone's normal prompt messages will  
go through its cycle according to the phone's  
operating instructions.  
4-90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Sending a Stored Name Tag During a Call  
Dual Tone Multi-Frequency  
(DTMF) Tones  
The invehicle Bluetooth system can send numbers and  
numbers stored as name tags during a call. This is used  
when calling a menu driven phone system. Account  
numbers can be programmed into the phonebook for  
retrieval during menu driven calls.  
1. Press b g . The system responds with Ready”  
followed by a tone.  
2. Say Send name tag.The system responds with  
Say a name tag to send tonesfollowed by a tone.  
3. Say the name tag to send.  
.
If the system clearly recognizes the name tag it  
Sending a Number During a Call  
responds with OK, Sending <name tag>and  
the dial tones are sent and the call continues.  
1. Press b g . The system responds with Ready”  
.
If the system is not sure it recognized the name  
followed by a tone.  
tag properly, it responds Dial <name tag>,  
Please say yes or no?followed by a tone.  
If the name tag is correct, say Yes. The  
system responds with OK, Sending <name  
tag>and the dial tones are sent and the call  
continues.  
2. Say Dial. The system responds with Say a  
number to send tonesfollowed by a tone.  
3. Say the number to send.  
.
If the system clearly recognizes the number it  
responds with OK, Sending Numberand the  
dial tones are sent and the call continues.  
Clearing the System  
.
If the system is not sure it recognized the  
Unless information is deleted out of the invehicle  
Bluetooth system, it will be retained indefinitely. This  
includes all saved name tags in the phonebook and  
phone pairing information. For information on how to  
delete this information, see the above sections on  
Deleting a Paired Phone and Deleting Name Tags.  
number properly, it responds Dial Number,  
Please say yes or no?followed by a tone.  
If the number is correct, say Yes. The system  
responds with OK, Sending Numberand the  
dial tones are sent and the call continues.  
4-91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Other Information  
Audio Steering Wheel Controls  
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are owned by the  
Bluetooth® SIG, Inc. and any use of such marks by  
General Motors is under license. Other trademarks and  
trade names are those of their respective owners.  
Vehicles with audio  
steering wheel controls  
could differ depending on  
the vehicle's options.  
Some audio controls can  
be adjusted at the  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 817 for FCC  
information.  
steering wheel.  
Theft-Deterrent Feature  
THEFTLOCK® is designed to discourage theft of the  
vehicle's radio by learning a portion of the Vehicle  
Identification Number (VIN). The radio does not operate  
if it is stolen or moved to a different vehicle.  
e + / e (Volume): Press to increase or to decrease  
the radio volume.  
w / x (Next / Previous): Press to change radio  
stations, select tracks on a CD, or to select tracks and  
navigate folders on an iPod® or USB device.  
4-92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To change radio stations:  
To navigate folders on an iPod or USB device:  
.
Press and release w or x to go to the next or  
1. Press and hold w or x while listening to a song  
until the contents of the current folder display on  
the radio display.  
previous radio station stored as a preset.  
.
Press and hold w or x to go to the next or  
previous radio station in the selected band with a  
strong signal.  
2. Press and hold x to go back to the previous  
folder list.  
To select tracks on a CD:  
3. Press and release w or x to scroll up or down  
the list.  
Press and release w or x to go to the next or previous  
track.  
.
To select a folder, press and hold w when the  
folder is highlighted.  
To select tracks on an iPod or USB device:  
.
To go back further in the folder list, press and  
1. Press and hold w or x while listening to a song  
until the contents of the current folder display on  
the radio display.  
hold x .  
c (End): Press to reject an incoming call, or end a  
current call.  
2. Press and release w or x to scroll up or down the  
b g (Mute / Voice Recognition): Press to silence the  
list, then press and hold w to play the highlighted  
track.  
vehicle speakers only. Press again to turn the sound on.  
For vehicles with Bluetooth® or OnStar® systems press  
and hold b g for longer than two seconds to interact  
with those systems. See Bluetooth® on page 482 and  
the OnStar Owner's Guide for more information.  
4-93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
FM Stereo  
Radio Reception  
FM signals only reach about 10 to 40 miles (16 to 65 km).  
Although the radio has a built-in electronic circuit that  
automatically works to reduce interference, some static  
can occur, especially around tall buildings or hills,  
causing the sound to fade in and out.  
Frequency interference and static can occur during  
normal radio reception if items such as cell phone  
chargers, vehicle convenience accessories, and  
external electronic devices are plugged into the  
accessory power outlet. If there is interference or static,  
unplug the item from the accessory power outlet.  
XMSatellite Radio Service  
AM  
XM Satellite Radio Service gives digital radio reception  
from coast-to-coast in the 48 contiguous United States,  
and in Canada. Just as with FM, tall buildings or hills  
can interfere with satellite radio signals, causing the  
sound to fade in and out. In addition, traveling or  
standing under heavy foliage, bridges, garages,  
or tunnels may cause loss of the XM signal for a period  
of time.  
The range for most AM stations is greater than for FM,  
especially at night. The longer range can cause station  
frequencies to interfere with each other. For better radio  
reception, most AM radio stations boost the power  
levels during the day, and then reduce these levels  
during the night. Static can also occur when things like  
storms and power lines interfere with radio reception.  
When this happens, try reducing the treble on the radio.  
4-94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cellular Phone Usage  
XMSatellite Radio Antenna  
Cellular phone usage may cause interference with the  
vehicle's radio. This interference may occur when  
making or receiving phone calls, charging the phone's  
battery, or simply having the phone on. This  
interference causes an increased level of static while  
listening to the radio. If static is received while listening  
to the radio, unplug the cellular phone and turn it off.  
System  
The XM Satellite Radio antenna is located on the roof of  
the vehicle. Keep the antenna clear of obstructions for  
clear radio reception.  
If the vehicle has a sunroof, the performance of the XM  
system may be affected if the sunroof is open.  
Chime Level Adjustment  
Fixed Mast Antenna  
The radio may be used to adjust the vehicle's chime  
level. If the radio can be used to change the volume  
level of the chime, press and hold the sixth numbered  
pushbutton or the sixth FAV pushbutton with the ignition  
on and the radio power off. The volume level changes  
between Normal and Loud. The selected volume level  
appears on the radio display.  
The fixed mast antenna can withstand most car washes  
without being damaged as long as it is securely  
attached to the base. If the mast becomes slightly bent,  
straighten it out by hand. If the mast is badly bent,  
replace it.  
Occasionally check to make sure the antenna is  
tightened to its base. If tightening is required, tighten by  
hand until fully seated plus one quarter turn.  
Removing the radio and not replacing it with a factory  
radio or chime module will disable vehicle chimes.  
4-95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
4-96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 5 Driving Your Vehicle  
Your Driving, the Road, and the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Driving at Night . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17  
Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18  
Before Leaving on a Long Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21  
If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand,  
Mud, Ice, or Snow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Loading the Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Drunk Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Braking in Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6  
Traction Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-11  
Limited-Slip Differential . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13  
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13  
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
Racing or Other Competitive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17  
Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-29  
Towing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-29  
Recreational Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-30  
Towing a Trailer (Automatic Transmission) . . . . . 5-32  
Towing a Trailer (Manual Transmission) . . . . . . . . 5-40  
5-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Drunk Driving  
Your Driving, the Road, and the  
Vehicle  
WARNING:  
{
Defensive Driving  
Drinking and then driving is very dangerous.  
Your reflexes, perceptions, attentiveness, and  
judgment can be affected by even a small amount  
of alcohol. You can have a serious or even  
fatal collision if you drive after drinking. Do not  
drink and drive or ride with a driver who has been  
drinking. Ride home in a cab; or if you are with a  
group, designate a driver who will not drink.  
Defensive driving means always expect the  
unexpected.The first step in driving defensively  
is to wear your safety belt See Safety Belts: They  
Are for Everyone on page 214.  
WARNING:  
{
Assume that other road users (pedestrians,  
bicyclists, and other drivers) are going to be  
careless and make mistakes. Anticipate what  
they might do and be ready. In addition:  
Death and injury associated with drinking and driving is  
a global tragedy.  
Alcohol affects four things that anyone needs to drive a  
vehicle: judgment, muscular coordination, vision, and  
attentiveness.  
.
Allow enough following distance between  
you and the driver in front of you.  
.
Focus on the task of driving.  
Police records show that almost 40 percent of all motor  
vehicle-related deaths involve alcohol. In most cases,  
these deaths are the result of someone who was  
drinking and driving. In recent years, more than  
17,000 annual motor vehicle-related deaths have  
been associated with the use of alcohol, with about  
250,000 people injured.  
Driver distraction can cause collisions resulting in  
injury or possible death. These simple defensive  
driving techniques could save your life.  
5-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
For persons under 21, it is against the law in every  
U.S. state to drink alcohol. There are good medical,  
psychological, and developmental reasons for  
these laws.  
Braking  
See Brake System Warning Light on page 430.  
Braking action involves perception time and reaction  
time. Deciding to push the brake pedal is perception  
time. Actually doing it is reaction time.  
The obvious way to eliminate the leading highway  
safety problem is for people never to drink alcohol  
and then drive.  
Average reaction time is about threefourths of a  
second. But that is only an average. It might be less  
with one driver and as long as two or three seconds or  
more with another. Age, physical condition, alertness,  
coordination, and eyesight all play a part. So do alcohol,  
drugs, and frustration. But even in threefourths of a  
second, a vehicle moving at 100 km/h (60 mph) travels  
20 m (66 feet). That could be a lot of distance in an  
emergency, so keeping enough space between the  
vehicle and others is important.  
Medical research shows that alcohol in a person's  
system can make crash injuries worse, especially  
injuries to the brain, spinal cord, or heart. This means  
that when anyone who has been drinking driver or  
passenger is in a crash, that person's chance of  
being killed or permanently disabled is higher than if  
the person had not been drinking.  
Control of a Vehicle  
And, of course, actual stopping distances vary greatly  
with the surface of the road, whether it is pavement or  
gravel; the condition of the road, whether it is wet, dry,  
or icy; tire tread; the condition of the brakes; the weight  
of the vehicle; and the amount of brake force applied.  
The following three systems help to control the vehicle  
while driving brakes, steering, and accelerator. At  
times, as when driving on snow or ice, it is easy to ask  
more of those control systems than the tires and road  
can provide. Meaning, you can lose control of the  
vehicle. See Traction Control System (TCS) on  
page 59, Enhanced Traction System (ETS) on  
page 511, and Electronic Stability Control (ESC) on  
page 56  
.
Adding nondealer/nonretailer accessories can affect  
vehicle performance. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 63.  
5-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Avoid needless heavy braking. Some people drive in  
spurts, heavy acceleration followed by heavy braking,  
rather than keeping pace with traffic. This is a mistake.  
The brakes might not have time to cool between hard  
stops. The brakes will wear out much faster with a  
lot of heavy braking. Keeping pace with the traffic and  
allowing realistic following distances eliminates a lot of  
unnecessary braking. That means better braking and  
longer brake life.  
feel changes or the brake pedal feels hard to push, the  
system might not be receiving the intended brake boost  
and the SVC BRAKE SYSTEM DIC message may be  
displayed.  
Adding nondealer/nonretailer accessories can affect  
vehicle performance. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 63.  
Antilock Brake System (ABS)  
The vehicle might have the Antilock Brake System  
(ABS), an advanced electronic braking system that  
helps prevent a braking skid.  
If the engine ever stops while the vehicle is being  
driven, brake normally but do not pump the brakes.  
If the brakes are pumped, the pedal could get harder  
to push down. If the engine stops, there will still be  
some power brake assist but it will be used when the  
brake is applied. Once the power assist is used up, it  
can take longer to stop and the brake pedal will be  
harder to push.  
If the vehicle has ABS,  
this warning light on the  
instrument panel comes  
on briefly when the  
vehicle is started.  
If the vehicle has Electronic Stability Control (ESC) and  
the 2.0L turbocharged engine, it also has a hydraulic  
brake boost feature which supplements the power brake  
system to maintain consistent brake performance under  
conditions of low brake booster vacuum. Low brake  
booster vacuum conditions can include initial start up  
after the vehicle has been parked for several hours,  
very frequent brake stops, or high altitude driving. When  
hydraulic brake boost is active, minor brake pulsation or  
movement might be felt but this is normal. If brake pedal  
When the engine is started, or when the vehicle begins  
to drive away, ABS checks itself. A momentary motor  
or clicking noise might be heard while this test is going  
on, and it might even be noticed that the brake pedal  
moves or pulses a little. This is normal.  
5-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Let us say the road is wet and you are driving safely.  
Suddenly, an animal jumps out in front of you. You slam  
on the brakes and continue braking. Here is what  
happens with ABS:  
Braking in Emergencies  
At some time, nearly every driver gets into a situation  
that requires hard braking.  
If the vehicle has Electronic Stability Control (ESC)  
with Antilock Brake System (ABS), it allows the driver  
to steer and brake at the same time. However, if the  
vehicle does not have ESC with ABS, the first  
reaction to hit the brake pedal hard and hold it  
down might be the wrong thing to do. The wheels  
can stop rolling. Once they do, the vehicle cannot  
respond to the driver's steering. Momentum will carry it  
in whatever direction it was headed when the wheels  
stopped rolling. That could be off the road, into the very  
thing the driver was trying to avoid, or into traffic.  
A computer senses that the wheels are slowing down.  
If one of the wheels is about to stop rolling, the  
computer will separately work the brakes at each wheel.  
ABS can change the brake pressure to each wheel, as  
required, faster than any driver could. This can help the  
driver steer around the obstacle while braking hard.  
As the brakes are applied, the computer keeps  
receiving updates on wheel speed and controls braking  
pressure accordingly.  
Remember: ABS does not change the time needed to  
get a foot up to the brake pedal or always decrease  
stopping distance. If you get too close to the vehicle in  
front of you, there will not be enough time to apply the  
brakes if that vehicle suddenly slows or stops. Always  
leave enough room up ahead to stop, even with ABS.  
If the vehicle does not have ABS, use a squeeze”  
braking technique. This gives maximum braking while  
maintaining steering control. Do this by pushing on the  
brake pedal with steadily increasing pressure.  
In an emergency, you will probably want to squeeze the  
brakes hard without locking the wheels. If you hear or  
feel the wheels sliding, ease off the brake pedal. This  
helps retain steering control. Without ABS, it is different.  
See Antilock Brake System (ABS) on page 54.  
Using ABS  
Do not pump the brakes. Just hold the brake pedal  
down firmly and let antilock work. A slight brake pedal  
pulsation might be felt or some noise noticed, but this is  
normal.  
In many emergencies, steering can help more than  
even the very best braking.  
5-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Brake Assist  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)  
If this vehicle has ESC with ABS, it also has a Brake  
Assist feature designed to assist the driver in stopping  
or decreasing vehicle speed in emergency driving  
conditions. This feature uses the stability system  
hydraulic brake control module to supplement the power  
brake system under conditions where the driver has  
quickly and forcefully applied the brake pedal in an  
attempt to quickly stop or slow down the vehicle. The  
stability system hydraulic brake control module  
increases brake pressure at each corner of the vehicle  
until the ABS activates. Minor brake pedal pulsations or  
pedal movement during this time is normal and the  
driver should continue to apply the brake pedal as the  
driving situation dictates The Brake Assist feature will  
automatically disengage when the brake pedal is  
released or brake pedal pressure is quickly decreased.  
The vehicle has an Electronic Stability Control (ESC)  
system which combines antilock brake, and traction and  
stability control systems that help the driver maintain  
directional control of the vehicle in most driving  
conditions.  
When the vehicle is started and begins to move, the  
system performs several diagnostic checks to ensure  
there are no problems. The system may be heard or felt  
while it is working. This is normal and does not mean  
there is a problem with the vehicle. The system should  
initialize before the vehicle reaches 20 mph (32 km/h).  
If the system fails to turn on or activate, the ESC/TCS  
light comes on, and the ESC OFF and/or SERVICE  
ESC message displays.  
For more information, see Driver Information Center  
(DIC) on page 446 and Electronic Stability Control  
(ESC)/Traction Control System (TCS) Indicator/Warning  
Light on page 433.  
5-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Electronic Stability Control (ESC) system is  
automatically enabled whenever the vehicle is started.  
To assist the driver with vehicle directional control,  
especially in slippery road conditions, always leave the  
system on. ESC can be turned off if needed.  
This light flashes on the  
instrument panel cluster  
when the ESC system is  
on and activated.  
If the vehicle is in cruise control when the system  
begins to assist the driver maintain directional control of  
the vehicle, the ESC/TCS light will flash and the cruise  
control will automatically disengage. The cruise control  
can be re-engaged when road conditions allow. See  
Cruise Control on page 48.  
ESC activates when the computer senses a  
discrepancy between the intended path and the  
direction the vehicle is actually traveling. ESC  
selectively applies braking pressure at any one of the  
vehicle's brakes to help steer the vehicle in the intended  
direction.  
The ESC/TCS button is  
located on the instrument  
panel.  
When the system activates, an ESC ACTIVE message  
displays on the Driver Information Center. See DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 448. This light also  
flashes on the instrument panel cluster when the ESC  
system is on and activated. Noise or vibration may be  
felt in the brake pedal. This is normal. Continue to steer  
the vehicle in the desired direction.  
The traction control system can be turned off or back  
on by pressing the ESC/TCS button. To disable both  
traction control and ESC, press and hold the button  
from five to ten seconds.  
When the light is on solid and the message(s),  
SERVICE ESC, ESC OFF, or both display, the system  
will not assist the driver in maintaining directional  
control of the vehicle. Adjust your driving accordingly.  
See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 448.  
5-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When the ESC system is turned off, the TRACTION  
OFF and ESC OFF messages appear, and the  
ESC/TCS light comes on to warn the driver that  
both traction control and ESC are disabled.  
Competitive Driving Mode  
(SS Models Only)  
The driver can select this optional handling mode by  
pressing the ESC/TCS button on the console two times  
quickly. COMPETITIVE MODE will be displayed in the  
It is recommended that the system remain on for normal  
driving conditions, but it may be necessary to turn the  
system off if the vehicle is stuck in sand, mud, ice or  
snow, and you want to rockyour vehicle to attempt to  
free it. It may also be necessary to turn off the system  
when driving in extreme off-road conditions where high  
wheel spin is required. See If Your Vehicle is Stuck in  
DIC. See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 448  
.
Competitive Driving Mode allows the driver to have full  
control of the front wheels while the ESC system helps  
maintain directional control of the vehicle by selective  
brake application. The ESC/TCS light will be on and the  
traction control system will not be operating. Adjust your  
driving accordingly. This electronic stability control  
mode is recommended only for use during closed track  
events and competitive driving venues.  
Sand, Mud, Ice, or Snow on page 523  
.
ESC may also turn off automatically if it determines that  
a problem exists with the system. The ESC OFF and  
SERVICE ESC messages and the ESC/TCS light  
comes on to warn the driver that ESC is disabled and  
requires service. If the problem does not clear after  
restarting the vehicle, see your dealer/retailer for  
service. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 448 for more information.  
When the ESC button is pressed again, or the vehicle is  
restarted, the ESC and TCS will be turned back on.  
Notice: When traction control is turned off,  
or Competitive Driving Mode is active, it is possible  
to lose traction. If you attempt to shift with the  
front wheels spinning with a loss of traction, it is  
possible to cause damage to the transmission.  
Do not attempt to shift when the front wheels do  
not have traction. Damage caused by misuse of the  
vehicle is not covered. See your warranty book for  
additional information.  
Adding nondealer/nonretailer accessories can  
affect the vehicle's performance. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 63 for more information.  
5-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Launch Control (SS Models Only)  
Traction Control System (TCS)  
Launch Control is a form of traction control, to control  
tire spin while launching the vehicle during closed track  
events and competitive driving. The feature is activated  
when the vehicle is at rest while in Competitive Mode.  
At rest, if the accelerator pedal is pressed to the floor  
with the clutch engaged, the RPM is limited to a  
predetermined level. A smooth, quick release of the  
clutch while keeping the accelerator pedal on the floor  
will provide controlled wheel spin for consistent  
acceleration. Complete shifts as described in Manual  
Transmission Operation on page 331.  
The vehicle has a Traction Control System (TCS) that  
limits wheel spin. This is especially useful in slippery  
road conditions. The system operates only if it senses  
that the front wheels are spinning too much or are  
beginning to lose traction. When this happens, the  
system works the front brakes and reduces engine  
power by closing the throttle and managing engine  
spark to limit wheel spin.  
This light flashes while  
the traction control system  
is limiting wheel spin.  
LAUNCH CONTROL displays in the DIC after the  
COMPETITIVE MODE message, when the vehicle is  
stopped. The system will exit to COMPETITIVE MODE  
after the vehicle is launched. See Competitive Driving  
Modeearlier in this section. The normal Traction  
Control System (TCS) will not be operating while in the  
Competitive Driving mode and the TCS light on the  
instrument panel cluster comes on. Adjust your driving  
accordingly. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 448 for more information.  
The system may be heard or felt while it is working.  
This is normal and does not mean there is a problem  
with the vehicle.  
See Electronic Stability Control (ESC)/Traction Control  
System (TCS) Indicator/Warning Light on page 433 for  
more information.  
5-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle is in cruise control while TCS begins to  
limit wheel spin, the cruise control will automatically  
disengage. The cruise control can be re-engaged when  
road conditions allow. See Turn Signal/Multifunction  
Lever on page 44.  
To turn the system off or  
on, press and release the  
ESC/TCS button located  
on the instrument panel.  
When this light is on and  
either the SERVICE  
TRACTION or TRACTION  
OFF message is  
displayed, the system  
will not limit wheel spin.  
The DIC displays the appropriate message as  
described previously when the button is pressed.  
Traction Control Operation  
Traction control limits wheel spin by reducing engine  
power to the wheels (engine speed management) and  
by applying brakes to each individual wheel  
(brake-traction control) as necessary.  
Adjust your driving accordingly. See DIC Warnings and  
Messages on page 448 for more information.  
The Traction Control System comes on automatically  
whenever the vehicle is started. It is recommended to  
leave the system on for normal driving conditions, but  
it may be necessary to turn the system off if the vehicle  
is stuck in sand, mud, ice or snow, and you want to  
rockyour vehicle to attempt to free it. It may also be  
necessary to turn off the system when driving in off-road  
conditions where high wheel spin is required. See If  
Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice, or Snow on  
The traction control system is enabled automatically  
when the vehicle is started, and it will activate and flash  
the ESC/TCS light and display the LOW TRACTION  
message if it senses that either of the front wheels are  
spinning or beginning to lose traction while driving. For  
more information on the LOW TRACTION message,  
see Driver Information Center (DIC) on page 446.  
page 523  
.
5-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: If the wheel(s) of one axle are allowed to  
spin excessively while the ESC/TCS, ABS and  
Brake warning lights and the SERVICE ESC and/or  
SERVICE TRACTION messages are displayed, the  
differential could be damaged. The repairs would  
not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Reduce  
engine power and do not spin the wheel(s)  
excessively while these lights and this message  
are displayed.  
Adding nondealer/nonretailer accessories can affect  
the vehicle's performance. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 63 for more information.  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS)  
The vehicle may have an Enhanced Traction System  
(ETS) that limits wheel spin. This is especially useful in  
slippery road conditions. The system operates only if it  
senses that one or both of the front wheels are spinning  
or beginning to lose traction. When this happens, the  
system reduces engine power and may also upshift the  
transmission to limit wheel spin.  
Notice: When traction control is turned off,  
or Competitive Driving Mode is active, it is  
possible to lose traction. If you attempt to shift with  
the drive wheels spinning with a loss of traction,  
it is possible to cause damage to the transmission.  
Do not attempt to shift when the drive wheels do  
not have traction. Damage caused by misuse of the  
vehicle is not covered. See the warranty book for  
additional information.  
If the vehicle has ETS, there is not an ESC/TCS button  
on the instrument panel. To turn the system off, shift to  
L (Low) or R (Reverse). There is more information about  
how to turn the system off later in this section.  
The ETS indicator/warning light flashes and LOW  
TRACTION appears on the Driver Information Center  
(DIC) when the traction control system is actively  
limiting wheel spin. The system may be heard or felt  
while it is working, but this is normal. Slippery road  
conditions may exist if this message is displayed, so  
adjust your driving accordingly.  
The traction control system may activate on dry or  
rough roads or under conditions such as heavy  
acceleration while turning or abrupt upshifts/downshifts  
of the transmission. When this happens, a reduction  
in acceleration may be noticed or a noise or vibration  
may be heard. This is normal.  
If the vehicle is in cruise control when the ETS begins  
to limit wheel spin, the cruise control will automatically  
disengage. The cruise control can be re-engaged when  
road conditions allow. See Cruise Control on page 48.  
If the vehicle is in cruise control while the system  
activates, the ESC/TCS light flashes and the cruise  
control automatically disengages. The cruise control  
can be re-engaged when road conditions allow. See  
Cruise Control on page 48.  
5-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the ETS indicator/warning light comes on and  
stays on for an extended period of time when the  
transmission shift lever is in any position other than  
L (Low), the vehicle may need service.  
When this light is on solid, the system will not limit  
wheel spin. Adjust your driving accordingly.  
Check the DIC messaging to determine whether it is  
because of the driver turning off the system, or that the  
system may not be working properly and the vehicle  
requires service. When this light is turned on, either the  
SERVICE TRACTION or TRACTION OFF message will  
be displayed.  
The ETS indicator/warning light may come on for the  
following reasons:  
.
The indicator/warning light flashes while the  
traction control system is limiting wheel spin.  
.
See DIC Warnings and Messages on page 448 for  
more information on the messages associated with this  
light.  
If the system is turned off by moving the shift lever  
to L (Low), the indicator/warning light comes on  
and stays on. To turn the system back on, move  
the shift lever back to a position other than L (Low).  
The indicator/warning light should go off.  
To limit wheel spin, especially in slippery road  
conditions, ETS should always be left on. But the  
system can be turned off if needed.  
.
The indicator/warning light will come on when the  
parking brake is set with the engine running, and it  
will stay on if the parking brake does not release  
fully. If the transmission shift lever is in any position  
other than L (Low) and the indicator/warning light  
stays on after the parking brake is fully released,  
there is a problem with the system.  
To turn the system off, shift to L (Low) or R (Reverse).  
When the system is turned off, the ETS indicator/  
warning light will come on and stay on and the  
TRACTION OFF message will be displayed when  
the gear shift is in L (Low). The indicator/warning light  
and message will not come on when the gear shift is in  
R (Reverse). If the ETS is limiting wheel spin when the  
.
If the traction control system is affected by an  
engine related problem, the system will turn off  
and the indicator/warning light will come on.  
5-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
transmission is shifted to L (Low) or R (Reverse) to turn  
the system off, the indicator/warning light and  
Steering  
TRACTION OFF will come on in L (Low). But the  
system will not turn off right away. It will wait until there  
is no longer a current need to limit wheel spin. See DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 448 for more  
information on the messages associated with this light.  
Electric Power Steering  
If the engine stalls while driving, the power steering  
assist system will continue to operate until you are  
able to stop the vehicle. If power steering assist is lost  
because the electric power steering system is not  
functioning, the vehicle can be steered but it will take  
more effort.  
The system can be turned back on at any time by  
shifting to D (Automatic Overdive) or I (Intermediate).  
The ETS indicator/warning light should go off.  
If you turn the steering wheel in either direction several  
times until it stops, or hold the steering wheel in the  
stopped position for an extended amount of time, you  
may notice a reduced amount of power steering assist.  
The normal amount of power steering assist should  
return shortly after a few normal steering movements.  
Adding nondealer/nonretailer accessories can affect  
the vehicle's performance. See Accessories and  
Modifications on page 63 for more information.  
Limited-Slip Differential  
The electric power steering system does not require  
regular maintenance. If you suspect steering system  
problems and/or the POWER STEERING message  
comes on, contact your dealer/retailer for service  
repairs. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
Vehicles with a limited-slip differential can give more  
traction on snow, mud, ice, sand or gravel. It works like  
a standard axle most of the time, but when traction is  
low, this feature allows the drive wheel with the most  
traction to move the vehicle. The limited slip design has  
minimal impact to the steering feel, but boosts the  
traction performance under all conditions.  
page 448  
.
5-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
speed as possible from a collision. Then steer around  
the problem, to the left or right depending on the space  
available.  
Steering Tips  
It is important to take curves at a reasonable speed.  
Traction in a curve depends on the condition of the tires  
and the road surface, the angle at which the curve is  
banked, and vehicle speed. While in a curve, speed is  
the one factor that can be controlled.  
If there is a need to reduce speed, do it before entering  
the curve, while the front wheels are straight.  
Try to adjust the speed so you can drive through the  
curve. Maintain a reasonable, steady speed. Wait to  
accelerate until out of the curve, and then accelerate  
gently into the straightaway.  
Steering in Emergencies  
There are times when steering can be more effective  
than braking. For example, you come over a hill and  
find a truck stopped in your lane, or a car suddenly pulls  
out from nowhere, or a child darts out from between  
parked cars and stops right in front of you. These  
problems can be avoided by braking if you can stop  
in time. But sometimes you cannot stop in time because  
there is no room. That is the time for evasive  
An emergency like this requires close attention and a  
quick decision. If holding the steering wheel at the  
recommended 9 and 3 o'clock positions, it can be  
turned a full 180 degrees very quickly without removing  
either hand. But you have to act fast, steer quickly, and  
just as quickly straighten the wheel once you have  
avoided the object.  
action steering around the problem.  
The vehicle can perform very well in emergencies like  
these. First apply the brakes but, unless the vehicle  
has antilock brakes, not enough to lock the wheels. See  
Braking on page 53. It is better to remove as much  
The fact that such emergency situations are always  
possible is a good reason to practice defensive driving  
at all times and wear safety belts properly.  
5-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Off-Road Recovery  
Passing  
The vehicle's right wheels can drop off the edge of a  
road onto the shoulder while driving.  
Passing another vehicle on a two-lane road can be  
dangerous. To reduce the risk of danger while passing:  
.
Look down the road, to the sides, and to  
crossroads for situations that might affect a  
successful pass. If in doubt, wait.  
.
Watch for traffic signs, pavement markings, and  
lines that could indicate a turn or an intersection.  
Never cross a solid or doublesolid line on your  
side of the lane.  
.
Do not get too close to the vehicle you want to  
pass. Doing so can reduce your visibility.  
.
Wait your turn to pass a slow vehicle.  
.
When you are being passed, ease to the right.  
Loss of Control  
Let us review what driving experts say about what  
happens when the three control systems brakes,  
steering, and acceleration do not have enough  
friction where the tires meet the road to do what the  
driver has asked.  
If the level of the shoulder is only slightly below the  
pavement, recovery should be fairly easy. Ease off the  
accelerator and then, if there is nothing in the way, steer  
so that the vehicle straddles the edge of the pavement.  
Turn the steering wheel 8 to 13 cm (3 to 5 inches),  
about one-eighth turn, until the right front tire contacts  
the pavement edge. Then turn the steering wheel to go  
straight down the roadway.  
In any emergency, do not give up. Keep trying to steer  
and constantly seek an escape route or area of less  
danger.  
5-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle has Electronic Stability Control (ESC), the  
ESC might activate. See Electronic Stability Control  
(ESC) on page 56.  
Skidding  
In a skid, a driver can lose control of the vehicle.  
Defensive drivers avoid most skids by taking  
reasonable care suited to existing conditions, and  
by not overdriving those conditions. But skids are  
always possible.  
Of course, traction is reduced when water, snow, ice,  
gravel, or other material is on the road. For safety, slow  
down and adjust your driving to these conditions. It is  
important to slow down on slippery surfaces because  
stopping distance will be longer and vehicle control  
more limited.  
The three types of skids correspond to the vehicle's  
three control systems. In the braking skid, the wheels  
are not rolling. In the steering or cornering skid, too  
much speed or steering in a curve causes tires to slip  
and lose cornering force. And in the acceleration skid,  
too much throttle causes the driving wheels to spin.  
While driving on a surface with reduced traction, try  
your best to avoid sudden steering, acceleration,  
or braking, including reducing vehicle speed by shifting  
to a lower gear. Any sudden changes could cause the  
tires to slide. You may not realize the surface is slippery  
until the vehicle is skidding. Learn to recognize warning  
clues such as enough water, ice, or packed snow on  
the road to make a mirrored surface and slow down  
when you have any doubt.  
If the vehicle has the Traction Control System (TCS) or  
the Enhanced Traction System (ETS), remember: It  
helps to avoid only the acceleration skid. See Traction  
Control System (TCS) on page 59 or Enhanced  
Traction System (ETS) on page 511. If the vehicle  
does not have TCS or ETS, or if the system is off, then  
an acceleration skid is best handled by easing your foot  
off the accelerator pedal.  
If the vehicle has the Antilock Brake System (ABS),  
remember: It helps avoid only the braking skid. If the  
vehicle does not have ABS, then in a braking skid,  
where the wheels are no longer rolling, release enough  
pressure on the brakes to get the wheels rolling again.  
This restores steering control. Push the brake pedal  
down steadily when you have to stop suddenly. As long  
as the wheels are rolling, you will have steering control.  
If the vehicle starts to slide, ease your foot off the  
accelerator pedal and quickly steer the way you want  
the vehicle to go. If you start steering quickly enough,  
the vehicle may straighten out. Always be ready for a  
second skid if it occurs.  
5-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Night driving tips include:  
Racing or Other Competitive Driving  
.
Drive defensively.  
See your warranty book before using your vehicle for  
racing or other competitive driving. After reviewing your  
warranty book, please see the GM Performance Parts  
website or catalog and contact the race sanctioning  
bodies, for example Sports Car Club of America  
(SCCA) or Grand American, for parts and equipment  
required for racing or other competitive driving.  
.
Do not drink and drive.  
.
Reduce headlamp glare by adjusting the inside  
rearview mirror.  
.
Slow down and keep more space between you and  
other vehicles because headlamps can only light  
up so much road ahead.  
Notice: If you use your vehicle for competitive  
driving, the engine may use more oil than it would  
with normal use. Low oil levels can damage the  
engine. Be sure to check the oil level often during  
competitive driving and keep the level at or near the  
upper mark that shows the proper operating range  
on the engine oil dipstick. For information on how to  
add oil, see Engine Oil on page 619.  
.
Watch for animals.  
.
When tired, pull off the road.  
.
Do not wear sunglasses.  
.
Avoid staring directly into approaching headlamps.  
.
Keep the windshield and all glass on your vehicle  
clean inside and out.  
.
Keep your eyes moving, especially during turns or  
Driving at Night  
curves.  
Night driving is more dangerous than day driving  
because some drivers are likely to be impaired by  
alcohol or drugs, with night vision problems, or by  
fatigue.  
No one can see as well at night as in the daytime.  
But, as we get older, these differences increase.  
A 50-year-old driver might need at least twice as much  
light to see the same thing at night as a 20-year-old.  
5-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hydroplaning  
Driving in Rain and on Wet Roads  
Hydroplaning is dangerous. Water can build up under  
your vehicle's tires so they actually ride on the water.  
This can happen if the road is wet enough and you are  
going fast enough. When your vehicle is hydroplaning, it  
has little or no contact with the road.  
Rain and wet roads can reduce vehicle traction and  
affect your ability to stop and accelerate. Always drive  
slower in these types of driving conditions and avoid  
driving through large puddles and deepstanding or  
flowing water.  
There is no hard and fast rule about hydroplaning. The  
best advice is to slow down when the road is wet.  
WARNING:  
{
Other Rainy Weather Tips  
Wet brakes can cause crashes. They might not  
work as well in a quick stop and could cause  
pulling to one side. You could lose control of the  
vehicle.  
Besides slowing down, other wet weather driving tips  
include:  
.
Allow extra following distance.  
.
Pass with caution.  
After driving through a large puddle of water or a  
car/vehicle wash, lightly apply the brake pedal  
until the brakes work normally.  
.
Keep windshield wiping equipment in good shape.  
.
Keep the windshield washer fluid reservoir filled.  
.
Have good tires with proper tread depth. See Tires  
Flowing or rushing water creates strong forces.  
Driving through flowing water could cause your  
vehicle to be carried away. If this happens, you  
and other vehicle occupants could drown. Do not  
ignore police warnings and be very cautious about  
trying to drive through flowing water.  
on page 654  
.
.
Turn off cruise control.  
5-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before Leaving on a Long Trip  
Highway Hypnosis  
To prepare your vehicle for a long trip, consider having  
it serviced by your dealer/retailer before departing.  
Always be alert and pay attention to your surroundings  
while driving. If you become tired or sleepy, find a safe  
place to park your vehicle and rest.  
Things to check on your own include:  
Other driving tips include:  
.
Windshield Washer Fluid: Reservoir full? Windows  
clean inside and outside?  
.
Keep the vehicle well ventilated.  
.
.
Wiper Blades: In good shape?  
Keep interior temperature cool.  
.
.
Fuel, Engine Oil, Other Fluids: All levels checked?  
Keep your eyes moving scan the road ahead  
and to the sides.  
.
Lamps: Do they all work and are lenses clean?  
.
Check the rearview mirror and vehicle instruments  
often.  
.
Tires: Are treads good? Are tires inflated to  
recommended pressure?  
.
Weather and Maps: Safe to travel?  
Have up-to-date maps?  
5-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Hill and Mountain Roads  
Driving on steep hills or through mountains is different  
than driving on flat or rolling terrain. Tips for driving in  
these conditions include:  
WARNING:  
{
Coasting downhill in N (Neutral) or with the  
ignition off is dangerous. The brakes will have to  
do all the work of slowing down and they could  
get so hot that they would not work well. You  
would then have poor braking or even none going  
down a hill. You could crash. Always have the  
engine running and the vehicle in gear when  
going downhill.  
.
Keep the vehicle serviced and in good shape.  
.
Check all fluid levels and brakes, tires, cooling  
system, and transmission.  
.
Going down steep or long hills, shift to a  
lower gear.  
WARNING:  
{
.
Stay in your own lane. Do not swing wide or cut  
across the center of the road. Drive at speeds that  
let you stay in your own lane.  
If you do not shift down, the brakes could get so  
hot that they would not work well. You would then  
have poor braking or even none going down a hill.  
You could crash. Shift down to let the engine  
assist the brakes on a steep downhill slope.  
.
.
Top of hills: Be alert something could be in your  
lane (stalled car, accident).  
Pay attention to special road signs (falling rocks  
area, winding roads, long grades, passing or  
no-passing zones) and take appropriate action.  
5-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle has the Traction Control System (TCS) on  
page 59 or Enhanced Traction System (ETS) on  
page 511, it improves the ability to accelerate on  
slippery roads, but slow down and adjust your driving to  
the road conditions. When driving through deep snow,  
turn off the traction system to help maintain vehicle  
motion at lower speeds.  
Winter Driving  
Driving on Snow or Ice  
Drive carefully when there is snow or ice between the  
tires and the road, creating less traction or grip. Wet ice  
can occur at about 0°C (32°F) when freezing rain  
begins to fall, resulting in even less traction. Avoid  
driving on wet ice or in freezing rain until roads can be  
treated with salt or sand.  
The Antilock Brake System (ABS) on page 54  
improves vehicle stability during hard stops on a  
slippery roads, but apply the brakes sooner than when  
on dry pavement.  
Drive with caution, whatever the condition. Accelerate  
gently so traction is not lost. Accelerating too quickly  
causes the wheels to spin and makes the surface under  
the tires slick, so there is even less traction.  
Allow greater following distance on any slippery road  
and watch for slippery spots. Icy patches can occur on  
otherwise clear roads in shaded areas. The surface  
of a curve or an overpass can remain icy when the  
surrounding roads are clear. Avoid sudden steering  
maneuvers and braking while on ice.  
Try not to break the fragile traction. If you accelerate too  
fast, the drive wheels will spin and polish the surface  
under the tires even more.  
Turn off cruise control, if equipped, on slippery surfaces.  
5-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Blizzard Conditions  
Being stuck in snow can be in a serious situation. Stay  
with the vehicle unless there is help nearby. If possible,  
WARNING: (Continued)  
use the Roadside Assistance Program on page 86  
To get help and keep everyone in the vehicle safe:  
.
.
Open a window about 5 cm (two inches) on  
the side of the vehicle that is away from the  
wind to bring in fresh air.  
.
Turn on the Hazard Warning Flashers on  
page 43  
.
.
.
Fully open the air outlets on or under the  
instrument panel.  
.
Tie a red cloth to an outside mirror.  
Adjust the Climate Control system to a setting  
that circulates the air inside the vehicle and  
set the fan speed to the highest setting. See  
Climate Control System in the Index.  
WARNING:  
{
Snow can trap engine exhaust under the vehicle.  
This may cause exhaust gases to get inside.  
Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide (CO)  
which cannot be seen or smelled. It can cause  
unconsciousness and even death.  
For more information about carbon monoxide, see  
Engine Exhaust on page 339.  
Snow can trap exhaust gases under your vehicle.  
This can cause deadly CO (carbon monoxide) gas  
to get inside. CO could overcome you and kill you.  
You cannot see it or smell it, so you might not  
know it is in your vehicle. Clear away snow from  
around the base of your vehicle, especially any  
that is blocking the exhaust.  
If the vehicle is stuck in the snow:  
.
Clear away snow from around the base of  
your vehicle, especially any that is blocking  
the exhaust pipe.  
.
Check again from time to time to be sure  
snow does not collect there.  
Run the engine for short periods only as needed to  
keep warm, but be careful.  
(Continued)  
5-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To save fuel, run the engine for only short periods as  
needed to warm the vehicle and then shut the engine  
off and close the window most of the way to save heat.  
Repeat this until help arrives but only when you feel  
really uncomfortable from the cold. Moving about to  
keep warm also helps.  
WARNING:  
{
If the vehicle's tires spin at high speed, they can  
explode, and you or others could be injured. The  
vehicle can overheat, causing an engine  
compartment fire or other damage. Spin the  
wheels as little as possible and avoid going above  
55 km/h (35 mph) as shown on the speedometer.  
If it takes some time for help to arrive, now and then  
when you run the engine, push the accelerator pedal  
slightly so the engine runs faster than the idle speed.  
This keeps the battery charged to restart the vehicle  
and to signal for help with the headlamps. Do this as  
little as possible to save fuel.  
For information about using tire chains on the vehicle,  
see Tire Chains on page 677.  
If Your Vehicle is Stuck in Sand,  
Mud, Ice, or Snow  
Slowly and cautiously spin the wheels to free the  
vehicle when stuck in sand, mud, ice, or snow. See  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out on page 524.  
If the vehicle has a traction system, it can often help to  
free a stuck vehicle. Refer to the vehicle's traction  
system in the Index. If stuck too severely for the traction  
system to free the vehicle, turn the traction system off  
and use the rocking method.  
5-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get It Out  
Loading the Vehicle  
Turn the steering wheel left and right to clear the area  
around the front wheels. Turn off any traction system.  
Shift back and forth between R (Reverse) and a forward  
gear, or with a manual transmission, between 1 (First) or  
2 (Second) and R (Reverse), spinning the wheels as  
little as possible. To prevent transmission wear, wait  
until the wheels stop spinning before shifting gears.  
Release the accelerator pedal while shifting, and press  
lightly on the accelerator pedal when the transmission is  
in gear. Slowly spinning the wheels in the forward and  
reverse directions causes a rocking motion that could  
free the vehicle. If that does not get the vehicle out after  
a few tries, it might need to be towed out. If the vehicle  
does need to be towed out, see Towing Your Vehicle on  
It is very important to know how much weight your  
vehicle can carry. Two labels on your vehicle  
show how much weight it may properly carry, the  
Tire and Loading Information label and the Vehicle  
Certification label.  
WARNING:  
{
Do not load the vehicle any heavier than the  
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR),  
or either the maximum front or rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). If you do, parts  
on the vehicle can break, and it can change  
the way the vehicle handles. These could  
cause you to lose control and crash. Also,  
overloading can shorten the life of the  
vehicle.  
page 529  
.
5-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The Tire and Loading Information label also lists  
the tire size of the original equipment tires (C) and  
the recommended cold tire inflation pressures (D).  
For more information on tires and inflation, see  
Tires on page 654 and Inflation - Tire Pressure on  
Tire and Loading Information Label  
page 663  
.
There is also important loading information on the  
Certification/Tire label. It tells you the Gross  
Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) and the Gross  
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR) for the front and rear  
axles. See Certification/Tire Labellater in this  
section.  
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit  
1. Locate the statement The combined weight  
of occupants and cargo should never exceed  
XXX kg or XXX lbson your vehicle's placard.  
Label Example  
A vehicle specific Tire and Loading Information  
label is attached to the vehicle's center pillar  
(B-pillar). With the driver's door open, you will find  
the label attached below the door lock post  
(striker). The tire and loading information label  
lists the number of occupant seating positions (A),  
and the maximum vehicle capacity weight (B) in  
kilograms and pounds. The vehicle capacity  
weight includes the weight of all occupants,  
cargo, and all nonfactoryinstalled options.  
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver  
and passengers that will be riding in your  
vehicle.  
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver  
and passengers from XXX kg or XXX lbs.  
5-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. The resulting figure equals the available  
amount of cargo and luggage load capacity.  
For example, if the XXXamount equals  
1400 lbs and there will be five 150 lb  
passengers in your vehicle, the amount of  
available cargo and luggage load capacity is  
650 lbs (1400 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs).  
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage  
and cargo being loaded on the vehicle. That  
weight may not safely exceed the available  
cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in  
Step 4.  
Example 1  
Description  
Item  
Total  
1,000 lbs  
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, the load  
from your trailer will be transferred to your  
vehicle. Consult this manual to determine  
how this reduces the available cargo and  
luggage load capacity for your vehicle.  
Maximum Vehicle  
Capacity Weight for  
Example 1 =  
A
(453 kg)  
Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 150 lbs  
(68 kg) × 2 =  
B
C
300 lbs (136 kg)  
700 lbs (317 kg)  
If your vehicle can tow a trailer, see Towing a  
Trailer (Automatic Transmission) on page 532 or  
Towing a Trailer (Manual Transmission) on  
page 540 for important information on towing a  
trailer, towing safety rules, and trailering tips.  
Available Occupant  
and Cargo Weight =  
5-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Example 2  
Description  
Example 3  
Description  
Item  
Total  
1,000 lbs  
Item  
Total  
1,000 lbs  
Maximum Vehicle  
Capacity Weight for  
Example 2 =  
Maximum Vehicle  
Capacity Weight for  
Example 3 =  
A
A
(453 kg)  
(453 kg)  
Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 150 lbs  
(68 kg) × 5 =  
Subtract Occupant  
Weight @ 200 lbs  
(91 kg) × 5 =  
1,000 lbs  
(453 kg)  
B
C
750 lbs (340 kg)  
250 lbs (113 kg)  
B
C
Available Cargo  
Weight =  
Available Cargo  
Weight =  
0 lbs (0 kg)  
Refer to your vehicle's tire and loading information  
label for specific information about your vehicle's  
maximum vehicle capacity weight and seating  
5-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
positions. The combined weight of the driver,  
passengers, and cargo should never exceed your  
vehicle's maximum vehicle capacity weight.  
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR). The  
GVWR includes the weight of the vehicle, all  
occupants, fuel, and cargo.  
The Certification/Tire label also tells you the  
maximum weights for the front and rear axles,  
called the Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR).  
To find out the actual loads on your front and  
rear axles, you need to go to a weigh station and  
weigh your vehicle. Your dealer can help you with  
this. Be sure to spread out your load equally on  
both sides of the centerline.  
Certification Label  
Never exceed the GVWR for your vehicle or the  
GAWR for either the front or rear axle.  
WARNING:  
{
Do not load the vehicle any heavier than  
the Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR),  
or either the maximum front or rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating (GAWR). If you do, parts  
on the vehicle can break, and it can change  
the way the vehicle handles. These could  
cause you to lose control and crash. Also,  
overloading can shorten the life of the  
vehicle.  
A vehicle specific Certification/Tire label is found  
on the rear edge of the driver's door, or on the  
vehicle's center pillar (Bpillar).  
The label shows the size of your original tires and  
the inflation pressures needed to obtain the gross  
weight capacity of your vehicle. This is called the  
5-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice : Overloading the vehicle may cause  
damage. Repairs would not be covered by the  
vehicle warranty. Do not overload the vehicle.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
.
If you put things inside your vehicle like  
suitcases, tools, packages, or anything  
else they will go as fast as the vehicle goes.  
If you have to stop or turn quickly, or if there  
is a crash, they will keep going.  
Do not leave an unsecured child restraint  
in your vehicle.  
.
When you carry something inside the  
vehicle, secure it whenever you can.  
.
Do not leave a seat folded down unless  
you need to.  
WARNING:  
{
Towing  
Things you put inside your vehicle can strike  
and injure people in a sudden stop or turn,  
or in a crash.  
Towing Your Vehicle  
.
To avoid damage, the disabled vehicle should be towed  
with all four wheels off the ground. Consult your dealer/  
retailer or a professional towing service if the disabled  
vehicle must be towed. See Roadside Assistance  
Program on page 86.  
Put things in the cargo area of your  
vehicle. Try to spread the weight evenly.  
.
Never stack heavier things, like  
suitcases, inside the vehicle so that some  
of them are above the tops of the seats.  
To tow the vehicle behind another vehicle for  
recreational purposes, such as behind a motorhome,  
see Recreational Vehicle Towingfollowing.  
(Continued)  
5-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Dinghy Towing  
Recreational Vehicle Towing  
Recreational vehicle towing means towing the vehicle  
behind another vehicle such as behind a motorhome.  
The two most common types of recreational vehicle  
towing are known as dinghy towing and dolly towing.  
Dinghy towing is towing the vehicle with all four wheels  
on the ground. Dolly towing is towing the vehicle with  
two wheels on the ground and two wheels up on a  
device known as a dolly.  
Here are some important things to consider before  
recreational vehicle towing:  
.
What is the towing capacity of the towing vehicle?  
Be sure to read the tow vehicle manufacturer's  
recommendations.  
.
What is the distance that will be travelled? Some  
vehicles have restrictions on how far and how long  
they can tow.  
Use the following procedure to dinghy tow the vehicle  
from the front with all four wheels on the ground:  
.
Is the proper towing equipment going to be used?  
1. Set the parking brake.  
See your dealer/retailer or trailering professional  
for additional advice and equipment  
recommendations.  
2. Turn the ignition key to ACC/ACCESSORY to  
unlock the steering wheel.  
.
3. Shift the transmission to N (Neutral).  
4. Release the parking brake.  
Is the vehicle ready to be towed? Just as preparing  
the vehicle for a long trip, make sure the vehicle is  
prepared to be towed. See Before Leaving on a  
Long Trip on page 519.  
5-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To prevent the battery from draining while the vehicle is  
being towed, remove the following fuse from the floor  
console fuse block: 8 (Ignition Switch, PASSKey® III+).  
See Floor Console Fuse Block on page 6120 for more  
information.  
Dolly Towing  
Remember to reinstall the fuse once the destination has  
been reached.  
Notice: If 105 km/h (65 mph) is exceeded while  
towing the vehicle, it could be damaged. Never  
exceed 105 km/h (65 mph) while towing the vehicle.  
Notice: Towing the vehicle from the rear could  
damage it. Also, repairs would not be covered by  
the vehicle warranty. Never have the vehicle towed  
from the rear.  
Use the following procedure to dolly tow the vehicle  
from the front with two wheels on the ground:  
1. Put the front wheels on a dolly.  
2. Move the shift lever to P (Park).  
3. Set the parking brake and then remove the key.  
4. Clamp the steering wheel in a straight-ahead  
position with a clamping device designed for  
towing.  
5. Secure the vehicle to the dolly.  
6. Release the parking brake.  
5-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Trailering is different than just driving the vehicle by  
itself. Trailering means changes in handling,  
acceleration, braking, cooling, durability and fuel  
economy. Successful, safe trailering takes correct  
equipment, and it has to be used properly.  
Towing a Trailer  
(Automatic Transmission)  
WARNING:  
{
The following information has many time-tested,  
important trailering tips and safety rules. Many of  
these are important for your safety and that of your  
passengers. So please read this section carefully  
before pulling a trailer.  
The driver can lose control when pulling a trailer if  
the correct equipment is not used or the vehicle is  
not driven properly. For example, if the trailer is  
too heavy, the brakes may not work well or  
even at all. The driver and passengers could be  
seriously injured. The vehicle may also be  
damaged; the resulting repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Pull a trailer only  
if all the steps in this section have been followed.  
Ask your dealer/retailer for advice and information  
about towing a trailer with the vehicle.  
Load-pulling components such as the engine,  
transmission, wheel assemblies and tires are forced to  
work harder against the drag of the added weight. The  
engine is required to operate at relatively higher speeds  
and under greater loads, generating extra heat. Also,  
the trailer adds considerably to wind resistance,  
increasing the pulling requirements.  
SS Package  
If the vehicle has the SS package, it is neither designed  
nor intended to tow a trailer.  
The vehicle can tow a trailer if it is equipped with an  
automatic transmission and the proper trailer towing  
equipment. If the vehicle is not equipped as stated  
above, do not tow a trailer. To identify the trailering  
capacity of the vehicle, read the information in Weight  
of the Trailerthat appears later in this section.  
5-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Three important considerations have to do with weight:  
Pulling A Trailer  
Here are some important points:  
.
The weight of the trailer  
.
The weight of the trailer tongue  
.
There are many different laws, including speed  
.
limit restrictions, having to do with trailering. Make  
sure the rig will be legal, not only where you live  
but also where you will be driving. A good source  
for this information can be state or provincial  
police.  
The total weight on the vehicle's tires  
Weight of the Trailer  
How heavy can a trailer safely be?  
It should never weigh more than 1,000 lbs (450 kg). But  
even that can be too heavy.  
.
Do not tow a trailer at all during the first 500 miles  
(800 km) the new vehicle is driven. The engine,  
transmission or other parts could be damaged.  
It depends on how the rig is used. For example, speed,  
altitude, road grades, outside temperature and how  
much the vehicle is used to pull a trailer are all  
important. It can depend on any special equipment on  
the vehicle, and the amount of tongue weight the  
vehicle can carry. See Weight of the Trailer Tongue”  
later in this section for more information.  
.
Then, during the first 500 miles (800 km) that a  
trailer is towed, do not drive over 50 mph (80 km/h)  
and do not make starts at full throttle. This helps  
the engine and other parts of the vehicle wear in at  
the heavier loads.  
.
Obey speed limit restrictions when towing a trailer.  
Maximum trailer weight is calculated assuming only the  
driver is in the tow vehicle and it has all the required  
trailering equipment. The weight of additional optional  
equipment, passengers and cargo in the tow vehicle  
must be subtracted from the maximum trailer weight.  
Do not drive faster than the maximum posted  
speed for trailers, or no more than 55 mph  
(90 km/h), to save wear on the vehicle's parts.  
.
Do not tow when the outside air temperature is  
above 100°F (38°C).  
Ask your dealer/retailer for our trailering information or  
advice, or write us at our Customer Assistance Offices.  
See Customer Assistance Offices on page 85 for  
more information.  
.
Do not tow more than 1,000 miles (1 600 km)  
per year.  
5-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Weight of the Trailer Tongue  
The tongue load (A) of any trailer is an important weight  
to measure because it affects the total gross weight of  
the vehicle. The Gross Vehicle Weight (GVW) includes  
the curb weight of the vehicle, any cargo carried in it,  
and the people who will be riding in the vehicle. If there  
are a lot of options, equipment, passengers or cargo in  
the vehicle, it will reduce the tongue weight the vehicle  
can carry, which will also reduce the trailer weight the  
vehicle can tow. If towing a trailer, the tongue load must  
be added to the GVW because the vehicle will be  
carrying that weight, too. See Loading the Vehicle on  
page 524 for more information about the vehicle's  
maximum load capacity.  
If using a weight-carrying hitch, the trailer tongue (A)  
should weigh 10 to 15 percent of the total loaded trailer  
weight (B).  
Do not exceed the maximum allowable tongue weight  
for the vehicle. Choose the shortest hitch extension that  
will position the hitch ball closest to the vehicle. This will  
help reduce the effect of trailer tongue weight on the  
rear axle.  
After loading the trailer, weigh the trailer and then the  
tongue, separately, to see if the weights are proper.  
If they are not, adjustments might be made by moving  
some items around in the trailer.  
5-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Trailering may be limited by the vehicle's ability to carry  
tongue weight. Tongue weight cannot cause the vehicle  
to exceed the GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) or  
the RGAWR (Rear Gross Axle Weight Rating). The  
effect of additional weight may reduce the trailering  
capacity more than the total of the additional weight.  
Since the rear axle already weighs 2,700 lbs (1 225 kg),  
adding 1,275 lbs (578 kg) brings the total to 3,975 lbs  
(1 803 kg). This is very close to, but within the limit for  
RGAWR as well. The vehicle is set to trailer up to  
8,500 lbs (3 856 kg).  
If the vehicle has many options and there is a front seat  
passenger and two rear seat passengers with some  
luggage and gear in the vehicle as well. 300 lbs (136 kg)  
could be added to the front axle weight and 400 lbs  
(181 kg) to the rear axle weight. The vehicle now  
weighs:  
Consider the following example:  
A vehicle model base weight is 5,500 lbs (2 495 kg);  
2,800 lbs (1 270 kg) at the front axle and 2,700 lbs  
(1 225 kg) at the rear axle. It has a GVWR of 7,200 lbs  
(3 266 kg), a RGAWR of 4,000 lbs (1 814 kg) and a  
GCWR (Gross Combination Weight Rating) of  
14,000 lbs (6 350 kg). The trailer rating should be:  
Weight is still below 7,200 lbs (3 266 kg) and you  
might think 700 additional pounds (318 kg) should be  
subtracted from the trailering capacity to stay within  
GCWR limits. The maximum trailer would only be  
7,800 lbs (3 538 kg). You may go further and think the  
tongue weight should be limited to less than 1,000 lbs  
(454 kg) to avoid exceeding GVWR.  
Expect tongue weight to be at least 10 percent of trailer  
weight (850 lbs (386 kg)) and because the weight is  
applied well behind the rear axle, the effect on the rear  
axle is greater than just the weight itself, as much as  
1.5 times as much. The weight at the rear axle could  
be 850 lbs (386 kg) X 1.5 = 1,275 lbs (578 kg).  
5-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
But the effect on the rear axle must still be considered.  
Because the rear axle now weighs 3,100 lbs (1 406 kg),  
900 lbs (408 kg) can be put on the rear axle without  
exceeding RGAWR. The effect of tongue weight is  
about 1.5 times the actual weight. Dividing the 900 lbs  
(408 kg) by 1.5 leaves only 600 lbs (272 kg) of tongue  
weight that can be handled. Since tongue weight is  
usually at least 10 percent of total loaded trailer weight,  
expect that the largest trailer the vehicle can properly  
handle is 6,000 lbs (2 721 kg).  
Hitches  
It is important to have the correct hitch equipment.  
Crosswinds, large trucks going by and rough roads are  
a few reasons why the right hitch is needed.  
.
The rear bumper on the vehicle is not intended  
for hitches. Do not attach rental hitches or  
other bumper-type hitches to it. Use only a  
frame-mounted hitch that does not attach to the  
bumper.  
.
It is important that the vehicle does not exceed any of  
its ratings GCWR, GVWR, RGAWR, Maximum  
Trailer Rating or Tongue Weight. The only way to be  
sure it is not exceeding any of these ratings is to weigh  
the vehicle and trailer.  
Will there be any holes in the body of the vehicle  
after installing a trailer hitch? If there are, then  
be sure to seal the holes later when the hitch is  
removed. If the holes are not sealed, deadly  
carbon monoxide (CO) from exhaust can get into  
the vehicle. See Engine Exhaust on page 339  
Dirt and water can also enter the vehicle.  
.
Total Weight on the Vehicle's Tires  
Be sure the vehicle's tires are inflated to the upper  
limit for cold tires. These numbers can be found on the  
Tire-Loading Information label. See Loading the Vehicle  
on page 524. Make sure not to go over the GVW limit  
for the vehicle, or the GAWR, including the weight of the  
trailer tongue.  
5-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Before starting, check all trailer hitch parts and  
attachments, safety chains, electrical connectors,  
lamps, tires and mirror adjustments. If the trailer has  
electric brakes, start the vehicle and trailer moving and  
then apply the trailer brake controller by hand to be sure  
the brakes are working. This checks the electrical  
connection at the same time.  
Safety Chains  
Always attach chains between the vehicle and the  
trailer. Cross the safety chains under the tongue of the  
trailer to help prevent the tongue from contacting the  
road if it becomes separated from the hitch. Always  
leave just enough slack so the rig can turn. Never allow  
safety chains to drag on the ground.  
During the trip, check occasionally to be sure that the  
load is secure, and that the lamps and any trailer  
brakes are still working.  
Trailer Brakes  
A loaded trailer that weighs more than 1,500 lbs  
(680 kg) needs to have its own brake system that is  
adequate for the weight of the trailer. Be sure to read  
and follow the instructions for the trailer brakes so they  
are installed, adjusted and maintained properly.  
Following Distance  
Stay at least twice as far behind the vehicle ahead as  
you would when driving the vehicle without a trailer.  
This can help to avoid situations that require heavy  
braking and sudden turns.  
Driving with a Trailer  
Towing a trailer requires a certain amount of  
experience. Get to know the rig before setting out  
for the open road. Get acquainted with the feel of  
handling and braking with the added weight of the  
trailer. And always keep in mind that the vehicle you  
are driving is now longer and not as responsive as the  
vehicle is by itself.  
Passing  
More passing distance is needed when towing a trailer.  
Because the rig is longer, it is necessary to go much  
farther beyond the passed vehicle before returning to  
the lane.  
5-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Backing Up  
Driving on Grades  
Hold the bottom of the steering wheel with one hand.  
Then, to move the trailer to the left, move that hand to  
the left. To move the trailer to the right, move your hand  
to the right. Always back up slowly and, if possible,  
have someone guide you.  
Notice: Do not tow on steep continuous grades  
exceeding 6 miles (9.6 km). Extended, higher than  
normal engine and transmission temperatures may  
result and damage the vehicle. Frequent stops are  
very important to allow the engine and transmission  
to cool.  
Making Turns  
When towing under severe conditions such as hot  
ambient temperatures or steep grades, the vehicle may  
experience more transmission shifting. A COOLING  
MODE ON message may also appear in the DIC. This  
alerts the driver that the shifting mode is in progress  
and is aiding engine cooling. See DIC Warnings and  
Messages on page 448 DIC Warnings and Messages  
for more information.  
When turning with a trailer, make wider turns than  
normal. Do this so the trailer will not strike soft  
shoulders, curbs, road signs, trees or other objects.  
Avoid jerky or sudden maneuvers. Signal well in  
advance.  
Turn Signals When Towing a Trailer  
The arrows on the instrument panel flash whenever  
signaling a turn or lane change. Properly hooked up,  
the trailer lamps also flash, telling other drivers the  
vehicle is turning, changing lanes or stopping.  
Reduce speed and shift to a lower gear before starting  
down a long or steep downgrade. If the transmission is  
not shifted down, the brakes might have to be used so  
much that they would get hot and no longer work well.  
When towing a trailer, the arrows on the instrument  
panel flash for turns even if the bulbs on the trailer are  
burned out. For this reason you may think other drivers  
are seeing the signal when they are not. It is important  
to check occasionally to be sure the trailer bulbs are still  
working.  
Pay attention to the engine coolant gauge. If the  
indicator is in the red area, turn off the air conditioning  
to reduce engine load. See Engine Overheating on  
page 634  
.
5-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Parking on Hills  
Leaving After Parking on a Hill  
1. Apply and hold the brake pedal while you:  
.
start the engine,  
WARNING:  
{
.
shift into a gear, and  
.
Parking the vehicle on a hill with the trailer  
attached can be dangerous. If something goes  
wrong, the rig could start to move. People can be  
injured, and both the vehicle and the trailer can be  
damaged. When possible, always park the rig on  
a flat surface.  
release the parking brake.  
2. Let up on the brake pedal.  
3. Drive slowly until the trailer is clear of the chocks.  
4. Stop and have someone pick up and store the  
chocks.  
If parking the rig on a hill:  
1. Press the brake pedal, but do not shift into P (Park)  
yet. Turn the wheels into the curb if facing downhill  
or into traffic if facing uphill.  
2. Have someone place chocks under the trailer  
wheels.  
3. When the wheel chocks are in place, release the  
brake pedal until the chocks absorb the load.  
4. Reapply the brake pedal. Then apply the parking  
brake and shift into P (Park).  
5. Release the brake pedal.  
5-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance When Trailer Towing  
Engine Cooling When Trailer Towing  
The vehicle needs service more often when pulling a  
trailer. See this manual's Maintenance Schedule or  
Index for more information. Things that are especially  
important in trailer operation are automatic transmission  
fluid, engine oil, axle lubricant, belts, cooling system  
and brake system. It is a good idea to inspect these  
before and during the trip.  
The cooling system may temporarily overheat during  
severe operating conditions. See Engine Overheating  
on page 634  
.
Towing a Trailer  
(Manual Transmission)  
Do not tow a trailer if the vehicle is equipped with a  
manual transmission.  
Check periodically to see that all hitch nuts and bolts  
are tight.  
5-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6 Service and Appearance Care  
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28  
Engine Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-29  
Engine Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-34  
Windshield Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-36  
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-37  
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-40  
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-41  
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3  
California Proposition 65 Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
California Perchlorate Materials  
Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
Doing Your Own Service Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
Adding Equipment to the Outside of the  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-45  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-5  
Gasoline Octane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Gasoline Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
California Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
Fuel E85 (85% Ethanol) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8  
Fuels in Foreign Countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9  
Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10  
Filling a Portable Fuel Container . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
Headlamps, Front Turn Signal, and Parking  
Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) . . . . . 6-50  
Taillamps, Turn Signal, Stoplamps and Back-up  
Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-51  
License Plate Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-52  
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-53  
Checking Things Under the Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14  
Hood Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15  
Engine Compartment Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-16  
Engine Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25  
Automatic Transmission Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27  
Manual Transmission Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28  
Hydraulic Clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28  
Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . 6-53  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-54  
Tire Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-56  
Tire Terminology and Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-60  
Inflation - Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-63  
Tire Pressure Monitor System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-64  
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-65  
Tire Inspection and Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-69  
6-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 6 Service and Appearance Care  
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-71  
Weatherstrips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-114  
Washing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-114  
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-114  
Finish Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-114  
Windshield and Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-115  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels  
and Trim . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-116  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-117  
Sheet Metal Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-117  
Finish Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-117  
Underbody Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-117  
Chemical Paint Spotting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-117  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-72  
Different Size Tires and Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-74  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-74  
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-76  
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-76  
Tire Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-77  
If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-77  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit Storage . . . . . . 6-87  
Changing a Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-88  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-89  
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the Spare  
Tire (All Models Except SS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-92  
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the Spare  
Tire (SS Model) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-96  
Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . 6-106  
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-110  
Vehicle Identification . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-118  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . 6-118  
Service Parts Identification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-118  
Electrical System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-118  
Add-On Electrical Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-118  
Headlamp Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-119  
Windshield Wiper Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-119  
Power Windows and Other Power Options . . . 6-119  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-119  
Floor Console Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-120  
Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-122  
Appearance Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-111  
Interior Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-111  
Fabric/Carpet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-112  
Leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-113  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other Plastic  
Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-113  
Care of Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-113  
Capacities and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-125  
6-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories and Modifications  
Service  
When nondealer/nonretailer accessories are added to  
the vehicle, they can affect vehicle performance and  
safety, including such things as airbags, braking,  
stability, ride and handling, emissions systems,  
aerodynamics, durability, and electronic systems like  
antilock brakes, traction control, and stability control.  
Some of these accessories could even cause  
malfunction or damage not covered by the vehicle  
warranty.  
For service and parts needs, visit your dealer/retailer.  
You will receive genuine GM parts and GM-trained and  
supported service people.  
Genuine GM parts have one of these marks:  
Damage to vehicle components resulting from the  
installation or use of nonGM certified parts, including  
control module modifications, is not covered under the  
terms of the vehicle warranty and may affect remaining  
warranty coverage for affected parts.  
GM Accessories are designed to complement and  
function with other systems on the vehicle. Your GM  
dealer/retailer can accessorize the vehicle using  
genuine GM Accessories. When you go to your GM  
dealer/retailer and ask for GM Accessories, you will  
know that GM-trained and supported service  
technicians will perform the work using genuine GM  
Accessories.  
Also, see Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle on page 277.  
6-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
California Proposition 65 Warning  
Doing Your Own Service Work  
WARNING:  
Most motor vehicles, including this one, contain and/or  
emit chemicals known to the State of California to  
cause cancer and birth defects or other reproductive  
harm. Engine exhaust, many parts and systems, many  
fluids, and some component wear by-products contain  
and/or emit these chemicals.  
{
You can be injured and the vehicle could be  
damaged if you try to do service work on a  
vehicle without knowing enough about it.  
California Perchlorate Materials  
Requirements  
Certain types of automotive applications, such as  
airbag initiators, seat belt pretensioners, and lithium  
batteries contained in remote keyless transmitters,  
may contain perchlorate materials. Special handling  
may be necessary. For additional information, see  
www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.  
.
Be sure you have sufficient knowledge,  
experience, the proper replacement parts,  
and tools before attempting any vehicle  
maintenance task.  
.
Be sure to use the proper nuts, bolts, and  
other fasteners. English and metric fasteners  
can be easily confused. If the wrong fasteners  
are used, parts can later break or fall off. You  
could be hurt.  
If doing some of your own service work, use the proper  
service manual. It tells you much more about how to  
service the vehicle than this manual can. To order the  
proper service manual, see Service Publications  
Ordering Information on page 814.  
This vehicle has an airbag system. Before attempting  
to do your own service work, see Servicing Your  
Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on page 276.  
6-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Keep a record with all parts receipts and list the mileage  
and the date of any service work performed. See  
Maintenance Record on page 714.  
Adding Equipment to the Outside of  
the Vehicle  
Things added to the outside of the vehicle can affect  
the airflow around it. This can cause wind noise and  
can affect fuel economy and windshield washer  
performance. Check with your dealer/retailer before  
adding equipment to the outside of the vehicle.  
Fuel  
Use of the recommended fuel is an important part of  
the proper maintenance of this vehicle. To help keep  
the engine clean and maintain optimum vehicle  
performance, we recommend the use of gasoline  
advertised as TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline.  
The 8th digit of the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
shows the code letter or number that identifies the  
vehicle's engine. The VIN is at the top left of the  
instrument panel. See Vehicle Identification Number  
(VIN) on page 6118.  
Look for the TOP TIER label on the fuel pump to  
ensure gasoline meets enhanced detergency standards  
developed by auto companies. A list of marketers  
providing TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline can be found  
at www.toptiergas.com.  
6-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the vehicle has the 2.2L L4 engine (VIN Code B) or  
the 2.4L L4 engine (VIN Code V), you can use either  
unleaded gasoline or ethanol fuel containing up to  
85% ethanol (E85). See Fuel E85 (85% Ethanol) on  
page 68. If the vehicle has the 2.0L L4 engine  
(VIN Code M), use only unleaded gasoline. See  
Gasoline Octane on page 66.  
acceleration could be slightly reduced, and a slight  
audible knocking noise, commonly referred to as spark  
knock, might be heard. If the octane is less than 87, you  
might notice a heavy knocking noise when you drive.  
If this occurs, use a gasoline rated at 87 octane or  
higher as soon as possible. Otherwise, you could  
damage the engine. If heavy knocking is heard when  
using gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher, the engine  
needs service.  
Gasoline Octane  
If the vehicle has the 2.2L L4 engine (VIN Code B), use  
regular unleaded gasoline with a posted octane rating  
of 87 or higher. If the octane rating is less than 87, an  
audible knocking noise, commonly referred to as spark  
knock, might be heard when driving. If this occurs,  
use a gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher as soon  
as possible. If heavy knocking is heard when using  
gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher, the engine needs  
service.  
Gasoline Specifications  
At a minimum, gasoline should meet ASTM  
specification D 4814 in the United States or  
CAN/CGSB3.5 or 3.511 in Canada. Some  
gasolines contain an octane-enhancing additive called  
methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl (MMT).  
We recommend against the use of gasolines containing  
MMT. See Additives on page 67 for additional  
information.  
If the vehicle has the 2.4L L4 engine (VIN Code V)  
or the 2.0L L4 engine (VIN Code M), use premium  
unleaded gasoline with a posted octane rating of  
91 or higher. You can also use regular unleaded  
gasoline rated at 87 octane or higher, but the vehicle's  
6-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
experiences problems due to dirty injectors or valves,  
look for gasoline that is advertised as TOP TIER  
Detergent Gasoline.  
California Fuel  
If the vehicle is certified to meet California Emissions  
Standards, it is designed to operate on fuels that meet  
California specifications. See the underhood emission  
control label. If this fuel is not available in states  
adopting California emissions standards, the vehicle  
will operate satisfactorily on fuels meeting federal  
specifications, but emission control system performance  
might be affected. The malfunction indicator lamp could  
turn on and the vehicle might fail a smogcheck test.  
See Malfunction Indicator Lamp on page 435. If this  
occurs, return to your authorized dealer/retailer for  
diagnosis. If it is determined that the condition is caused  
by the type of fuel used, repairs might not be covered  
by the vehicle warranty.  
For customers who do not use TOP TIER Detergent  
Gasoline regularly, one bottle of GM Fuel System  
Treatment PLUS, added to the fuel tank at every engine  
oil change, can help clean deposits from fuel injectors  
and intake valves. GM Fuel System Treatment PLUS is  
the only gasoline additive recommended by General  
Motors.  
Also, your dealer/retailer has additives that will help  
correct and prevent most depositrelated problems.  
Gasolines containing oxygenates, such as ethers and  
ethanol, and reformulated gasolines might be available  
in your area. We recommend that you use these  
gasolines, if they comply with the specifications  
described earlier. However, E85 (85% ethanol) and  
other fuels containing more than 10% ethanol must  
not be used in vehicles that were not designed for  
those fuels.  
Additives  
To provide cleaner air, all gasolines in the United States  
are now required to contain additives that help prevent  
engine and fuel system deposits from forming, allowing  
the emission control system to work properly. In most  
cases, nothing should have to be added to the fuel.  
However, some gasolines contain only the minimum  
amount of additive required to meet U.S. Environmental  
Protection Agency regulations. To help keep fuel  
injectors and intake valves clean, or if the vehicle  
Notice: This vehicle was not designed for fuel that  
contains methanol. Do not use fuel containing  
methanol. It can corrode metal parts in the fuel  
system and also damage plastic and rubber parts.  
That damage would not be covered under the  
vehicle warranty.  
6-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Some gasolines that are not reformulated for low  
emissions can contain an octane-enhancing additive  
called methylcyclopentadienyl manganese tricarbonyl  
(MMT); ask the attendant where you buy gasoline  
whether the fuel contains MMT. We recommend against  
the use of such gasolines. Fuels containing MMT can  
reduce the life of spark plugs and the performance of  
the emission control system could be affected. The  
malfunction indicator lamp might turn on. If this occurs,  
return to your dealer/retailer for service.  
Only vehicles that have the 2.2L L4 engine  
(VIN Code B) or the 2.4L L4 engine (VIN Code V)  
can use 85% ethanol fuel (E85). We encourage the  
use of E85 in vehicles that are designed to use it. The  
ethanol in E85 is a renewablefuel, meaning it is made  
from renewable sources such as corn and other crops.  
Many service stations will not have an 85% ethanol  
fuel (E85) pump available. The U. S. Department  
of Energy has an alternative fuels website  
(www.eere.energy.gov/afdc/infrastructure/locator.html)  
that can help you find E85 fuel. Those stations that  
do have E85 should have a label indicating ethanol  
content. Do not use the fuel if the ethanol content is  
greater than 85%.  
Fuel E85 (85% Ethanol)  
The 8th digit of the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
shows the code letter or number that identifies the  
vehicle's engine. The VIN is at the top left of the  
instrument panel. See Vehicle Identification Number  
(VIN) on page 6118.  
At a minimum, E85 should meet ASTM Specification  
D 5798. By definition, this means that fuel labeled E85  
will have an ethanol content between 70% and 85%.  
Filling the fuel tank with fuel mixtures that do not meet  
ASTM specifications can affect driveability and could  
cause the malfunction indicator lamp to come on.  
If your vehicle has the 2.2L L4 engine (VIN Code B) or  
the 2.4L L4 engine (VIN Code V), you can use either  
unleaded gasoline or ethanol fuel containing up to  
85% ethanol (E85). See Fuel on page 65. In all  
other engines, use only the unleaded gasoline  
described under Gasoline Octane on page 66.  
6-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To ensure quick starts in the wintertime, the E85 fuel  
must be formulated properly for your climate according  
to ASTM specification D 5798. If you have trouble  
starting on E85, it could be because the E85 fuel is not  
properly formulated for your climate. If this happens,  
switching to gasoline or adding gasoline to the fuel  
tank can improve starting. For good starting and heater  
efficiency below 0°C (32°F), the fuel mix in the fuel tank  
should contain no more than 70% ethanol. It is best not  
to alternate repeatedly between gasoline and E85.  
If you do switch fuels, it is recommended that you add  
as much fuel as possible do not add less than  
11 L (three gallons) when refueling. You should drive  
the vehicle immediately after refueling for at least  
11 km (seven miles) to allow the vehicle to adapt to  
the change in ethanol concentration.  
Notice: Some additives are not compatible with  
E85 fuel and can harm the vehicle's fuel system.  
Do not add anything to E85. Damage caused by  
additives would not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty.  
Notice: This vehicle was not designed for fuel that  
contains methanol. Do not use fuel containing  
methanol. It can corrode metal parts in the fuel  
system and also damage plastic and rubber parts.  
That damage would not be covered under the  
vehicle warranty.  
Fuels in Foreign Countries  
If you plan on driving in another country outside the  
United States or Canada, the proper fuel might be  
hard to find. Never use leaded gasoline or any other  
fuel not recommended in the previous text on fuel.  
Costly repairs caused by use of improper fuel would  
not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
E85 has less energy per gallon than gasoline, so you  
will need to refill the fuel tank more often when using  
E85 than when you are using gasoline. See Filling the  
Tank on page 610.  
To check the fuel availability, ask an auto club,  
or contact a major oil company that does business  
in the country where you will be driving.  
6-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Filling the Tank  
WARNING:  
{
Fuel vapor burns violently and a fuel fire can  
cause bad injuries. To help avoid injuries to you  
and others, read and follow all the instructions on  
the fuel pump island. Turn off the engine when  
refueling. Do not smoke near fuel or when  
refueling the vehicle. Do not use cellular phones.  
Keep sparks, flames, and smoking materials away  
from fuel. Do not leave the fuel pump unattended  
when refueling the vehicle. This is against the law  
in some places. Do not re-enter the vehicle while  
pumping fuel. Keep children away from the fuel  
pump; never let children pump fuel.  
To open the fuel door, push the rearward center edge in  
and release and it will open.  
6-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Fuel can spray out on you if you open the fuel cap  
too quickly. If you spill fuel and then something  
ignites it, you could be badly burned. This spray  
can happen if the tank is nearly full, and is more  
likely in hot weather. Open the fuel cap slowly and  
wait for any hiss noise to stop. Then unscrew the  
cap all the way.  
Be careful not to spill fuel. Do not top off or overfill the  
tank and wait a few seconds after you have finished  
pumping before removing the nozzle. Clean fuel from  
painted surfaces as soon as possible. See Washing  
Your Vehicle on page 6114.  
The tethered fuel cap is located behind a hinged fuel  
door on the passenger side of the vehicle. If the vehicle  
has E85 fuel capability, the fuel cap will be yellow and  
state that E85 or gasoline can be used. See Fuel E85  
(85% Ethanol) on page 68.  
To remove the fuel cap, turn it slowly counterclockwise.  
The fuel cap has a spring in it; if the cap is released too  
soon, it will spring back to the right.  
While refueling, hang the tethered fuel cap from the  
hook on the fuel door.  
6-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When replacing the fuel cap, turn it clockwise until  
it clicks. Make sure the cap is fully installed. The  
diagnostic system can determine if the fuel cap has  
been left off or improperly installed. This would allow  
fuel to evaporate into the atmosphere. See Malfunction  
Indicator Lamp on page 435.  
WARNING:  
{
If a fire starts while you are refueling, do not  
remove the nozzle. Shut off the flow of fuel by  
shutting off the pump or by notifying the station  
attendant. Leave the area immediately.  
The CHECK GAS CAP message displays on the Driver  
Information Center (DIC) if the fuel cap is not properly  
installed. See DIC Warnings and Messages on  
page 448 for more information.  
Notice: If you need a new fuel cap, be sure to get  
the right type. Your dealer/retailer can get one  
for you. If you get the wrong type, it may not fit  
properly. This may cause the malfunction indicator  
lamp to light and may damage the fuel tank and  
emissions system. See Malfunction Indicator Lamp  
To close the fuel door securely, push the door to the  
closed position.  
on page 435  
.
6-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Filling a Portable Fuel Container  
WARNING:  
WARNING: (Continued)  
{
.
Bring the fill nozzle in contact with the inside  
of the fill opening before operating the nozzle.  
Contact should be maintained until the filling is  
complete.  
Never fill a portable fuel container while it is in  
the vehicle. Static electricity discharge from the  
container can ignite the fuel vapor. You can be  
badly burned and the vehicle damaged if this  
occurs. To help avoid injury to you and others:  
.
Do not smoke while pumping fuel.  
.
Do not use a cellular phone while  
pumping fuel.  
.
Dispense fuel only into approved containers.  
.
Do not fill a container while it is inside a  
vehicle, in a vehicle's trunk, pickup bed, or  
on any surface other than the ground.  
(Continued)  
6-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Checking Things Under  
the Hood  
WARNING:  
{
Things that burn can get on hot engine parts and  
start a fire. These include liquids like fuel, oil,  
coolant, brake fluid, windshield washer and other  
fluids, and plastic or rubber. You or others could  
be burned. Be careful not to drop or spill things  
that will burn onto a hot engine.  
WARNING:  
{
An electric fan under the hood can start up and  
injure you even when the engine is not running.  
Keep hands, clothing, and tools away from any  
underhood electric fan.  
6-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. Then go to the front of  
the vehicle and push  
the secondary hood  
release lever to the left.  
It is located under the  
front center of the  
grille.  
Hood Release  
To open the hood, do the following.  
1. Pull the interior hood  
release lever with this  
symbol on it. It is  
located to the left of the  
instrument panel on the  
driver's side of the  
vehicle.  
3. After you have partially lifted the hood, gas struts  
will automatically take over to lift and hold the hood  
in the fully open position.  
Before closing the hood, be sure all the filler caps  
are on properly. Lower the hood until the lifting  
force of the struts is reduced, then release the  
hood to latch fully. Check to make sure the hood is  
closed and repeat the process if necessary.  
6-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Compartment Overview  
When you open the hood on the 2.4L engine (2.2L engine similar), here is what you will see:  
6-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir. See Adding  
Washer Fluidunder Windshield Washer Fluid on  
G. Engine Oil Dipstick (Out of View). See Checking  
Engine Oilunder Engine Oil on page 619.  
page 636  
.
H. Brake Master Cylinder Reservoir. See Brakes on  
page 637 and Hydraulic Clutch on page 628.  
B. Pressure Cap. See Cooling System on page 628.  
C. Coolant Recovery Tank. See Checking Coolant”  
under Engine Coolant on page 629.  
I. Remote Positive (+) Terminal. See Jump Starting  
on page 641  
.
D. Engine Air Cleaner/Filter. See Engine Air Cleaner/  
Filter on page 625.  
J. Engine Compartment Fuse Block. See Engine  
Compartment Fuse Block on page 6122.  
E. Electric Engine Cooling Fan (Out of View). See  
K. Remote Negative () Terminal (Out of View).  
See Jump Starting on page 641.  
Cooling System Cooling System on page 628.  
F. Engine Oil Fill Cap. See When to Add Engine Oil”  
under Engine Oil on page 619.  
6-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When you open the hood on the 2.0L L4 engine, this is what you will see:  
6-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A. Pressure Cap. See Cooling System on page 628.  
Engine Oil  
B. Engine Air Cleaner/Filter. See Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter on page 625.  
Checking Engine Oil  
It is a good idea to check the engine oil level at each  
fuel fill. In order to get an accurate reading, the oil must  
be warm and the vehicle must be on level ground.  
C. Windshield Washer Fluid Reservoir. See Adding  
Washer Fluidunder Windshield Washer Fluid on  
page 636  
.
D. Coolant Recovery Tank. See Checking Coolant”  
under Engine Coolant on page 629.  
The engine oil dipstick handle is a yellow loop. See  
Engine Compartment Overview on page 616 for the  
location of the engine oil dipstick.  
E. Engine Oil Dipstick. See Checking Engine Oil”  
under Engine Oil on page 619.  
1. Turn off the engine and give the oil several minutes  
to drain back into the oil pan. If this is not done, the  
oil dipstick might not show the actual level.  
F. Engine Oil Fill Cap. See When to Add Engine Oil”  
under Engine Oil on page 619.  
2. Pull out the dipstick and clean it with a paper towel  
or cloth, then push it back in all the way. Remove it  
again, keeping the tip down, and check the level.  
G. Brake Master Cylinder Reservoir. See Brake  
Fluidunder Brakes on page 637 and Hydraulic  
Clutch on page 628.  
H. Underhood Fuse Block. See Engine Compartment  
Fuse Block on page 6122.  
I. Remote Negative () Terminal. See Jump Starting  
on page 641  
J. Remote Positive (+) Terminal. See Jump Starting  
on page 641  
.
.
6-19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When to Add Engine Oil  
If the oil is below the MIN (minimum) mark, add at  
least one quart/liter of the recommended oil. This  
section explains what kind of oil to use. For engine oil  
crankcase capacity, see Capacities and Specifications  
2.2L L4 Engine and  
2.4L L4 Engine  
2.0L L4 Engine  
on page 6125  
.
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 616 for  
Notice: Do not add too much oil. If the engine has  
so much oil that the oil level gets above the upper  
mark that shows the proper operating range, the  
engine could be damaged.  
the location of the engine oil fill cap.  
Add enough oil to put the level somewhere in the proper  
operating range. Push the dipstick all the way back in  
when through.  
6-20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Oils meeting these  
What Kind of Engine Oil to Use  
requirements should have  
the starburst symbol on  
the container. This symbol  
indicates that the oil has  
been certified by the  
American Petroleum  
Institute (API).  
For Vehicles With the 2.2L or  
2.4L L4 Engine  
Look for three things:  
.
GM6094M  
Use only an oil that meets GM Standard  
GM6094M.  
.
SAE 5W-30  
SAE 5W-30 is best for the vehicle. These numbers  
on an oil container show its viscosity, or thickness.  
Do not use other viscosity oils such as  
SAE 20W-50.  
Notice: Use only engine oil identified as meeting  
GM Standard GM6094M and showing the American  
Petroleum Institute Certified For Gasoline Engines  
starburst symbol. Failure to use the recommended  
oil can result in engine damage not covered by the  
vehicle warranty.  
.
American Petroleum Institute (API) starburst  
symbol  
6-21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Oils meeting these  
For Vehicles with the 2.0L L4 Engine Only  
requirements should have  
the starburst symbol on  
the container. This symbol  
indicates that the oil has  
been certified by the  
American Petroleum  
Institute (API).  
Look for three things:  
.
GM4718M  
This vehicle's engine requires a special oil meeting  
GM Standard GM4718M, such as Mobil 1® or  
equivalent. Oils meeting this standard may be  
identified as synthetic. However, not all synthetic  
oils will meet this GM standard. Use only an oil that  
meets GM Standard GM4718M.  
Notice: Using oils that do not have the GM4718M  
Standard designation can cause engine damage  
not covered by the vehicle warranty.  
This vehicle's engine was filled at the factory with a  
synthetic oil meeting all requirements for this vehicle.  
.
SAE 5W-30  
Substitute Engine Oil: When adding oil to maintain  
engine oil level, oil meeting GM Standard GM4718M  
might not be available. You can add substitute oil  
designated SAE 5W-30 with the starburst symbol at all  
temperatures. Substitute oil not meeting GM Standard  
GM4718M should not be used for an oil change.  
SAE 5W-30 is best for the vehicle. These numbers  
on an oil container show its viscosity, or thickness.  
Do not use other viscosity oils such as  
SAE 20W-50.  
.
American Petroleum Institute (API) starburst  
symbol  
6-22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cold Temperature Operation  
Engine Oil Life System  
For Vehicles With the 2.2L or  
2.4L L4 Engine  
When to Change Engine Oil  
This vehicle has the Engine Oil Life System, a computer  
system that indicates when to change the engine oil  
and filter. This is based on engine revolutions and  
engine temperature, and not on mileage. Based on  
driving conditions, the mileage at which an oil change is  
indicated can vary considerably. For the oil life system  
to work properly, the system must be reset every time  
the oil is changed.  
If in an area of extreme cold, where the temperature  
falls below 20°F (29°C), use either an SAE 5W-30  
synthetic oil or an SAE 0W-30 engine oil. Both provide  
easier cold starting for the engine at extremely low  
temperatures. Always use an oil that meets the required  
specification, GM6094M. See What Kind of Engine Oil  
to Usefor more information.  
When the system has calculated that oil life has been  
diminished, it indicates that an oil change is necessary.  
A CHANGE OIL SOON message comes on. See DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 448. Change the  
oil as soon as possible within the next 600 miles  
(1 000 km). It is possible that, if driving under the best  
conditions, the oil life system might not indicate that an  
oil change is necessary for over a year. However, the  
engine oil and filter must be changed at least once a  
year and at this time the system must be reset. Your  
dealer/retailer has trained service people who will  
perform this work using genuine parts and reset the  
system. It is also important to check the oil regularly  
and keep it at the proper level.  
Engine Oil Additives / Engine Oil  
Flushes  
Do not add anything to the oil. The recommended oils  
with the starburst symbol that meet GM standards are  
all that is needed for good performance and engine  
protection.  
Engine oil system flushes are not recommended and  
could cause engine damage not covered by the vehicle  
warranty.  
6-23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the system is ever reset accidentally, the oil must  
be changed at 3,000 miles (5 000 km) since the last  
oil change. Remember to reset the oil life system  
whenever the oil is changed.  
3. Press the information button to scroll through the  
available personalization menu modes until the  
DIC display shows OILLIFE RESET.  
4. Press and hold the reset button until the DIC  
display shows ACKNOWLEDGED. This will tell  
you the system has been reset.  
How to Reset the Engine Oil Life  
System  
5. Turn the key to LOCK/OFF.  
The Engine Oil Life System calculates when to change  
your engine oil and filter based on vehicle use.  
Whenever the oil is changed, reset the system so it  
can calculate when the next oil change is required. If a  
situation occurs where the oil is changed prior to a  
CHANGE OIL SOON message being turned on, reset  
the system.  
For vehicles with the 2.2L (VIN Code V) or 2.4L  
(VIN Code B) engines, you can also reset the system  
as follows:  
1. Turn the ignition key to ON/RUN with the  
engine off.  
2. Fully press and release the accelerator pedal  
slowly three times within five seconds.  
After changing the engine oil, the system must be reset:  
1. Turn the ignition to ON/RUN, with the engine off.  
3. Turn the key to LOCK/OFF, then start the engine.  
If the CHANGE OIL SOON message comes back on  
when the vehicle is started, the engine oil life system  
has not reset. Repeat the reset procedure.  
2. Press the information and reset buttons on the  
Driver Information Center (DIC) at the same time to  
enter the personalization menu. See DIC Vehicle  
Personalization on page 454.  
6-24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
What to Do with Used Oil  
How to Inspect the Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter (2.2L and 2.4L Engines)  
Used engine oil contains certain elements that can be  
unhealthy for your skin and could even cause cancer.  
Do not let used oil stay on your skin for very long. Clean  
your skin and nails with soap and water, or a good hand  
cleaner. Wash or properly dispose of clothing or rags  
containing used engine oil. See the manufacturer's  
warnings about the use and disposal of oil products.  
Used oil can be a threat to the environment. If you  
change your own oil, be sure to drain all the oil from the  
filter before disposal. Never dispose of oil by putting it in  
the trash, pouring it on the ground, into sewers, or into  
streams or bodies of water. Recycle it by taking it to a  
place that collects used oil.  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
When to Inspect the Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 616 for  
the location of the engine air cleaner/filter.  
Inspect the air cleaner/filter at the Maintenance II  
intervals and replace it at the first oil change after each  
50,000 mile (80 000 km) interval. See Scheduled  
Maintenance on page 73 for more information. If you  
are driving in dusty/dirty conditions, inspect the filter at  
each engine oil change. The 2.0L engine inspect at  
each oil change. Replace filter if appears dusty or dirty.  
To inspect the air cleaner/filter remove the filter from the  
vehicle and lightly shake the filter to release loose dust  
and dirt. If the filter remains caked with dirt, a new filter  
is required. Never use compressed air to clean the filter.  
6-25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Because this operation can be a little difficult, you may  
choose to have this done at the dealer/retailer service  
department.  
How to Inspect the Engine Air  
Cleaner/Filter (2.0L Engine Only)  
To inspect or replace the filter, do the following:  
1. Disconnect the Mass Air Flow sensor, PCV hose,  
and both ducts.  
2. Pull the entire system from the top of the engine.  
3. Turn the system over and place it on a soft,  
nonabrasive surface.  
4. Remove the screws that hold the housing and  
cover together and lift off the housing.  
5. Inspect or replace the engine air cleaner/filter.  
6. Reverse the steps to reinstall the system. Be sure  
to reinstall the housing tightly.  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 616 for  
the location of the engine air cleaner/filter.  
To inspect the air cleaner/filter remove the filter from the  
vehicle and lightly shake the filter to release loose dust  
and dirt. If the filter remains caked with dirt, a new filter  
is required. Never use compressed air to clean the filter.  
Because this operation can be a little difficult, you may  
choose to have this done at the dealer/retailer service  
department.  
6-26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To inspect or replace the filter, do the following:  
Automatic Transmission Fluid  
1. Remove the screws that hold the housing and  
cover together and lift off the cover.  
It is not necessary to check the transmission fluid level.  
A transmission fluid leak is the only reason for fluid  
loss. If a leak occurs, take your vehicle to a dealer/  
retailer and have it repaired as soon as possible.  
2. Inspect or replace the engine air cleaner/filter.  
3. Reverse the steps to reinstall the system. Be sure  
to reinstall the housing tightly.  
Change the fluid and filter at the intervals listed in the  
Maintenance Schedule. See Scheduled Maintenance  
on page 73. Be sure to use the transmission fluid  
listed in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
WARNING:  
{
page 710  
.
Operating the engine with the air cleaner/filter off  
can cause you or others to be burned. The air  
cleaner not only cleans the air; it helps to stop  
flames if the engine backfires. Use caution when  
working on the engine and do not drive with the  
air cleaner/filter off.  
Notice: Use of the incorrect automatic transmission  
fluid may damage the vehicle, and the damages may  
not be covered by the vehicle's warranty. Always  
use the automatic transmission fluid listed in  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 710.  
Notice: If the air cleaner/filter is off, dirt can easily  
get into the engine, which could damage it. Always  
have the air cleaner/filter in place when you are  
driving.  
6-27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Manual Transmission Fluid  
Cooling System  
It is not necessary to check the manual transmission  
fluid level. A transmission fluid leak is the only reason  
for fluid loss. If a leak occurs, take the vehicle to a  
dealer/retailer for service. Have it repaired as soon as  
possible. You may also have the fluid level checked  
by your dealer/retailer when the oil is changed. See  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on page 710 for  
the proper fluid to use.  
The Cooling System allows the engine to maintain the  
correct working temperature.  
Hydraulic Clutch  
The hydraulic clutch linkage in your vehicle is  
self-adjusting. This system does not have its own  
reservoir. It receives fluid from the brake master  
cylinder reservoir.  
See Brakes on page 637 for more information.  
A. Pressure Cap  
B. Coolant Recovery Tank  
C. Electric Engine Cooling Fan  
6-28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Using coolant other than DEX-COOL® can  
cause premature engine, heater core, or radiator  
corrosion. In addition, the engine coolant could  
require changing sooner, at 50 000 km (30,000 miles)  
or 24 months, whichever occurs first. Any repairs  
would not be covered by the vehicle warranty.  
Always use DEX-COOL® (silicate-free) coolant in  
the vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
An electric engine cooling fan under the hood can  
start up even when the engine is not running and  
can cause injury. Keep hands, clothing, and tools  
away from any underhood electric fan.  
Engine Coolant  
The cooling system in the vehicle is filled with  
DEX-COOL® engine coolant. This coolant is designed  
to remain in the vehicle for five years or 150,000 miles  
(240 000 km), whichever occurs first.  
WARNING:  
{
Heater and radiator hoses, and other engine  
parts, can be very hot. Do not touch them. If you  
do, you can be burned.  
The following explains the cooling system and how  
to check and add coolant when it is low. If there is a  
problem with engine overheating, see Engine  
Overheating on page 634  
Do not run the engine if there is a leak. If you run  
the engine, it could lose all coolant. That could  
cause an engine fire, and you could be burned.  
Get any leak fixed before you drive the vehicle.  
6-29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Use a 50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable water and  
DEX-COOL® coolant. If using this mixture, nothing else  
needs to be added. This mixture:  
What to Use  
.
WARNING:  
{
Gives freezing protection down to 34°F (37°C),  
outside temperature.  
.
Gives boiling protection up to 265°F (129°C),  
engine temperature.  
Adding only plain water to the cooling system can  
be dangerous. Plain water, or some other liquid  
such as alcohol, can boil before the proper  
.
Protects against rust and corrosion.  
coolant mixture will. The vehicle's coolant warning  
system is set for the proper coolant mixture. With  
plain water or the wrong mixture, the engine could  
get too hot but you would not get the overheat  
warning. The engine could catch fire and you or  
others could be burned. Use a 50/50 mixture of  
clean, drinkable water and DEX-COOL® coolant.  
.
Will not damage aluminum parts.  
.
Helps keep the proper engine temperature.  
Notice: If an improper coolant mixture is used, the  
engine could overheat and be badly damaged. The  
repair cost would not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Too much water in the mixture can freeze  
and crack the engine, radiator, heater core, and  
other parts.  
Notice: If extra inhibitors and/or additives are used  
in the vehicle's cooling system, the vehicle could be  
damaged. Use only the proper mixture of the engine  
coolant listed in this manual for the cooling system.  
See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
page 710 for more information.  
6-30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Checking Coolant  
The vehicle must be on a level surface when checking  
the coolant level.  
The coolant recovery tank  
cap has this symbol on it.  
The tank is located in the  
engine compartment  
toward the front of  
the engine on the  
passenger's side of  
the vehicle.  
When the engine is cold, the coolant level should be at  
the COLD FILL (A) line or a little higher. The COLD  
FILL line is near the bottom of the tank and sticks out  
from the rear of the tank.  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 616 for  
more information on location.  
Check to see if coolant is visible in the coolant recovery  
tank. If the coolant inside the coolant recovery tank is  
boiling, do not do anything else until it cools down.  
If coolant is visible but the coolant level is not at or  
above the COLD FILL mark, add a 50/50 mixture of  
clean, drinkable water and DEX-COOL® coolant at the  
coolant recovery tank, but be sure the cooling system is  
cool before this is done.  
When the engine is cold, the coolant level should be at  
or above the COLD FILL line. If it is not, you may have  
a leak in the cooling system.  
6-31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How to Add Coolant to the Cooling  
System  
WARNING:  
{
An electric engine cooling fan under the hood can  
start up even when the engine is not running and  
can cause injury. Keep hands, clothing, and tools  
away from any underhood electric fan.  
WARNING:  
{
You can be burned if you spill coolant on hot  
engine parts. Coolant contains ethylene glycol  
and it will burn if the engine parts are hot enough.  
Do not spill coolant on a hot engine.  
WARNING:  
{
Notice: This vehicle has a specific coolant fill  
procedure. Failure to follow this procedure could  
cause the engine to overheat and be severely  
damaged.  
Steam and scalding liquids from a hot cooling  
system can blow out and burn you badly. They  
are under pressure, and if you turn the surge tank  
pressure cap even a little they can come out  
at high speed. Never turn the cap when the  
cooling system, including the surge tank pressure  
cap, is hot. Wait for the cooling system and surge  
tank pressure cap to cool if you ever have to turn  
the pressure cap.  
6-32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If no coolant is visible in the coolant recovery tank, add  
coolant at the pressure cap as follows:  
1. Remove the pressure  
cap when the cooling  
system, including the  
pressure cap and  
upper radiator hose, is  
no longer hot.  
Turn the pressure cap slowly counterclockwise.  
If you hear a hiss, wait for that to stop. A hiss  
means there is still some pressure left to be  
vented.  
5. Then fill the coolant recovery tank to the COLD  
FILL (A) line.  
6. Put the cap back on the coolant recovery tank, but  
leave the pressure cap off.  
2. Then keep turning the pressure cap and remove it.  
3. Add the proper DEX-COOL® coolant mixture to the  
coolant fill port, up to the base of the port. See  
Engine Coolant on page 629 Engine Coolant for  
more information about the proper coolant mixture.  
4. Rinse or wipe any spilled coolant from the engine  
and the compartment.  
6-33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Start the engine and let it run until you can feel the  
upper radiator hose getting hot. Watch out for the  
engine cooling fan.  
Engine Overheating  
The vehicle has several indicators to warn of engine  
overheating.  
8. By this time, the coolant level inside the radiator  
filler port may be lower. If the level is lower, add  
more of the proper DEX-COOL® coolant mixture  
through the fill port until the level reaches the base  
of the fill port.  
You will find a coolant temperature warning light and a  
coolant temperature gauge on your vehicle's instrument  
panel. See Engine Coolant Temperature Warning Light  
on page 434 and Engine Coolant Temperature Gauge  
on page 434 for more information.  
9. Then replace the pressure cap. At any time during  
this procedure, if coolant begins to flow out of the  
fill port, reinstall the pressure cap. Be sure the  
pressure cap is hand-tight and fully seated.  
You may decide not to lift the hood when this warning  
appears, but instead get service help right away. See  
Roadside Assistance Program on page 86.  
10. When the engine has cooled, check the coolant in  
the coolant recovery tank. The level in the coolant  
recovery tank should be at the COLD FILL line  
when the engine is cold.  
If you do decide to lift the hood, make sure the vehicle  
is parked on a level surface.  
Then check to see if the engine cooling fans are  
running. If the engine is overheating, both fans should  
be running. If they are not, do not continue to run the  
engine and have the vehicle serviced.  
Notice: Engine damage from running the engine  
without coolant is not covered by the warranty.  
Notice: If the engine catches fire because of being  
driven with no coolant, your vehicle can be badly  
damaged. The costly repairs would not be covered  
by the vehicle warranty.  
6-34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If Steam Is Coming From The Engine  
Compartment  
If No Steam Is Coming From The  
Engine Compartment  
If an engine overheat warning is displayed but no  
steam can be seen or heard, the problem may not be  
too serious. Sometimes the engine can get a little too  
hot when the vehicle:  
WARNING:  
{
Steam from an overheated engine can burn you  
badly, even if you just open the hood. Stay away  
from the engine if you see or hear steam coming  
from it. Just turn it off and get everyone away from  
the vehicle until it cools down. Wait until there is  
no sign of steam or coolant before you open  
the hood.  
.
Climbs a long hill on a hot day.  
.
Stops after high-speed driving.  
.
Idles for long periods in traffic.  
.
Tows a trailer.  
If the overheat warning is displayed with no sign of  
steam:  
If you keep driving when your engine is  
overheated, the liquids in it can catch fire. You or  
others could be badly burned. Stop your engine if  
it overheats, and get out of the vehicle until the  
engine is cool.  
1. Turn the air off.  
2. Turn the heater on to the highest temperature and  
to the highest fan speed. Open the windows as  
necessary.  
3. In heavy traffic, let the engine idle in N (Neutral)  
while stopped. If it is safe to do so, pull off the  
road, shift to P (Park) or N (Neutral) and let the  
engine idle.  
6-35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If the temperature overheat gauge is no longer in the  
overheat zone or an overheat warning no longer  
displays, the vehicle can be driven. Continue to drive  
the vehicle slow for about 10 minutes. Keep a safe  
vehicle distance from the car in front of you. If the  
warning does not come back on, continue to drive  
normally.  
Adding Washer Fluid  
Open the cap with the  
washer symbol on it.  
Add washer fluid until the  
tank is full. See Engine  
Compartment Overview  
on page 616 for  
If the warning continues, pull over, stop, and park the  
vehicle right away.  
reservoir location.  
If there is no sign of steam, idle the engine for  
three minutes while parked. If the warning is still  
displayed, turn off the engine until it cools down.  
Notice:  
.
When using concentrated washer fluid,  
follow the manufacturer's instructions for  
adding water.  
Windshield Washer Fluid  
What to Use  
When you need windshield washer fluid, be sure to  
read the manufacturer's instructions before use. If you  
will be operating your vehicle in an area where the  
temperature may fall below freezing, use a fluid that has  
sufficient protection against freezing.  
.
Do not mix water with ready-to-use washer  
fluid. Water can cause the solution to freeze  
and damage the washer fluid tank and other  
parts of the washer system. Also, water does  
not clean as well as washer fluid.  
.
.
Fill the washer fluid tank only three-quarters  
full when it is very cold. This allows for fluid  
expansion if freezing occurs, which could  
damage the tank if it is completely full.  
Do not use engine coolant (antifreeze) in  
the windshield washer. It can damage the  
vehicle's windshield washer system and  
paint.  
6-36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Do not top off the brake/clutch fluid. Adding fluid does  
not correct a leak. If fluid is added when the brake  
linings are worn, there will be too much fluid when new  
brake linings are installed. Add or remove fluid, as  
necessary, only when work is done on the brake/clutch  
hydraulic system.  
Brakes  
Brake Fluid  
The brake master cylinder and, on manual transmission  
vehicles, the clutch hydraulic system use the same  
reservoir. See Engine Compartment Overview on  
page 616 for the location of the reservoir. The  
reservoir is filled with DOT 3 brake fluid.  
WARNING:  
{
There are only two reasons why the brake fluid level in  
the reservoir might go down:  
If too much brake fluid is added, it can spill on the  
engine and burn, if the engine is hot enough. You  
or others could be burned, and the vehicle could  
be damaged. Add brake fluid only when work is  
done on the brake and/or clutch hydraulic system.  
.
The brake fluid level goes down because of  
normal brake lining wear. When new linings are  
installed, the fluid level goes back up.  
.
A fluid leak in the brake and/or clutch hydraulic  
system can also cause a low fluid level. Have the  
brake and/or clutch hydraulic system fixed, since a  
leak means that sooner or later the brakes and/or  
clutch will not work well.  
When the brake fluid falls to a low level, the brake  
warning light comes on. See Brake System Warning  
Light on page 430.  
6-37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice:  
What to Add  
.
Using the wrong fluid can badly damage  
Use only new DOT 3 brake fluid from a sealed  
brake or clutch hydraulic system parts. For  
example, just a few drops of mineral-based  
oil, such as engine oil, in the brake or clutch  
hydraulic system can damage brake or  
clutch hydraulic system parts so badly that  
they will have to be replaced. Do not let  
someone put in the wrong kind of fluid.  
container. See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
page 710  
.
Always clean the brake fluid reservoir cap and the area  
around the cap before removing it. This helps keep dirt  
from entering the reservoir.  
WARNING:  
{
.
If brake fluid is spilled on the vehicle's  
painted surfaces, the paint finish can be  
damaged. Be careful not to spill brake  
fluid on the vehicle. If you do, wash it off  
immediately. See Washing Your Vehicle on  
With the wrong kind of fluid in the brake or clutch  
hydraulic system, the brakes or clutch might not  
work well. This could cause a crash. Always use  
the proper brake fluid.  
page 6114  
.
6-38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Properly torqued wheel nuts are necessary to help  
prevent brake pulsation. When tires are rotated, inspect  
brake pads for wear and evenly tighten wheel nuts in  
the proper sequence to torque specifications in  
Capacities and Specifications on page 6125.  
Brake Wear  
This vehicle has front disc brakes and could have rear  
drum brakes or rear disc brakes.  
Disc brake pads have built-in wear indicators that make  
a high-pitched warning sound when the brake pads are  
worn and new pads are needed. The sound can come  
and go or be heard all the time the vehicle is moving,  
except when applying the brake pedal firmly.  
If the vehicle has rear drum brakes, they do not  
have wear indicators, but if a rear brake rubbing  
noise is heard, have the rear brake linings inspected  
immediately. Rear brake drums should be removed and  
inspected each time the tires are removed for rotation or  
changing. When the front brake pads are replaced,  
have the rear brakes inspected, too.  
WARNING:  
{
Brake linings should always be replaced as complete  
axle sets.  
The brake wear warning sound means that soon  
the brakes will not work well. That could lead to  
an accident. When the brake wear warning sound  
is heard, have the vehicle serviced.  
Brake Pedal Travel  
See your dealer/retailer if the brake pedal does not  
return to normal height, or if there is a rapid increase in  
pedal travel. This could be a sign that brake service  
might be required.  
Notice: Continuing to drive with worn-out brake  
pads could result in costly brake repair.  
Some driving conditions or climates can cause a brake  
squeal when the brakes are first applied or lightly  
applied. This does not mean something is wrong with  
the brakes.  
Brake Adjustment  
Every time the brakes are applied, with or without the  
vehicle moving, the brakes adjust for wear.  
6-39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Replacing Brake System Parts  
DANGER:  
{
The braking system on a vehicle is complex. Its many  
parts have to be of top quality and work well together if  
the vehicle is to have really good braking. The vehicle  
was designed and tested with top-quality brake parts.  
When parts of the braking system are replaced for  
example, when the brake linings wear down and new  
ones are installed be sure to get new approved  
replacement parts. If this is not done, the brakes might  
not work properly. For example, if someone puts in  
brake linings that are wrong for the vehicle, the balance  
between the front and rear brakes can change for the  
worse. The braking performance expected can change  
in many other ways if the wrong replacement brake  
parts are installed.  
Battery posts, terminals, and related accessories  
contain lead and lead compounds, chemicals  
known to the State of California to cause cancer  
and reproductive harm. Wash hands after  
handling.  
Vehicle Storage  
WARNING:  
{
Batteries have acid that can burn you and gas  
that can explode. You can be badly hurt if you are  
not careful. See Jump Starting on page 641 for  
tips on working around a battery without  
getting hurt.  
Battery  
Refer to the replacement number on the original battery  
label when a new battery is needed.  
The battery is located in the cargo area. Access to the  
battery is not necessary to jump start the vehicle. See  
Jump Starting on page 641.  
Infrequent Usage: Remove the black, negative () cable  
from the battery to keep the battery from running down.  
Extended Storage: Remove the black, negative ()  
cable from the battery or use a battery trickle charger.  
6-40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: If the other vehicle's system is not a 12-volt  
system with a negative ground, both vehicles can  
be damaged. Only use vehicles with 12-volt systems  
with negative grounds to jump start your vehicle.  
Jump Starting  
If the vehicle's battery has run down, you may want to  
use another vehicle and some jumper cables to start the  
vehicle. Be sure to use the following steps to do it  
safely.  
2. Get the vehicles close enough so the jumper  
cables can reach, but be sure the vehicles are not  
touching each other. If they are, it could cause a  
ground connection you do not want. You would not  
be able to start the vehicle, and the bad grounding  
could damage the electrical systems.  
WARNING:  
{
Batteries can hurt you. They can be dangerous  
because:  
To avoid the possibility of the vehicles rolling, set  
the parking brake firmly on both vehicles involved  
in the jump start procedure. Put an automatic  
transmission in P (Park) or a manual transmission  
in N (Neutral) before setting the parking brake.  
.
They contain acid that can burn you.  
.
They contain gas that can explode or ignite.  
.
They contain enough electricity to burn you.  
Notice: If you leave the radio or other accessories  
on during the jump starting procedure, they could  
be damaged. The repairs would not be covered by  
the warranty. Always turn off the radio and other  
accessories when jump starting the vehicle.  
If you do not follow these steps exactly, some or  
all of these things can hurt you.  
Notice: Ignoring these steps could result in costly  
damage to the vehicle that would not be covered by  
the warranty.  
3. Turn off the ignition on both vehicles. Unplug  
unnecessary accessories plugged into the  
cigarette lighter or the accessory power outlet.  
Turn off the radio and all lamps that are not  
needed. This will avoid sparks and help save  
both batteries. And it could save the radio!  
Trying to start the vehicle by pushing or pulling it  
will not work, and it could damage the vehicle.  
1. Check the other vehicle. It must have a 12-volt  
battery with a negative ground system.  
6-41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Open the hood on the other vehicle and locate the  
positive (+) and negative () terminal locations on  
that vehicle.  
Locate the remote  
negative () ground  
terminal, marked  
GND (), which is  
located at the front of  
the engine compartment  
on the driver side of the  
vehicle.  
You will not see the battery of your vehicle under  
the hood. It is located in the rear cargo area. You  
will not need to access your battery for jump  
starting. The vehicle has a remote positive (+) and  
a remote negative () jump starting terminal.  
Locate the remote  
positive terminal which  
is located under a red  
tethered cap on the  
engine compartment fuse  
block. Remove the cap to  
access the terminal.  
See Engine Compartment Overview on page 616  
for more information on the location of the  
positive (+) and negative () terminals on the  
vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
An electric fan can start up even when the engine  
is not running and can injure you. Keep hands,  
clothing and tools away from any underhood  
electric fan.  
Do not remove fuse block cover to jump start the  
vehicle.  
6-42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
WARNING:  
{
{
Using a match near a battery can cause battery  
gas to explode. People have been hurt doing this,  
and some have been blinded. Use a flashlight if  
you need more light.  
Fans or other moving engine parts can injure you  
badly. Keep your hands away from moving parts  
once the engine is running.  
Be sure the battery has enough water. You do not  
need to add water to the battery installed in your  
new vehicle. But if a battery has filler caps, be  
sure the right amount of fluid is there. If it is low,  
add water to take care of that first. If you don't,  
explosive gas could be present.  
5. Check that the jumper cables do not have loose  
or missing insulation. If they do, you could get a  
shock. The vehicles could be damaged too.  
Before you connect the cables, here are some  
basic things you should know. Positive (+) will go  
to positive (+) or to a remote positive (+) terminal if  
the vehicle has one. Negative () will go to a  
heavy, unpainted metal engine part or to a remote  
negative () terminal if the vehicle has one.  
Battery fluid contains acid that can burn you. Do  
not get it on you. If you accidentally get it in your  
eyes or on your skin, flush the place with water  
and get medical help immediately.  
Do not connect positive (+) to negative () or you  
will get a short that would damage the battery and  
maybe other parts too. And do not connect the  
negative () cable to the negative () terminal on  
the dead battery because this can cause sparks.  
6-43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
6. Connect the red positive (+) cable to the  
positive (+) terminal location on the vehicle with  
the dead battery. Use a remote positive (+) terminal  
if the vehicle has one.  
Notice: If the jumper cables are connected or  
removed in the wrong order, electrical shorting may  
occur and damage the vehicle. The repairs would  
not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Always  
connect and remove the jumper cables in the  
correct order, making sure that the cables do not  
touch each other or other metal.  
7. Do not let the other end touch metal. Connect it to  
the positive (+) terminal of the good battery. Use a  
remote positive (+) terminal if the vehicle has one.  
8. Now connect the black negative () cable to the  
negative () terminal of the good battery. Use a  
remote negative () terminal if the vehicle has one.  
Do not let the other end touch anything until the  
next step. The other end of the negative () cable  
does not go to the dead battery. It goes to a heavy,  
unpainted metal engine part or to a remote  
negative () terminal on the vehicle with the  
dead battery.  
9. Connect the other end of the negative () cable to  
the negative () terminal location on the vehicle  
with the dead battery. Your vehicle has a remote  
negative () ground terminal marked GND ().  
10. Now start the vehicle with the good battery and run  
the engine for a while.  
Jumper Cable Removal  
A. Heavy, Unpainted Metal Engine Part or Remote  
11. Try to start the vehicle that had the dead battery.  
If it will not start after a few tries, it probably needs  
service.  
Negative () Terminal (GND)  
B. Good Battery or Remote Positive (+) and Remote  
Negative () Terminals  
C. Dead Battery or Remote Positive (+) Terminal  
6-44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To disconnect the jumper cables from both vehicles:  
It is recommended that the vehicle is taken to your  
dealer/retailer for service if the headlamps need to be  
re-aimed. It is possible however, to re-aim the  
headlamps as described.  
1. Disconnect the black negative () cable from the  
vehicle that had the dead battery.  
2. Disconnect the black negative () cable from the  
The vehicle should:  
vehicle with the good battery.  
.
Be placed so the headlamps are 25 ft. (7.6 m) from  
3. Disconnect the red positive (+) cable from the  
vehicle with the good battery.  
a light colored wall.  
.
Have all four tires on a level surface which is level  
4. Disconnect the red positive (+) cable from the other  
vehicle.  
all the way to the wall.  
.
Be placed so it is perpendicular to the wall or other  
5. Return the positive (+) terminal cover to its original  
position.  
flat surface.  
.
Not have any snow, ice, or mud on it.  
.
Headlamp Aiming  
The vehicle has a visual optical headlamp aiming  
system. The aim has been preset at the factory and  
should need no further adjustment.  
Be fully assembled and all other work stopped  
while headlamp aiming is being performed.  
.
Normally loaded with a full tank of fuel and one  
person or 160 lbs (75 kg) sitting on the driver seat.  
.
Have all tires properly inflated.  
However, if the vehicle is damaged in a crash, the  
headlamp aim may be affected and adjustment may be  
necessary.  
.
Have the spare tire is in its original location in the  
vehicle.  
If oncoming vehicles flash their high beams at you, this  
may also mean the vertical aim needs to be adjusted.  
6-45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Headlamp aiming is done with the vehicle's low-beam  
headlamps. The high-beam headlamps will be correctly  
aimed if the low-beam headlamps are aimed properly.  
To adjust the vertical aim:  
1. Open the hood. See Hood Release on page 615  
for more information.  
4. At the wall measure from the ground upward (A) to  
the recorded distance from Step 3 and mark it.  
5. Draw or tape a horizontal line (B) on the wall the  
width of the vehicle at the height of the mark in  
Step 4.  
Notice: Do not cover a headlamp to improve beam  
cut-off when aiming. Covering a headlamp may  
cause excessive heat build-up which may cause  
damage to the headlamp.  
2. Find the aim dot on the lens of the lowbeam  
headlamp.  
3. Measure the distance from the ground to the  
aim dot on the lowbeam headlamp. Record the  
distance.  
6. Turn on the low-beam headlamps and place a  
piece of cardboard or equivalent in front of the  
headlamp not being adjusted. Do not place directly  
on the headlamp. This allows only the beam of  
light from the headlamp being adjusted to be seen  
on the flat surface.  
6-46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The top edge of the cut-off should be positioned at  
the bottom edge of the horizontal tape line.  
Driver Side Shown  
9. Make sure that the light from the headlamp is  
positioned at the bottom edge of the horizontal  
tape line. The lamp on the left (A) shows the  
correct headlamp aim. The lamp on the right (B)  
shows the incorrect headlamp aim.  
7. Locate the vertical headlamp aiming screws, which  
are under the hood near each headlamp assembly.  
The adjustment screw can be turned with a 6 mm  
hex socket.  
10. Repeat Steps 7 through 9 for the opposite  
headlamp.  
8. Turn the vertical aiming screw until the headlamp  
beam is aimed to the horizontal tape line. Turn it  
clockwise or counterclockwise to raise or lower the  
angle of the beam.  
6-47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Headlamps, Front Turn Signal, and  
Parking Lamps  
Bulb Replacement  
For the proper type of replacement bulbs, see  
Replacement Bulbs on page 653.  
For any bulb changing procedure not listed in this  
section, contact your dealer/retailer.  
Halogen Bulbs  
WARNING:  
{
Halogen bulbs have pressurized gas inside and  
can burst if you drop or scratch the bulb. You or  
others could be injured. Be sure to read and  
follow the instructions on the bulb package.  
A. Headlamp  
B. Turn Signal/Parking Lamp  
6-48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To replace the headlamp, turn signal, or parking  
lamp bulb:  
3. Reach in behind the wheel well liner and locate the  
bulb to be changed.  
1. Turn the wheel to access the wheel well.  
4. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise and pull it  
straight out of the lamp assembly.  
5. Pull the old bulb straight out of the bulb socket.  
6. Push the new bulb straight into the bulb socket  
until it clicks.  
7. Push the bulb socket straight into the lamp  
assembly and turn it clockwise to lock it into place.  
8. Reinstall the wheel well liner using fasteners.  
2. Remove the fasteners located on the wheel liner.  
To access the headlamp and the turn  
signal/parking lamp bulbs.  
6-49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp  
(CHMSL)  
To replace the center high-mounted stoplamp bulb:  
1. Open the liftgate. See Liftgate on page 313.  
4. Pull the old bulb straight out of the bulb socket.  
5. Push the new bulb straight into the bulb socket  
until it clicks.  
6. Push the bulb socket straight into the lamp  
assembly and turn it clockwise to lock it into place.  
2. Remove the center trim located near the top of the  
liftgate.  
7. Reinstall the center trim.  
3. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise and pull it  
straight out of the lamps assembly.  
6-50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To replace one of these bulbs:  
Taillamps, Turn Signal, Stoplamps  
and Back-up Lamps  
1. Open the liftgate. See Liftgate on page 313.  
A. Stoplamp/Taillamp/Turn Signal Lamp  
B. Back-up Lamp  
2. Remove the cover in the rear cargo area of the  
vehicle to access the bulbs.  
3. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise and pull it  
straight out of the lamp assembly.  
6-51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Pull the bulb straight out of the socket.  
License Plate Lamp  
To replace one of these bulbs:  
5. Install a new bulb. When installing the bulb socket  
into the assembly, line up the tabs with the slots in  
the bulb assembly.  
1. Remove the two screws holding each of the  
license plate lamps to the fascia.  
6. Push the bulb socket straight into the lamp  
assembly and turn it clockwise to lock it into place.  
7. Reinstall the cover.  
2. Turn and pull the license plate lamp forward  
through the fascia opening.  
3. Turn the bulb socket counterclockwise and pull the  
bulb straight out of the socket.  
4. Push the new bulb into the bulb socket and turn it  
clockwise to lock it into place.  
6-52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Push and turn the license plate back through the  
fascia opening.  
Replacement blades come in different types and are  
removed in different ways. For the proper type and  
length, see Maintenance Replacement Parts on  
page 712. Here's how to remove the wiper blade:  
6. Reinstall the two screws holding the license plate  
lamps to the fascia.  
1. Pull the windshield wiper arm away from the  
windshield.  
Replacement Bulbs  
Exterior Lamp  
Bulb Number  
Back-up Lamp and CHMSL  
921  
Front Turn Signal and Parking  
Lamp (Amber)  
5702KA  
Front Turn Signal and Parking  
Lamp (Clear)  
B2N  
H13  
Headlamp High/Low-Beam  
Stoplamp/Taillamp/Turn Signal  
3057KX  
For replacement bulbs not listed here, contact your  
dealer/retailer.  
2. While holding the wiper arm, lift the clip up from  
the blade connecting point, and pull the blade  
assembly down toward the windshield to remove it  
from the wiper arm.  
Windshield Wiper Blade  
Replacement  
Windshield wiper blades should be inspected for wear  
or cracking. See Scheduled Maintenance on page 73  
for more information on wiper blade inspection.  
3. Install the new wiper blade on the wiper arm and  
press down on the clip to snap it into place.  
6-53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Backglass Wiper Blade Replacement  
1. Remove the protective cap from the wiper arm.  
If the protective cap is not removed before lifting  
the wiper arm, the wiper arm could be damaged.  
Tires  
Your new vehicle comes with high-quality tires  
made by a leading tire manufacturer. If you ever  
have questions about your tire warranty and  
where to obtain service, see your vehicle  
Warranty booklet for details. For additional  
information refer to the tire manufacturer.  
2. Pull the wiper arm away from the backglass and  
into the service position.  
3. Rotate the wiper blade, and pull down on it to  
remove it from the wiper arm.  
4. Install the new wiper blade, then set the wiper arm  
back into its original position and replace the  
protective cap.  
WARNING:  
{
Poorly maintained and improperly used tires  
are dangerous.  
.
Overloading your vehicle's tires can  
cause overheating as a result of too  
much flexing. You could have an air-out  
and a serious accident. See Loading the  
Vehicle on page 524  
.
(Continued)  
6-54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Low-Profile Performance Tire  
WARNING: (Continued)  
If your vehicle has P225/45R18 size tires, they are  
classified as lowprofile performance tires. These  
tires are designed for very responsive driving on  
wet or dry pavement. You may also notice more  
road noise with lowprofile performance tires and  
that they tend to wear faster.  
.
Underinflated tires pose the same  
danger as overloaded tires. The resulting  
accident could cause serious injury.  
Check all tires frequently to maintain the  
recommended pressure. Tire pressure  
should be checked when your vehicle's  
tires are cold. See Inflation - Tire  
Notice: If the vehicle has lowprofile tires, they  
are more susceptible to damage from road  
hazards or curb impact than standard profile  
tires. Tire and/or wheel assembly damage can  
occur when coming into contact with road  
hazards like, potholes, or sharp edged objects,  
or when sliding into a curb. The vehicle  
warranty does not cover this type of damage.  
Keep tires set to the correct inflation pressure  
and, when possible avoid contact with curbs,  
potholes, and other road hazards.  
Pressure on page 663  
.
.
.
Overinflated tires are more likely to be  
cut, punctured, or broken by a sudden  
impact such as when you hit a pothole.  
Keep tires at the recommended pressure.  
Worn, old tires can cause accidents.  
If the tire's tread is badly worn, or if your  
vehicle's tires have been damaged,  
replace them.  
6-55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(A) Tire Size: The tire size is a combination of  
letters and numbers used to define a particular  
tire's width, height, aspect ratio, construction type,  
and service description. See the Tire Size”  
illustration later in this section for more detail.  
Tire Sidewall Labeling  
Useful information about a tire is molded into its  
sidewall. The examples below show a typical  
passenger vehicle tire and a compact spare tire  
sidewall.  
(B) TPC Spec (Tire Performance Criteria  
Specification): Original equipment tires designed  
to GM's specific tire performance criteria have a  
TPC specification code molded onto the sidewall.  
GM's TPC specifications meet or exceed all  
federal safety guidelines.  
(C) DOT (Department of Transportation): The  
Department of Transportation (DOT) code  
indicates that the tire is in compliance with the  
U.S. Department of Transportation Motor Vehicle  
Safety Standards.  
Passenger (PMetric) Tire Example  
6-56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(D) Tire Identification Number (TIN): The letters  
and numbers following DOT (Department of  
Transportation) code is the Tire Identification  
Number (TIN). The TIN shows the manufacturer  
and plant code, tire size, and date the tire was  
manufactured. The TIN is molded onto both sides  
of the tire, although only one side may have the  
date of manufacture.  
(E) Tire Ply Material: The type of cord and  
number of plies in the sidewall and under the  
tread.  
(F) Uniform Tire Quality Grading (UTQG): Tire  
manufacturers are required to grade tires based  
on three performance factors: treadwear, traction,  
and temperature resistance. For more information  
see Uniform Tire Quality Grading on page 674  
.
Compact Spare Tire Example  
(G) Maximum Cold Inflation Load Limit:  
Maximum load that can be carried and the  
maximum pressure needed to support that load.  
(A) Temporary Use Only: The compact spare  
tire or temporary use tire has a tread life of  
approximately 3,000 miles (5 000 km) and should  
not be driven at speeds over 65 mph (105 km/h).  
The compact spare tire is for emergency use  
when a regular road tire has lost air and gone flat.  
If your vehicle has a compact spare tire, see  
Compact Spare Tire on page 6110 andIf a Tire  
Goes Flat on page 677  
.
6-57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(B) Tire Ply Material: The type of cord and  
number of plies in the sidewall and under the  
tread.  
(E) Tire Inflation: The temporary use tire or  
compact spare tire should be inflated to 60 psi  
(420 kPa). For more information on tire pressure  
and inflation see Inflation - Tire Pressure on  
(C) Tire Identification Number (TIN): The letters  
and numbers following the DOT (Department of  
Transportation) code is the Tire Identification  
Number (TIN). The TIN shows the manufacturer  
and plant code, tire size, and date the tire was  
manufactured. The TIN is molded onto both sides  
of the tire, although only one side may have the  
date of manufacture.  
page 663  
.
(F) Tire Size: A combination of letters and  
numbers define a tire's width, height, aspect ratio,  
construction type, and service description. The  
letter T as the first character in the tire size means  
the tire is for temporary use only.  
(G) TPC Spec (Tire Performance Criteria  
Specification): Original equipment tires designed  
to GM's specific tire performance criteria have a  
TPC specification code molded onto the sidewall.  
GM's TPC specifications meet or exceed all  
federal safety guidelines.  
(D) Maximum Cold Inflation Load Limit:  
Maximum load that can be carried and the  
maximum pressure needed to support that load.  
6-58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(C) Aspect Ratio: A twodigit number that  
indicates the tire heighttowidth measurements.  
For example, if the tire size aspect ratio is 60, as  
shown in item C of the illustration, it would mean  
that the tire's sidewall is 60 percent as high as it  
is wide.  
Tire Size  
The following illustration shows an example of a  
typical passenger vehicle tire size.  
(D) Construction Code: A letter code is used to  
indicate the type of ply construction in the tire.  
The letter R means radial ply construction; the  
letter D means diagonal or bias ply construction;  
and the letter B means beltedbias ply  
construction.  
(A) Passenger (PMetric) Tire: The United States  
version of a metric tire sizing system. The letter P  
as the first character in the tire size means a  
passenger vehicle tire engineered to standards  
set by the U.S. Tire and Rim Association.  
(E) Rim Diameter: Diameter of the wheel in  
inches.  
(F) Service Description: These characters  
represent the load index and speed rating of the  
tire. The load index represents the load carry  
capacity a tire is certified to carry. The speed  
rating is the maximum speed a tire is certified to  
carry a load.  
(B) Tire Width: The threedigit number indicates  
the tire section width in millimeters from sidewall  
to sidewall.  
6-59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Cold Tire Pressure: The amount of air pressure  
in a tire, measured in pounds per square inch (psi)  
or kilopascals (kPa) before a tire has built up heat  
from driving. See Inflation - Tire Pressure on  
Tire Terminology and Definitions  
Air Pressure: The amount of air inside the tire  
pressing outward on each square inch of the tire.  
Air pressure is expressed in pounds per square  
inch (psi) or kilopascal (kPa).  
page 663  
.
Curb Weight: The weight of a motor vehicle with  
standard and optional equipment including the  
maximum capacity of fuel, oil, and coolant, but  
without passengers and cargo.  
Accessory Weight: This means the combined  
weight of optional accessories. Some examples of  
optional accessories are, automatic transmission,  
power steering, power brakes, power windows,  
power seats, and air conditioning.  
DOT Markings: A code molded into the sidewall  
of a tire signifying that the tire is in compliance  
with the U.S. Department of Transportation (DOT)  
motor vehicle safety standards. The DOT code  
includes the Tire Identification Number (TIN), an  
alphanumeric designator which can also identify  
the tire manufacturer, production plant, brand, and  
date of production.  
Aspect Ratio: The relationship of a tire's height to  
its width.  
Belt: A rubber coated layer of cords that is  
located between the plies and the tread. Cords  
may be made from steel or other reinforcing  
materials.  
GVWR: Gross Vehicle Weight Rating. See  
Bead: The tire bead contains steel wires wrapped  
by steel cords that hold the tire onto the rim.  
Loading the Vehicle on page 524  
.
GAWR FRT: Gross Axle Weight Rating for the  
front axle. See Loading the Vehicle on page 524  
Bias Ply Tire: A pneumatic tire in which the plies  
are laid at alternate angles less than 90 degrees  
to the centerline of the tread.  
.
6-60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GAWR RR: Gross Axle Weight Rating for the rear  
axle. See Loading the Vehicle on page 524  
Maximum Loaded Vehicle Weight: The sum of  
curb weight, accessory weight, vehicle capacity  
weight, and production options weight.  
.
Intended Outboard Sidewall: The side of an  
asymmetrical tire, that must always face outward  
when mounted on a vehicle.  
Normal Occupant Weight: The number of  
occupants a vehicle is designed to seat multiplied  
by 150 lbs (68 kg). See Loading the Vehicle on  
Kilopascal (kPa): The metric unit for air pressure.  
page 524  
.
Light Truck (LTMetric) Tire: A tire used on light  
duty trucks and some multipurpose passenger  
vehicles.  
Occupant Distribution: Designated seating  
positions.  
Outward Facing Sidewall: The side of an  
asymmetrical tire that has a particular side that  
faces outward when mounted on a vehicle. The  
side of the tire that contains a whitewall, bears  
white lettering, or bears manufacturer, brand,  
and/or model name molding that is higher or  
deeper than the same moldings on the other  
sidewall of the tire.  
Load Index: An assigned number ranging from  
1 to 279 that corresponds to the load carrying  
capacity of a tire.  
Maximum Inflation Pressure: The maximum air  
pressure to which a cold tire can be inflated. The  
maximum air pressure is molded onto the  
sidewall.  
Maximum Load Rating: The load rating for a tire  
at the maximum permissible inflation pressure for  
that tire.  
Passenger (P-Metric) Tire: A tire used on  
passenger cars and some light duty trucks  
and multipurpose vehicles.  
6-61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recommended Inflation Pressure: Vehicle  
manufacturer's recommended tire inflation  
pressure as shown on the tire placard.  
UTQGS (Uniform Tire Quality Grading  
Standards): A tire information system that  
provides consumers with ratings for a tire's  
traction, temperature, and treadwear. Ratings  
are determined by tire manufacturers using  
government testing procedures. The ratings are  
molded into the sidewall of the tire. See Uniform  
See Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 663 and  
Loading the Vehicle on page 524  
.
Radial Ply Tire: A pneumatic tire in which the  
ply cords that extend to the beads are laid at  
90 degrees to the centerline of the tread.  
Tire Quality Grading on page 674  
.
Vehicle Capacity Weight: The number of  
designated seating positions multiplied by 150 lbs  
(68 kg) plus the rated cargo load. See Loading the  
Rim: A metal support for a tire and upon which  
the tire beads are seated.  
Sidewall: The portion of a tire between the tread  
and the bead.  
Vehicle on page 524  
.
Vehicle Maximum Load on the Tire: Load on an  
individual tire due to curb weight, accessory  
weight, occupant weight, and cargo weight.  
Speed Rating: An alphanumeric code assigned  
to a tire indicating the maximum speed at which a  
tire can operate.  
Vehicle Placard: A label permanently attached to  
a vehicle showing the vehicle's capacity weight  
and the original equipment tire size and  
Traction: The friction between the tire and the  
road surface. The amount of grip provided.  
recommended inflation pressure. See Tire and  
Loading Information Labelunder Loading the  
Tread: The portion of a tire that comes into  
contact with the road.  
Vehicle on page 524  
.
Treadwear Indicators: Narrow bands, sometimes  
called wear bars, that show across the tread of  
a tire when only 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) of tread  
remains. See When It Is Time for New Tires on  
page 671  
.
6-62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A vehicle specific Tire and Loading Information  
label is attached to your vehicle. This label shows  
your vehicle's original equipment tires and the  
correct inflation pressures for your tires when they  
are cold. The recommended cold tire inflation  
pressure, shown on the label, is the minimum  
amount of air pressure needed to support your  
vehicle's maximum load carrying capacity.  
Inflation - Tire Pressure  
Tires need the correct amount of air pressure to  
operate effectively.  
Notice: Do not let anyone tell you that under‐  
inflation or overinflation is all right. It is not.  
If your tires do not have enough air  
(underinflation), you can get the following:  
.
For additional information regarding how much  
weight your vehicle can carry, and an example of  
the Tire and Loading Information label, see  
Loading the Vehicle on page 524. How you load  
your vehicle affects vehicle handling and ride  
comfort. Never load your vehicle with more weight  
than it was designed to carry.  
Too much flexing  
.
Too much heat  
.
Tire overloading  
.
Premature or irregular wear  
.
Poor handling  
.
Reduced fuel economy  
When to Check  
If your tires have too much air (overinflation),  
you can get the following:  
Check your tires once a month or more. Do not  
forget to check the compact spare tire, it should  
be at 60 psi (420 kPa). For additional information  
regarding the compact spare tire, see Compact  
.
Unusual wear  
.
Poor handling  
Spare Tire on page 6110  
.
.
Rough ride  
.
Needless damage from road hazards  
6-63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
How to Check  
Tire Pressure Monitor System  
Use a good quality pocket-type gauge to check  
tire pressure. You cannot tell if your tires are  
properly inflated simply by looking at them.  
Radial tires may look properly inflated even  
when they are underinflated. Check the tire's  
inflation pressure when the tires are cold.  
Cold means your vehicle has been sitting for  
at least three hours or driven no more than  
1 mile (1.6 km).  
The Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS) uses radio  
and sensor technology to check tire pressure levels.  
The TPMS sensors monitor the air pressure in your  
vehicle's tires and transmit tire pressure readings to a  
receiver located in the vehicle.  
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be  
checked monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation  
pressure recommended by the vehicle manufacturer  
on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label.  
(If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size  
indicated on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure  
label, you should determine the proper tire inflation  
pressure for those tires.)  
Remove the valve cap from the tire valve stem.  
Press the tire gauge firmly onto the valve to get a  
pressure measurement. If the cold tire inflation  
pressure matches the recommended pressure on  
the Tire and Loading Information label, no further  
adjustment is necessary. If the inflation pressure  
is low, add air until you reach the recommended  
amount.  
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been  
equipped with a tire pressure monitoring system  
(TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure telltale when  
one or more of your tires is significantly underinflated.  
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale  
illuminates, you should stop and check your tires as  
soon as possible, and inflate them to the proper  
pressure. Driving on a significantly underinflated tire  
causes the tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure.  
Underinflation also reduces fuel efficiency and tire  
tread life, and may affect the vehicle's handling and  
stopping ability.  
If you overfill the tire, release air by pushing on  
the metal stem in the center of the tire valve.  
Recheck the tire pressure with the tire gauge.  
Be sure to put the valve caps back on the valve  
stems. They help prevent leaks by keeping out dirt  
and moisture.  
6-64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper  
tire maintenance, and it is the driver's responsibility to  
maintain correct tire pressure, even if underinflation  
has not reached the level to trigger illumination of the  
TPMS low tire pressure telltale.  
Federal Communications Commission  
(FCC) and Industry Canada  
See Radio Frequency Statement on page 817 for  
information regarding Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) Rules and  
RSS-210/211 of Industry Canada.  
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS  
malfunction indicator to indicate when the system is  
not operating properly. The TPMS malfunction indicator  
is combined with the low tire pressure telltale. When  
the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash  
for approximately one minute and then remain  
continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue  
upon subsequent vehicle startups as long as the  
malfunction exists.  
Tire Pressure Monitor Operation  
This vehicle may have a Tire Pressure Monitor System  
(TPMS). The TPMS is designed to warn the driver when  
a low tire pressure condition exists. If your vehicle has  
this feature, TPMS sensors are mounted onto each tire  
and wheel assembly, excluding the spare tire and wheel  
assembly. The TPMS sensors monitor the air pressure  
in the vehicle's tires and transmits the tire pressure  
readings to a receiver located in the vehicle.  
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the  
system may not be able to detect or signal low tire  
pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions may occur  
for a variety of reasons, including the installation of  
replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the  
vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning  
properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale  
after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your  
vehicle to ensure that the replacement or alternate tires  
and wheels allow the TPMS to continue to function  
properly.  
When a low tire pressure  
condition is detected, the  
TPMS turns on the low  
tire pressure warning light  
located on the instrument  
panel cluster.  
See Tire Pressure Monitor Operation on page 665 for  
additional information.  
6-65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A Tire and Loading Information label shows the size of  
your vehicle's original equipment tires and the correct  
inflation pressure for your vehicle's tires when they are  
cold. See Loading the Vehicle on page 524, for an  
example of the Tire and Loading Information label and  
its location on your vehicle. Also see Inflation - Tire  
Pressure on page 663.  
If the warning light comes on, stop as soon as possible  
and inflate the tires to the recommended pressure  
shown on the tire loading information label. See  
Loading the Vehicle on page 524.  
At the same time a message to check the pressure in a  
specific tire appears on the Driver Information Center  
(DIC) display. The low tire pressure warning light and  
the DIC warning message come on at each ignition  
cycle until the tires are inflated to the correct inflation  
pressure. Using the DIC, tire pressure levels can be  
viewed by the driver. For additional information and  
details about the DIC operation and displays see DIC  
Operation and Displays on page 446 and DIC  
Warnings and Messages on page 448.  
Your vehicle's TPMS system can warn you about a low  
tire pressure condition but it does not replace normal  
tire maintenance. See Tire Inspection and Rotation on  
page 669 and Tires on page 654.  
Notice: Using nonapproved tire sealants could  
damage the Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS)  
sensors. TPMS sensor damage caused by using an  
incorrect tire sealant is not covered by the vehicle  
warranty. Always use the GM approved tire sealant  
available through your dealer/retailer.  
The low tire pressure warning light may come on in cool  
weather when the vehicle is first started, and then turn  
off as you start to drive. This could be an early indicator  
that the air pressure in the tire(s) are getting low and  
need to be inflated to the proper pressure.  
Factory-installed Tire Inflator Kits use a GM approved  
liquid tire sealant. Using non-approved tire sealants  
could damage the TPMS sensors. See Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit on page 678 for information regarding  
the inflator kit materials and instructions.  
6-66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
.
One or more TPMS sensors are missing or  
damaged. The DIC message and the TPMS  
malfunction light should go off when the TPMS  
sensors are installed and the sensor matching  
process is performed successfully. See your  
dealer/retailer for service.  
TPMS Malfunction Light and Message  
The TPMS will not function properly if one or more of  
the TPMS sensors are missing or inoperable. When the  
system detects a malfunction, the low tire warning light  
flashes for about one minute and then stays on for the  
remainder of the ignition cycle. A DIC warning message  
is also displayed. The low tire warning light and DIC  
warning message come on at each ignition cycle until  
the problem is corrected. Some of the conditions that  
can cause the malfunction light and DIC message to  
come on are:  
Replacement tires or wheels do not match your  
vehicle's original equipment tires or wheels. Tires  
and wheels other than those recommended for  
your vehicle could prevent the TPMS from  
functioning properly. See Buying New Tires on  
page 672  
.
.
One of the road tires has been replaced with the  
Operating electronic devices or being near facilities  
using radio wave frequencies similar to the TPMS  
could cause the TPMS sensors to malfunction.  
spare tire. The spare tire does not have a TPMS  
sensor. The TPMS malfunction light and DIC  
message should go off once you reinstall the  
road tire containing the TPMS sensor.  
If the TPMS is not functioning it cannot detect or signal  
a low tire condition. See your dealer/retailer for service  
if the TPMS malfunction light and DIC message comes  
on and stays on.  
.
The TPMS sensor matching process was started  
but not completed or not completed successfully  
after rotating the vehicle's tires. The DIC message  
and TPMS malfunction light should go off once the  
TPMS sensor matching process is performed  
successfully. See TPMS Sensor Matching  
Processlater in this section.  
6-67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
3. Press and hold the Remote Keyless Entry (RKE)  
transmitter's LOCK and UNLOCK buttons, at the  
same time, for about five seconds to start the  
TPMS learn mode. The horn sounds twice  
indicating the TPMS receiver is ready and in  
learn mode.  
TPMS Sensor Matching Process  
Each TPMS sensor has a unique identification code.  
Any time you replace one or more of the TPMS sensors  
or rotate the vehicle's tires, the identification codes  
need to be matched to the new tire/wheel location. The  
sensors are matched, to the tire/wheel locations, in the  
following order: driver side front tire, passenger side  
front tire, passenger side rear tire, and driver side rear  
tire using a TPMS diagnostic tool. See your dealer/  
retailer for service.  
4. Start with the driver side front tire. The driver side  
front turn signal also comes on to indicate that  
corner's sensor is ready to be learned.  
5. Remove the valve cap from the tire's valve stem.  
Activate the TPMS sensor by increasing or  
decreasing the tire's air pressure for about  
eight seconds. The horn chirp, can take up to  
30 seconds to sound. It chirps one time and then  
all the turn signals flash one time to confirm the  
sensor identification code has been matched to the  
tire/wheel position.  
The TPMS sensors can also be matched to each  
tire/wheel position by increasing or decreasing the tire's  
air pressure. When increasing the tire's pressure, do not  
exceed the maximum inflation pressure indicated on the  
tire's sidewall. To decrease the tire's air-pressure use  
the pointed end of the valve cap, a pencil-style air  
pressure gauge, or a key.  
6. The passenger side front turn signal comes on to  
indicate that corner sensor is ready to be learned.  
Proceed to the passenger side front tire and repeat  
the procedure in Step 5.  
You have two minutes to match each tire and wheel  
position. If it takes longer than two minutes to match  
any tire and wheel position, the matching process stops  
and you need to start over.  
7. The passenger side rear turn signal comes on to  
indicate that corner sensor is ready to be learned.  
Proceed to the passenger side rear tire and repeat  
the procedure in Step 5.  
The TPMS matching process is outlined below:  
1. Set the parking brake.  
2. Turn the ignition switch to ON/RUN with the  
engine off.  
6-68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8. The driver side rear turn signal comes on to  
indicate that corner sensor is ready to be learned.  
Proceed to the driver side rear tire, and repeat the  
procedure in Step 5.  
Tire Inspection and Rotation  
We recommend that you regularly inspect your  
vehicle's tires, including the spare tire, for signs of  
wear or damage. See When It Is Time for New  
Tires on page 671 for more information.  
9. After hearing the single horn chirp for the driver  
side rear tire, two additional horn chirps sound to  
indicate the tire learning process is done. Turn the  
ignition switch to LOCK/OFF.  
Tires should be rotated every 5,000 to 8,000 miles  
(8 000 to 13 000 km). See Scheduled Maintenance  
If no tires are learned after entering the TPMS  
learn mode, or if communication with the receiver  
stops, or if the time limit has expired, turn the  
ignition switch to LOCK/OFF and start over  
beginning with Step 2.  
on page 73  
.
The purpose of a regular tire rotation is to achieve  
a uniform wear for all tires on the vehicle. This will  
ensure that your vehicle continues to perform  
most like it did when the tires were new.  
10. Set all four tires to the recommended air pressure  
level as indicated on the Tire and Loading  
Information label.  
Any time you notice unusual wear, rotate the tires  
as soon as possible and check wheel alignment.  
Also check for damaged tires or wheels.  
11. Put the valve caps back on the valve stems.  
SeeWhen It Is Time for New Tires on page 671  
and Wheel Replacement on page 676  
.
6-69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Reset the Tire Pressure Monitor System. See Tire  
Pressure Monitor Operation on page 665  
.
Make certain that all wheel nuts are properly  
tightened. See Wheel Nut Torqueunder  
Capacities and Specifications on page 6125  
.
WARNING:  
{
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to  
which it is fastened, can make wheel nuts  
become loose after time. The wheel could  
come off and cause an accident. When you  
change a wheel, remove any rust or dirt from  
places where the wheel attaches to the  
vehicle. In an emergency, you can use a  
cloth or a paper towel to do this; but be sure  
to use a scraper or wire brush later,  
When rotating the vehicle's tires, always use the  
correct rotation pattern shown here.  
Do not include the compact spare tire in the tire  
rotation.  
After the tires have been rotated, adjust the front  
and rear inflation pressures as shown on the Tire  
and Loading Information label. See Inflation - Tire  
Pressure on page 663 and Loading the Vehicle on  
if needed, to get all the rust or dirt off.  
See Changing a Flat Tire on page 688  
.
page 524  
.
6-70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
When It Is Time for New Tires  
Various factors, such as maintenance, temperatures,  
driving speeds, vehicle loading, and road conditions  
influence when you need new tires.  
You need new tires if any of the following statements  
are true:  
.
You can see the indicators at three or more places  
around the tire.  
.
You can see cord or fabric showing through the  
tire's rubber.  
One way to tell when it is  
time for new tires is to  
check the treadwear  
indicators, which will  
appear when your tires  
have only 1/16 inch  
(1.6 mm) or less of tread  
remaining.  
.
The tread or sidewall is cracked, cut, or snagged  
deep enough to show cord or fabric.  
.
The tire has a bump, bulge, or split.  
.
The tire has a puncture, cut, or other damage that  
cannot be repaired well because of the size or  
location of the damage.  
The rubber in tires degrades over time, even if they are  
not being used. This is also true for the spare tire,  
if your vehicle has one. Multiple conditions affect how  
fast this aging takes place, including temperatures,  
loading conditions, and inflation pressure maintenance.  
With proper care and maintenance tires will typically  
wear out before they degrade due to age. If you are  
unsure about the need to replace your tires as they get  
older, consult the tire manufacturer for more information.  
6-71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
GM recommends replacing tires in sets of four.  
This is because uniform tread depth on all tires  
will help keep your vehicle performing most like it  
did when the tires were new. Replacing less than  
a full set of tires can affect the braking and  
handling performance of your vehicle. See Tire  
Inspection and Rotation on page 669 for  
Buying New Tires  
GM has developed and matched specific tires for  
your vehicle. The original equipment tires installed  
on your vehicle, when it was new, were designed  
to meet General Motors Tire Performance Criteria  
Specification (TPC Spec) system rating. If you  
need replacement tires, GM strongly recommends  
that you get tires with the same TPC Spec rating.  
This way, your vehicle will continue to have tires  
that are designed to give the same performance  
and vehicle safety, during normal use, as the  
original tires.  
information on proper tire rotation.  
WARNING:  
{
Mixing tires could cause you to lose  
control while driving. If you mix tires of  
different sizes, brands, or types (radial and  
bias-belted tires), the vehicle may not handle  
properly, and you could have a crash. Using  
tires of different sizes, brands, or types may  
also cause damage to your vehicle. Be sure  
to use the correct size, brand, and type of  
tires on all wheels. It is all right to drive with  
your compact spare temporarily, as it was  
developed for use on your vehicle. See  
GM's exclusive TPC Spec system considers over  
a dozen critical specifications that impact the  
overall performance of your vehicle, including  
brake system performance, ride and handling,  
traction control, and tire pressure monitoring  
performance. GM's TPC Spec number is molded  
onto the tire's sidewall near the tire size. If the  
tires have an allseason tread design, the TPC  
Spec number will be followed by an MS for mud  
and snow. See Tire Sidewall Labeling on  
Compact Spare Tire on page 6110  
.
page 656 for additional information.  
6-72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicles that have a tire pressure monitoring  
system could give an inaccurate lowpressure  
warning if nonTPC Spec rated tires are installed  
on your vehicle. NonTPC Spec rated tires may  
give a lowpressure warning that is higher or lower  
than the proper warning level you would get with  
TPC Spec rated tires. See Tire Pressure Monitor  
WARNING:  
{
If you use bias-ply tires on the vehicle, the  
wheel rim flanges could develop cracks after  
many miles of driving. A tire and/or wheel  
could fail suddenly, causing a crash. Use  
only radial-ply tires with the wheels on the  
vehicle.  
System on page 664  
.
Your vehicle's original equipment tires are listed  
on the Tire and Loading Information Label. See  
Loading the Vehicle on page 524, for more  
information about the Tire and Loading  
If you must replace your vehicle's tires with those  
that do not have a TPC Spec number, make sure  
they are the same size, load range, speed rating,  
and construction type (radial and biasbelted tires)  
as your vehicle's original tires.  
Information Label and its location on your vehicle.  
6-73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Different Size Tires and Wheels  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading  
If you add wheels or tires that are a different size than  
your original equipment wheels and tires, this could  
affect the way your vehicle performs, including its  
braking, ride and handling characteristics, stability, and  
resistance to rollover. Additionally, if your vehicle has  
electronic systems such as antilock brakes, rollover  
airbags, traction control, and electronic stability control,  
the performance of these systems can be affected.  
Quality grades can be found where applicable on  
the tire sidewall between tread shoulder and  
maximum section width. For example:  
Treadwear 200 Traction AA  
Temperature A  
The following information relates to the system  
developed by the United States National Highway  
Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA), which  
grades tires by treadwear, traction, and  
WARNING:  
{
temperature performance. This applies only to  
vehicles sold in the United States. The grades are  
molded on the sidewalls of most passenger car  
tires. The Uniform Tire Quality Grading (UTQG)  
system does not apply to deep tread, winter-type  
snow tires, space-saver, or temporary use spare  
tires, tires with nominal rim diameters of  
If you add different sized wheels, your vehicle  
may not provide an acceptable level of  
performance and safety if tires not recommended  
for those wheels are selected. You may increase  
the chance that you will crash and suffer serious  
injury. Only use GM specific wheel and tire  
systems developed for your vehicle, and have  
them properly installed by a GM certified  
technician.  
10 to 12 inches (25 to 30 cm), or to some  
limited-production tires.  
While the tires available on General Motors  
passenger cars and light trucks may vary with  
respect to these grades, they must also conform  
to federal safety requirements and additional  
General Motors Tire Performance Criteria (TPC)  
standards.  
See Buying New Tires on page 672 and Accessories  
and Modifications on page 63 for additional  
information.  
6-74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
All Passenger Car Tires Must Conform to  
Federal Safety Requirements In Addition To  
These Grades.  
braking traction tests, and does not include  
acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning, or peak  
traction characteristics.  
Treadwear  
Temperature A, B, C  
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating  
based on the wear rate of the tire when tested  
under controlled conditions on a specified  
government test course. For example, a tire  
graded 150 would wear one and a half (1½) times  
as well on the government course as a tire  
graded 100. The relative performance of tires  
depends upon the actual conditions of their use,  
however, and may depart significantly from the  
norm due to variations in driving habits, service  
practices and differences in road characteristics  
and climate.  
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B,  
and C, representing the tire's resistance to the  
generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat  
when tested under controlled conditions on a  
specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained  
high temperature can cause the material of the  
tire to degenerate and reduce tire life, and  
excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire  
failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of  
performance which all passenger car tires must  
meet under the Federal Motor Safety Standard  
No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels  
of performance on the laboratory test wheel than  
the minimum required by law. Warning: The  
temperature grade for this tire is established for a  
tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded.  
Excessive speed, underinflation, or excessive  
loading, either separately or in combination, can  
cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.  
Traction AA, A, B, C  
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are  
AA, A, B, and C. Those grades represent the  
tire's ability to stop on wet pavement as measured  
under controlled conditions on specified  
government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete.  
A tire marked C may have poor traction  
performance. Warning: The traction grade  
assigned to this tire is based on straight-ahead  
6-75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you need to replace any of your wheels, wheel bolts,  
wheel nuts, or Tire Pressure Monitor System (TPMS)  
sensors, replace them only with new GM original  
equipment parts. This way, you will be sure to have the  
right wheel, wheel bolts, wheel nuts, and TPMS sensors  
for your vehicle.  
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance  
The tires and wheels on your vehicle were aligned and  
balanced carefully at the factory to give you the longest  
tire life and best overall performance. Adjustments  
to wheel alignment and tire balancing will not be  
necessary on a regular basis. However, if you notice  
unusual tire wear or your vehicle pulling to one side or  
the other, the alignment might need to be checked.  
If you notice your vehicle vibrating when driving on a  
smooth road, the tires and wheels might need to be  
rebalanced. See your dealer/retailer for proper  
diagnosis.  
WARNING:  
{
Using the wrong replacement wheels, wheel bolts,  
or wheel nuts on your vehicle can be dangerous.  
It could affect the braking and handling of your  
vehicle, make your tires lose air and make you  
lose control. You could have a collision in which  
you or others could be injured. Always use the  
correct wheel, wheel bolts, and wheel nuts for  
replacement.  
Wheel Replacement  
Replace any wheel that is bent, cracked, or badly  
rusted or corroded. If wheel nuts keep coming loose,  
the wheel, wheel bolts, and wheel nuts should be  
replaced. If the wheel leaks air, replace it (except some  
aluminum wheels, which can sometimes be repaired).  
See your dealer/retailer if any of these conditions exist.  
Notice: The wrong wheel can also cause problems  
with bearing life, brake cooling, speedometer or  
odometer calibration, headlamp aim, bumper height,  
vehicle ground clearance, and tire or tire chain  
clearance to the body and chassis.  
Your dealer/retailer will know the kind of wheel  
you need.  
Each new wheel should have the same load-carrying  
capacity, diameter, width, offset, and be mounted the  
same way as the one it replaces.  
See Changing a Flat Tire on page 688 for more  
information.  
6-76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Used Replacement Wheels  
WARNING: (Continued)  
WARNING:  
{
Use another type of traction device only if its  
manufacturer recommends it for use on the  
vehicle and tire size combination and road  
conditions. Follow that manufacturer's  
instructions. To help avoid damage to the vehicle,  
drive slowly, readjust or remove the device if it is  
contacting the vehicle, and do not spin the  
vehicle's wheels. If you do find traction devices  
that will fit, install them on the front tires.  
Putting a used wheel on the vehicle is dangerous.  
You cannot know how it has been used or how far  
it has been driven. It could fail suddenly and  
cause a crash. If you have to replace a wheel, use  
a new GM original equipment wheel.  
Tire Chains  
If a Tire Goes Flat  
WARNING:  
{
It is unusual for a tire to blowout while you are driving,  
especially if you maintain your vehicle's tires properly.  
If air goes out of a tire, it is much more likely to leak out  
slowly. But if you should ever have a blowout, here are  
a few tips about what to expect and what to do:  
Do not use tire chains. There is not enough  
clearance. Tire chains used on a vehicle without  
the proper amount of clearance can cause  
damage to the brakes, suspension or other  
vehicle parts. The area damaged by the tire  
chains could cause you to lose control of the  
vehicle and you or others may be injured in a  
crash.  
If a front tire fails, the flat tire creates a drag that pulls  
the vehicle toward that side. Take your foot off the  
accelerator pedal and grip the steering wheel firmly.  
Steer to maintain lane position, and then gently brake  
to a stop well out of the traffic lane.  
(Continued)  
6-77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
A rear blowout, particularly on a curve, acts much like a  
skid and may require the same correction you would  
use in a skid. In any rear blowout remove your foot from  
the accelerator pedal. Get the vehicle under control by  
steering the way you want the vehicle to go. It may be  
very bumpy and noisy, but you can still steer. Gently  
brake to a stop, well off the road if possible.  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit  
WARNING:  
{
Idling a vehicle in an enclosed area with poor  
ventilation is dangerous. Engine exhaust may  
enter the vehicle. Engine exhaust contains  
Carbon Monoxide (CO) which cannot be seen or  
smelled. It can cause unconsciousness and even  
death. Never run the engine in an enclosed area  
that has no fresh air ventilation. For more  
WARNING:  
{
Lifting a vehicle and getting under it to do  
maintenance or repairs is dangerous without the  
appropriate safety equipment and training. If a  
jack is provided with the vehicle, it is designed  
only for changing a flat tire. If it is used for  
anything else, you or others could be badly  
injured or killed if the vehicle slips off the jack.  
If a jack is provided with the vehicle, only use it  
for changing a flat tire.  
information, see Engine Exhaust on page 339.  
WARNING:  
{
Over-inflating a tire could cause the tire to rupture  
and you or others could be injured. Be sure to  
read and follow the tire sealant and compressor  
kit instructions and inflate the tire to its  
recommended pressure. Do not exceed the  
recommended pressure.  
This vehicle may come with a jack and spare tire or a  
tire sealant and compressor kit. To use the jack and  
spare tire, follow the instructions below. To use the tire  
sealant and compressor kit, see Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit on page 678  
.
6-78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Read and follow all of the tire sealant and compressor  
kit instructions.  
WARNING:  
{
The kit includes:  
Storing the tire sealant and compressor kit or  
other equipment in the passenger compartment of  
the vehicle could cause injury. In a sudden stop or  
collision, loose equipment could strike someone.  
Store the tire sealant and compressor kit in its  
original location.  
If this vehicle has a tire sealant and compressor kit,  
there may not be a spare tire, tire changing equipment,  
and on some vehicles there may not be a place to store  
a tire.  
The tire sealant and compressor can be used to  
temporarily seal punctures up to ¼ inch (6 mm) in the  
tread area of the tire. It can also be used to inflate an  
under inflated tire.  
A. On/Off Button  
D. Pressure Gauge  
If the tire has been separated from the wheel, has  
damaged sidewalls, or has a large puncture, the  
tire is too severely damaged for the tire sealant and  
compressor kit to be effective. See Roadside  
Assistance Program on page 86.  
B. Selector Switch  
(Sealant/Air  
E. Air Only Hose  
(Black)  
or Air Only)  
F. Sealant/Air Hose  
(Clear)  
C. Pressure Relief  
Button  
G. Power Plug  
6-79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tire Sealant  
Read and follow the safe handling instructions on the  
label adhered to the compressor.  
Using the Tire Sealant and Compressor  
Kit to Temporarily Seal and Inflate a  
Punctured Tire  
Check the tire sealant expiration date on the sealant  
canister. The sealant canister should be replaced before  
its expiration date. Replacement sealant canisters are  
available at your local dealer/retailer. See Removal and  
Installation of the Sealant Canisterfollowing.  
Follow the directions closely for correct sealant usage.  
There is only enough sealant to seal one tire. After  
usage, the sealant canister and sealant/air hose  
assembly must be replaced. See Removal and  
Installation of the Sealant Canisterfollowing.  
When using the tire sealant and compressor kit  
during cold temperatures, warm the kit in a heated  
environment for 5 minutes. This will help to inflate  
the tire faster.  
6-80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Always do a safety check first. See If a Tire Goes Flat  
on page 677. Do not remove any objects that have  
penetrated the tire.  
6. Plug the power plug (G) into the accessory power  
outlet in the vehicle. Unplug all items from other  
accessory power outlets. See Accessory Power  
Outlet(s) on page 416.  
1. Remove the tire sealant and compressor kit from  
its storage location. See Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit Storage on page 687.  
If the vehicle has an accessory power outlet, do  
not use the cigarette lighter.  
2. Unwrap the sealant/air hose (F) and the power  
plug (G).  
If the vehicle only has a cigarette lighter, use the  
cigarette lighter.  
3. Place the kit on the ground.  
Do not pinch the power plug cord in the door or  
window.  
Make sure the tire valve stem is positioned close  
to the ground so the hose will reach it.  
7. Start the vehicle. The vehicle must be running  
while using the air compressor.  
4. Remove the valve stem cap from the flat tire by  
turning it counterclockwise.  
8. Turn the selector switch (B) clockwise to the  
Sealant + Air position.  
5. Attach the sealant/air hose (F) onto the tire valve  
stem. Turn it clockwise until it is tight.  
6-81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9. Press the on/off (A) button to turn the tire sealant  
and compressor kit on.  
Notice: If the recommended pressure cannot be  
reached after approximately 25 minutes, the vehicle  
should not be driven farther. The tire is too severely  
damaged and the tire sealant and compressor kit  
cannot inflate the tire. Remove the power plug from  
the accessory power outlet and unscrew the  
inflating hose from the tire valve. See Roadside  
Assistance Program on page 86.  
The compressor will inject sealant and air into  
the tire.  
The pressure gauge (D) will initially show a high  
pressure while the compressor pushes the sealant  
into the tire. Once the sealant is completely  
dispersed into the tire, the pressure will quickly  
drop and start to rise again as the tire inflates  
with air only.  
11. Press the on/off button (A) to turn the tire sealant  
and compressor kit off.  
The tire is not sealed and will continue to leak air  
until the vehicle is driven and the sealant is  
distributed in the tire, therefore, Steps 12 through  
18 must be done immediately after Step 11.  
10. Inflate the tire to the recommended inflation  
pressure using the pressure gauge (D). The  
recommended inflation pressure can be found on  
the Tire and Loading Information label. See  
Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 663.  
Be careful while handling the tire sealant and  
compressor kit as it could be warm after usage.  
The pressure gauge (D) may read higher than the  
actual tire pressure while the compressor is on.  
Turn the compressor off to get an accurate  
pressure reading. The compressor may be  
turned on/off until the correct pressure is reached.  
12. Unplug the power plug (G) from the accessory  
power outlet in the vehicle.  
13. Turn the sealant/air hose (F) counterclockwise to  
remove it from the tire valve stem.  
6-82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
14. Replace the tire valve stem cap.  
If the tire pressure has fallen more than  
10 psi (68 kPa) below the recommended inflation  
pressure, stop driving the vehicle. The tire is too  
severely damaged and the tire sealant cannot seal  
the tire. See Roadside Assistance Program on  
15. Replace the sealant/air hose (F), and the power  
plug (G) back in their original location.  
16. If the flat tire was  
able to inflate to the  
recommended inflation  
pressure, remove the  
maximum speed label  
from the sealant  
page 86  
.
If the tire pressure has not dropped more than  
10 psi (68 kPa) from the recommended inflation  
pressure, inflate the tire to the recommended  
inflation pressure.  
canister and place it  
in a highly visible  
20. Wipe off any sealant from the wheel, tire, and  
vehicle.  
location. The label is a  
reminder not to exceed  
55 mph (90 km/h) until  
the damaged tire is  
repaired or replaced.  
21. Dispose of the used sealant canister and sealant/  
air hose (F) assembly at a local dealer/retailer or in  
accordance with local state codes and practices.  
22. Replace it with a new canister available from your  
dealer/retailer.  
17. Return the equipment to its original storage  
location in the vehicle.  
23. After temporarily sealing a tire using the tire  
sealant and compressor kit, take the vehicle to  
an authorized dealer/retailer within a 100 miles  
(161 km) of driving to have the tire repaired or  
replaced.  
18. Immediately drive the vehicle 5 miles (8 km) to  
distribute the sealant in the tire.  
19. Stop at a safe location and check the tire pressure.  
Refer to Steps 1 through 11 under Using the Tire  
Sealant and Compressor Kit without Sealant to  
Inflate a Tire (Not Punctured).”  
6-83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2. Unwrap the air only hose (E) and the power  
plug (G).  
Using the Tire Sealant and Compressor  
Kit without Sealant to Inflate a Tire  
(Not Punctured)  
To use the air compressor to inflate a tire with air only  
and not sealant:  
3. Place the kit on the ground.  
Make sure the tire valve stem is positioned close to  
the ground so the hose will reach it.  
4. Remove the tire valve stem cap from the flat tire by  
turning it counterclockwise.  
5. Attach the air only hose (E) onto the tire valve  
stem by turning it clockwise until it is tight.  
6. Plug the power plug (G) into the accessory power  
outlet in the vehicle. Unplug all items from other  
accessory power outlets. See Accessory Power  
Outlet(s) on page 416.  
If the vehicle has an accessory power outlet, do  
not use the cigarette lighter.  
If the vehicle only has a cigarette lighter, use the  
cigarette lighter.  
Do not pinch the power plug cord in the door or  
window.  
Always do a safety check first. See If a Tire Goes Flat  
on page 677  
.
1. Remove the tire sealant and compressor kit  
from its storage location. See Tire Sealant and  
Compressor Kit Storage on page 687.  
6-84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Start the vehicle. The vehicle must be running  
while using the air compressor.  
11. Press the on/off button (A) to turn the tire sealant  
and compressor kit off.  
8. Turn the selector switch (B) counterclockwise to  
the Air Only position.  
Be careful while handling the tire sealant and  
compressor kit as it could be warm after usage.  
9. Press the on/off (A) button to turn the  
compressor on.  
12. Unplug the power plug (G) from the accessory  
power outlet in the vehicle.  
The compressor will inflate the tire with air only.  
13. Disconnect the air only hose (E) from the tire valve  
stem, by turning it counterclockwise, and replace  
the tire valve stem cap.  
10. Inflate the tire to the recommended inflation  
pressure using the pressure gauge (D). The  
recommended inflation pressure can be found  
on the Tire and Loading Information label. See  
Inflation - Tire Pressure on page 663.  
14. Replace the air only hose (E) and the power  
plug (G) and cord back in its original location.  
15. Place the equipment in the original storage location  
in the vehicle.  
The pressure gauge (D) may read higher than the  
actual tire pressure while the compressor is on.  
Turn the compressor off to get an accurate  
reading. The compressor may be turned on/off  
until the correct pressure is reached.  
6-85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
4. Replace with a new canister which is available  
from your dealer/retailer.  
Removal and Installation of the Sealant  
Canister  
5. Push the new canister into place.  
6. Screw the connector (B) to the canister (A).  
7. Slide the plastic cover back on.  
To remove the sealant canister:  
1. Remove the plastic cover.  
2. Unscrew the connector (B) from the canister (A).  
3. Pull up on the canister (A) to remove it.  
6-86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit  
Storage  
The tire sealant and compressor kit is located in the  
rear compartment storage area.  
1. Open the liftgate. See Liftgate on page 313.  
2. Lift the storage cover.  
3. Turn the retainer clockwise and remove the tire  
sealant and compressor kit.  
To store the tire sealant and compressor kit, reverse the  
steps.  
6-87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Changing a Flat Tire  
If a tire goes flat, avoid further tire and wheel damage  
by driving slowly to a level place. Turn on the hazard  
warning flashers. See Hazard Warning Flashers on  
WARNING: (Continued)  
3. Turn off the engine and do not restart while  
the vehicle is raised.  
page 43  
.
4. Do not allow passengers to remain in the  
vehicle.  
WARNING:  
{
To be even more certain the vehicle will not move,  
you should put blocks at the front and rear of the  
tire farthest away from the one being changed.  
That would be the tire on the other side, at the  
opposite end of the vehicle.  
Changing a tire can be dangerous. The vehicle  
can slip off the jack and roll over or fall on you or  
other people. You and they could be badly injured  
or even killed. Find a level place to change your  
tire. To help prevent the vehicle from moving:  
When the vehicle has a flat tire (B), use the following  
example as a guide to assist you in the placement of  
wheel blocks (A).  
1. Set the parking brake firmly.  
2. Put an automatic transmission shift lever in  
P (Park), or shift a manual transmission to  
1 (First) or R (Reverse).  
(Continued)  
6-88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools  
The jack, wheel wrench, and spare tire are stowed in  
the rear of the vehicle, underneath the floor of the cargo  
area. To remove the spare tire and tools:  
1. Open the liftgate. See Liftgate on page 313 for  
more information.  
A. Wheel Block  
B. Flat Tire  
The following information explains how to use the jack  
and change a tire.  
2. Remove the cargo cover.  
6-89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Remove the spare tire by placing your hands at the  
four and eight o'clock positions. Gently pull it up  
and out of the trunk. See Compact Spare Tire on  
page 6110  
.
6. Remove the wing nut that holds the jack. Then  
remove the jack, wheel wrench, and flat tire strap.  
3. Turn the retainer counterclockwise to remove the  
tire cover.  
4. Remove the tire cover.  
The tools needed are the jack (A) and wheel wrench (B).  
6-90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Turn the plastic wheel nut counterclockwise to loosen  
the wheel wrench from the jack.  
Press the button and then pull on the end of the wheel  
wrench to extend the handle.  
6-91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Removing the Flat Tire and  
Installing the Spare Tire  
(All Models Except SS)  
1. Do a safety check before proceeding. See  
Changing a Flat Tire on page 688 for more  
information.  
3. Position the jack and raise the jack lift head to fit  
over the car flange under the down arrow markings  
on the rocker panel.  
2. Using the wheel wrench, loosen all the wheel nuts.  
Do not remove them yet.  
6-92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Getting under a vehicle when it is jacked up is  
dangerous. If the vehicle slips off the jack, you  
could be badly injured or killed. Never get under a  
vehicle when it is supported only by a jack.  
WARNING:  
{
Raising your vehicle with the jack improperly  
positioned can damage the vehicle and even  
make the vehicle fall. To help avoid personal  
injury and vehicle damage, be sure to fit the jack  
lift head into the proper location before raising the  
vehicle.  
4. Raise the vehicle by turning the jack handle  
clockwise. Raise the vehicle far enough off the  
ground so there is enough room for the compact  
spare tire to fit underneath the wheel well.  
6-93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Remove all the wheel  
nuts and take off the  
flat tire.  
WARNING:  
{
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to which it  
is fastened, can make wheel nuts become loose  
after time. The wheel could come off and cause  
an accident. When changing a wheel, remove any  
rust or dirt from places where the wheel attaches  
to the vehicle. In an emergency, use a cloth or a  
paper towel to do this; but be sure to use a  
scraper or wire brush later, if needed, to get all the  
rust or dirt off. See Changing a Flat Tire on  
page 688  
.
6-94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
8. Reinstall the wheel nuts with the rounded end of  
the nuts toward the wheel. Tighten each nut by  
hand until the wheel is held against the hub.  
6. Remove any rust or dirt  
from the wheel bolts,  
mounting surfaces and  
spare wheel.  
7. Place the compact spare tire on the  
wheel-mounting surface.  
WARNING:  
{
Never use oil or grease on bolts or nuts because  
the nuts might come loose. The vehicle's wheel  
could fall off, causing a crash.  
9. Lower the vehicle by turning the jack handle  
counterclockwise. Lower the jack completely.  
6-95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
10. Tighten the wheel nuts  
firmly in a crisscross  
WARNING:  
{
sequence as shown.  
Wheel nuts that are improperly or incorrectly  
tightened can cause the wheels to become loose  
or come off. The wheel nuts should be tightened  
with a torque wrench to the proper torque  
specification after replacing. Follow the torque  
specification supplied by the aftermarket  
manufacturer when using accessory locking wheel  
nuts. See Capacities and Specifications on  
page 6125 for original equipment wheel nut  
torque specifications.  
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing  
the Spare Tire (SS Model)  
The SS Model has larger performance brakes than the  
base model. The compact spare tire will not clear the  
front brakes.  
Notice: Improperly tightened wheel nuts can lead  
to brake pulsation and rotor damage. To avoid  
expensive brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel  
nuts in the proper sequence and to the proper  
torque specification. See Capacities and  
Specifications on page 6125 for the wheel nut  
torque specification.  
Do not use the compact spare tire in the event of a front  
flat tire.  
You must use the rear tire to replace the front flat tire.  
6-96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
To change the rear road tire:  
Rear Tire Changing Procedure  
1. Do a safety check before proceeding. See  
Changing a Flat Tire on page 688 for more  
information.  
3. Position the jack on the rear position and raise the  
jack lift head to fit over the car flange under the  
down arrow markings on the rocker panel.  
WARNING:  
{
2. Using the wheel wrench, loosen all the wheel nuts  
on the rear tire. Do not remove them yet.  
Getting under a vehicle when it is jacked up is  
dangerous. If the vehicle slips off the jack, you  
could be badly injured or killed. Never get under a  
vehicle when it is supported only by a jack.  
6-97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Raising your vehicle with the jack improperly  
positioned can damage the vehicle and even  
make the vehicle fall. To help avoid personal  
injury and vehicle damage, be sure to fit the jack  
lift head into the proper location before raising the  
vehicle.  
4. Raise the vehicle by turning the jack handle  
clockwise. Raise the vehicle far enough off the  
ground so there is enough room for the compact  
spare tire to fit underneath the wheel well.  
6-98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Remove all the wheel  
nuts and take off  
the tire.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
to the vehicle. In an emergency, use a cloth or a  
paper towel to do this; but be sure to use a  
scraper or wire brush later, if needed, to get all the  
rust or dirt off. See Changing a Flat Tire on  
page 688  
.
7. Remove any rust or dirt  
from the wheel bolts,  
mounting surfaces and  
spare wheel.  
6. Install the compact spare tire.  
WARNING:  
{
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to which it  
is fastened, can make wheel nuts become loose  
after time. The wheel could come off and cause  
an accident. When changing a wheel, remove any  
rust or dirt from places where the wheel attaches  
8. Place the compact spare tire on the  
wheel-mounting surface.  
(Continued)  
6-99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
WARNING:  
{
{
Never use oil or grease on bolts or nuts because  
the nuts might come loose. The vehicle's wheel  
could fall off, causing a crash.  
Wheel nuts that are improperly or incorrectly  
tightened can cause the wheels to become loose  
or come off. The wheel nuts should be tightened  
with a torque wrench to the proper torque  
specification after replacing. Follow the torque  
specification supplied by the aftermarket  
manufacturer when using accessory locking wheel  
nuts. See Capacities and Specifications on  
page 6125 for original equipment wheel nut  
torque specifications.  
9. Reinstall the wheel nuts with the rounded end of  
the nuts toward the wheel. Tighten each nut by  
hand until the wheel is held against the hub.  
Notice: Improperly tightened wheel nuts can lead to  
brake pulsation and rotor damage. To avoid  
expensive brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel  
nuts in the proper sequence and to the proper  
torque specification. See Capacities and  
Specifications on page 6125 for the wheel nut torque  
specification.  
10. Lower the vehicle by turning the jack handle  
counterclockwise. Lower the jack completely.  
6-100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
11. Tighten the wheel nuts  
firmly in a crisscross  
sequence as shown.  
To change the front flat tire:  
Front Tire Changing Procedure  
1. Perform a rear tire change by removing the rear  
tire and installing the compact spare tire in the rear  
wheel location. The rear road tire will be used to  
replace the front flat tire. See Rear Tire Changing  
Procedure in this section.  
2. Using the wheel wrench, loosen all the wheel nuts  
on the front flat tire. Do not remove them yet.  
6-101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING:  
{
Getting under a vehicle when it is jacked up is  
dangerous. If the vehicle slips off the jack, you  
could be badly injured or killed. Never get under a  
vehicle when it is supported only by a jack.  
WARNING:  
{
Raising your vehicle with the jack improperly  
positioned can damage the vehicle and even  
make the vehicle fall. To help avoid personal  
injury and vehicle damage, be sure to fit the jack  
lift head into the proper location before raising the  
vehicle.  
3. Position the jack on the front position and raise the  
jack lift head to fit over the car flange under the  
down arrow markings on the rocker panel.  
6-102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Remove all the wheel  
nuts and take off the  
flat tire.  
6. Install the tire.  
4. Raise the vehicle by turning the jack handle  
clockwise. Raise the vehicle far enough off the  
ground so there is enough room for the tire.  
6-103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
7. Remove any rust or dirt  
from the wheel bolts,  
mounting surfaces, and  
wheel.  
WARNING:  
{
Rust or dirt on a wheel, or on the parts to which it  
is fastened, can make wheel nuts become loose  
after time. The wheel could come off and cause  
an accident. When changing a wheel, remove any  
rust or dirt from places where the wheel attaches  
to the vehicle. In an emergency, use a cloth or a  
paper towel to do this; but be sure to use a  
scraper or wire brush later, if needed, to get all the  
rust or dirt off. See Changing a Flat Tire on  
8. Place the tire on the wheel mounting surface.  
page 688  
.
9. Reinstall the wheel nuts with the rounded end of  
the nuts toward the wheel. Tighten each by hand  
until the wheel is held against the hub.  
WARNING:  
{
Never use oil or grease on bolts or nuts because  
the nuts might come loose. The vehicle's wheel  
could fall off, causing a crash.  
6-104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
specification supplied by the aftermarket  
manufacturer when using accessory locking wheel  
nuts. See Capacities and Specifications on  
page 6125 for original equipment wheel nut  
torque specifications.  
Notice: Improperly tightened wheel nuts can lead to  
brake pulsation and rotor damage. To avoid  
expensive brake repairs, evenly tighten the wheel  
nuts in the proper sequence and to the proper  
torque specification. See Capacities and  
Specifications on page 6125 for the wheel nut torque  
specification.  
10. Lower the vehicle by turning the jack handle  
counterclockwise. Lower the jack completely.  
11. Tighten the wheel nuts  
firmly in a crisscross  
sequence, as shown.  
WARNING:  
{
Wheel nuts that are improperly or incorrectly  
tightened can cause the wheels to become loose  
or come off. The wheel nuts should be tightened  
with a torque wrench to the proper torque  
specification after replacing. Follow the torque  
(Continued)  
6-105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Storing the Flat Tire and Tools  
To store the flat tire:  
Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and  
Tools  
1. Open the liftgate. See Liftgate on page 313 for  
more information.  
WARNING:  
{
2. Put back all tools as they were stored in the rear  
storage compartment and put the compartment  
cover back on. For more information, see Storing  
the Compact Spare Tire and Toolsnext in this  
section.  
Storing a jack, a tire, or other equipment in the  
passenger compartment of the vehicle could  
cause injury. In a sudden stop or collision, loose  
equipment could strike someone. Store all these  
in the proper place.  
3. Install the cargo cover. For more information, see  
Rear Compartment Storage Panel/Cover on  
page 348  
.
4. Place the tire, lying flat, in the rear storage  
compartment.  
If there is a loop on the end of the strap used to  
secure the flat tire, go to Step 5. If there is not a  
loop, go to Step 8.  
6-106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
5. Route the loop end of  
the strap (C) through  
one of the cargo  
tie-downs (A) located in  
the rear of the vehicle.  
6. Route the hook (B) through the loop (C).  
7. Pull the strap to tighten it around the cargo  
tie-down (A).  
Aluminum Wheel  
6-107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
9. Attach the strap to the  
cargo tie-downs in the  
rear of the vehicle.  
10. Slide the buckle to tighten the tie-down strap.  
Steel Wheel  
8. Route the hook end of the strap through the wheel.  
6-108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
1. Open the liftgate. See Liftgate on page 313 for  
Storing the Compact Spare Tire and  
Tools  
Use the diagram as a guide for storing the compact  
spare tire once you are done using it.  
more information.  
2. Install the strap (F) on the floor of the spare tire  
compartment.  
3. Place the jack and wheel wrench (E) over the  
bolt (G), making sure the strap is securely stored,  
under the jack and wheel wrench.  
4. Secure the jack and wheel wrench (E) with the  
wing nut (D).  
5. With the valve stem up, place the spare tire (C) on  
the compartment floor.  
6. Make sure the bolt (G) passes through the wheel  
center.  
7. Install the spare tire cover (B).  
8. Secure the spare tire and tools with the  
retainer (A).  
The compact spare tire storage area is designed only  
for the compact spare tire, the standard tire cannot be  
stored there.  
A. Retainer  
B. Cover  
E. Jack and Wheel  
Wrench  
F. Strap  
G. Bolt  
C. Spare Tire  
D. Wing Nut  
6-109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
distances up to 3,000 miles (5 000 km), so you can  
finish your trip and have the full-size tire repaired or  
replaced at your convenience. Of course, it is best to  
replace the spare with a full-size tire as soon as  
possible. The spare tire will last longer and be in good  
shape in case it is needed again.  
Compact Spare Tire  
WARNING:  
{
Driving with more than one compact spare tire at  
a time could result in loss of braking and handling.  
This could lead to a crash and you or others could  
be injured. Use only one compact spare tire at  
a time.  
Notice: When the compact spare is installed, do not  
take the vehicle through an automatic car wash with  
guide rails. The compact spare can get caught on  
the rails which can damage the tire, wheel and other  
parts of the vehicle.  
Do not use the compact spare on other vehicles.  
If this vehicle has a compact spare tire it was fully  
inflated when the vehicle was new, however, it can lose  
air after a time. Check the inflation pressure regularly.  
It should be 60 psi (420 kPa).  
Do not mix the compact spare tire or wheel with other  
wheels or tires. They will not fit. Keep the spare tire and  
its wheel together.  
Notice: Tire chains will not fit the compact spare.  
Using them can damage the vehicle and can  
damage the chains too. Do not use tire chains on  
the compact spare.  
After installing the compact spare on the vehicle, stop  
as soon as possible and make sure the spare tire is  
correctly inflated. The compact spare is made to  
perform well at speeds up to 65 mph (105 km/h) for  
6-110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Using abrasive cleaners when cleaning  
glass surfaces on the vehicle, could scratch the  
glass and/or cause damage to the rear window  
defogger. When cleaning the glass on the vehicle,  
use only a soft cloth and glass cleaner.  
Appearance Care  
Interior Cleaning  
The vehicle's interior will continue to look its best if it is  
cleaned often. Although not always visible, dust and dirt  
can accumulate on the upholstery. Dirt can damage  
carpet, fabric, leather, and plastic surfaces. Regular  
vacuuming is recommended to remove particles from  
the upholstery. It is important to keep the upholstery  
from becoming and remaining heavily soiled. Soils  
should be removed as quickly as possible. The  
vehicle's interior may experience extremes of heat that  
could cause stains to set rapidly.  
Many cleaners contain solvents that may become  
concentrated in the vehicle's breathing space. Before  
using cleaners, read and adhere to all safety  
instructions on the label. While cleaning the vehicle's  
interior, maintain adequate ventilation by opening the  
vehicle's doors and windows.  
Dust may be removed from small buttons and knobs  
using a small brush with soft bristles.  
Products that remove odors from the vehicle's  
upholstery and clean the vehicle's glass can be  
obtained from your dealer/retailer.  
Lighter colored interiors may require more frequent  
cleaning. Use care because newspapers and garments  
that transfer color to home furnishings may also transfer  
color to the vehicle's interior.  
Do not clean the vehicle using:  
.
A knife or any other sharp object to remove a soil  
from any interior surface.  
When cleaning the vehicle's interior, only use cleaners  
specifically designed for the surfaces being cleaned.  
Permanent damage may result from using cleaners on  
surfaces for which they were not intended. Use glass  
cleaner only on glass. Remove any accidental  
.
.
A stiff brush. It can cause damage to the vehicle's  
interior surfaces.  
Heavy pressure or aggressive rubbing with a  
cleaning cloth. Use of heavy pressure can damage  
the interior and does not improve the effectiveness  
of soil removal.  
over-spray from other surfaces immediately. To prevent  
over-spray, apply cleaner directly to the cleaning cloth.  
6-111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Laundry detergents or dishwashing soaps with  
degreasers can leave residue that streaks and  
attracts dirt. For liquid cleaners, about 20 drops per  
gallon (3.78 L) of water is a good guide. Use only  
mild, neutral-pH soaps.  
To clean:  
1. Saturate a lint-free, clean white cloth with water or  
club soda.  
2. Wring the cloth to remove excess moisture.  
.
.
3. Start on the outside edge of the soil and gently rub  
toward the center. Continue cleaning, using a clean  
area of the cloth each time it becomes soiled.  
Too much cleaner that saturates the upholstery.  
Organic solvents such as naptha, alcohol, etc. that  
can damage the vehicle's interior.  
4. Continue to gently rub the soiled area until the  
cleaning cloth remains clean.  
Fabric/Carpet  
5. If the soil is not completely removed, use a mild  
soap solution and repeat the cleaning process that  
was used with plain water.  
Use a vacuum cleaner with a soft brush attachment  
frequently to remove dust and loose dirt. A canister  
vacuum with a beater bar in the nozzle may only be  
used on floor carpet and carpeted floor mats. For any  
soil, always try to remove it first with plain water or club  
soda. Before cleaning, gently remove as much of the  
soil as possible using one of the following techniques:  
If any of the soil remains, a commercial fabric cleaner or  
spot lifter may be necessary. When a commercial  
upholstery cleaner or spot lifter is to be used, test a  
small hidden area for colorfastness first. If the locally  
cleaned area gives any impression that a ring formation  
may result, clean the entire surface.  
.
For liquids: gently blot the remaining soil with a  
paper towel. Allow the soil to absorb into the paper  
towel until no more can be removed.  
After the cleaning process has been completed, a paper  
towel can be used to blot excess moisture from the  
fabric or carpet.  
.
For solid dry soils: remove as much as possible  
and then vacuum.  
6-112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
commercial cleaners and coatings that are sold to  
preserve and protect soft plastic surfaces may  
permanently change the appearance and feel of the  
interior and are not recommended. Do not use silicone  
or wax-based products, or those containing organic  
solvents to clean the vehicle's interior because they  
can alter the appearance by increasing the gloss in a  
non-uniform manner.  
Leather  
A soft cloth dampened with water can be used to  
remove dust. If a more thorough cleaning is necessary,  
a soft cloth dampened with a mild soap solution can  
be used. Allow the leather to dry naturally. Do not use  
heat to dry. Never use steam to clean leather. Never  
use spot lifters or spot removers on leather. Many  
commercial leather cleaners and coatings that are  
sold to preserve and protect leather may permanently  
change the appearance and feel of the leather and are  
not recommended. Do not use silicone or wax-based  
products, or those containing organic solvents to  
clean the vehicle's interior because they can alter the  
appearance by increasing the gloss in a non-uniform  
manner. Never use shoe polish on leather.  
Some commercial products may increase gloss on the  
instrument panel. The increase in gloss may cause  
annoying reflections in the windshield and even make it  
difficult to see through the windshield under certain  
conditions.  
Care of Safety Belts  
Keep belts clean and dry.  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other  
Plastic Surfaces  
A soft cloth dampened with water may be used to  
remove dust. If a more thorough cleaning is necessary,  
a clean soft cloth dampened with a mild soap solution  
can be used to gently remove dust and dirt. Never  
use spot lifters or removers on plastic surfaces. Many  
WARNING:  
{
Do not bleach or dye safety belts. It may severely  
weaken them. In a crash, they might not be able  
to provide adequate protection. Clean safety belts  
only with mild soap and lukewarm water.  
6-113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Rinse the vehicle well, before washing and after to  
remove all cleaning agents completely. If they are  
allowed to dry on the surface, they could stain.  
Weatherstrips  
Silicone grease on weatherstrips will make them last  
longer, seal better, and not stick or squeak. Apply  
silicone grease with a clean cloth. During very cold,  
damp weather frequent application may be required.  
See Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
Dry the finish with a soft, clean chamois or an all-cotton  
towel to avoid surface scratches and water spotting.  
High pressure car washes may cause water to enter the  
vehicle. Avoid using high pressure washes closer than  
12 inches (30 cm) to the surface of the vehicle. Use of  
power washers exceeding 1,200 psi (8 274 kPa) can  
result in damage or removal of paint and decals.  
page 710  
.
Washing Your Vehicle  
The best way to preserve the vehicle's finish is to keep  
it clean by washing it often.  
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses  
Use only lukewarm or cold water, a soft cloth and a car  
washing soap to clean exterior lamps and lenses.  
Follow instructions under Washing Your Vehicle on  
Notice: Certain cleaners contain chemicals that can  
damage the emblems or nameplates on the vehicle.  
Check the cleaning product label. If it states that it  
should not be used on plastic parts, do not use it on  
the vehicle or damage may occur and it would not  
be covered by the warranty.  
page 6114  
.
Finish Care  
Do not wash the vehicle in direct sunlight. Use a car  
washing soap. Do not use cleaning agents that are  
petroleum based or that contain acid or abrasives, as  
they can damage the paint, metal or plastic on the  
vehicle. Approved cleaning products can be obtained  
from your dealer/retailer. Follow all manufacturers'  
directions regarding correct product usage, necessary  
safety precautions and appropriate disposal of any  
vehicle care product.  
Occasional waxing or mild polishing of the vehicle by  
hand may be necessary to remove residue from the  
paint finish. Approved cleaning products can be  
obtained from your dealer/retailer.  
If the vehicle has a basecoat/clearcoat paint finish, the  
clearcoat gives more depth and gloss to the colored  
basecoat. Always use waxes and polishes that are  
non-abrasive and made for a basecoat/clearcoat paint  
finish.  
6-114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Notice: Machine compounding or aggressive  
polishing on a basecoat/clearcoat paint finish may  
damage it. Use only non-abrasive waxes and  
polishes that are made for a basecoat/clearcoat  
paint finish on the vehicle.  
Use special care with aluminum trim. To avoid  
damaging protective trim, never use auto or chrome  
polish, steam or caustic soap to clean aluminum.  
A coating of wax, rubbed to high polish, is  
recommended for all bright metal parts.  
Foreign materials such as calcium chloride and other  
salts, ice melting agents, road oil and tar, tree sap, bird  
droppings, chemicals from industrial chimneys, etc., can  
damage the vehicle's finish if they remain on painted  
surfaces. Wash the vehicle as soon as possible.  
If necessary, use non-abrasive cleaners that are  
marked safe for painted surfaces to remove foreign  
matter.  
Windshield and Wiper Blades  
Clean the outside of the windshield with glass cleaner.  
Clean the rubber blades using a lint free cloth or paper  
towel soaked with windshield washer fluid or a mild  
detergent. Wash the windshield thoroughly when  
cleaning the blades. Bugs, road grime, sap, and a  
buildup of vehicle wash/wax treatments may cause  
wiper streaking. Replace the wiper blades if they are  
worn or damaged.  
Exterior painted surfaces are subject to aging, weather  
and chemical fallout that can take their toll over a period  
of years. To help keep the paint finish looking new, keep  
the vehicle garaged or covered whenever possible.  
Wipers can be damaged by:  
.
Extreme dusty conditions  
Protecting Exterior Bright Metal Parts  
.
Sand and salt  
Bright metal parts should be cleaned regularly to keep  
their luster. Washing with water is all that is usually  
needed. However, chrome polish may be used on  
chrome or stainless steel trim, if necessary.  
.
Heat and sun  
.
Snow and ice, without proper removal  
6-115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The surface of these wheels is similar to the painted  
surface of the vehicle. Do not use strong soaps,  
chemicals, abrasive polishes, abrasive cleaners,  
cleaners with acid, or abrasive cleaning brushes on  
them because they could damage the surface. Do not  
use chrome polish on aluminum wheels.  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels  
and Trim  
The vehicle may have either aluminum or  
chrome-plated wheels.  
Keep the wheels clean using a soft clean cloth with mild  
soap and water. Rinse with clean water. After rinsing  
thoroughly, dry with a soft clean towel. A wax may then  
be applied.  
Notice: Using chrome polish on aluminum wheels  
could damage the wheels. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Use chrome polish  
on chrome wheels only.  
Notice: Chrome wheels and other chrome trim may  
be damaged if the vehicle is not washed after  
driving on roads that have been sprayed with  
magnesium, calcium or sodium chloride. These  
chlorides are used on roads for conditions such as  
ice and dust. Always wash the vehicle's chrome  
with soap and water after exposure.  
Use chrome polish only on chrome-plated wheels, but  
avoid any painted surface of the wheel, and buff off  
immediately after application.  
Notice: Driving the vehicle through an automatic  
car wash that has silicone carbide tire cleaning  
brushes, could damage the aluminum or  
chrome-plated wheels. The repairs would not be  
covered by the vehicle warranty. Never drive a  
vehicle that has aluminum or chrome-plated wheels  
through an automatic car wash that uses silicone  
carbide tire cleaning brushes.  
Notice: Using strong soaps, chemicals, abrasive  
polishes, cleaners, brushes, or cleaners that contain  
acid on aluminum or chrome-plated wheels, could  
damage the surface of the wheel(s). The repairs  
would not be covered by the vehicle warranty. Use  
only approved cleaners on aluminum or  
chrome-plated wheels.  
6-116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires  
Underbody Maintenance  
To clean the tires, use a stiff brush with tire cleaner.  
Chemicals used for ice and snow removal and dust  
control can collect on the underbody. If these are not  
removed, corrosion and rust can develop on the  
underbody parts such as fuel lines, frame, floor pan,  
and exhaust system even though they have corrosion  
protection.  
Notice: Using petroleum-based tire dressing  
products on the vehicle may damage the paint finish  
and/or tires. When applying a tire dressing, always  
wipe off any overspray from all painted surfaces on  
the vehicle.  
At least every spring, flush these materials from the  
underbody with plain water. Clean any areas where  
mud and debris can collect. Dirt packed in close areas  
of the frame should be loosened before being flushed.  
Your dealer/retailer or an underbody car washing  
system can do this.  
Sheet Metal Damage  
If the vehicle is damaged and requires sheet metal  
repair or replacement, make sure the body repair shop  
applies anti-corrosion material to parts repaired or  
replaced to restore corrosion protection.  
Original manufacturer replacement parts will provide the  
corrosion protection while maintaining the vehicle  
warranty.  
Chemical Paint Spotting  
Some weather and atmospheric conditions can create a  
chemical fallout. Airborne pollutants can fall upon and  
attack painted surfaces on the vehicle. This damage  
can take two forms: blotchy, ring-shaped discolorations,  
and small, irregular dark spots etched into the paint  
surface.  
Finish Damage  
Any stone chips, fractures or deep scratches in the  
finish should be repaired right away. Bare metal will  
corrode quickly and may develop into major repair  
expense.  
Although no defect in the paint job causes this, we will  
repair, at no charge to the owner, the surfaces of new  
vehicles damaged by this fallout condition within  
12 months or 12,000 miles (20 000 km) of purchase,  
whichever occurs first.  
Minor chips and scratches can be repaired with  
touch-up materials available from your dealer/retailer.  
Larger areas of finish damage can be corrected in  
your dealer's/retailer's body and paint shop.  
6-117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service Parts Identification Label  
This label, on the inside of the glove box, has the  
following information:  
Vehicle Identification  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
.
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
.
Model designation  
.
Paint information  
.
Production options and special equipment  
Do not remove this label from the vehicle.  
Electrical System  
This legal identifier is in the front corner of the  
instrument panel, on the driver side. It can be seen  
through the windshield from outside. The VIN also  
appears on the Vehicle Certification and Service Parts  
labels and certificates of title and registration.  
Add-On Electrical Equipment  
Notice: Do not add anything electrical to the vehicle  
unless you check with your dealer/retailer first.  
Some electrical equipment can damage the vehicle  
and the damage would not be covered by the  
vehicle's warranty. Some add-on electrical  
equipment can keep other components from  
working as they should.  
Engine Identification  
The eighth character in the VIN is the engine code. This  
code identifies the vehicle's engine, specifications, and  
replacement parts. See Engine Specificationsunder  
Capacities and Specifications on page 6125 for the  
vehicle's engine code.  
Add-on equipment can drain the vehicle battery, even if  
the vehicle is not operating.  
6-118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The vehicle has an airbag system. Before attempting to  
add anything electrical to the vehicle, see Servicing  
Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on page 276 and  
Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle on  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers  
The wiring circuits in the vehicle are protected from  
short circuits by a combination of fuses, circuit breakers  
and fusible thermal links. This greatly reduces the  
chance of damage caused by electrical problems.  
page 277  
.
Headlamp Wiring  
Look at the silver-colored band inside the fuse. If the  
band is broken or melted, replace the fuse. Be sure you  
replace a bad fuse with a new one of the identical size  
and rating.  
The headlamp wiring is protected by fuses in the fuse  
block. An electrical overload will cause the lamps to turn  
off. If this happens, have the headlamp wiring checked  
right away.  
If you ever have a problem on the road and do not have  
a spare fuse, you can borrowone that has the  
same amperage. Just pick some feature of the vehicle  
that you can get along without like the radio or  
cigarette lighter and use its fuse if it is the  
Windshield Wiper Fuses  
The windshield wiper motor is protected by a circuit  
breaker and a fuse. If the motor overheats due to heavy  
snow, etc., the wiper will stop until the motor cools.  
If the overload is caused by some electrical problem,  
have it fixed.  
correct amperage. Replace it as soon as you can.  
There are two fuse blocks in the vehicle: the floor  
console fuse block and the engine compartment fuse  
block.  
There are also one or two fuses located at the back of  
the vehicle near the battery.  
Power Windows and Other Power  
Options  
Fuses in the fuse block protect the power windows.  
When the current load is too heavy, the fuse opens  
protecting the circuit until the problem is fixed.  
6-119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Floor Console Fuse Block  
The floor console fuse block is located on the  
passenger side of the floor console behind the forward  
panel. The panel has four clips, one in each corner. Pull  
the panel to disconnect the four clips, and access the  
fuses. Use the fuse puller to remove fuses.  
6-120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses  
Usage  
Fuses  
Usage  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
Fuse Puller  
Empty  
18  
Empty  
Electric Power Steering, Steering  
Wheel Control  
19  
Empty  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
Sunroof  
Empty  
Empty  
Empty  
Empty  
Amplifier  
Audio System  
XM Radio, OnStar™  
Cluster  
Ignition Switch, PASS-Key® III+  
Stoplamp  
Engine Control Module, Transmission  
Control Module  
25  
Heating, Ventilation, Air Conditioning,  
PASS-Key® III+  
10  
26  
27  
28  
29  
Door Locks  
Interior Lights  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
Empty  
Steering Wheel Control Illumination  
Empty  
Empty  
Airbag  
Empty  
Relays  
30  
Usage  
Climate Control System  
Empty  
Windshield Wiper  
Climate Control System, Ignition, Rear  
View Camera  
16  
17  
31  
32  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP)  
Power Windows  
6-121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Compartment Fuse Block  
The underhood fuse block is located on the driver side  
of the engine compartment. Lift the cover to access the  
fuse/relay block.  
Fuses  
Usage  
Body Control Module 3  
Starting System  
4
5
6
Body Control Module 2  
Notice: Spilling liquid on any electrical components  
on the vehicle may damage it. Always keep the  
covers on any electrical component.  
Rear Power Plug (Panel Van Only),  
Cooling Fan (SS only)  
7
8
Vacuum Pump  
Air Conditioning Clutch Diode  
Liftgate, Sunroof  
Empty  
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
20  
21  
22  
23  
25  
27  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
Rear Power Outlet (Panel Van Only)  
Fuel Pump  
Rear Wiper  
Mirror  
Air Conditioning  
Heated Seats (Option)  
Fuse Puller  
Empty  
Cigarette Lighter  
Power Outlet  
Fuses  
Usage  
Electric Power Steering  
Rear Defogger  
1
2
3
Daytime Running Lamps  
Empty  
Empty  
Emissions  
6-122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fuses  
36  
Usage  
Power Windows  
Fuses  
57  
Usage  
Antilock Brake System (Option)  
Windshield Wiper Diode  
Windshield Wiper  
37  
Power Seat (Option)  
58  
40  
Cooling Fan  
59  
41  
Engine Control Module  
Cam Phaser (Turbo Only)  
Engine Control Module, Transmission  
Antilock Brake System (Option)  
Injectors, Ignition Module  
Backup Lamps  
60  
Horn  
42  
61  
Antilock Brake System (Option)  
Instrument Panel, Ignition  
Driver Side High-Beam  
Canister Vent  
43  
62  
44  
63  
45  
64  
46  
65  
Driver Side Low-Beam  
Passenger Side Low-Beam  
Passenger Side High-Beam  
Parking Lamps  
47  
Heated Seat  
66  
49  
Windshield Washer Pump  
Fog Lamps (Option)  
67  
53  
69  
Sensing and Diagnostic  
Module (SDM)  
56  
6-123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Relays  
14  
Usage  
Rear Defogger Relay  
Air Conditioning Clutch  
Empty  
Relays  
52  
Usage  
Windshield Wiper  
15  
54  
Fog Lamps (Option)  
Horn  
16  
55  
17  
Rear Wiper  
68  
Parking Lamps  
18  
Liftgate Release  
Fuel Pump  
70  
Windshield Wipers  
Headlamp Low-Beam  
Headlamp High-Beam  
19  
71  
24  
Empty  
72  
26  
Powertrain  
A Center High-Mounted Stoplamp Relay, and a Rear  
Access Panel Door Interlock Relay (Panel Van only),  
are located underhood in front of the left shock tower.  
28  
Daytime Running Lamps  
Starting System  
Empty  
34  
35  
The Left Rear Access Panel Door Relay (Panel Van  
Only), and the Right Rear Access Panel Door Relay  
(Panel Van Only) are located in the rear of the vehicle  
behind the right rear quarter trim panel.  
38  
Empty  
39  
Windshield Washer Pump  
Rear Windshield Washer  
Cooling Fan  
48  
A Rear Power Plug mini fuse (Panel Van Only) is  
located near the battery in the rear of the vehicle.  
50  
51  
Run, Crank  
6-124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Capacities and Specifications  
The following approximate capacities are given in English and metric conversions. Please refer to Maintenance  
Replacement Parts on page 712 for more information.  
Capacities  
Application  
English  
Metric  
For the air conditioning system refrigerant charge  
amount, see the refrigerant caution label located  
under the hood. See your dealer/retailer for more  
information.  
Air Conditioning Refrigerant R134a  
Cooling System  
2.0L Engine  
9.2 qt  
7.4 qt  
8.7 L  
7.0 L  
8.0 L  
8.2 L  
4.7 L  
61.3 L  
2.2L Engine  
2.4L Engine with Automatic Transmission  
2.4L Engine with Manual Transmission  
Engine Oil with Filter  
8.5 qt  
8.7 qt  
5.0 qt  
Fuel Tank  
16.2 gal  
Transmission Fluid  
Automatic (Bottom Pan Removal)  
Manual 2.0L L4 Engine (Drain and Refill)  
Manual 2.2L L4 or 2.4L L4 Engine (Drain and Refill)  
Wheel Nut Torque  
7.0 qt  
2.0 qt  
6.6 L  
1.9 L  
1.7 qt  
1.6 L  
100 lb ft  
140 Y  
All capacities are approximate. When adding, be sure to fill to the approximate level, as recommended in this manual.  
6-125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Specifications  
Engine  
2.0L L4 Engine  
VIN Code  
Transmission  
Spark Plug Gap  
Automatic  
Manual  
M
0.035 in (0.90 mm)  
Automatic  
Manual  
2.2L L4 Engine  
2.4L L4 Engine  
B
V
0.040 in (1.01 mm)  
0.040 in (1.01 mm)  
Automatic  
Manual  
6-126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 7 Maintenance Schedule  
Maintenance Schedule . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . 7-10  
Maintenance Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12  
Engine Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13  
Maintenance Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-2  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3  
Owner Checks and Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8  
7-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
are driven on reasonable road surfaces within legal  
driving limits.  
Maintenance Schedule  
use the recommended fuel. See Gasoline Octane  
Introduction  
on page 66  
.
Notice: Maintenance intervals, checks, inspections,  
recommended fluids, and lubricants are necessary  
to keep this vehicle in good working condition.  
Damage caused by failure to follow scheduled  
maintenance might not be covered by the vehicle  
warranty.  
WARNING:  
{
Performing maintenance work on a vehicle can be  
dangerous. In trying to do some jobs, you can be  
seriously injured. Do your own maintenance work  
only if you have the required know-how and the  
proper tools and equipment for the job. If you  
have any doubt, see your dealer/retailer to have a  
qualified technician do the work. See Doing Your  
Own Service Work on page 64.  
As the vehicle owner, you are responsible for the  
scheduled maintenance in this section. We recommend  
having your dealer/retailer perform these services.  
Proper vehicle maintenance helps to keep the vehicle in  
good working condition, improves fuel economy, and  
reduces vehicle emissions for better air quality.  
Because of all the different ways people use vehicles,  
maintenance needs vary. The vehicle might need  
more frequent checks and services. Please read the  
information under Scheduled Maintenance. To keep the  
vehicle in good condition, see your dealer/retailer.  
At your dealer/retailer, you can be certain that you will  
receive the highest level of service available. Your  
dealer/retailer has specially trained service technicians,  
uses genuine replacement parts, as well as, up to date  
tools and equipment to ensure fast and accurate  
diagnostics.  
The maintenance schedule is for vehicles that:  
.
carry passengers and cargo within recommended  
The proper replacement parts, fluids, and lubricants to  
use are listed in Recommended Fluids and Lubricants  
on page 710 and Maintenance Replacement Parts on  
page 712. We recommend the use of genuine parts  
from your dealer/retailer.  
limits on the Tire and Loading Information label.  
See Loading the Vehicle on page 524.  
7-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Your dealer/retailer has trained service technicians  
who will perform this work and reset the system. If the  
engine oil life system is reset accidentally, service the  
vehicle within 5 000 km/3,000 miles since the last  
service. Reset the oil life system whenever the oil is  
changed. See Engine Oil Life System on page 623.  
Rotation of New Tires  
To maintain ride, handling, and performance of the  
vehicle, it is important that the first rotation service  
for new tires be performed when they have 8 000 to  
13 000 km (5,000 to 8,000 miles). See Tire Inspection  
and Rotation on page 669.  
When the Change Oil Soon message displays, certain  
services, checks, and inspections are required. The  
services described for Maintenance I should be  
performed at every engine oil change. The services  
described for Maintenance II should be  
Scheduled Maintenance  
When the Change Oil Soon Message  
Displays  
performed when:  
.
Change engine oil and filter. See Engine Oil on  
page 619. An Emission Control Service.  
Maintenance I was performed the last time the  
engine oil was changed.  
.
When the Change Oil Soon message displays, service  
is required for the vehicle as soon as possible, within  
the next 1 000 km/600 miles. If driving under the best  
conditions, the engine oil life system might not indicate  
the need for vehicle service for more than a year. The  
engine oil and filter must be changed at least once a  
year and the oil life system must be reset.  
It has been 10 months or more since the Change  
Oil Soon message has displayed or since the last  
service.  
7-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance I  
Maintenance II  
.
.
Change engine oil and filter. See Engine Oil on  
Perform all services described in Maintenance I.  
page 619. An Emission Control Service.  
.
Steering and suspension inspection. Visual  
.
Engine coolant level check. See Engine Coolant  
inspection for damaged, loose, or missing parts or  
on page 629  
.
signs of wear.  
.
.
.
.
.
.
Windshield washer fluid level check. See  
Windshield Washer Fluid on page 636.  
Engine cooling system inspection. Visual  
inspection of hoses, pipes, fittings, and clamps  
and replacement, if needed.  
Tire inflation check. See Inflation - Tire Pressure  
.
on page 663  
.
Windshield wiper blade inspection for wear,  
cracking, or contamination and windshield and  
wiper blade cleaning, if contaminated. See  
Windshield and Wiper Blades on page 6115. Worn  
or damaged wiper blade replacement. See  
Windshield Wiper Blade Replacement on  
Tire wear inspection. See Tire Inspection and  
Rotation on page 669.  
Rotate tires. See Tire Inspection and Rotation on  
page 669  
.
page 653  
.
Fluids visual leak check (or every 12 months,  
whichever occurs first). A leak in any system  
must be repaired and the fluid level checked.  
.
Body hinges and latches, key lock cylinders, and  
rear compartment hinges lubrication. See  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants on  
page 710. More frequent lubrication may be  
required when vehicle is exposed to a corrosive  
environment. Applying silicone grease on  
weatherstrips with a clean cloth makes them last  
longer, seal better, and not stick or squeak.  
.
2.2L and 2.4L Engines: Engine air cleaner filter  
inspection (vehicles driven in dusty conditions  
only). See Engine Air Cleaner/Filter on page 625.  
.
.
2.0L Engine: Engine air cleaner filter inspection.  
See Engine Air Cleaner/Filter on page 625.  
Brake system inspection (or every 12 months,  
whichever occurs first).  
.
Restraint system component check. See Checking  
the Restraint Systems on page 278.  
7-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
Passenger compartment air filter replacement (or  
every 12 months, whichever occurs first). More  
frequent replacement may be required if vehicle is  
driven regularly under dusty conditions.  
Once a Year  
.
Starter switch check. See Owner Checks and  
Services on page 78.  
.
.
Parking brake and automatic transmission P (Park)  
mechanism check. See Owner Checks and  
Services on page 78.  
2.2L and 2.4L Engines: Engine air cleaner filter  
inspection (vehicles not driven in dusty conditions).  
See Engine Air Cleaner/Filter on page 625.  
Automatic transmission shiftlock control system  
Additional Required Services  
At Each Fuel Stop  
check. See Owner Checks and Services on  
page 78  
.
.
.
Ignition transmission lock check. See Owner  
Checks and Services on page 78.  
.
Engine oil level check. See Engine Oil on  
page 619  
Engine coolant level check. See Engine Coolant  
on page 629  
.
Engine cooling system and pressure cap pressure  
check. Radiator and air conditioning condenser  
outside cleaning. See Cooling System on  
.
.
.
Windshield washer fluid level check. See  
Windshield Washer Fluid on page 636.  
page 628  
.
.
.
Exhaust system and nearby heat shields  
inspection for loose or damaged components.  
Once a Month  
.
Throttle system inspection for interference, binding  
or for damaged or missing parts. Replace parts as  
needed. Replace any components that have high  
effort or excessive wear. Do not lubricate  
Tire inflation check. See Inflation - Tire Pressure  
on page 663  
.
.
Tire wear inspection. See Tire Inspection and  
Rotation on page 669.  
accelerator or cruise control cables.  
7-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
40 000 km/25,000 Miles  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
240 000 km/150,000 Miles  
.
.
Fuel system inspection for damage or leaks.  
Engine cooling system drain, flush, and refill,  
cooling system and cap pressure check, and  
cleaning of outside of radiator and air conditioning  
condenser (or every 5 years, whichever occurs  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
80 000 km/50,000 Miles  
first). See Engine Coolant on page 629  
.
.
Engine air cleaner filter replacement. See Engine  
An Emission Control Service.  
Air Cleaner/Filter on page 625.  
.
Engine accessory drive belt inspection for fraying,  
excessive cracks, or obvious damage and  
replacement, if needed. An Emission Control  
Service.  
.
Automatic transmission fluid change (severe  
service only) for vehicles mainly driven in heavy  
city traffic in hot weather, in hilly or mountainous  
terrain, when frequently towing a trailer, or used for  
taxi, police, or delivery service. See Automatic  
Transmission Fluid on page 627.  
First Engine Oil Change After Every  
160 000 km/100,000 Miles  
.
Spark plug replacement. An Emission Control  
Service.  
7-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Scheduled Maintenance  
Service  
Maintenance I Maintenance II  
Change engine oil and filter. Reset oil life system.  
Engine coolant level check.  
Windshield washer fluid level check.  
Tire inflation pressures check.  
Tire wear inspection.  
Rotate tires.  
Fluids visual leak check.  
2.2L and 2.4L Engines: Engine air cleaner filter inspection (vehicles driven in dusty  
conditions only).  
2.0L Engine: Engine air cleaner filter inspection.  
Brake system inspection.  
Steering and suspension inspection.  
Engine cooling system inspection.  
Windshield wiper blades inspection.  
Body components lubrication.  
Restraint system components check.  
Passenger compartment air filter replacement.  
2.2L and 2.4L Engines: Engine air cleaner filter inspection (vehicles not driven in  
dusty conditions).  
7-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
down all the way to the floor. If the starter works  
when the clutch pedal is not pushed all the way  
down, your vehicle needs service.  
Owner Checks and Services  
Starter Switch Check  
Automatic Transmission Shift Lock  
Control System Check  
WARNING:  
{
When you are doing this inspection, the vehicle  
could move suddenly. If the vehicle moves, you or  
others could be injured.  
WARNING:  
{
When you are doing this inspection, the vehicle  
could move suddenly. If the vehicle moves, you or  
others could be injured.  
1. Before starting this check, be sure there is enough  
room around the vehicle.  
2. Firmly apply both the parking brake and the regular  
1. Before starting this check, be sure there is enough  
room around the vehicle. It should be parked on a  
level surface.  
brake. See Parking Brake on page 334.  
Do not use the accelerator pedal, and be ready to  
turn off the engine immediately if it starts.  
2. Firmly apply the parking brake. See Parking Brake  
3. For automatic transmission vehicles, try to start the  
engine in each gear. The starter should work only  
in P (Park) or N (Neutral). If the starter works in any  
other position, your vehicle needs service.  
on page 334  
.
Be ready to apply the regular brake immediately if  
the vehicle begins to move.  
3. With the engine off, turn the ignition to ON/RUN,  
but do not start the engine. Without applying the  
regular brake, try to move the shift lever out of  
P (Park) with normal effort. If the shift lever moves  
out of P (Park), contact your dealer/retailer for  
service.  
For manual transmission vehicles, put the shift  
lever in Neutral, push the clutch pedal down  
halfway, and try to start the engine. The starter  
should work only when the clutch pedal is pushed  
7-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ignition Transmission Lock Check  
While parked, and with the parking brake set, try to turn  
the ignition to LOCK/OFF in each shift lever position.  
WARNING: (Continued)  
.
room in front of the vehicle in case it begins to  
roll. Be ready to apply the regular brake at once  
should the vehicle begin to move.  
For automatic transmission vehicles, the ignition  
should turn to LOCK/OFF only when the shift lever  
is in P (Park). The ignition key should come out  
only in LOCK/OFF.  
.
For manual transmission vehicles, the ignition key  
should come out only in LOCK/OFF.  
Park on a fairly steep hill, with the vehicle facing  
downhill. Keeping your foot on the regular brake, set the  
parking brake.  
Turn the steering wheel to the left and to the right.  
It should only lock when turned to the right.  
.
To check the parking brake's holding ability: With  
the engine running and the transmission in  
N (Neutral), slowly remove foot pressure from the  
regular brake pedal. Do this until the vehicle is held  
by the parking brake only.  
Contact your dealer/retailer if service is required.  
Parking Brake and Automatic  
Transmission P (Park) Mechanism  
Check  
.
To check the P (Park) mechanism's holding ability:  
With the engine running, shift to P (Park). Then  
release the parking brake followed by the regular  
brake.  
WARNING:  
{
Contact your dealer/retailer if service is required.  
When you are doing this check, the vehicle could  
begin to move. You or others could be injured and  
property could be damaged. Make sure there is  
(Continued)  
7-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Recommended Fluids and  
Lubricants  
Fluids and lubricants identified below by name, part  
number, or specification can be obtained from your  
dealer/retailer.  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
50/50 mixture of clean, drinkable  
Engine Cooling water and use only DEX-COOL®  
System  
Coolant. See Engine Coolant on  
page 629  
.
DOT 3 Hydraulic Brake Fluid  
(GM Part No. U.S. 88863461, in  
Canada 88863462).  
Hydraulic Brake  
System  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
Engine oil which meets GM Standard  
GM6094M and displays the American  
Petroleum Institute (API) Certified for  
Gasoline Engines starburst symbol.  
DOT 3 Hydraulic Brake Fluid  
(GM Part No. U.S. 88863461, in  
Canada 88863462).  
Hydraulic Clutch  
System  
Engine Oil  
(2.2L and  
2.4L L4 engines) To determine the proper viscosity for  
Windshield  
Washer  
Optikleen® Washer Solvent.  
your vehicle's engine, see Engine Oil  
on page 619  
.
Chassis Lubricant (GM Part No.  
The engine requires a special engine  
oil meeting GM Standard GM4718M.  
Oils meeting this standard can be  
identified with the American  
Parking Brake U.S. 12377985, in Canada 88901242)  
Cable Guides or lubricant meeting requirements of  
NLGI #2, Category LB or GCLB.  
Manual  
Petroleum Institute (API) Certified for  
Gasoline Engines starburst symbol.  
Transmission DEXRON®-VI Automatic  
Engine Oil  
(2.2L and  
2.4L L4 engines)  
Transmission Fluid.  
(2.0L L4 engine) However, not all synthetic API oils  
with the starburst symbol will meet  
this GM standard. Look for and use  
only an oil that meets GM Standard  
GM4718M. For the proper viscosity,  
see Engine Oil on page 619.  
Manual  
Manual Transmission Fluid  
Transmission (GM Part No. U.S. 88862472, in  
(2.0L L4 engine) Canada 88862473).  
7-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
DEXRON®-VI Automatic  
Usage  
Fluid/Lubricant  
Automatic  
Transmission Transmission Fluid.  
Hood Latch  
Assembly,  
Secondary  
Lubriplate Lubricant Aerosol  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12346293, in  
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12346241, in  
Canada 10953474).  
Key Lock  
Cylinders  
Latch, Pivots, Canada 992723) or lubricant meeting  
Spring Anchor, requirements of NLGI #2,  
and  
Release Pawl  
Category LB or GC-LB.  
Chassis Lubricant  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12377985, in  
Manual  
Multi-Purpose Lubricant, Superlube  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12346241, in  
Canada 10953474).  
Transmission Canada 88901242) or lubricant  
Shift Linkage  
Hood and Door  
Hinges  
meeting requirements of NLGI #2,  
Category LB or GC-LB.  
Weatherstrip Lubricant  
(GM Part No. U.S. 3634770, in  
Canada 10953518) or  
Dielectric Silicone Grease  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12345579, in  
Canada 992887).  
Chassis Lubricant  
(GM Part No. U.S. 12377985, in  
Canada 88901242) or lubricant  
meeting requirements of NLGI #2,  
Category LB or GC-LB.  
Chassis  
Lubrication  
Weatherstrip  
Conditioning  
7-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Replacement Parts  
Replacement parts identified below by name, part number, or specification can be obtained from your dealer/retailer.  
Maintenance Replacement Parts  
Part  
GM Part Number  
ACDelco Part Number  
Engine Air Cleaner/Filter  
2.0L Engine  
15909459  
22731072  
12605566  
52493319  
2.2L and 2.4L Engines  
Engine Oil Filter  
A3054C  
PF457G  
CF125  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter  
Spark Plugs  
2.0L Engine  
12620540  
12625058  
41-108  
41-103  
2.2L and 2.4L Engines  
Wiper Blades  
Front 19.7 inches (50 cm)  
Rear 10.8 inches (27.4 cm)  
25882578  
22709463  
7-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine Drive Belt Routing  
Dotted line shows routing for vehicles without air  
conditioning.  
7-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Record  
After the scheduled services are performed, record the date, odometer reading, who performed the service, and the  
type of services performed in the boxes provided. Retain all maintenance receipts.  
Maintenance Record  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
Serviced By  
Services Performed  
7-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Record (cont'd)  
Serviced By Services Performed  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
7-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance Record (cont'd)  
Serviced By Services Performed  
Odometer  
Reading  
Date  
7-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Section 8 Customer Assistance Information  
Customer Assistance and Information . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-2  
Reporting Safety Defects . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13  
Reporting Safety Defects to the  
Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-4  
Customer Assistance for Text  
United States Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13  
Reporting Safety Defects to the  
Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5  
Customer Assistance Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5  
GM Mobility Reimbursement Program . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Roadside Assistance Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-6  
Scheduling Service Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8  
Courtesy Transportation Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9  
Collision Damage Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14  
Reporting Safety Defects to General Motors . . . 8-14  
Service Publications Ordering Information . . . . . 8-14  
Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Event Data Recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16  
Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Radio Frequency Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Radio Frequency Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
8-1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
We encourage you to call the toll-free number in order  
to give your inquiry prompt attention. Have the following  
information available to give the Customer Assistance  
Representative:  
Customer Assistance and  
Information  
.
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN). This is  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure  
available from the vehicle registration or title, or  
the plate at the top left of the instrument panel and  
visible through the windshield.  
Your satisfaction and goodwill are important to your  
dealer and to Chevrolet. Normally, any concerns with  
the sales transaction or the operation of the vehicle  
will be resolved by the dealer's sales or service  
departments. Sometimes, however, despite the best  
intentions of all concerned, misunderstandings can  
occur. If your concern has not been resolved to your  
satisfaction, the following steps should be taken:  
.
Dealership name and location.  
.
Vehicle delivery date and present mileage.  
When contacting Chevrolet, remember that your  
concern will likely be resolved at a dealer's facility.  
That is why we suggest following Step One first.  
STEP ONE: Discuss your concern with a member  
of dealership management. Normally, concerns can  
be quickly resolved at that level. If the matter has  
already been reviewed with the sales, service, or  
parts manager, contact the owner of the dealership  
or the general manager.  
STEP THREE U.S. Owners: Both General Motors  
and your dealer are committed to making sure you are  
completely satisfied with your new vehicle. However,  
if you continue to remain unsatisfied after following the  
procedure outlined in Steps One and Two, you can file  
with the Better Business Bureau (BBB) Auto Line  
Program to enforce your rights.  
STEP TWO: If after contacting a member of dealership  
management, it appears your concern cannot be  
resolved by the dealership without further help, in the  
U.S., call the Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center  
at 1-800-222-1020. In Canada, call General Motors  
of Canada Customer Communication Centre at  
The BBB Auto Line Program is an out of court program  
administered by the Council of Better Business Bureaus  
to settle automotive disputes regarding vehicle repairs  
or the interpretation of the New Vehicle Limited  
Warranty. Although you may be required to resort to  
this informal dispute resolution program prior to filing a  
court action, use of the program is free of charge and  
your case will generally be heard within 40 days.  
1-800-263-3777 (English), or 1-800-263-7854 (French).  
8-2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If you do not agree with the decision given in your case,  
you may reject it and proceed with any other venue for  
relief available to you.  
The program provides for the review of the facts  
involved by an impartial third party arbiter, and may  
include an informal hearing before the arbiter. The  
program is designed so that the entire dispute  
settlement process, from the time you file your  
complaint to the final decision, should be completed in  
about 70 days. We believe our impartial program offers  
advantages over courts in most jurisdictions because it  
is informal, quick, and free of charge.  
You may contact the BBB Auto Line Program using the  
toll-free telephone number or write them at the following  
address:  
BBB Auto Line Program  
Council of Better Business Bureaus, Inc.  
4200 Wilson Boulevard  
Suite 800  
For further information concerning eligibility in the  
Canadian Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP),  
call toll-free 1-800-207-0685, or call the General Motors  
Customer Communication Centre, 1-800-263-3777  
(English), 1-800-263-7854 (French), or write to:  
Arlington, VA 22203-1838  
Telephone: 1-800-955-5100  
dr.bbb.org/goauto  
This program is available in all 50 states and the  
District of Columbia. Eligibility is limited by vehicle age,  
mileage, and other factors. General Motors reserves the  
right to change eligibility limitations and/or discontinue  
its participation in this program.  
The Mediation/Arbitration Program  
c/o Customer Communication Centre  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Mail Code: CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
STEP THREE Canadian Owners: In the event that  
you do not feel your concerns have been addressed  
after following the procedure outlined in Steps 1 and 2,  
General Motors of Canada Limited wants you to be  
aware of its participation in a no-charge Mediation/  
Arbitration Program. General Motors of Canada Limited  
has committed to binding arbitration of owner disputes  
involving factory-related vehicle service claims.  
Your inquiry should be accompanied by the Vehicle  
Identification Number (VIN).  
8-3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
My GM Canada (Canada) www.gm.ca  
Online Owner Center  
My GM Canada is a password-protected section  
of www.gm.ca where you can save information on  
GM vehicles, get personalized offers, and use handy  
tools and forms with greater ease.  
Online Owner Center (U.S.) —  
www.gmownercenter.com/chevrolet  
Information and services customized for your specific  
vehicle all in one convenient place.  
Here are a few of the valuable tools and services you  
will have access to:  
.
Digital owner manual, warranty information,  
.
and more  
My Showroom: Find and save information on  
vehicles and current offers in your area.  
.
Online service and maintenance records  
.
My Dealers/Retailers: Save details such as  
address and phone number for each of your  
preferred GM dealers/retailers.  
.
Find Chevrolet dealers for service nationwide  
.
Exclusive privileges and offers  
.
Recall notices for your specific vehicle  
OnStar® and GM Cardmember Services Earnings  
summaries  
.
My Driveway: Access quick links to parts and  
.
service estimates, check trade-in values,  
or schedule a service appointment by adding the  
vehicles you own to your driveway profile.  
Other Helpful Links:  
.
My Preferences: Manage your profile and use tools  
and forms with greater ease.  
Chevrolet www.chevrolet.com  
Chevrolet Merchandise www.chevymall.com  
Help Center www.chevrolet.com/helpcenter  
To sign up, visit the My GM Canada section within  
www.gm.ca.  
.
FAQ  
.
Contact Us  
8-4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
From Puerto Rico:  
Customer Assistance for Text  
Telephone (TTY) Users  
1-800-496-9992 (English)  
1-800-496-9993 (Spanish)  
To assist customers who are deaf, hard of hearing,  
or speech-impaired and who use Text Telephones  
(TTYs), Chevrolet has TTY equipment available at  
its Customer Assistance Center. Any TTY user in the  
U.S. can communicate with Chevrolet by dialing:  
1-800-833-CHEV (2438). (TTY users in Canada can  
dial 1-800-263-3830.)  
From U.S. Virgin Islands:  
1-800-496-9994  
Canada Customer Assistance  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Customer Communication Centre, CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
gmcanada.com  
Customer Assistance Offices  
Chevrolet encourages customers to call the toll-free  
number for assistance. However, if a customer wishes  
to write or e-mail Chevrolet, the letter should be  
addressed to:  
1-800-263-3777 (English)  
1-800-263-7854 (French)  
1-800-263-3830 (For Text Telephone  
devices (TTYs))  
Roadside Assistance: 1-800-268-6800  
United States Customer Assistance  
Chevrolet Motor Division  
Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center  
P.O. Box 33170  
Overseas Customer Assistance  
Please contact the local General Motors Business Unit.  
Detroit, MI 48232-5170  
Chevrolet.com  
1-800-222-1020  
1-800-833-2438 (For Text Telephone  
devices (TTYs))  
Roadside Assistance: 1-800-CHEV-USA (243-8872)  
8-5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
The offer is available for a very limited period of time  
from the date of vehicle purchase/lease. For more  
details, or to determine your vehicle's eligibility, visit  
gmmobility.com or call the GM Mobility Assistance  
Center at 1-800-323-9935. Text telephone (TTY) users,  
call 1-800-833-9935.  
Mexico, Central America and  
Caribbean Islands/Countries  
(Except Puerto Rico and U.S. Virgin  
Islands) Customer Assistance  
General Motors de Mexico, S. de R.L. de C.V.  
Customer Assistance Center  
Paseo de la Reforma # 2740  
Col. Lomas de Bezares  
General Motors of Canada also has a Mobility Program.  
Call 1-800-GM-DRIVE (463-7483) for details. TTY users  
call 1-800-263-3830.  
C.P. 11910, Mexico, D.F.  
Roadside Assistance Program  
01-800-508-0000  
Long Distance: 011-52-53 29 0 800  
For U.S. purchased vehicles, call 1800CHEVUSA  
(18002438872); (Text telephone (TTY):  
18888892438).  
GM Mobility Reimbursement  
Program  
For Canadian purchased vehicles, call 1-800-268-6800.  
Service is available 24 hours a day, 365 days a year.  
Calling for Assistance  
When calling Roadside Assistance, have the following  
information ready:  
.
Your name, home address, and home telephone  
number  
.
Telephone number of your location  
This program, available to qualified applicants,  
can reimburse you up to $1,000 of the cost of  
eligible aftermarket adaptive equipment required  
for your vehicle, such as hand controls or a  
wheelchair/scooter lift.  
.
Location of the vehicle  
8-6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
.
.
Model, year, color, and license plate number of the  
vehicle  
Services Provided  
.
Emergency Fuel Delivery: Delivery of enough  
fuel for the vehicle to get to the nearest service  
station.  
Odometer reading, Vehicle Identification Number  
(VIN), and delivery date of the vehicle  
Description of the problem  
.
LockOut Service: Service is provided to unlock  
the vehicle if you are locked out. A remote unlock  
may be available if you have OnStar®. For security  
reasons, the driver must present identification  
before this service is given.  
Coverage  
Services are provided up to 5 years/100,000 miles  
(160 000 km), whichever comes first.  
.
In the U.S., anyone driving the vehicle is covered.  
In Canada, a person driving the vehicle without  
permission from the owner is not covered.  
Emergency Tow From a Public Road or  
Highway: Tow to the nearest Chevrolet dealer for  
warranty service, or if the vehicle was in a crash  
and cannot be driven. Assistance is also given  
when the vehicle is stuck in the sand, mud,  
or snow.  
Roadside Assistance is not a part of the New Vehicle  
Limited Warranty. Chevrolet and General Motors of  
Canada Limited reserve the right to make any changes  
or discontinue the Roadside Assistance program at any  
time without notification.  
.
Flat Tire Change: Service is provided to change  
a flat tire with the spare tire. The spare tire,  
if equipped, must be in good condition and  
properly inflated. It is the owner's responsibility for  
the repair or replacement of the tire if it is not  
covered by the warranty.  
Chevrolet and General Motors of Canada Limited  
reserve the right to limit services or payment to an  
owner or driver if they decide the claims are made too  
often, or the same type of claim is made many times.  
.
Battery Jump Start: Service is provided to jump  
start a dead battery.  
8-7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Trip Interruption Benefits and Assistance: Must  
be over 250 km from where your trip was started to  
qualify. General Motors of Canada Limited requires  
pre-authorization, original detailed receipts, and a  
copy of the repair orders. Once authorization has  
been received, the Roadside Assistance advisor  
will help you make arrangements and explain how  
to receive payment.  
Services Not Included in Roadside  
Assistance  
.
.
.
Impound towing caused by violation of any laws.  
Legal fines.  
Mounting, dismounting or changing of snow tires,  
chains, or other traction devices.  
.
.
Towing or services for vehicles driven on a  
non-public road or highway.  
Alternative Service: If assistance cannot be  
provided right away, the Roadside Assistance  
advisor may give you permission to get local  
emergency road service. You will receive payment,  
up to $100, after sending the original receipt to  
Roadside Assistance. Mechanical failures may be  
covered, however any cost for parts and labor for  
repairs not covered by the warranty are the owner  
responsibility.  
Services Specific to Canadian  
Purchased Vehicles  
.
Fuel delivery: Reimbursement is approximately  
$5 Canadian. Diesel fuel delivery may be  
restricted. Propane and other fuels are not  
provided through this service.  
.
Lock-Out Service: Vehicle registration is  
required.  
Scheduling Service Appointments  
When your vehicle requires warranty service, contact  
your dealer/retailer and request an appointment. By  
scheduling a service appointment and advising your  
service consultant of your transportation needs, your  
dealer/retailer can help minimize your inconvenience.  
.
Trip Routing Service: Detailed maps of North  
America are provided when requested either with  
the most direct route or the most scenic route.  
There is a limit of six requests per year. Additional  
travel information is also available. Allow three  
weeks for delivery.  
8-8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
If your vehicle cannot be scheduled into the service  
department immediately, keep driving it until it can be  
scheduled for service, unless, of course, the problem  
is safety-related. If it is, please call your dealership/  
retailer, let them know this, and ask for instructions.  
Transportation Options  
Warranty service can generally be completed while  
you wait. However, if you are unable to wait, GM  
helps to minimize your inconvenience by providing  
several transportation options. Depending on the  
circumstances, your dealer can offer you one of the  
following:  
If the dealer/retailer requests you to bring the vehicle for  
service, you are urged to do so as early in the work day  
as possible to allow for the same day repair.  
Shuttle Service  
Courtesy Transportation Program  
Shuttle service is the preferred means of offering  
Courtesy Transportation. Dealers may provide you  
with shuttle service to get you to your destination  
with minimal interruption of your daily schedule. This  
includes oneway or round trip shuttle service within  
reasonable time and distance parameters of the  
dealer's area.  
To enhance your ownership experience, we and our  
participating dealers are proud to offer Courtesy  
Transportation, a customer support program for vehicles  
with the New Vehicle Limited Warranty (Base Warranty  
Coverage period in Canada) and extended powertrain,  
and hybrid specific warranty in both the U.S. and  
Canada.  
Public Transportation or Fuel  
Reimbursement  
Several courtesy transportation options are available to  
assist in reducing your inconvenience when warranty  
repairs are required.  
If your vehicle requires overnight warranty repairs, and  
public transportation is used instead of the dealer's  
shuttle service, the expense must be supported by  
original receipts and can only be up to the maximum  
amount allowed by GM for shuttle service. In addition,  
for U.S. customers, should you arrange transportation  
through a friend or relative, limited reimbursement for  
reasonable fuel expenses may be available.  
Courtesy Transportation is not a part of the New Vehicle  
Limited Warranty. A separate booklet entitled Warranty  
and Owner Assistance Informationfurnished with each  
new vehicle provides detailed warranty coverage  
information.  
8-9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Claim amounts should reflect actual costs and be  
supported by original receipts. See your dealer for  
information regarding the allowance amounts for  
reimbursement of fuel or other transportation costs.  
General Motors reserves the right to unilaterally modify,  
change or discontinue Courtesy Transportation at any  
time and to resolve all questions of claim eligibility  
pursuant to the terms and conditions described herein  
at its sole discretion.  
Courtesy Rental Vehicle  
Your dealer may arrange to provide you with a courtesy  
rental vehicle or reimburse you for a rental vehicle that  
you obtain if your vehicle is kept for an overnight  
warranty repair. Rental reimbursement will be limited  
and must be supported by original receipts. This  
requires that you sign and complete a rental agreement  
and meet state/provincial, local, and rental vehicle  
provider requirements. Requirements vary and may  
include minimum age requirements, insurance  
Collision Damage Repair  
If your vehicle is involved in a collision and it is  
damaged, have the damage repaired by a qualified  
technician using the proper equipment and quality  
replacement parts. Poorly performed collision repairs  
diminish your vehicle's resale value, and safety  
performance can be compromised in subsequent  
collisions.  
coverage, credit card, etc. You are responsible for fuel  
usage charges and may also be responsible for taxes,  
levies, usage fees, excessive mileage, or rental usage  
beyond the completion of the repair.  
Collision Parts  
Genuine GM Collision parts are new parts made with  
the same materials and construction methods as the  
parts with which your vehicle was originally built.  
Genuine GM Collision parts are your best choice to  
ensure that your vehicle's designed appearance,  
durability, and safety are preserved. The use of  
Genuine GM parts can help maintain your GM New  
Vehicle Warranty.  
It may not be possible to provide a like-vehicle as a  
courtesy rental.  
Additional Program Information  
All program options, such as shuttle service, may not be  
available at every dealer. Please contact your dealer for  
specific information about availability. All Courtesy  
Transportation arrangements will be administered by  
appropriate dealer personnel.  
Recycled original equipment parts may also be used for  
repair. These parts are typically removed from vehicles  
that were total losses in prior crashes. In most cases,  
the parts being recycled are from undamaged sections  
8-10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
of the vehicle. A recycled original equipment GM part,  
may be an acceptable choice to maintain your vehicle's  
originally designed appearance and safety performance,  
however, the history of these parts is not known. Such  
parts are not covered by your GM New Vehicle Limited  
Warranty, and any related failures are not covered by  
that warranty.  
Insuring Your Vehicle  
Protect your investment in your GM vehicle with  
comprehensive and collision insurance coverage. There  
are significant differences in the quality of coverage  
afforded by various insurance policy terms. Many  
insurance policies provide reduced protection to your  
GM vehicle by limiting compensation for damage  
repairs by using aftermarket collision parts. Some  
insurance companies will not specify aftermarket  
collision parts. When purchasing insurance, we  
recommend that you assure your vehicle will be  
repaired with GM original equipment collision parts.  
If such insurance coverage is not available from your  
current insurance carrier, consider switching to another  
insurance carrier.  
Aftermarket collision parts are also available. These are  
made by companies other than GM and may not have  
been tested for your vehicle. As a result, these parts  
may fit poorly, exhibit premature durability/corrosion  
problems, and may not perform properly in subsequent  
collisions. Aftermarket parts are not covered by your  
GM New Vehicle Limited Warranty, and any vehicle  
failure related to such parts are not covered by that  
warranty.  
If your vehicle is leased, the leasing company may  
require you to have insurance that assures repairs with  
Genuine GM Original Equipment Manufacturer (OEM)  
parts or Genuine Manufacturer replacement parts. Read  
your lease carefully, as you may be charged at the end  
of your lease for poor quality repairs.  
Repair Facility  
We recommend that you choose a collision repair  
facility that meets your needs before you ever need  
collision repairs. Your dealer/retailer may have a  
collision repair center with GM-trained technicians and  
state of the art equipment, or be able to recommend a  
collision repair center that has GM-trained technicians  
and comparable equipment.  
8-11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
.
Gather the important information you will need from  
the other driver. Things like name, address, phone  
number, driver's license number, vehicle license  
plate, vehicle make, model and model year,  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), insurance  
company and policy number, and a general  
description of the damage to the other vehicle.  
If a Crash Occurs  
Here is what to do if you are involved in a crash.  
.
Check to make sure that you are all right. If you  
are uninjured, make sure that no one else in your  
vehicle, or the other vehicle, is injured.  
.
If there has been an injury, call emergency  
.
If possible, call your insurance company from the  
scene of the crash. They will walk you through the  
information they will need. If they ask for a police  
report, phone or go to the police department  
headquarters the next day and you can get a copy  
of the report for a nominal fee. In some states/  
provinces with no faultinsurance laws, a report  
may not be necessary. This is especially true if  
there are no injuries and both vehicles are  
driveable.  
services for help. Do not leave the scene of a  
crash until all matters have been taken care of.  
Move your vehicle only if its position puts you in  
danger or you are instructed to move it by a police  
officer.  
.
Give only the necessary and requested information  
to police and other parties involved in the crash.  
Do not discuss your personal condition, mental  
frame of mind, or anything unrelated to the crash.  
This will help guard against post-crash legal action.  
.
Choose a reputable collision repair facility for your  
vehicle. Whether you select a dealer/retailer or a  
private collision repair facility to fix the damage,  
make sure you are comfortable with them.  
Remember, you will have to feel comfortable with  
their work for a long time.  
.
If you need roadside assistance, call GM Roadside  
Assistance. See Roadside Assistance Program on  
page 86 for more information.  
.
If your vehicle cannot be driven, know where the  
towing service will be taking it. Get a card from the  
tow truck operator or write down the driver's name,  
the service's name, and the phone number.  
.
Once you have an estimate, read it carefully and  
make sure you understand what work will be  
performed on your vehicle. If you have a question,  
ask for an explanation. Reputable shops welcome  
this opportunity.  
.
Remove any valuables from your vehicle before it  
is towed away. Make sure this includes your  
insurance information and registration if you keep  
these items in your vehicle.  
8-12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Managing the Vehicle Damage Repair  
Process  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Reporting Safety Defects to the  
United States Government  
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect  
which could cause a crash or could cause injury  
or death, you should immediately inform the  
National Highway Traffic Safety Administration  
(NHTSA) in addition to notifying General Motors.  
In the event that your vehicle requires damage repairs,  
GM recommends that you take an active role in its  
repair. If you have a pre-determined repair facility of  
choice, take your vehicle there, or have it towed there.  
Specify to the facility that any required replacement  
collision parts be original equipment parts, either new  
Genuine GM parts or recycled original GM parts.  
Remember, recycled parts will not be covered by your  
GM vehicle warranty.  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open  
an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect  
exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall  
and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot  
become involved in individual problems between  
you, your dealer, or General Motors.  
Insurance pays the bill for the repair, but you must live  
with the repair. Depending on your policy limits, your  
insurance company may initially value the repair  
using aftermarket parts. Discuss this with your repair  
professional, and insist on Genuine GM parts.  
Remember if your vehicle is leased you may be  
obligated to have the vehicle repaired with Genuine  
GM parts, even if your insurance coverage does not  
pay the full cost.  
To contact NHTSA, you may call the  
Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at  
1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153);  
go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to:  
If another party's insurance company is paying for the  
repairs, you are not obligated to accept a repair  
valuation based on that insurance company's collision  
policy repair limits, as you have no contractual limits  
with that company. In such cases, you can have control  
of the repair and parts choices as long as cost stays  
within reasonable limits.  
Administrator, NHTSA  
1200 New Jersey Avenue, S.E.  
Washington, D.C. 20590  
You can also obtain other information about motor  
vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov.  
8-13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In Canada, call 1-800-263-3777 (English) or  
1-800-263-7854 (French), or write:  
Reporting Safety Defects to the  
Canadian Government  
If you live in Canada, and you believe that your  
vehicle has a safety defect, notify Transport Canada  
immediately, in addition to notifying General Motors of  
Canada Limited. Call them at 1-800-333-0510 or  
write to:  
General Motors of Canada Limited  
Customer Communication Centre, CA1-163-005  
1908 Colonel Sam Drive  
Oshawa, Ontario L1H 8P7  
Service Publications Ordering  
Information  
Transport Canada  
Road Safety Branch  
2780 Sheffield Road  
Ottawa, Ontario K1B 3V9  
Service Manuals  
Service Manuals have the diagnosis and repair  
information on engines, transmission, axle suspension,  
brakes, electrical, steering, body, etc.  
Reporting Safety Defects to General  
Motors  
In addition to notifying NHTSA (or Transport Canada)  
in a situation like this, please notify General Motors.  
Service Bulletins  
Service Bulletins give additional technical service  
information needed to knowledgeably service  
General Motors cars and trucks. Each bulletin contains  
instructions to assist in the diagnosis and service of  
your vehicle.  
Call 1-800-222-1020, or write:  
Chevrolet Motor Division  
Chevrolet Customer Assistance Center  
P.O. Box 33170  
Owner Information  
Detroit, MI 48232-5170  
Owner publications are written specifically for owners  
and intended to provide basic operational information  
about the vehicle. The owner manual includes the  
Maintenance Schedule for all models.  
8-14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
In-Portfolio: Includes a Portfolio, Owner Manual, and  
Warranty Booklet.  
Vehicle Data Recording and  
Privacy  
RETAIL SELL PRICE: $35.00 (U.S.) plus processing fee  
Without Portfolio: Owner Manual only.  
Your GM vehicle has a number of sophisticated  
computers that record information about the vehicles  
performance and how it is driven. For example, your  
vehicle uses computer modules to monitor and control  
engine and transmission performance, to monitor the  
conditions for airbag deployment and deploy airbags in  
a crash and, if so equipped, to provide antilock braking  
to help the driver control the vehicle. These modules  
may store data to help your dealer/retailer technician  
service your vehicle. Some modules may also store  
data about how you operate the vehicle, such as rate of  
fuel consumption or average speed. These modules  
may also retain the owners personal preferences, such  
as radio pre-sets, seat positions, and temperature  
settings.  
RETAIL SELL PRICE: $25.00 (U.S.) plus processing fee  
Current and Past Model Order Forms  
Technical Service Bulletins and Manuals are available  
for current and past model GM vehicles. To request an  
order form, specify year and model name of the vehicle.  
ORDER TOLL FREE: 1-800-551-4123  
Monday-Friday 8:00 AM - 6:00 PM  
Eastern Time  
For Credit Card Orders Only  
(VISA-MasterCard-Discover), visit Helm, Inc.  
on the World Wide Web at: helminc.com  
Or you can write to:  
Helm, Incorporated  
P.O. Box 07130  
Detroit, MI 48207  
Prices are subject to change without notice and without  
incurring obligation. Allow ample time for delivery.  
Note to Canadian Customers: All listed prices are  
quoted in U.S. funds. Canadian residents are to make  
checks payable in U.S. funds.  
8-15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Important: EDR data is recorded by your vehicle only if  
a non-trivial crash situation occurs; no data is recorded  
by the EDR under normal driving conditions and no  
personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and crash  
location) is recorded. However, other parties, such as  
law enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the  
type of personally identifying data routinely acquired  
during a crash investigation.  
Event Data Recorders  
This vehicle has an Event Data Recorder (EDR). The  
main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or  
near crash-like situations, such as an airbag  
deployment or hitting a road obstacle, data that will  
assist in understanding how a vehicle's systems  
performed. The EDR is designed to record data related  
to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short  
period of time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in  
this vehicle is designed to record such data as:  
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is  
required, and access to the vehicle or the EDR is  
needed. In addition to the vehicle manufacturer, other  
parties, such as law enforcement, that have the special  
equipment, can read the information if they have access  
to the vehicle or the EDR.  
.
How various systems in your vehicle were  
operating  
.
Whether or not the driver and passenger safety  
belts were buckled/fastened  
GM will not access this data or share it with others  
except: with the consent of the vehicle owner or, if the  
vehicle is leased, with the consent of the lessee; in  
response to an official request of police or similar  
government office; as part of GM's defense of litigation  
through the discovery process; or, as required by law.  
Data that GM collects or receives may also be used for  
GM research needs or may be made available to others  
for research purposes, where a need is shown and the  
data is not tied to a specific vehicle or vehicle owner.  
.
How far, if at all, the driver was pressing the  
accelerator and/or brake pedal  
.
How fast the vehicle was traveling  
This data can help provide a better understanding of the  
circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur.  
8-16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Navigation System  
Radio Frequency Statement  
If your vehicle has a navigation system, use of the  
system may result in the storage of destinations,  
addresses, telephone numbers, and other trip  
information. Refer to the navigation system operating  
manual for information on stored data and for deletion  
instructions.  
This vehicle has systems that operate on a radio  
frequency that comply with Part 15 of the Federal  
Communications Commission (FCC) Rules and with  
RSS-210/211 of Industry Canada.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
1. The device may not cause interference.  
2. The device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired  
operation of the device.  
Radio Frequency  
Identification (RFID)  
RFID technology is used in some vehicles for functions  
such as tire pressure monitoring and ignition system  
security, as well as in connection with conveniences  
such as key fobs for remote door locking/unlocking and  
starting, and in-vehicle transmitters for garage door  
openers. RFID technology in GM vehicles does not  
use or record personal information or link with any other  
GM system containing personal information.  
Changes or modifications to any of these systems by  
other than an authorized service facility could void  
authorization to use this equipment.  
8-17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
2 NOTES  
8-18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Antenna  
A
Fixed Mast . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-95  
Antenna, XMSatellite Radio Antenna System . . . 4-95  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-4  
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Appearance Care  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . .6-116  
Care of Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-113  
Chemical Paint Spotting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-117  
Cleaning Exterior Lamps/Lenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-114  
Fabric/Carpet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-112  
Finish Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-114  
Finish Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-117  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other Plastic  
Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-113  
Interior Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-111  
Leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-113  
Sheet Metal Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-117  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-117  
Underbody Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-117  
Washing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-114  
Weatherstrips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-114  
Windshield and Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-115  
Ashtray . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18  
Assistance Program, Roadside . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6  
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3  
Accessory Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25  
Accessory Power Outlets . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16  
Add-On Electrical Equipment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-118  
Additives, Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-7  
Adjustment  
Chime Level . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-95  
Air Cleaner/Filter, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25  
Air Conditioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18  
Air Filter, Passenger Compartment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21  
Airbag  
Adding Equipment to Your Airbag-Equipped  
Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-77  
Airbag System  
How Does an Airbag Restrain? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-67  
Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . 2-76  
What Makes an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-67  
What Will You See After an Airbag Inflates? . . . . . . 2-68  
When Should an Airbag Inflate? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-65  
Where Are the Airbags? . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-63  
Airbags  
Passenger Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Readiness Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
System Check . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-60  
i - 1  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Audio System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-60  
Audio Steering Wheel Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-92  
Radio Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-94  
Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61  
Theft-Deterrent Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-92  
XMSatellite Radio Antenna System . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-95  
Audio System(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-62  
Automatic Door Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Automatic Headlamp System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Automatic Transmission  
Braking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3  
Braking in Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-5  
Break-In, New Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-53  
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) . . . . . . . . 6-50  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
Headlamp Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-45  
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
Headlamps, Front Turn Signal, and Parking  
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28  
Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
License Plate Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-52  
Taillamps, Turn Signal, Stoplamps and  
Back-up Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-51  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-72  
B
Battery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-40  
Electric Power Management . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15  
Run-Down Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-15  
Belt Routing, Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13  
Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-82  
Boost Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Brake  
C
Calibration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41  
California  
Perchlorate Materials Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
California Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-7  
Camera, Rear Vision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-44  
Canadian Owners . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii  
Capacities and Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-125  
Emergencies . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-5  
Brakes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-37  
Antilock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-4  
Parking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
System Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
i - 2  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Carbon Monoxide  
Cleaning  
Engine Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Liftgate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21  
Care of  
Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-113  
Cargo, Rear Side Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
CD, MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-74  
Center High-Mounted Stoplamp (CHMSL) . . . . . . . . . 6-50  
Chains, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-77  
Charging System Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Check  
Engine Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Checking Things Under the Hood . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14  
Chemical Paint Spotting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-117  
Child Restraints  
Infants and Young Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children . . . . . . . . . . 2-45  
Older Children . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35  
Securing a Child Restraint in a Rear Seat  
Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53  
Securing a Child Restraint in the Right Front  
Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-56  
Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-41  
Where to Put the Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43  
Chime Level Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-95  
Cigarette Lighter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18  
Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-119  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels . . . . . . . . . . . .6-116  
Exterior Lamps/Lenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-114  
Fabric/Carpet . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-112  
Finish Care . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-114  
Instrument Panel, Vinyl, and Other Plastic  
Surfaces . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-113  
Interior . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-111  
Leather . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-113  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-117  
Underbody Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-117  
Washing Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-114  
Weatherstrips . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-114  
Windshield and Wiper Blades . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-115  
Climate Control System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18  
Outlet Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21  
Climate Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-14  
Clock, Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61  
Clutch, Hydraulic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28  
Collision Damage Repair . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Compact Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-110  
Compass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41  
Competitive Driving, Racing or Other . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17  
Compressor Kit, Tire Sealant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Content Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19  
Control of a Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-3  
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-51  
i - 3  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Coolant  
Door  
Automatic Door Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-29  
Engine Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Engine Temperature Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28  
Courtesy Transportation Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-9  
Cruise Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-8  
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Customer Assistance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-5  
Offices . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5  
Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-5  
Customer Information  
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Power Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Programmable Automatic Door Unlock . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Rear Side Cargo . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
Driver  
Seat Height Adjuster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Driver Information Center (DIC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
DIC Operation and Displays . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-46  
DIC Vehicle Personalization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54  
DIC Warnings and Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48  
Driving  
Service Publications Ordering Information . . . . . . . . 8-14  
Customer Satisfaction Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-2  
At Night . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17  
Before a Long Trip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19  
Defensive . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Drunk . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-2  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20  
In Rain and on Wet Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-18  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
Off-Road Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get it Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Winter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21  
Driving for Better Fuel Economy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24  
D
Damage Repair, Collision . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-10  
Data Recorders, Event . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Defensive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-2  
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Differential, Limited-Slip . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13  
Disc, MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-74  
Display  
Reconfigurable Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-41  
Doing Your Own Service Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-4  
Dome Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
i - 4  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Engine (cont.)  
E
Exhaust . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-39  
Oil . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
Overheating . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-34  
Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25  
Engine Oil  
Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) Active Light . . . . . 5-11  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) Indicator/  
Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Entry/Exit Lighting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Event Data Recorders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-16  
Extender, Safety Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34  
E85 Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-8  
EDR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Electrical Equipment, Add-On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-118  
Electrical System  
Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-122  
Floor Console Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-120  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-119  
Headlamp Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-119  
Power Windows and Other Power Options . . . . . .6-119  
Windshield Wiper Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-119  
Electronic Immobilizer  
PASS-Key® III+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
Electronic Immobilizer Operation  
PASS-Key® III+ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
Electronic Stability Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-6  
Electronic Stability Control Indicator Light . . . . . . . . . . 4-33  
Engine  
F
Filter  
Engine Air Cleaner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25  
Finish Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-117  
Fixed Mast Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-95  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-5  
Flashers, Hazard Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-77  
Flat Tire, Changing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-88  
Flat Tire, Storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-106  
Fluid  
Air Cleaner/Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-25  
Check and Service Engine Soon Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Compartment Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-16  
Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-29  
Coolant Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27  
Coolant Temperature Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Coolant Temperature Warning Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Cooling System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28  
Drive Belt Routing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-13  
Automatic Transmission . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27  
Windshield Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-36  
i - 5  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Fog Lamps  
G
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-13  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11  
Folding Seatback, Passenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9  
Front Console Storage Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-5  
Additives . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
California Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-7  
E85 (85% Ethanol) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-8  
Filling a Portable Fuel Container . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-13  
Filling the Tank . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-10  
Fuels in Foreign Countries . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-9  
Gasoline Octane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Gasoline Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Gauge . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Fuel Economy  
Gasoline  
Octane . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Specifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-6  
Gauges  
Boost . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Engine Coolant Temperature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Fuel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-40  
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
GM Mobility Reimbursement Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6  
H
Halogen Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
Hazard Warning Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-2  
Headlamp Wiring . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-119  
Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Aiming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-45  
Bulb Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
Daytime Running Lamps (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Headlamps, Front Turn Signal, and Parking  
Driving for Better . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-24  
Fuses  
Engine Compartment Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-122  
Floor Console Fuse Block . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-120  
Fuses and Circuit Breakers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-119  
Windshield Wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-119  
Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-48  
i - 6  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Headlamps (cont.)  
Instrument Panel  
High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Wiper Activated . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Heated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-6  
Heater . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-18  
Engine Coolant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-27  
Height Adjuster, Driver Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-5  
Hideaway Rear Storage Bins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-51  
Highbeam On Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
Highway Hypnosis . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-19  
Hill and Mountain Roads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-20  
Hood  
Checking Things Under . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-14  
Release . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-15  
Horn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19  
Hydraulic Clutch . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28  
Brightness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Storage Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Instrument Panel Cluster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-24  
Integrated Trailer Brake Control  
System (ITBC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-32, 5-40  
Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-2  
J
Jump Starting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-41  
K
Keyless Entry  
Remote (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-4  
Keyless Entry System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4  
Keys . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-3  
L
Labeling, Tire Sidewall . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-56  
Lamps  
I
Ignition Positions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-23  
Indicator/Warning LIghts  
Daytime Running (DRL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Dome . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
License Plate . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-52  
Malfunction Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Reading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Infants and Young Children, Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-38  
Inflation - Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-63  
i - 7  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28  
LATCH System for Child Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45  
Liftgate  
Locks  
Automatic Door Lock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Delayed Locking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-9  
Lockout Protection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
Power Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Programmable Automatic Door Unlock . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Loss of Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
Lower Anchors and Tethers for Children . . . . . . . . . . . 2-45  
Lumbar  
Carbon Monoxide . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-13  
Lighting  
Entry/Exit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
Lights . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Airbag Readiness . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-27  
Antilock Brake System (ABS) Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-31  
Brake System Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-30  
Charging System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Engine Coolant Temperature Warning . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-34  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) Active . . . . . . . . . 5-11  
Flash-to-Pass . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Fog Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
High/Low Beam Changer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Highbeam On . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
Oil Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38  
On Reminder . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-12  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Safety Belt Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26  
Security . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Up-Shift . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
Limited-Slip Differential . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13  
Loading Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Power Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6  
M
Maintenance Schedule  
Maintenance Record . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-14  
Maintenance Replacement Parts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12  
Owner Checks and Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-8  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-3  
Malfunction Indicator Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Manual Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-4  
Manual Transmission  
Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31  
Message  
DIC Warnings and Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48  
i - 8  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Mirrors  
Outside  
Automatic Dimming Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41  
Manual Rearview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41  
Outside Convex Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43  
Outside Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43  
MP3 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-74  
Convex Mirror . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43  
Power Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-43  
Owner Checks and Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-8  
Owners, Canadian . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iii  
P
N
Paint, Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-117  
Park  
Navigation System, Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Net, Convenience . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-51  
New Vehicle Break-In . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-22  
Shifting Into . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Shifting Out of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Parking  
Brake . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-34  
Over Things That Burn . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
Parking Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer  
O
Odometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Off-Road  
Recovery . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
Oil  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
Passenger Airbag Status Indicator . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-28  
Passenger Compartment Air Filter . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21  
Passenger Sensing System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-70  
Passing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-15  
Perchlorate Materials Requirements, California . . . . . .6-4  
Phone  
Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-19  
Engine Oil Life System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-23  
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-38  
Older Children, Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-35  
Online Owner Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-4  
OnStar® System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1-25  
Outlet Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21  
Outlets  
Bluetooth® . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-82  
Accessory Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-16  
i - 9  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Power  
Rear Compartment Storage Panel/Cover . . . . . . . . . . 3-48  
Rear Door Security Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Rear Side Cargo Door . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-12  
Rear Storage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-48  
Rear Vision Camera (RVC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-44  
Rear Window Washer/Wiper . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-7  
Rearview Mirrors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41  
Automatic Dimming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-41  
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-7  
Recommended Fluids and Lubricants . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-10  
Reconfigurable Performance Display (RPD) . . . . . . . 4-41  
Recreational Vehicle Towing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-30  
Reimbursement Program, GM Mobility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6  
Remote Keyless Entry (RKE) System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-4  
Remote Vehicle Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-7  
Removing the Flat Tire and Installing the  
Door Locks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-10  
Electrical System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-119  
Lumbar Controls . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6  
Retained Accessory (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25  
Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17  
Pregnancy, Using Safety Belts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34  
Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Navigation System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Radio Frequency Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Program  
Courtesy Transportation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-9  
Programmable Automatic Door Unlock . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-11  
Proposition 65 Warning, California . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-4  
Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-92, 6-96  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-89  
Replacement Bulbs . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-53  
Replacement Parts  
Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7-12  
Reporting Safety Defects  
Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14  
General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14  
U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13  
R
Racing or Other Competitive Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-17  
Radio Frequency  
Identification (RFID) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Statement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-17  
Radio(s) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-62  
Radios  
Reception . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-94  
Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61  
Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-92  
Reading Lamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-14  
i - 10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Restraint System Check  
Safety Defects Reporting  
Checking the Restraint Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-78  
Replacing Restraint System Parts After a  
Canadian Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14  
General Motors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14  
U.S. Government . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-13  
Safety Warnings and Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . iv  
Scheduled Maintenance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .7-3  
Scheduling Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-8  
Sealant Kit, Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78  
Seatback, Folding Passenger . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .2-9  
Seats  
Driver Seat Height Adjuster . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Head Restraints . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-2  
Heated Seats . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6  
Passenger Folding Seatback . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-9  
Power Lumbar . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-6  
Power Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-5  
Reclining Seatbacks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-7  
Split Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11  
Securing a Child Restraint  
Rear Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-53  
Right Front Seat Position . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-56  
Security  
Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-39  
Service . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-3  
Accessories and Modifications . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-3  
Adding Equipment to the Outside of the Vehicle . . . 6-5  
Doing Your Own Work . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-4  
Engine Soon Lamp . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Crash . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-79  
Retained Accessory Power (RAP) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25  
Ride Control Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5-6  
Electronic Stability (ESC) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-6  
Enhanced Traction System (ETS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13  
Roadside Assistance Program . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-6  
Rocking Your Vehicle to Get it Out . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Roof  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-52  
Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-50  
Running the Vehicle While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-40  
S
Safety Belts  
Care of . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-113  
Extender . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34  
How to Wear Safety Belts Properly . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-19  
Lap-Shoulder Belt . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-28  
Reminders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-26  
Safety Belts Are for Everyone . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-14  
Use During Pregnancy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-34  
i - 11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Service (cont.)  
Storage Areas (cont.)  
Parts Identification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-118  
Publications Ordering Information . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-14  
Scheduling Appointments . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-8  
Servicing Your Airbag-Equipped Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . 2-76  
Setting the Clock . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61  
Sheet Metal Damage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-117  
Shifting  
Glove Box . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Hideaway Rear Storage Bins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-51  
Instrument Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Rear . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-48  
Rear Compartment Storage Panel/Cover . . . . . . . . . 3-48  
Roof Rack System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-50  
Storing the Tire Sealant and Compressor Kit  
Out of Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-37  
Shifting Into Park . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-36  
Signals, Turn and Lane-Change . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4  
Spare Tire  
. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-87  
Stuck in Sand, Mud, Ice, or Snow . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-23  
Sun Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Sunroof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-52  
Compact . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-110  
Installing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-92, 6-96  
Removing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-89  
Storing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-106  
Specifications and Capacities . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-125  
Speedometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Split Folding Rear Seat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-11  
Start Vehicle, Remote . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3-7  
Starting the Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-25  
Steering . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13  
Steering Wheel Controls, Audio . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-92  
Steering Wheel, Tilt Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Storage Areas  
T
Tachometer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-25  
Taillamps  
Turn Signal, Stoplamps and Back-up Lamps . . . . . . 6-51  
Text Telephone (TTY) Users . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-5  
Theft-Deterrent Feature . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-92  
Theft-Deterrent Systems . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
Content Theft-Deterrent . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-19  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
PASS-Key® III+ Electronic Immobilizer  
Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-20  
Tilt Wheel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-3  
Time, Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-61  
Convenience Net . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-51  
Cupholders . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
Floor Console Storage Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-47  
i - 12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-54  
Aluminum or Chrome-Plated Wheels,  
Towing  
Recreational Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-30  
Towing a Trailer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-32, 5-40  
Your Vehicle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-29  
Traction  
Control System (TCS) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-9  
Limited-Slip Differential . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-13  
Traction System  
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-116  
Buying New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-72  
Chains . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-77  
Changing a Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-88  
Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-117  
Compact Spare . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-110  
Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-74  
If a Tire Goes Flat . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-77  
Inflation - Tire Pressure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-63  
Inspection and Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-69  
Installing the Spare Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-92, 6-96  
Pressure Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-35  
Pressure Monitor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-65  
Pressure Monitor System . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-64  
Removing the Flat Tire . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-92, 6-96  
Removing the Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-89  
Sealant and Compressor Kit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-78, 6-87  
Sidewall Labeling . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-56  
Storing a Flat or Spare Tire and Tools . . . . . . . . . . .6-106  
Terminology and Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-60  
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-74  
Wheel Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-76  
Wheel Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-76  
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-71  
Enhanced . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-32  
Transmission  
Fluid, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-27  
Fluid, Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-28  
Transmission Operation, Automatic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-28  
Transmission Operation, Manual . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-31  
Transportation Program, Courtesy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .8-9  
Turn and Lane-Change Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4  
Turn Signal/Multifunction Lever . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .4-4  
U
Uniform Tire Quality Grading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-74  
Up-Shift Light . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-29  
V
Vehicle  
Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-3  
Loading . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-24  
Parking Your . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-38  
i - 13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Vehicle (cont.)  
When It Is Time for New Tires . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-71  
Where to Put the Child Restraint . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2-43  
Windows . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-16  
Power . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-17  
Windshield  
Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-6  
Washer Fluid . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-36  
Wiper Blade Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-53  
Wiper Blades, Cleaning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-115  
Wiper Fuses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-119  
Wipers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-5  
Winter Driving . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5-21  
Wiper Activated Headlamps . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-11  
Wipers  
Remote Start . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-7  
Running While Parked . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-40  
Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .iv  
Vehicle Data Recording and Privacy . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8-15  
Vehicle Identification  
Number (VIN) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-118  
Service Parts Identification Label . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .6-118  
Vehicle Personalization  
DIC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-54  
Ventilation Adjustment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-21  
Visors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3-18  
W
Rear Washer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-7  
Warning Lights, Gauges, and Indicators . . . . . . . . . . . 4-23  
Warnings  
X
DIC Warnings and Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-48  
Hazard Flashers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-3  
Safety and Symbols . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .iv  
Wheels  
XM Radio Messages . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-80  
XMSatellite Radio  
Antenna . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4-95  
Alignment and Tire Balance . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-76  
Different Size . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-74  
Replacement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6-76  
i - 14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Big Agnes Camping Equipment Big House 4 User Manual
Black Box Network Card KV1308C User Manual
Boss Audio Systems Car Stereo System 865DBI User Manual
Bradford White Corp Water Heater TGHE 160I NX User Manual
Brocade Communications Systems Computer Hardware DCX 8510 4 User Manual
Campbell Hausfeld Air Compressor DG480100CK User Manual
Cannon All in One Printer K10376 MX712 User Manual
Canon Camera Lens SD850 IS User Manual
Casio Electronic Keyboard FZ 1 User Manual
Chariot Carriers Stroller 51100442 User Manual